MC Advanced Guide
MC Advanced Guide
MC Advanced Guide
m a k e m a n a g e m ove | m e d i a ™ Avid ®
Copyright and Disclaimer
Product specifications are subject to change without notice and do not represent a commitment on the part of Avid Technology,
Inc.
The software described in this document is furnished under a license agreement. You can obtain a copy of that license by
visiting Avid's Web site at www.avid.com. The terms of that license are also available in the product in the same directory as
the software. The software may not be reverse assembled and may be used or copied only in accordance with the terms of the
license agreement. It is against the law to copy the software on any medium except as specifically allowed in the license
agreement.
Avid products or portions thereof are protected by one or more of the following United States Patents: 4,746,994; 4,970,663;
5,045,940; 5,267,351; 5,309,528; 5,355,450; 5,396,594; 5,440,348; 5,452,378; 5,467,288; 5,513,375; 5,528,310; 5,557,423;
5,568,275; 5,577,190; 5,584,006; 5,640,601; 5,644,364; 5,654,737; 5,715,018; 5,724,605; 5,726,717; 5,729,673; 5,745,637;
5,752,029; 5,754,851; 5,799,150; 5,812,216; 5,852,435; 5,584,006; 5,905,841; 5,929,836; 5,930,445; 5,946,445; 5,987,501;
6,016,152; 6,018,337; 6,023,531; 6,058,236; 6,061,758; 6,091,778; 6,105,083; 6,118,444; 6,128,001; 6,134,607; 6,137,919;
6,141,691; 6,198,477; 6,201,531; 6,223,211; 6,249,280; 6,269,195; 6,317,158; 6,317,515; 6,330,369; 6,351,557; 6,353,862;
6,357,047; 6,392,710; 6,404,435; 6,407,775; 6,417,891; 6,426,778; 6,477,271; 6,489,969; 6,512,522; 6,532,043; 6,546,190;
6,552,731; 6,553,142; 6,570,624; 6,571,255; 6,583,824; 6,618,547; 6,636,869; 6,665,450; 6,678,461; 6,687,407; 6,704,445;
6,747,705; 6,763,134; 6,766,063; 6,791,556; 6,810,157; 6,813,622; 6,847,373; 6,871,003; 6,871,161; 6,901,211; 6,907,191;
6,928,187; 6,933,948; 6,961,801; 7,043,058; 7,081,900; 7,103,231; D392,269; D396,853; D398,912.
Other patents are pending.
This document is protected under copyright law. An authorized licensee of Avid Media Composer may reproduce this
publication for the licensee’s own use in learning how to use the software. This document may not be reproduced or
distributed, in whole or in part, for commercial purposes, such as selling copies of this document or providing support or
educational services to others. This document is supplied as a guide for Avid Media Composer. Reasonable care has been
taken in preparing the information it contains. However, this document may contain omissions, technical inaccuracies, or
typographical errors. Avid Technology, Inc. does not accept responsibility of any kind for customers’ losses due to the use of
this document. Product specifications are subject to change without notice.
Copyright © 2007 Avid Technology, Inc. and its licensors. All rights reserved.
The following disclaimer is required by Apple Computer, Inc.
APPLE COMPUTER, INC. MAKES NO WARRANTIES WHATSOEVER, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, REGARDING
THIS PRODUCT, INCLUDING WARRANTIES WITH RESPECT TO ITS MERCHANTABILITY OR ITS FITNESS FOR ANY
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE EXCLUSION OF IMPLIED WARRANTIES IS NOT PERMITTED BY SOME STATES. THE
ABOVE EXCLUSION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU. THIS WARRANTY PROVIDES YOU WITH SPECIFIC LEGAL RIGHTS.
THERE MAY BE OTHER RIGHTS THAT YOU MAY HAVE WHICH VARY FROM STATE TO STATE.
The following disclaimer is required by Sam Leffler and Silicon Graphics, Inc. for the use of their TIFF library:
Copyright © 1988–1997 Sam Leffler
Copyright © 1991–1997 Silicon Graphics, Inc.
Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this software [i.e., the TIFF library] and its documentation for any purpose
is hereby granted without fee, provided that (i) the above copyright notices and this permission notice appear in all copies of
the software and related documentation, and (ii) the names of Sam Leffler and Silicon Graphics may not be used in any
advertising or publicity relating to the software without the specific, prior written permission of Sam Leffler and Silicon
Graphics.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS-IS” AND WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR
OTHERWISE, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
IN NO EVENT SHALL SAM LEFFLER OR SILICON GRAPHICS BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, INDIRECT
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY KIND, OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE,
DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER OR NOT ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF DAMAGE, AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
2
The following disclaimer is required by Ray Sauers Associates, Inc.:
“Install-It” is licensed from Ray Sauers Associates, Inc. End-User is prohibited from taking any action to derive a source code
equivalent of “Install-It,” including by reverse assembly or reverse compilation, Ray Sauers Associates, Inc. shall in no event be
liable for any damages resulting from reseller’s failure to perform reseller’s obligation; or any damages arising from use or
operation of reseller’s products or the software; or any other damages, including but not limited to, incidental, direct, indirect,
special or consequential Damages including lost profits, or damages resulting from loss of use or inability to use reseller’s
products or the software for any reason including copyright or patent infringement, or lost data, even if Ray Sauers Associates
has been advised, knew or should have known of the possibility of such damages.
“This software contains V-LAN ver. 3.0 Command Protocols which communicate with V-LAN ver. 3.0 products developed by
Videomedia, Inc. and V-LAN ver. 3.0 compatible products developed by third parties under license from Videomedia, Inc. Use
of this software will allow “frame accurate” editing control of applicable videotape recorder decks, videodisc recorders/players
and the like.”
The following disclaimer is required by Altura Software, Inc. for the use of its Mac2Win software and Sample
Source Code:
©1993–1998 Altura Software, Inc.
Trademarks
888 I/O, Adrenaline, AirPlay, AirSPACE, AirSPACE HD, AirSpeed, AniMatte, AudioSuite, AudioVision, AutoSync, Avid,
Avid DNA, Avid DNxcel, Avid DNxHD, AVIDdrive, AVIDdrive Towers, Avid DS Assist Station, Avid ISIS,
Avid Learning Excellerator, Avid Liquid, Avid Mojo, AvidNet, AvidNetwork, Avid Remote Response, AVIDstripe, Avid Unity,
Avid Unity ISIS, Avid Xpress, AVoption, AVX, CamCutter, ChromaCurve, ChromaWheel, DAE, Dazzle, Deko, DekoCast, D-Fi,
D-fx, DigiDelivery, Digidesign, Digidesign Audio Engine, Digidesign Intelligent Noise Reduction, DigiDrive,
Digital Nonlinear Accelerator, DigiTranslator, DINR, DNxchange, do more, D-Verb, Equinox, ExpertRender, Face Robot,
FACE ROBOT, FieldPak, Film Composer, FilmScribe, FluidMotion, FXDeko, HIIP, HyperSPACE, HyperSPACE HDCAM,
IllusionFX, Image Independence, iNEWS, iNEWS ControlAir, Instinct, Interplay, Intraframe, iS9, iS18, iS23, iS36, IsoSync,
LaunchPad, Lightning, Lo-Fi, Magic Mask, make manage move | media, Marquee, Matador, Maxim, MCXpress,
Media Browse, Media Composer, MediaDock, MediaDock Shuttle, Media Fusion, Media Illusion, MediaLog, Media Reader,
Media Recorder, MEDIArray, MediaShare, MediaStream, Meridien, MetaSync, MissionControl, NaturalMatch, Nearchive,
NetReview, NewsCutter, Nitris, OMF, OMF Interchange, OMM, Open Media Framework, Open Media Management, PCTV,
Pinnacle MediaSuite, Pinnacle Studio, Pinnacle Systems, ProEncode, Pro Tools, QuietDrive, Recti-Fi, RetroLoop, rS9, rS18,
Sci-Fi, ScriptSync, SecureProductionEnvironment, Show Center, Softimage, Sound Designer II, SPACE, SPACEShift,
SpectraGraph, SpectraMatte, SteadyGlide, Symphony, TARGA, Thunder, Thunder station, Trilligent, UnityRAID, Vari-Fi,
Video RAID, Video Slave Driver, VideoSPACE, and Xdeck are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Avid Technology,
Inc. in the United States and/or other countries.Adobe and Photoshop are either registered trademarks or trademarks of
Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries. Apple and Macintosh are trademarks of Apple
Computer, Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. DVCPRO HD is a registered trademark of Matsushita Electric
Corporation of America.Windows is either a registered trademark or trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States
and/or other countries. All other trademarks contained herein are the property of their respective owners.
3
Adobe and Photoshop are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States
and/or other countries. Windows is either a registered trademark or trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States
and/or other countries. All other trademarks contained herein are the property of their respective owners.
Footage
Arri — Courtesy of Arri/Fauer — John Fauer, Inc.
Bell South “Anticipation” — Courtesy of Two Headed Monster — Tucker/Wayne Atlanta/GMS.
Canyonlands — Courtesy of the National Park Service/Department of the Interior.
Eco Challenge British Columbia — Courtesy of Eco Challenge Lifestyles, Inc., All Rights Reserved.
Eco Challenge Morocco — Courtesy of Discovery Communications, Inc.
It’s Shuttletime — Courtesy of BCP & Canadian Airlines.
Nestlé Coffee Crisp — Courtesy of MacLaren McCann Canada.
Saturn “Calvin Egg” — Courtesy of Cossette Communications.
“Tigers: Tracking a Legend” — Courtesy of www.wildlifeworlds.com, Carol Amore, Executive Producer.
'The Big Swell” — Courtesy of Swell Pictures, Inc.
Windhorse — Courtesy of Paul Wagner Productions.
GOT FOOTAGE?
Editors — Filmmakers — Special Effects Artists — Game Developers — Animators — Educators — Broadcasters — Content
creators of every genre — Just finished an incredible project and want to share it with the world?
Send us your reels and we may use your footage in our show reel or demo!*
4
Contents
5
Linking User Settings and Workspaces. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Switching Between Workspaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Deleting a Workspace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Assigning a Workspace Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Sharing Bins and Projects in an Avid Unity Environment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Understanding Avid Unity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Sharing Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Opening a Shared Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Working with Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Default Locking Mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Overriding the Default Locking Mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Restrictions and Limitations for Locked Bins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Suggestions for Improving Performance When Working with Shared Bins. . . . 72
Shared Bin and Project Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Shared Bin Lock Icon Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Drive Filtering in Networked Workflows. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Chapter 2 Using Tools. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Using the Tools Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Using the Deck Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Using the Command Palette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Understanding Button Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Mapping User-Selectable Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Using the Blank Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Mapping Modifier Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Mapping Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Activating Commands from the Command Palette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Using the Avid Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Using the Console Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Displaying System Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Reviewing a Log of Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Getting Information with the Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Using the Console Window to Access Network Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Using the Hardware Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
6
Using External Controllers as Editing Control Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Preparing Log Files for Import. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Converting Log Files with Avid Log Exchange (Windows) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Using Drag-and-Drop Conversion for Log Files (Windows) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Converting Log Files with Avid Log Exchange (Macintosh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Using Drag-and-Drop Conversion for Log Files (Macintosh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Compatible Log Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Understanding Avid Log Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Avid Log Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Global Headings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Column Headings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Data Entries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Sample Avid Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Creating Avid Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Double-Checking Log Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Transferring Bins from MediaLog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Transferring Bins (Windows) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Transferring Bins (Macintosh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Associating the Bin with Your Project. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Logging Directly into a Bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Tips for Logging Preroll, Logging Timecode, and Naming Tapes . . . . . . . . . . 112
Logging with Avid-Controlled Decks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Pausing the Deck While Logging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Using a Memory Mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Logging with Non-Avid-Controlled Decks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Setting the Pulldown Phase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Logging Film Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Displaying Film Columns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Entering Pulldown Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Determining the Pulldown Phase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Modifying the Pulldown Phase Before Capturing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Entering Frames-per-Second Rates for PAL Transfers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
7
Entering Key Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Entering Additional Timecodes (Option) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Entering the Ink Number (Option) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Entering Additional Film Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Modifying Clip Information Before Capturing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Exporting Shot Log Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Advanced Capture Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Capturing Across Timecode Breaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Selecting the Preroll Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Capturing to Multiple Media Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
General Settings for Capture. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Settings for Film and 24p Projects. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Disabling Video Resolutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Understanding Drop-Frame and Non-Drop-Frame Timecode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Preparing for Audio Input: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Creating Tone Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Using the Passthrough Mix Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Resizing the Passthrough Mix Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Monitoring Audio with the Passthrough Mix Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Changing an Audio Level in the Passthrough Mix Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Adjusting Pan Values in the Passthrough Mix Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Changing the Audio Hardware Calibration Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Calibrating Audio Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Calibrating Audio Output Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Using the Console Window to Check Audio Levels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Preparing for Video Input: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Limitation When Using Consumer Decks or Decks Without
Time-Base Correctors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Saving Video Input Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Saving a Custom Default Setting for the Video Input Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Adjusting Video Levels for Tapes Without Color Bars. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Using Function Keys When Capturing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
8
Special Capture Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Logging Errors to the Console Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Creating Subclips While Capturing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Creating Timed Subclips While Capturing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Adding Locators On-the-Fly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Naming a New Tape from the Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Controlling Decks from the Keyboard. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Mapping the Record Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Ejecting Tapes with a Button or Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Returning to the Previous Place in the Select Tape Dialog Box . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Understanding DV Capture Offset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Capturing DV Material with Offset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Delaying Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Live Capture with External Timecode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Capturing to the Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Patching When Capturing to the Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Capturing Video Without Pulldown into a 24p NTSC Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Remote Play, Capture, and Punch-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Selecting Remote Play and Capture Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Enabling Remote Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Enabling Remote Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Setting up Your System for Remote Punch-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Avid Serial Driver and Remote Play and Capture (Windows Only) . . . . . . . . . 176
Relinking Clips by Key Number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Modifying the Pulldown Phase After Capturing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
DV and HDV Scene Extraction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Setting Up DV and HDV Scene Extraction Before Capturing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Setting Up DV Scene Extraction After Capturing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Support for Panasonic VariCam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Importing Photoshop Graphics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Importing Single-Layer Photoshop Graphics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
9
Importing Multilayered Photoshop Graphics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Example of Multilayered Photoshop Graphics Import . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Support for Multilayered Photoshop Graphics Import. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Preserving Layer Effects in Multilayered Photoshop Graphics. . . . . . . . . 191
Importing Multilayered Photoshop Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Importing Media from XDCAM Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Connecting the XDCAM Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Working with XDCAM HD Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Playing XDCAM Media on an Avid Symphony . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Setting the XDCAM Import Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Importing XDCAM Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Automatically Importing Proxy Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
Importing All Proxy Media from an XDCAM Disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Copying XDCAM Proxy Media to a Local Drive or a Server. . . . . . . . . . . 200
Manually Importing XDCAM Media from the XDCAM Disc . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Importing Essence Marks as Locators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Editing the Proxy Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Batch Importing High-Resolution Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
Editing and Finishing High-Resolution Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Importing Editcam Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Importing Sequences from Pro Tools through Interplay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Advanced Bin Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Film Scene Workflow. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Displaying Custom Bin Views . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Customizing Bin Views in Text View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Saving a Custom Bin View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Assigning Colors to Bin Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Sifting Clips and Sequences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Sifting Timecodes or Keycode Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Locking and Unlocking Items in a Bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Selecting Offline Items in a Bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Selecting Media Relatives for an Object . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
10
Selecting Sources Used by an Object . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Selecting Unreferenced Clips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Using Text View: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Manipulating Bin Columns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Duplicating Bin Columns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Adding Customized Columns to a Bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Changing a Custom Bin Column Heading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Tracking Frames Based on File Name. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Managing Clip Information in Text View. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Moving Within Column Cells . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Modifying Clip Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Modifying Data Directly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Using the Modify Command to Modify Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Copying Information Between Columns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Copying Information from Another Cell in a Custom Column . . . . . . . . . . 234
Selecting a Film Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Tracking 3-Perf Counts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Selecting an Edgecode Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Sorting Clips in Text View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Displaying Timecodes in a 24p or 25p Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Frame Counting for Timecodes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Adding Timecode Columns to a Bin or the Media Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Adding Timecode Values to the Timecode Columns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Bin Column Headings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Working with Restricted Material. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Displaying or Outputting Restricted Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Disassociating Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Viewing Restriction Comments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Changing Restriction Comments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Searching the Database for Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Printing Bins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Preparing Digital Bars and Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Importing Color Bars and Other Test Patterns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
11
Creating Leader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Creating Video Leader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Creating Audio Leader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Using Panasonic DVCPRO P2 Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Panasonic P2 Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
P2 Files and Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Workflow for Editing with P2 Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Installing the Panasonic P2 Drivers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Preparing to Mount P2 Cards as Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Mounting P2 Cards as Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
Copying P2 Files to a FireWire or Network Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
Copying P2 Files to a Local Media Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Changing P2 Cards in the Card Reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Importing P2 Clips and Media Directly from a P2 Card
or a Copy of a P2 Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Dragging P2 Master Clips from the Media Tool to a Bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Working with Spanned Clips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
Sharing P2 Clips and Sequences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Exporting Your Clip or Sequence to a P2 Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Deleting P2 Clips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
Finding a Related Media File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
Relinking Media Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Relink Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
Relinking Clips to a New Project Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Relinking by Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Relinking to Selected Clips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
Relinking Consolidated Clips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Relinking Moved Projects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Unlinking Media Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Using Videotapes for Archiving and Restoring Media Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Archiving Media Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Archive to Videotape Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
12
Restoring an Archive from Videotape. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Lined Script Basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
Explanation of Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
Lining in the Digital Realm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
Script Integration Workflow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Using Script Integration in Video Projects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Script Window Basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Script Settings Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Importing a Script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Selecting Text Encoding for Scripts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Opening, Closing, and Saving the Script Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Displaying Clip and Sequence Information in a Script Window . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
Exploring the Script Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
Adjusting the Script Margins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
Manipulating Script Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Changing the Font of the Script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Selecting Text. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
Cutting, Copying, and Pasting Script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
Removing Script Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
Searching Through Script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
Using Page and Scene Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
Adding a Page or Scene Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
Changing a Page or Scene Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
Deleting a Page or Scene Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
Searching for a Page or Scene Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
Conducting a Text Search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
Linking Clips to the Script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
Interpolating Position for Script Integration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Manipulating Slates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Selecting Slates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Resizing Slates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Holding Slates On Screen in the Script Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
13
Hiding Slate Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
Showing One Take Per Slate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
Moving a Slate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
Deleting a Slate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
Manipulating Takes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
Selecting Takes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
Adding Takes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
Deleting Takes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
Displaying Take Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
Changing the Representative Frame for a Take . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
Loading Takes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
Playing Takes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
Adjusting Take Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
Indicating Off-Screen Dialog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
Using Color Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
Using Script Marks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Placing Script Marks Manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Using Real-Time Screening and Marking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
Marking with ScriptSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
Loading and Playing Marked Segments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
Moving a Script Mark. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
Deleting a Script Mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
Finding Clips and Script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
Finding Script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
Finding Clips and Bins from the Script Window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
Editing with the Script Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
Assembling a Rough Cut. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
Splicing a Script Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Revising the Script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Interactive Screenings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Chapter 9 Viewing and Marking Footage: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
Displaying the Info Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
Displaying Timecode in the Timecode Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
14
Adjusting the Play Delay Offset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
Using the Tool Palette. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329
Playing Selected Clips in a Loop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
Using Locators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Ways to Use Locators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Adding Locators While Editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
Finding Locators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333
Editing Locator Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333
Copying Locators from Source Clips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
Marking an Area Using Locators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
Moving to the Previous or Next Locator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335
Deleting Locators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335
Using the Locators Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335
Viewing Locators in the Locators Window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
Working in the Locators Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
Exporting and Importing Locators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
Creating a Locator Text (.txt) File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Copying and Pasting Locators Using the Locators Window . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Printing the Contents of the Locators Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
Chapter 10 Creating and Editing Sequences: Advanced. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343
User Preferences for Creating Tracks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
Using Phantom Marks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
Setting One Mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
Adding a Second Mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
Adding Comments to Sequence Clips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
Playback Performance Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
Playing a Limited Duration of a Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
Autosyncing Clips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
Understanding Autosyncing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
Creating an Autosynced Subclip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
Using the AutoSequence Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
Understanding AutoSequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
Adding Audio to Original Videotape Using AutoSequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
15
Resyncing Subframe Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
Understanding Subframe Resyncing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
Resyncing Audio for a Selected Subclip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
Managing Sync with Multiple Tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
Using Sync Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
Syncing with Tail Leader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354
Syncing with Locators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355
Using Add Edit When Trimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357
Ganging Footage in Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
Using Sync Point Editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
Synchronizing Metadata Using MetaSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361
Timeline Views: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
Displaying the Timeline Top Toolbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
Displaying Timecode Tracks in the Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
Assigning Local Colors to Clips in the Timeline. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363
Displaying Local and Source Colors in the Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
Changing the Timeline Background Color. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
Changing the Timeline Track Color . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
Showing Locators in the Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365
Navigating in the Timeline: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365
Using the Full-Screen Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365
Displaying Source Material in the Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367
IN to OUT Highlighting in the Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367
Using Advanced Timeline Techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368
Bin Editing into the Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368
Bin Editing Directly into a Sequence Using the Keyboard. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369
Editing with the Film Track . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370
Editing in Heads or Heads Tails View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
Performing a Quick Edit Using the Top and Tail Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372
Adding an Edit (Match Framing). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372
Adding Edits to Filler Clips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373
Removing Match-Frame Edits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
16
Detecting Duplicate Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
Adjusting Handle Length in Dupe Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376
Tracking Color Frame Shifts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
Finding Black Holes and Flash Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380
Printing the Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
Chapter 12 Working in Trim Mode: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
Creating Overlap Edits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
Extending an Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384
Maintaining Sync While Trimming. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386
Adding Black When Trimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386
Trimming with Sync-Locked Tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
Slipping or Sliding Segments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389
Selecting Segments for Slip or Slide Trimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390
The Four-Frame Slip/Slide Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
Performing the Slip or Slide Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
Slipping Shots in Source/Record Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
Using the Transition Corner Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397
Audio Gain Staging and an Audio Editing Workflow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
Rendering and Unrendering Order for Audio Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
Viewing Clip Gain and Automation Gain Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
Bypassing Existing Volume Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
About Adjusting Volume While Playing a Clip Gain Effect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
Adjusting Volume While Playing a Clip Gain Effect. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
Improving Response Time When Adjusting Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402
Using External Fader Controllers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402
Adjusting the Volume of Individual Keyframes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
Adjusting the Pan of Individual Keyframes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
Using an External Fader Controller or Mixer to Record Automation Gain . . . . 406
Using the Digi 002 and Command|8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407
Using the Digi 002 with Avid DNA Hardware (Windows Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
Using the Command|8 with Your Avid Editing System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
Configuring the Digi 002 or Command|8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
17
Mapping Buttons and Menu Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
Button Layouts on the Digi 002 and Command|8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
Using Buttons to Change Focus in the Avid Editing Application Interface 415
Using a Foot Pedal as a Foot Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
Switching Between the Digi 002 and Command|8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
Using a Digi 002 or Command|8 to Record Automation Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
Using the Latch Mode Feature on the Digi 002 and Command|8 . . . . . . . . . . 417
Configuring USB-to-MIDI Software for External Controllers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418
Installing USB-to-MIDI Software (Windows) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418
Installing USB-to-MIDI Software (Macintosh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
Testing the Fader Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
Switching Between MIDI Connections on the USB-to-MIDI Converter . . . . . . 421
Troubleshooting the MIDI Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421
Using the FaderMaster Pro and MCS-3000X. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422
MCS-3000X Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423
Using the Snap Mode Feature on the MCS-3000X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
Ganging Faders on the FaderMaster Pro . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425
Using the Yamaha 01V/96 or the Yamaha 01V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425
Setting Up the Yamaha 01V/96 or Yamaha 01V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425
Initializing the Yamaha 01V/96 or Yamaha 01V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426
Configuring the Yamaha 01V/96 or Yamaha 01V to Recognize Control
Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426
Starting the Avid System with the Yamaha 01V/96 or the
Yamaha 01V Attached . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428
Operating the Yamaha 01V/96 and Yamaha 01V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
Soloing Avid System Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 430
Using the Audio EQ Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 431
Audio EQ Tool Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 432
Applying Audio EQ Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
Saving Audio EQ Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437
Removing Audio EQ Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438
Audio EQ Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438
Low Shelf Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439
Small Octave Range Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
18
Using Audio EQ Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 441
Applying an EQ Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 441
Creating Your Own Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
Adding an EQ Template to the Audio EQ Tool Fast Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
Adjusting EQ While Playing an Audio Effect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443
Recording Voice-Over Narration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444
Connecting Voice-Over Recording Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444
Understanding the Audio Punch-In Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
Recording Voice-Over Narration Using Audio Punch-in. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
Monitoring Previously Recorded Tracks While Recording
Voice-Over Narration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 450
Using Peak Hold While Recording Voice-Over Narration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451
Using a GPI Device with the Audio Punch-In Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451
Understanding GPI Trigger Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452
GPI Signal Sequences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452
Example of Linking GPI Actions to Trigger Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
Connecting a V-LAN VLXi Controller and GPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
Configuring a V-LAN VLXi Controller and GPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 454
Working with GPI Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 454
Creating a GPI Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 455
GPI Settings Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 456
Editing a GPI Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 457
Deleting a GPI Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 457
Displaying Audio Formats in Bins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 458
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459
Understanding Digidesign AudioSuite Plug-Ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459
Installing AudioSuite Plug-Ins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459
Using Digidesign AudioSuite Plug-Ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 460
Applying an AudioSuite Plug-in to a Clip in the Timeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 461
Using an AudioSuite Plug-In Dialog Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 463
AudioSuite Fast Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 464
Rendering AudioSuite Plug-in Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 464
Creating New Master Clips with AudioSuite Plug-Ins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 464
19
AudioSuite Controls for Creating New Master Clips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 465
Mono, Stereo, and Multichannel Processing in AudioSuite Plug-Ins . . . . 467
Using AudioSuite Plug-ins to Create New Master Clips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468
Using AudioSuite Effect Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 469
Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins in Stereo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
AudioSuite Plug-in Limitations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
Troubleshooting AudioSuite Plug-Ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472
Chorus AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
D-Verb AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476
Compressor AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
Limiter AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479
Expander-Gate AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480
Gate AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482
DeEsser AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483
EQ AudioSuite Plug-Ins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
Flanger AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 489
Invert AudioSuite Plug-In. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 490
Duplicate AudioSuite Plug-In. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 490
Delay AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 491
Multi-Tap Delay AudioSuite Plug-In. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492
Normalize AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493
Gain AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493
Ping-Pong Delay AudioSuite Plug-In. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
Reverse AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
DC Offset Removal AudioSuite Plug-In. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495
Signal Generator AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495
Time Compression Expansion AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495
Pitch Shift AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 498
Time Shift AudioSuite Plug-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499
Non-Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 505
Exporting Using Send To Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506
20
Send To DigiDelivery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 507
Send To Digidesign Pro Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 509
Send to DVD Authoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512
Send to DVD One Step . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514
Send to Sorenson Squeeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517
Send To Avid DS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 518
Send To Third-Party Applications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521
Exporting OMFI and AAF Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523
Exporting Through OMF Interchange. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523
Exporting Through AAF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524
Selecting an OMFI or an AAF Transfer Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524
Exporting As an OMFI or an AAF File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 525
Guidelines for Exporting AAF Files to Pro Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527
Exporting Projects and Bins Using AFE Files (Windows Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529
Exporting Video in DV Stream Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530
Exporting QuickTime Movies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
Exporting As a QuickTime Movie . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534
Exporting As a QuickTime Reference Movie . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536
Using Avid Codecs for QuickTime . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538
Exporting As an AVI File (Windows Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
Installing or Copying the Avid Codecs for QuickTime on Other Systems . . . . . . . . 543
Exporting from a Third-Party QuickTime or AVI Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
Exporting as Windows Media (Windows Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
Exporting Using an Avid Supplied Template (Windows Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
Exporting Using an Existing Windows Media Profile (Windows Only) . . . . . . . 547
Exporting Using a Custom Profile (Windows Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
Creating a Custom Video Profile (Windows Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
Creating a Custom Audio Profile (Windows Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
Exporting Tracks As Audio Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552
Exporting As a Graphic File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 554
Exporting Media to XDCAM Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 556
Exporting to XDCAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 557
21
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561
Advanced Video Output Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561
Using Test Patterns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 562
Calibrating the System with Passthrough Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 562
Using the Digital Cut Tool: Advanced. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
Output Mode Resolution Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
Output Mode Resolutions with Progressive Projects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 566
Outputting DV 50 and DVCPRO HD Media Directly to a DV Device. . . . . . . . 567
Selecting Output and Timecode Formats for 23.976p, 24p, and 25p Projects 568
Selecting Output Formats for 23.976p, 24p, and 25p Projects. . . . . . . . . 568
Selecting the Timecode Format for Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 571
Outputting Drop-Frame and Non-Drop-Frame Timecode Simultaneously
for Downstream Encoding. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572
Indicating the Destination Timecode Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573
Performing an Insert Edit with Pulldown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573
Digital Cuts and Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 574
Changing the Default Pulldown Phase for Sequences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 575
Understanding DV Digital Cut Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 576
Delaying the Sequence for a Digital Cut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 577
Using EDL Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 578
Using the Matchback Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 578
How Matchback Works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 579
Matchback Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 580
Using FilmScribe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 580
Preserving Information in the Vertical Blanking Interval. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 580
Line Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581
Displaying and Preserving Vertical Blanking Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581
Editing a Sequence with VBI Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 583
Effects of Preserving Vertical Blanking Information on Compressed
Video Quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 584
Comparison with VBI on Meridien Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 585
Preserving HD Closed Captioning and Ancillary Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 586
22
Chapter 17 MultiCamera Editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 589
Understanding Grouping and Multigrouping Clips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 589
Creating Group Clips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 590
Creating Multigroup Clips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 592
MultiCamera Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 593
Full-Monitor Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 594
Quad Split Source View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 595
Nine Split Source View. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597
MultiCamera Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598
Real-time Playback in MultiCamera Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600
Limitations on Playback of MultiCamera Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600
MultiCamera Editing Techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 601
Switching Clips with the Arrow Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 601
Editing and Playing Back a Linecut in MultiCamera Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 602
Using the Add Edit Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 602
Using the Group Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 603
Using the Multi-angle View Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 604
Using Match Frame in MultiCamera Editing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 605
Selective Camera Cutting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 605
Chapter 18 Using Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 607
Using the Settings List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 609
Understanding Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 610
Defining Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 614
Displaying Project Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 615
Working with Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616
Selecting Another User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616
Modifying Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 617
Working with Multiple Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 617
Duplicating Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 618
Naming Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 618
Selecting Among Multiple Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 619
Deleting Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 619
Restoring Default Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 620
23
Copying Settings Between Settings Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 620
Using Site Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 622
Manipulating Settings by Importing User Profiles or Copying
Files Manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 623
Audio Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 625
Audio Project Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 626
Audio Projects Settings: Main Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 627
Audio Project Settings: Input Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630
Audio Project Settings: Output Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630
Audio Project Settings: Hardware Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 633
Audio Project Settings: Effects Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 634
Bin Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635
Capture Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636
Capture Settings: General Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636
Capture Settings: Batch Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 638
Capture Settings: Edit Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639
Capture Settings: OMF Media Files Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 640
Capture Settings: MXF Media Files Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 641
Capture Settings: DV Options Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 641
Capture Settings: Keys Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 642
Communication (Serial) Ports Tool Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 643
Composer Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 643
Composer Settings: Window Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 643
Composer Settings: Edit Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 645
Composer Settings: FF/REW Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 647
Composer Settings: MultiCam Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 648
Controller Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 649
Correction Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 650
Correction Settings: Features Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 650
Correction Settings: AutoCorrect Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 651
Deck Configuration Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 652
Deck Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 652
Deck Preferences Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 654
24
Effect Editor Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 655
Export Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 657
Export Settings Dialog Box Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 657
Export Settings: QuickTime Reference Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 659
Export Settings: QuickTime Movie Export Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 662
Export Settings: QuickTime Movie Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 664
Export Settings: QuickTime Compression Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 665
Export Settings: HDV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 667
Export Settings: DV Stream . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 668
Export Settings: OMFI, AAF, and AFE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 669
Export Settings: AVI (Windows Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 672
Export Settings: AVI Video Compression (Windows Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 674
Export Settings: Windows Media Export Options (Windows Only) . . . . . . . . . 675
Windows Media Legacy Template. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 675
Existing Windows Media Custom Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 675
Windows Media Options Video Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 676
Custom Profile Audio Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 678
Export Settings: Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 680
Export Settings: Graphic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 681
Export Settings: Graphic Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 682
P2 Export Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 686
Export Settings: XDCAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 687
Film and 24P Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 687
Full Screen Playback Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 689
General Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 690
Grid Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 691
Grid Settings: Coordinates Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 691
Grid Settings: Display Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 693
Import Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 694
Import Settings: Image Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 694
Import Settings: OMFI Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 700
Import Settings: Shot Log Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 700
Import Settings: Audio Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 701
25
Import Settings: XDCAM Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 702
Interface Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 703
Interface Settings: General Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 703
Interface Settings: Appearance Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 704
Interplay Folder Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 705
Interplay Server Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 706
Interplay User Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 706
Keyboard Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 707
Marquee Title Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 708
Media Creation Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 709
Media Creation Settings: Drive Filtering & Indexing Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 709
Media Creation Settings: Capture, Titles, Import, and
Mixdown & Transcode Tabs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 710
Media Creation Settings: Motion Effects Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 710
Media Creation Settings: Render Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 711
Media Creation Settings: Media Type Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 712
Media Services Settings (Windows Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 713
Mouse Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 714
PortServer Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 714
Remote Play and Capture Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 715
Render Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 716
Safe Colors Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 720
Script Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 721
Sound Card Configuration Settings
(Windows Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 722
Timeline Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 723
Timeline Settings: Display Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 723
Timeline Settings: Edit Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 724
Trim Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 725
Trim Settings: Play Loop Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 725
Trim Settings: Features Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 725
Video Display Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 726
Video Input Tool Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 728
Video Output Tool Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 729
26
Video Output Tool Settings: SD Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 729
Video Output Tool Settings: HD Tab (Adrenaline Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 733
Workspace Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 734
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 735
Graphics (Image) Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 736
Supported Graphics (Image) File Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 736
Import Specifications for Supported Graphics File Formats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 738
Preparing Graphics Files for Import . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 741
Frame Size for Imported Graphics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 743
Animation Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 744
Audio File Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 745
MXF Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
OMFI Files. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
BWF Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 748
BWF Information Displayed in Bins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 748
Preparing Custom BWF Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 749
Importing and Syncing BWF Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 750
Reimporting BWF Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 751
Field Ordering in Graphic Imports and Exports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 752
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755
Compression and Avid Editing Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 755
Monitor Display Resolutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 756
Compression and Resolutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 757
Resolution Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 757
Resolution Specifications: HD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 758
Resolution Specifications: JFIF Interlaced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 760
Resolution Specifications: JFIF Progressive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 762
Resolution Specifications: Multicam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 763
Resolution Specifications: Digital Video (DV) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 763
Resolution Specifications: MPEG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 764
Support for Uncompressed HD Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 765
Mixing Resolutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 766
Resolution Groups and Image Quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 766
27
Storage Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 767
Estimating Drive Space Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 767
Estimated Storage Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 768
Estimated Storage Requirements: HD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 768
Estimated Storage Requirements: JFIF Interlaced. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 770
Estimated Storage Requirements: JFIF Progressive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 773
Estimated Storage Requirements: DV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 776
Estimated Storage Requirements: MPEG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 777
Maximizing Drive Space. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 777
Managing Storage to Improve Playback Performance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 778
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 779
Working with 24p Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 780
Working with 25p Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 780
Planning a 24p or 25p Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 781
24-fps Film Source, SDTV Transfer, Multiformat Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 782
24-fps Film or HD Video Source, SDTV Downconversion, Multiformat Output 786
25-fps Film or HD Video Source, SDTV Downconversion, Multiformat Output 790
Audio Transfer Options for 24p PAL Projects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 794
Planning a 23.976p NTSC Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 794
Working in a 23.976p NTSC Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 795
23.976-fps Film Transfer or HD Video Source, SDTV Downconversion,
Multiformat Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 796
Limitations for 23.976p Projects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 803
Film Project Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 804
Film Shoot Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 804
Viewing Dailies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 805
Film Dailies Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 805
Video Dailies Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 806
Understanding the Film-to-Tape Transfer Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 808
Transferring 24-fps Film to NTSC Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 808
Stage 1: Transferring Film to Video. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 809
Frames Versus Fields. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 809
Part 1: Using a 2:3 Pulldown to Translate 24-fps Film to 30-fps Video . . 809
28
Part 2: Slowing the Film Speed to 23.976 fps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 810
Maintaining Synchronized Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 811
Stage 2: Capturing at 24 fps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 811
Transferring 24-fps Film to PAL Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 812
PAL Method 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 813
PAL Method 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 814
How Avid Editing Applications Store and Display 24p and 25p Media . . . . . . . . . . 815
Displaying Media While Editing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 816
Displaying Media During a Digital Cut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 816
Film-to-Tape Transfer Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 817
Film-to-Tape Transfer Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 818
Transfer Quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 818
Additional Film Transfer Aids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 819
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 821
High-Definition Television . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 822
HDTV Workflows. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 823
Film-Based Television Workflow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 823
Video-Based Television Workflow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 827
Broadcast Graphics Workflow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 829
Editing in HD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 830
Changing the Project Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 830
Modifying the Format of a Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 832
Converting a 23.976p NTSC Sequence to 720p/23.976 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 834
Mixing SD and HD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 835
Displaying Formats in a Bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 836
Editing at 60 fps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 836
Working with True 24 FPS Timecode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 837
Transcoding HD Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 837
Video Color Space for HD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 838
Working with HDV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 838
Understanding HDV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 839
HDV Basic Workflow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 840
Capturing and Importing HDV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 840
29
Capturing HDV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 841
Importing HDV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 841
Mixing Resolutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 842
Playing Back HDV Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 842
Rendering and Transcoding HDV Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 843
Outputting HDV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 843
Long-GOP Splicing for HDV Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 843
Exporting to an HDV Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 844
Outputting HDV through Avid DNA Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 845
Exporting an HDV Transport Stream . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 846
Exporting HDV as Windows Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 846
Finishing HDV on DS Nitris . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 848
HDV Compatibility Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 849
Chapter 23 International Character Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 851
Using a Local Language Operating System
(Windows Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 851
Choosing a Locale on an English Language Operating System (Windows and
Macintosh) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 852
Non-English Character Support (Macintosh). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 852
Setting the Language in System Preferences (Macintosh) . . . . . . . . . . . 852
Specifying the Language in the Get Info Dialog Box (Macintosh) . . . . . . 854
Non-English Character Support (Windows). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 855
Using Foreign Keyboard Mapping (Windows Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 859
Recommendations and Restrictions for International Character Support . . . . . . . 860
Avid Supports English Plus One Locale . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 860
Entering ASCII Characters in Double-Byte Systems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 860
Characters to Avoid When Naming Avid Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 860
EDL Manager Does Not Save Diacritical Marks or Chinese Characters. . . . . 861
Traditional Chinese Big 5 Character Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 862
Rebuilding the asifont.map File (Windows Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 862
Additional Tips and Limitations for International Character Support . . . . . . . . 862
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 865
30
Tables
32
Controller Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 649
Correction Settings: Features Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 650
Correction Settings: AutoCorrect Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 651
Deck Configuration Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 652
Deck Settings Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 652
Deck Preferences Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 654
Effect Editor Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 655
Export Settings Dialog Box Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 657
Export Settings: QuickTime Reference Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 659
Export Settings: QuickTime Movie Export Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 662
QuickTime Movie Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 664
Export Settings: Avid QuickTime Codecs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 666
Export Settings: HDV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 667
Export Settings: DV Stream . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 668
Export Settings Options (AAF, OMFI, and AAF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 669
Export Settings: AVI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 672
Export Settings: AVI Video Compression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 674
Windows Media Legacy Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 675
Existing Windows Media Custom Profile. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 675
Windows Media Options Video Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 676
Custom Profile Audio Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 678
Export Settings: Audio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 680
Export Settings: Graphic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 681
Export Settings: Graphic Format. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 682
P2 Export Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 686
Export Settings: XDCAM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 687
Film and 24P Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 687
Full Screen Playback Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 689
General Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 690
Grid Settings Options (Coordinates Tab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 691
Grid Settings Options (Display Tab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 693
Import Settings: Image Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 694
Import Setting: OMFI Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 700
33
Import Setting: Shot Log Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 700
Import Settings: Audio Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 701
Import Settings: XDCAM Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 702
Interface Settings: General Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 703
Interface Settings: Appearance Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 704
Interplay Folder Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 705
Interplay Server Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 706
Interplay User Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 706
Marquee Title Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 708
Media Creation Settings: Drive Filtering & Indexing Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 709
Media Creation Settings: Capture, Titles, Import, and Mixdown & Transcode Tabs 710
Media Creation Settings: Motion Effects Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 710
Media Creation Settings: Render Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 711
Media Creation Settings: Media Type Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 712
Media Services Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 713
Mouse Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 714
PortServer Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 714
Remote Play and Capture Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 715
Render Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 716
Safe Colors Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 720
Script Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 721
Sound Card Configuration Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 722
Timeline Settings: Display Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 723
Timeline Settings Options (Edit Tab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 724
Trim Settings: Play Loop Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 725
Trim Settings: Features Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 725
Video Display Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 726
Video Input Tool Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 728
Video Output Tool Settings: SD Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 729
Video Output Tool Settings: HD Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 733
Workspace Settings Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 734
Supported Graphics (Image) File Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 736
Graphics File Import Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 738
34
Graphics Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 741
Frame Size for Imported Graphics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 743
Audio File Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 745
OMFI File Import Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 746
Recommended Field Settings for Two-Field Import and Export . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 753
Monitor Display Resolutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 756
Resolution Specifications: HD (MXF only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 758
Avid HD Formats and HDCAM Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 760
Resolution Specifications: JFIF Interlaced (MXF and OMF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 760
Resolution Specifications: JFIF Progressive (MXF and OMF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 762
Resolution Specifications: Multicam (MXF and OMF). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 763
Resolution Specifications: Digital Video (MXF and OMF). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 764
Resolution Specifications: MPEG (MXF and OMF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 765
Estimated Storage Requirements: HD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 768
Estimated Storage Requirements: JFIF Interlaced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 770
Estimated Storage Requirements: JFIF Progressive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 773
Estimated Storage Requirements: DV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 776
Estimated Storage Requirements: MPEG. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 777
Film Shoot Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 804
Ratio of Film to Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 809
Ratio of Film to Video with FPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 811
Offline Formats for HD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 830
Choices for Modifying Sequences. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 833
HDV Render and Transcode Resolutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 843
Export to HDV Device Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 844
HDV Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 849
35
36
Using This Guide
Congratulations on your purchase of an Avid editing application. You can use your
application to create broadcast-quality output incorporating every possible production
element from full-speed, high-resolution footage, to multimedia artwork and animation, to
computer-generated effects and titling.
This guide contains all the advanced task-oriented instructions and conceptual information
you need to use the capture, editing, and output features of your Avid application, as well as
information about file format specifications, and other supplementary information. The
Basics Guide for your Avid application is a companion to this Advanced Guide. It contains
all the basic task-oriented instructions and conceptual information you need to get started
using the product. The contents of this guide and of the Basics guide are also available in the
Help. This guide is intended for all users, from beginning to advanced. Unless noted
otherwise, the material in this document applies to the Windows® XP operating system.
Unless noted otherwise, the material in this document applies to the Windows XP and Mac
OS X operating systems.The majority of screen shots in this document were captured on a
Windows XP system, but the information applies to both Windows XP and Mac OS X
systems. Where differences exist, both Windows XP and Mac OS X screen shots are shown.
n The documentation describes the features and hardware of all models. Therefore, your
system might not contain certain features and hardware that are covered in the
documentation.
Using This Guide
c A caution means that a specific action you take could cause harm to
your computer or cause you to lose data.
k This symbol represents the Apple or Command key. Press and hold
the Command key and another key to perform a keyboard shortcut.
(Windows®), (Windows This text indicates that the information applies only to the specified
only), (Macintosh), or operating system, either Windows XP or Macintosh OS X.
(Macintosh only)
Italic font Italic font is used to emphasize certain words and to indicate variables.
Courier Bold font Courier Bold font identifies text that you type.
Ctrl+key or mouse action Press and hold the first key while you press the last key or perform the
k+key or mouse action mouse action. For example, k+Option+C or Ctrl+drag.
38
If You Need Help
Most Avid online libraries also include multimedia content such as tutorials and feature
presentations. This multimedia content is an excellent first resource for learning how to use
your application or for helping you understand a particular feature or workflow.
The Online Library for your Avid editing application is installed along with the application
itself.
n You will need Adobe® Reader® to view the PDF documentation online. You can download
the latest version from the Adobe web site.
39
Using This Guide
To learn about Avid's new online learning environment, Avid Learning Excellerator
(ALEX), visit http://learn.avid.com.
40
Chapter 1
Working with the Project Window:
Advanced
The Project window provides controls for structuring and viewing important information
about your current project. You can also modify User, Project, and Site settings from the
Project window and display a list of effects.
For basic information about the project window, see “Working with the Project Window:
Basics” in the Help or the Basics Guide for your Avid editing application.
Each user profile is stored in settings files within a folder, as described in “Understanding
the Avid Projects and Avid Users Folders” in the Help. User profile folders are kept in the
following folder:
• (Windows) drive:\Program Files\Avid\Avid editing application\Avid Users\UserName
• (Macintosh) /Users/Shared/Avid editing application/Avid Users/UserName
You can work with user profiles in the following ways (for step-by-step procedures, see
“Managing User Profiles” on page 43):
• Create new user profiles
• Switch between user profiles
• Return to the original user profile
• Import settings from another user or user profile
• Create a user profile on one system, export it to a server, and then import the same user
profile from another system to the new system.
When you export a user profile, you can select either a Personal or Group profile.
- When you select Personal, the user profile performs an auto-load and an auto-save
every time you open a project. Every time the user profile is updated, it saves the
new profile information. For example, you can create the user profile Jennie on one
system, export it to another location (a server), and then import it to a different
system. Any time you change the Jennie user profile, it updates to the server and
when you open the Jennie user profile on either system, it uses the most updated
Jennie user profile.
- When you select Group, the user profile auto-loads but it does not auto-save.
Changes made to the user profile only affect the system on which the changes were
made. The changes do not update to the server.
n When exporting User Profiles in an Avid Unity™ environment, make sure the workspace
containing the user profile has the same drive letter on all systems.
• Update a user profile with the Update User Profile option, which lets you add user
settings, such as the Send To settings options, to an existing Settings list.
For example, if you are upgrading to a version of your application that contains the Send
To option from a version that did not have that option, you can choose the Update User
Profile option to make sure the Send To settings templates appear in your Settings list.
42
Working with User Profiles
For more information on user profiles, see “Understanding User Profiles” on page 41.
Task Procedure
n If you are using a user profile other than the default and you change to another project, the default user
settings are loaded, even though the Project window still displays your non-default user profile name. You
must reselect the user profile you want to have active.
43
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
Task Procedure
To delete a user 1. Navigate to the Avid Users folder, and then select the user folder you want to
profile from your delete.
desktop:
For information about the location of the Avid folders, see “Using the Avid
Projects and the Avid Users Folders” in the Help.
2. Do one of the following:
t (Windows) Press the Delete key, then click OK in the dialog box that appears.
t (Macintosh) Drag the folder to the Trash.
3. Empty the Recycle Bin (Windows) or the Trash (Macintosh) to remove the files
from the system.
4. Close the windows, and restart the Avid application.
The deleted user no longer appears in the Select Project dialog box.
44
Managing Folders and Bins
45
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
Project folder
Folders
containing
bin files
Bin files
Settings file
Project file
This hierarchy allows you to have one set of bins available in the Project window during
capture and organizing, and another set of bins available during editing to reduce clutter.
In the Bin tab of the Project window, a memory usage indicator increases and updates as you
open and close bins. Avid recommends that you keep memory usage below 80-85%. If you
exceed the recommended usage, a dialog box opens informing you that your memory usage
is high and recommending that you should close some bins and save your project.
46
Managing Folders and Bins
If your system is running low on memory and you need to free up memory, you can either
close your bins or use the Clear Memory button. If you close your bins, some of your
memory remains unavailable until you exit the application because the online master clips
remain in memory. The Clear Memory button, however, closes and saves all of your open
bins and clears out any cached data of the online master clips.
To free up memory:
1. Click the Info tab of the Project window.
2. Click the Clear Memory button.
A dialog box opens asking if you want to close and save all opened bins.
3. Click OK.
n This operation deletes cached data for the online master clips only. Memory might also be
used by other parts of the application and will not be reduced by using the Clear Memory
button.
n Bins containing sequences use more memory than bins containing master clips. For bins that
contain a large number of sequences, you can free up memory and still keep your old
sequences. Create an archive bin and move older sequences that you do not use anymore to
the archive bin. Keep the archive bin closed.
When you are working with bins, an asterisk (Windows) or a diamond (Macintosh) appears
before the bin name in the bin’s title bar. The asterisk (Windows) or diamond (Macintosh)
indicates that the changes to the bin have not been saved. After you save the bin, the asterisk
(Windows) or diamond (Macintosh) is removed.
47
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
The system automatically saves copies of all bins into the Avid Attic folder at regular
intervals for backup. When your work is lost, or when you want to recover an earlier version
of a bin or sequence, you can retrieve files from the Avid Attic folder. The procedure for
recovering bin files from the Avid Attic folder is described in “Retrieving Files from the
Attic Folder” in the Help.
For added security, you can save bins manually — for example, immediately after an
important edit. For more information, see “Saving Bins Manually” in the Help.
n Setting to zero the maximum number of files stored in the Avid Attic folder as well as the
maximum number of versions of a bin deletes existing files in the project folder in the Avid
Attic folder and prevents any backup bins from being saved. For more information about
backup options, click the Bin Settings dialog box and press F1(Windows) or the Help key
(Macintosh), or see “Bin Settings” on page 635.
Info tab
n The items listed in this view are for information only and cannot be changed.
48
Using the Info Display
Viewing Memory
You can display system memory information in the Info tab of the Project window.
(Windows only) You can view additional memory information through the Windows Task
Manager and Performance Monitor tools. You can view information about system activities,
such as driver messages, through the Windows Event Viewer. For information on these tools,
see the Windows Help.
n You can improve the performance of large projects by reducing the number of objects. To do
this, close unused bins, unmount unneeded media drives, consolidate finished elements,
eliminate old material from the project, or divide the project into separate projects. Then
quit and restart your Avid editing application. If performance is still slow, restart your
system.
The following table describes the information your Avid editing application displays in the
Memory window:
Item Description
Objects The total number of memory handles currently used by your Avid editing
application. Objects include memory requirements of the application,
such as windows, as well as clips, sequences, and other items associated
with a project.
Total physical memory The total number of bytes of RAM (random-access memory).
(Windows) or Total
Mem (Macintosh)
Available physical The amount of RAM available for allocation by the Windows or
memory (Windows) or Macintosh system.
Free Mem (Macintosh)
49
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
n For more information about the Hardware tool, see “Using the Hardware Tool” on page 87.
All statistics are gathered and reported by project. The file that contains this information is
formatted so you can use it as input to software programs such as analysis applications,
spreadsheets, or report generators.
c Do not rely on the Statistics feature for billing or other financial purposes.
50
Displaying Usage Information
Statistics.yymmdd.HHMMSS
where:
Variable Description
51
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
52
Displaying Usage Information
The values in the first column indicate the content of the line:
01 title1
02 title2
03 heading
100 project info
101 Time Project open
102 Capture tool open
104 Capture tool active
105 Captured Media bytes used
106 Rendered Effects bytes used
110 Effects rendering time
111 Title tool open
113 Title tool active
114 Title tool rendering
115 Capture tool capturing
116 Capture tool logging
117 user comments
The values in the second column indicate the type of data in the line:
01 project info
02 time used
03 bytes used
04 text string
53
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
54
Displaying Usage Information
The following figure is the sample file from the previous section as it appears when you
import it into a spreadsheet.
55
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
After the media database is loaded, the Usage window displays the number of files and disk
space used for captured media and rendered effects.
To prevent recalculation:
t Reenter the toggleStatSpace command.
For complete reference information on the Interface Settings dialog box, see “Interface
Settings” on page 703.
n The Settings list has several Interface templates with predefined color schemes. For
information about using the Interface templates, see “Using Interface Appearance
Templates” on page 60.
56
Customizing the Appearance of the Avid User Interface
Check box
Interface
component list
Color boxes
3. Click in the color box next to the interface component that you want to customize.
A color selection grid opens.
4. Click the color to which you want to set your interface component.
The color selection grid disappears. The color you selected appears in the color box. A
check mark appears in the check box to show that you want your new color attribute for
this component to take effect.
n If you deselect an interface component by clicking the check box, the color you specify in the
color selection grid does not take effect. The color of the interface component reverts to its
default value.
57
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
n If you click Cancel after you click Apply, interface components retain the colors you applied.
t Click OK to close the dialog box and put the new setting into effect.
t Click Cancel to close the dialog box.
The changes you selected but did not apply do not take effect.
3. Select from one or more of the menus, as described in the table following this
procedure.
58
Customizing the Appearance of the Avid User Interface
n If you click Cancel after you click Apply, your editing application retains the selections you
applied.
t Click OK to close the dialog box and put the new setting into effect.
t Click Cancel to close the dialog box.
The changes you selected but did not apply do not take effect.
Bright Radial
No button separation
59
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
n For information on how to change the appearance of particular components of your Avid
user interface, see “Customizing the Appearance of the Avid User Interface” on page 56.
60
Customizing the Appearance of the Avid User Interface
The following table describes the windows you can change, and where these changes are
saved.
Project Changes the font and point size of the text in the Project window; saved as a
Project setting.
Bin Changes the font and point size of the text in the Bin window; saved as a Bin
setting (not a Bin View setting).
Composer Changes the font and point size of the sequence or source clip name text;
saved as a Composer setting.
Script Changes the font and point size of the text in the Script window; saved as a
Script setting.
Timeline Changes the font and point size of clip text; saved as a Timeline View setting.
To change the font displayed in the Project, Timeline, Composer, Script, or Bin
window:
1. Click the Project, Timeline, Composer, Script, or Bin window to make it active.
2. Select Edit > Set Font.
The Set Font dialog box opens.
3. Click the Font menu, and select a font.
n Any font installed on the Avid system appears in the list. For information on adding fonts to
your system, see the documentation for your operating system.
4. Type another point size for the font in the Size text box.
5. Click OK.
The new font and point size appear in the active window.
When you close the window, the last font and point size applied are saved with the window.
61
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
For example, during capture you might want to display the Capture tool and Video Input tool
in specific locations. During effects editing, you might want to display the Effect Palette and
Effect Editor in particular locations and sizes. For information on switching between
workspaces, see “Switching Between Workspaces” on page 65.
While in a workspace, you can move tool windows or open and close tool windows. The
next time you select that workspace, the tool windows appear with either:
• The arrangement from the last time you left the workspace
• The arrangement you set for the workspace, regardless of any changes you made
You can select your preference in the Workspace Settings dialog box. For more information,
see “Creating a New Workspace Setting” on page 62.
You can assign up to eight buttons that allow you to switch between user-customized
workspaces. This is useful if there is more than one user accessing the same Avid system.
Each user can assign up to eight workspaces by using the workspace buttons. The buttons
are assigned to the workspaces in the Settings list in the Project window in the order that
they appear. For example, the W1 button is assigned to the first workspace that appears in
the Settings list; W2 is assigned to the second workspace that appears in the Settings list;
and so forth. For more information, see “Assigning a Workspace Button” on page 66.
n You cannot assign certain tool windows to a workspace, such as the Hardware tool, the
Communication (Serial) Ports tool, and the Media tool.
62
Customizing Your Workspace
n If you are duplicating a previously named workspace setting, a .1 appears at the end of the
new name.
New workspace
Custom name column
b. Type a name for the new custom workspace; (for example, Logging).
c. Press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
d. Open the windows and tools with which you want to associate the workspace.
Resize and move the windows to the location you want them to appear on
the monitors.
6. Double-click the custom workspace setting.
The Workspace Settings dialog box opens.
7. Select or deselect the following options, depending on your preference for the behavior
of the workspace:
- Activate Settings Linked By Name: This setting allows you to link other settings
to the workspace. For more information, see “Linking User Settings and
Workspaces” on page 64.
- Continually Update This Workspace: This setting automatically preserves the
workspace in its most recent arrangement. Future changes to the arrangement of the
tool windows are saved.
- Manually Update This Workspace: This setting saves the workspace in its current
arrangement when you click Save Workspace Now. Future changes to the
arrangement of the tool windows are disregarded.
8. Click OK.
63
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
For example, you can create an Audio workspace that opens the Audio Mixer tool and Audio
tool. This workspace can also open a customized Timeline (with enlarged audio tracks and
rubberbanding displays). You can also link this workspace to a Settings dialog box with
customized options selected. You do this by creating a setting and giving it the same name in
the Settings list in the Project window as the name of the workspace.
Linked setting
Linked setting
Linked workspace
64
Customizing Your Workspace
You can also switch between workspaces by using the workspace buttons. To assign
workspace buttons, see “Assigning a Workspace Button” on page 66.
Deleting a Workspace
To delete a workspace:
1. Select the workspace you want to delete from the Settings list in the Project window.
The workspace is highlighted.
n Make sure a check mark does not appear next to the workspace you want to delete. You
cannot delete an active workspace.
65
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
66
Sharing Bins and Projects in an Avid Unity Environment
For example, an editor can create sequences in one bin while an assistant recaptures media in
another bin. At the same time, other users can add audio effects or titles to other bins in the
project.
Each user can perform tasks from his or her own computer. Your Avid editing application
provides a locking mechanism to help you keep track of who is currently working in a bin.
The method allows one user to write to a bin; multiple users can read the files in that bin.
c The lock does not prevent you from deleting the media in a locked bin if you have write
access to the workspace. It ensures only that you don’t overwrite changes to the bin.
In an Avid Unity environment, your Avid editing application creates and stores projects and
bins on the client’s internal drive. If a user moves or saves these projects and bins to the
workspace, only one client can work on the project at a time. If two or more users are
working simultaneously on the same project, only one user can update the files. Other users
can open and play sequences but cannot make any changes to them.
For information on managing workspaces, see the clients’ Quick Start cards. For details on
Avid Unity, see the Avid Unity MediaNetwork Management Guide or the Avid Unity ISIS
Administration Guide.
Sharing Methods
Before you begin copying or creating bins and projects on an Avid Unity workspace,
determine the sharing method you are using for the project. You can either share bins alone
or you can share bins and projects.
67
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
Shared Bins
When you use shared bins, you store the project on your local computer and store bins and
media files on the shared workspace. This method allows users in a shared environment to
share only selected bins with other users. The system identifies the shared bins as follows:
• Stores the bin in a Unity Bins folder in the Project window. This folder is similar to the
Other Bins folder.
• Displays a second column of information for the bin that identifies the computer that
currently has the bin locked.
• Uses bold text to identify bins that are locked by another user.
If you share bins and projects, you create and store the project folder and bins on the shared
workspace (or copy an existing project, bins, and the related media files). Your Avid editing
application identifies information from each computer using the shared workspace as
follows:
• Creates a project folder for each computer that accesses the project. Your Avid editing
application adds the computer’s name to the folder name to create a unique name and
stores any project-specific information in the folder. This mechanism prevents users
from overwriting the project-specific data for other users.
The folder is similar to the folder created when you select New Folder from the Project
Window Fast menu. For more information, see “Managing Folders and Bins” on
page 45.
• Displays an extra column in the Project window that identifies the computer that has the
bin locked.
• Uses bold text to identify bins that are locked by other users.
• Creates a folder at the top level of the shared workspace called Unity Attic. This folder
contains backup files for each project on the shared volume.
n Depending on the number of users sharing a workspace, you might want to increase the
number of files that your Avid editing application stores in the Unity Attic folder (using the
Bin Settings dialog box).
68
Sharing Bins and Projects in an Avid Unity Environment
The following illustration shows the Project window for a shared project.
The following illustration shows the contents of a shared workspace at the desktop level.
Shared projects
69
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
Unlocked bin
Locked bin
When a bin is unlocked, you have permission to make changes. You should not make
changes to a locked bin. See “Restrictions and Limitations for Locked Bins” on page 71.
n The Bin Lock Status button does not appear if the bin is not on Avid Unity.
The user who opens the bin first gets the lock and obtains write access to the bin. Your Avid
editing application uses bold text in the Project window to identify bins that are locked by
another user. When the person who owns the lock closes the bin, it becomes available for
another user to open and take the lock.
If one user has the lock and another user has the same bin open, when the first user closes the
bin, the second user must close and reopen the bin to get the lock.
You can click the red or green Bin Lock Status button in the bin to view a history file that
shows which computers and users have modified the bin.
70
Sharing Bins and Projects in an Avid Unity Environment
You can instruct your Avid editing application to keep a bin locked even after you close it.
n The Lock Project Bin and Unlock Project Bin commands are also available from the Clip
menu.
The following restrictions apply to bins that are locked by another user:
• You cannot select a locked bin for operations such as capture, title creation, and
importing. This helps to minimize the problems of modifying a locked bin.
• You cannot drag an item to a locked bin.
• If you drag an item from a locked bin to a writable bin, the Avid system creates a
duplicate (not a copy) of the selection in the writable bin. The original item is not
removed from the locked bin. This operation is the equivalent of duplicating a selection
and then dragging the duplicate to another bin.
• You cannot move a bin that is locked by another user.
• If you modify a locked bin, your Avid editing application does not let you save the bin to
the same name, but it allows you to save the bin to another name. However, this causes
duplicate bin IDs and might cause system-level conflicts with the contents of the two
bins. The application sees the duplicate contents of these bins and resolves the conflicts
by newest modifications (this might not be desirable behavior).
71
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
Try to avoid creating duplicate bins by modifying a locked bin. If you do create a
duplicate bin in this way, you should manually merge the changes into the original bin
and delete the duplicate bin.
c The lock does not prevent you from deleting the media in a locked bin if you have write
access to the workspace. It ensures only that you don’t overwrite changes to the bin.
72
Sharing Bins and Projects in an Avid Unity Environment
• When you have an environment where more than five users are sharing bins on Avid
Unity, Avid recommends using an Avid Interplay server in the workgroup environment.
• When an Avid Interplay server is available in an Avid Unity system in the workgroup
environment, Avid does not recommend sharing bins or projects. Use the Avid Interplay
server and the Remote Assets feature to share media. All editing systems in a workgroup
environment that includes an Avid Interplay server must have the Avid Unity client
software installed. The Media Tool might become unreliable if an editor in the Avid
Unity workgroup environment does not have the Avid Unity client software installed.
Each editing application maintains a PMR file in its machine name folder inside the OMFI
MediaFiles folder or the Avid MediaFiles folder. The PMR file lists all the online media
files. Every editing application consults all the PMR files in all the machine name folders to
find out which media files are online. Whenever a media file is created, its name is
immediately added to the creating editor application's PMR file, and whenever a media file
is deleted by its creator, its name is immediately removed from the PMR file.
However, if an editing application other than the creator deletes a media file, the PMR file
that contains the deleted file is NOT updated immediately. Once the creating editor
encounters an event that causes its PMR to be updated, then all editing systems know that
the deleted media file has gone offline.
There are several ways to force an editing application to update its PMR. The simplest is to
switch to the desktop and back.
Avid recommends that you institute policies where media files are deleted by the editor who
created them, or if necessary, the deleting editors notify the editor who created the media
files that a deletion has occurred. This editor can then switch to the desktop and back, and all
other editors can see the deleted file go offline.
73
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
Both editors can modify their copies of the bin, but only the editor that holds the lock, as
indicated in the Project window, can save that bin. The other editor is warned that the bin is
locked but is allowed to save a copy of the changed bin.
Avid recommends that you use the “Save Bin Copy As...” button and continue working.
For Symphony Nitris and for current versions of Avid Media Composer and Avid
NewsCutter® products, these three options are selected by default. Some older versions of
Avid Media Composer and Avid NewsCutter® products shipped with Filter by Resolution
enabled, Filter by System Drive disabled, Filter by Launch Drive disabled. This caused
breakages with the networked workflows as media in new projects were being created on the
C: drive instead of the shared storage when using the default Media Creation Settings. To fix
this, all three drive filtering options are enabled by default.
Avid Xpress products and Avid Free DV default to Filtering off because these products
might not have additional drives available, especially if you are working on a laptop.
n Any project brought into a networked workflow that was created with any of the filtering
selections off might have problems with networked media creation, such as “Audio and/or
Video Mixdown” and “SendToPlayback,” because their Media Creation Settings are still
configured for standalone usage.
There are several ways for you to work around this issue. First, adjust the drive filtering
settings when switching environments, either by opening the Media Creation Setting and
switching the drive filtering settings or by creating multiple Media Creation Settings and
switching the active setting whenever you shift environments. If you always work in an
environment that differs from the defaults (for example, an Avid Xpress product always
connected to shared storage), you can create a Media Creation setting that fits your
workflow and add it to your Site Settings so new projects are created with the desired
defaults. For more information, see “Using Site Settings” on page 622.
74
Sharing Bins and Projects in an Avid Unity Environment
The default values for Filter by Resolution, Filter by System Drive, and Filter by Launch
Drive are as follows:
Avid Xpress DV No No No
Free DV No No No
75
Chapter 1 Working with the Project Window: Advanced
76
Chapter 2
Using Tools
The Tools menu in your Avid editing application provides quick access to essential tools that
you can use in your projects. In addition to the tools available from the Tools menu, you can
also add a controller to your system that you can use as an alternative to your keyboard and
mouse for editing footage. These tools are described in the following sections:
• Using the Tools Menu
• Using the Deck Controller
• Using the Command Palette
• Using the Avid Calculator
• Using the Console Window
• Using the Hardware Tool
• Using External Controllers as Editing Control Surfaces
To open a tool:
t Select Tools > tool name.
The Avid Deck Manager program is initialized, and a new Deck Controller window opens.
Timecode indicator
Logging controls
Close button
Timecode display
Timecode display
Delete Mark IN
Deck Selection
menu
n Information on connecting decks and cabling varies depending on the Avid DNA device you
use. See the appropriate “Connecting Peripheral Equipment” topic for your Avid DNA
device in the Help, within the “Using the Avid Adrenaline,” “Using the Avid Mojo,” or
“Using the Avid Mojo SDI” sections.
• The Timecode indicator flashes green during playback or capture to indicate that the
system is receiving valid timecode from the source tape. If the indicator remains unlit,
the system is not receiving timecode.
• The deck controls provide a standard range of playback capabilities, including fast
forward and rewind, stop and play, step backward and step forward, pause, and eject.
78
Using the Command Palette
• The Deck Selection menu allows you to specify a deck with deck control parameters
that you can customize in the Deck Settings dialog box. For more information, see
“Deck Configuration Settings” on page 652.
• The deck controller allows you to associate a tape name with the controller by clicking
the Tape Name button and selecting a tape in the Select Tape dialog box. For more
information, see “Selecting a Source Tape” in the Help.
• Logging controls allow you to log IN and OUT marks while cueing your tape.
For more information on logging, see “Logging Directly into a Bin” on page 112.
Marks you set with the deck controller are temporary and allow you to return to
timecode locations entered in the window while screening and cueing a tape. If the
Capture tool is open, however, timecodes logged in the deck controller also appear in
the Capture tool and can be entered into an open bin.
The Command palette organizes buttons by editing function. Tabs are displayed for each
editing function and the buttons that perform those functions are displayed in each tab. The
functions are Move, Play, Edit, Trim, FX (Effects), 3D, CC (Color Correction), MCam
(MultiCamera), Other, and More.
79
Chapter 2 Using Tools
n For information about each button in the Command palette, right-click (Windows) or
Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh) a button and select What’s This? from the menu.
n For more information on logging with the Capture tool, see “Logging Directly into a Bin”
on page 112.
n When you map buttons to the keyboard, the mapping might be specific to the current editing
mode. For example, buttons mapped to the Page Up key or the Page Down key revert to the
default key functions when you enter Effect mode. After you exit Effect mode, the keys return
to the mapped function.
• Complex layering and effects editing: You can map buttons such as Motion Effect,
Remove Effect, Transition Corner Display, Fade Effect, Render Effect, Cycle
Picture/Sound, Quick Transition, and Grid (which displays Safe Title overlays).
80
Using the Command Palette
• MultiCamera editing: You can map the Quad Split, Swap Cam Bank, and Gang
buttons.
When you remap buttons or commands, the system immediately saves your new
configuration in one of the default settings that you can open from the Project window. You
can also save, rename, and recall multiple versions of any of these settings to serve various
purposes.
For more information on multiple settings, see “Working with Multiple Settings” on
page 617.
You can change the appearance of the buttons in the Tool palette by using the Interface
settings from the Settings list in the Project window. For more information, see
“Customizing the Appearance of the Avid User Interface” on page 56. You can choose to
identify a button’s function with only an icon or with an icon and letters. For more
information, see “Interface Settings” on page 703.
81
Chapter 2 Using Tools
For more information on mapping the Blank button to a new location, see “Mapping User-
Selectable Buttons” on page 81.
Button Description
For example, on a Windows system, if you map the Add Alt Key button to the Mark IN key
(I key), the function of the I key changes to Go to IN Point (which is equivalent to pressing
Alt+I). For a list of other functions that use modifier keys, select Help > Shortcuts.
n After you modify a key or button with a modifier key button, you can use the default function
of the key or button by pressing and holding the appropriate modifier key while pressing the
key, or by pressing and holding the modifier key while clicking the button.
82
Using the Command Palette
n Before you can map some commands, you must first establish the condition that enables the
command. For example, before you can map the Render In/Out command from the Clip
menu, you must first mark IN and OUT points in the Timeline so that the menu command
appears.
Menu command
mapped to a button
83
Chapter 2 Using Tools
84
Using the Console Window
c Do not use the programming features of the Console without guidance from Avid
professionals. Contact your Avid Reseller with specific questions. (In North America,
you can contact Avid Customer Support.)
This feature is especially useful for finding the system ID when you need to contact your
Avid Reseller or Avid Customer Support.
85
Chapter 2 Using Tools
n For information about mapping dives to your computer, see your Windows or Macintosh
documentation.You do not need to use this feature to access Avid Unity shared network
drives.
When the feature is turned on, the mapped drive letter appears in the Target Drive menu.
When you turn the feature off, the mapped drive letter is dimmed. If you quit and restart your
application, the mapped drive letter does not appear in the Target Drive menu.
n Typing alldrives in the console window turns this feature on and off. Typing alldrives 2
restores the default behavior where only media drives are available.
86
Using the Hardware Tool
By default, network drives are filtered by resolution when the option Filter Network Drives
Based on Resolution option is selected in the Media Creation settings. For more information,
see “Media Creation Settings” on page 709.
n If your system is connected to an Avid Unity network, you see two drives tabs, Local Drives
and Avid Unity Drives.
• (Windows) The System tab lists the operating system, its version, service pack, and
build, and the physical memory.
• (Macintosh) The System tab lists the operating system, its version, and the physical
memory.
To check the hardware configuration of your Avid system, do one of the following:
t Select Tools > Hardware.
t Click the Info tab in the Project window, and then click Hardware.
The Hardware tool opens.
For information about connecting these controllers, see “Connecting Serial and MIDI Port
Devices” in the Help. For information about configuring these controllers and using them as
editing control surfaces, see “Using the Digi 002 and Command|8” on page 407.
87
Chapter 2 Using Tools
88
Chapter 3
Logging: Advanced
When you import shot log files or log directly into a bin, you provide your Avid editing
application with frame-accurate clip information used to capture the source footage. The
logs you create form the foundation for organizing, tracking, storing, retrieving, and
generating lists of edit information throughout your project. The following topics provide
advanced information for preparing log information:
• Preparing Log Files for Import
• Understanding Avid Log Specifications
• Creating Avid Logs
• Double-Checking Log Files
• Transferring Bins from MediaLog
• Logging Directly into a Bin
• Setting the Pulldown Phase
• Logging Film Information
• Modifying Clip Information Before Capturing
• Exporting Shot Log Files
For more information, see “Importing Shot Log Files” in the Help or the Basics Guide for
your Avid editing application.
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
Any options you set in the ALE utility are saved each time you close the ALE utility.
When you are converting an ATN file that contains multiple sections to an ALE file, multiple
ALE files are created. The Avid Log Exchange window displays only the first ALE file
created. The succeeding ALE files are given the same file name with incremental
numbering. For example, the file Nations1.atn is converted to Nations001.ale,
Nations002.ale, Nations003.ale, and so on. The converted output files are stored in the folder
containing the original input file.
90
Preparing Log Files for Import
6. Depending on the type of file you are opening, one of the following occurs:
- If the file type is recognized by the ALE utility, the file appears in the Avid Log
Exchange window.
- If the file does not contain the Windows line-ending format, then the Line Endings
dialog box opens. Select an option from the following table.
Option Description
Display & Save Opens the file in the Avid Log Exchange window and changes the file to the
Windows format.
Display Only Opens the file in the Avid Log Exchange window, but does not change the file.
n For specific information on the various file types, see “Compatible Log Formats” on
page 97.
91
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
7. Use the Options menu to select the tracks to include in the Tracks column of the log.
The default track selections are Log V, Log A1, and Log A2.
After you import the log into an Avid bin, the system captures all tracks shown in this
column when batch capturing.
n The Track selection only works on non-ALE files being converted to ALE format. When ALE
is the incoming format, Track selection does not work.
8. Select Options > Clean if you want ALE to clean the ALE output file to eliminate
overlapping timecodes for clips. By default, Clean is selected.
When you select Clean, the utility changes the end timecode of a previous event to be
less than that of the following event.
9. If you selected Clean, you can also select Options > Relaxed to prevent the deleting of
events that come earlier in the transfer. Relaxed is not set by default.
For example, if you transfer film footage with a timecode of 2:00:00:00 and then add
some clips at the end with a timecode of 1:00:00:00, Relaxed prevents the deleting of
events that come earlier in the transfer. This occurs when you shoot footage across the
midnight hour, the first half of the film has 24 hours, and the second half has 0 hours.
92
Preparing Log Files for Import
11. (Option) Select the original file from the Window menu if you want to convert the file
again using different options.
12. Select File > Close.
If you made changes in the editor, a message box opens.
13. Click Yes.
The converted file is stored in the same folder as the original log file.
n If the log file is a Final Cut Pro, Cinema Tools, or a Tabbed shot log file, you cannot use
drag-and-drop conversion. Use the procedure in “Converting Log Files with Avid Log
Exchange (Windows)” on page 90 to convert files of this type.
93
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
5. Drag the selected files to the Shortcut icon for the ALE utility, and release the mouse
button.
6. Depending on the type of files you are converting, one of the following occurs:
- If the file type is recognized by the ALE utility, a message box opens, indicating the
conversion was successful.
- If the file type is not recognized, the Select File Type dialog box opens. Select the
type of file you are converting and click OK.
A message box opens, indicating the conversion was successful.
- If the file type is an ALE file, the ALE Convert Type dialog box opens. Select a file
type for the converted output file and click OK.
A message box opens, indicating the conversion was successful.
7. Click OK to close the message box.
The converted files have the same file names as the original files, except the file name
extension matches the converted file format.
For example, the .ale file name extension is added to the new file names for the Avid
format. The converted files are stored in the folder containing the original log files.
94
Preparing Log Files for Import
Clean option
Track selection
Global Settings
Information
Convert
Convertbutton
button Quit button
2. Select the type of file you want to convert from the Input list.
If you are not sure of the type of file, select the Automatic option. ALE will determine
the type of file based on the file name.
3. Select the type of file you want to create from the Output list.
The default output selection is the Avid Log Exchange (.ale) format. This is the required
format for import into an Avid bin.
4. Select the tracks to include in the Tracks column of the log. After you import the log
into an Avid bin, the system captures all tracks shown in this column when batch
capturing.
95
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
n The Track selection only works on non ALE files being converted to ALE format. When ALE
is the incoming format, Track selection does not work.
5. Select the option if you want ALE to clean the ALE output file to eliminate overlapping
timecodes for clips.
When you select Clean, the utility changes the end timecode of a previous event to be
less than the following event.
6. If you selected the Clean option, you can also select the Relaxed option to prevent the
deleting of events that come earlier in the transfer. Relaxed is not set by default.
For example, if you transfer film footage with a timecode of 2:00:00:00 and then add
some clips at the end with a timecode of 1:00:00:00, Relaxed prevents the deleting of
events that come earlier in the transfer. This occurs when you shoot footage across the
midnight hour and the first half of the film has 24 hours and the second half has 0 hours.
7. Select the global settings information, for example, NTSC or PAL, that you want to
appear in the ALE file. Global settings appear at the top of the .ale file.
8. Click the Convert button to open the Select File To Convert dialog box.
9. Open the drive and folder that contain the files you want to convert.
10. Double-click the input file name.
If you selected a file type, ALE converts the file immediately.
If you selected the Automatic option, a message box opens and asks you to confirm the
file type.
11. Click the button for the selected file type.
A message box opens.
12. Do one of the following:
t Click the This File Only button to convert only the file you selected to the format
you selected.
t Click the All Files button to convert all files you select in this session to the format
you selected. If you click All Files, the message boxes will not open the next time
you double-click a file.
ALE stores the converted file in the same folder as the original input file.
The original file name extension is replaced by the extension for the new format. The .ale
files can be imported only into Avid products.
96
Preparing Log Files for Import
n If the log file is a Final Cut Pro, Cinema Tools, or a Tab Delimited shot log file, you cannot
use drag-and-drop conversion. Use the procedure in “Converting Log Files with Avid Log
Exchange (Macintosh)” on page 95) to convert files of this type.
97
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
To ensure accuracy, you must follow the Avid log specifications described in this section.
When you create an Avid log, you must follow the order precisely. The tables in these topics
follow this order.
For an example of a simple log file, see “Sample Avid Log” on page 108.
98
Understanding Avid Log Specifications
You can decide not to display a defined heading (including a required heading), except for
Name. Name must always be displayed.
The maximum number of combined global, standard, and custom headings in a log file is 64.
Global Headings
The global headings must come first in an Avid log file, and you must enter one value for
each heading.
99
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
The following table shows the format for the global headings and the supported values for
each heading.
GLOBAL HEADINGS: Global headings are case sensitive and must be spelled exactly as shown. Include all
required headings. Other headings are optional but might be necessary for your project. The maximum number
of combined global, standard, and custom headings in a log file is 64.
FIELD_DELIM [Tab] <TABS> [Enter] or Required Enter TABS to show that the
[Return] file is Tab delimited.
TAPE [Tab] <tape name> [Enter] or Required Name of the videotape reel
[Return] you are logging. If you omit
this heading, the file name
becomes the global tape
name. You can override this
for individual clips.
100
Understanding Avid Log Specifications
Column Headings
The standard column headings appear after the global headings in the Avid log file.
You do not enter the data for a column heading along with the heading. You enter the data
later, in a separate data section.
You must include the five required standard column headings; they are listed first in the
following table.
You can create your own custom column headings. Enter them after the standard headings
(see the last heading in the following table). To create a custom heading, substitute the
custom heading name for <Your_heading>. You can create several custom headings, as long
as the total of global, standard, and custom headings does not exceed 64.
COLUMN HEADINGS: Column headings are case sensitive and must be spelled exactly as shown. Note
that the first five headings are required. Other headings are optional but might be necessary for your
project. This table lists only the column headings that are relevant to shot log files. Some data, such as
Creation Date, is gathered by the system. The following table does not include headings for such data. The
maximum number of combined global, standard, and custom headings in a log file is 64.
Tracks [Tab] Required Heading for tracks you select for digitizing.
Start [Tab] Required Heading for video timecode of sync point — the
timecode IN for clip. From address track of video.
End [Tab] Required Heading for timecode OUT for clip. From address track
of video.
Auxiliary Ink [Tab] Heading for a second ink number used for the clip.
101
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
Camera [Tab] Heading for the camera used to film this clip. This
feature is used in multicamera shoots.
Camroll [Tab] Heading for the camera roll ID containing this clip.
Duration [Tab] Heading for timecode Start to timecode End, the length
of the video clip.
FPS [Tab] Heading for video frames per second rate for digitizing
the individual clip. If omitted, the global entry applies.
Ink Number [Tab] Heading for the ink number used for the clip.
KN Duration [Tab] Heading for the length of the clip, expressed in feet and
frames.
KN End [Tab] Heading for the ending key number for the clip.
KN Start [Tab] Heading for the starting key number for the clip.
Labroll [Tab] Heading for the lab roll ID for the clip. Lab rolls are a
combination of several camera rolls.
Perf [Tab] Heading for the film-edge perforations format used for
3-perf projects.
Pullin [Tab] Heading for the telecine pulldown of the first frame of
the clip (pulldown phase). Pullin can have the values A,
B, C, or D.
Pullout [Tab] Heading for the telecine pulldown of the last frame of
the clip (pulldown phase). Pullout can have the values A,
B, C, or D.
Shoot date [Tab] Heading for the date the footage was shot.
Sound TC [Tab] Heading for Nagra timecode, Arri® code, and so on, at
the sync point. Syncs with the Start timecode. Required
if tracking the sync sound. Capture rate can be 25 or 30
fps.
102
Understanding Avid Log Specifications
Tape [Tab] Heading for source tape ID for the individual clip. If
omitted, the global entry applies.
<Your_heading> [Tab] Add any category of information you want. Add as many
headings as you want, but do not use more than a total of
64 global and column headings in the file. Press the Tab
key between each heading. Do not press the Tab key
after the last heading.
103
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
Data Entries
The data entries come after the Custom column headings. The following table shows the
format for entering data. Enter a line of data in this format for every clip. Be sure to start the
data section for each clip with the word Data [Enter] (Windows) or Data [Return]
(Macintosh).
DATA HEADINGS: The word Data marks the start of the data for each clip.
Data [Enter] or Required Enter the word Data to mark the start of the logged clip
[Return] entries.
DATA FOR EACH CLIP: Enter a line of data for each clip. Enter the data so it aligns with its column
heading. (The data that goes with the ninth column heading must be the ninth data entry.) Be sure to enter
data for all the required values. To leave a data position unfilled, press the Tab key instead of typing data.
Press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh) at the end of each line.Your Avid system supports up to four
audio tracks in imported and exported logs.
<clip name> [Tab] Required Under Name heading. Enter a clip identifier (32 characters
maximum).
<V> [Tab] Required Under Tracks heading. Enter the tracks you want captured
<VA1> for the clip. Enter V for MOS takes. Enter A1, A2, or
<VA2> A1A2 for wild sound.
<VA1A2>
<A1A2>
<A1>
<A2>
<timecode> [Tab] Required Under Start heading. Enter the video timecode for the sync
point, the first frame of the clip. Use colons for
non-drop-frame (for example, 01:00:12:20). Use one or
more semicolons for drop-frame (for example,
01;18;00;02).
<timecode> [Tab] Required Under End heading. Enter the video timecode for the last
frame of the clip.
<22kHz> [Tab] Under Audio heading. Enter the audio sampling rate for
<24kHz> this clip only. If omitted, global entry applies.
<44kHz>
<48kHz>
104
Understanding Avid Log Specifications
<camera ID> [Tab] Under Camera heading. Identify the camera, using letters
or numbers. For multicamera shoots.
<camera roll ID> [Tab] Under Camroll heading. Identify the camera roll, using
letters and numbers.
<timecode> [Tab] Under Duration heading. Enter the length of the video
clip, Start to End.
<23.98> [Tab] Under FPS heading. Enter the video capture rate for this
<24> clip only. If omitted, the global entry applies. Use 23.98 fps
<25> (23.978 fps) for NTSC, 24 fps for NTSC or PAL, 25 fps for
<29.97> PAL, or 29.97 fps for NTSC.
<timecode> [Tab] Under Film TC heading. Identify the timecode used for the
film, usually at 24 fps.
<inknumber> [Tab] Under Ink Number heading. Identify the ink number for
the start of the clip.
<keynumber> [Tab] Under KN End heading. Identify the key number for the
end of the clip. You need to identify only feet and frames,
for example, 0342&07.
<lab roll ID> [Tab] Under Labroll heading. Identify the lab roll, using letters
and numbers.
<1> [Tab] Under Perf heading. Edit the perf for this clip only.
<2>
<3>
<A> [Tab] Under Pullin heading. Identify the telecine pulldown of the
<B> first frame of the clip (pulldown phase). NTSC only.
<X> (matchback only)
<C>
<D>
105
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
<reel ID> [Tab] Under Reel # heading. Identify the reel, using numbers.
<scene ID> [Tab] Under Scene heading. Identify the scene, using letters and
numbers.
<shoot date> [Tab] Under Shoot Date heading. Identify the date the footage
was shot, in numbers or in letters and numbers.
<sound roll ID> [Tab] Under Soundroll heading. Identify the sound roll, using
letters and numbers.
<timecode> [Tab] Under TC 24 heading. Identify the start of the clip for 24p
timecode.
<timecode> [Tab] Under TC 25p heading. Identify the start of the clip for 25p
timecode (PAL pulldown).
<timecode> [Tab] Under TC 25 heading. Identify the start of the clip for
25-fps timecode (PAL).
<timecode> [Tab] Under TC 30 heading. Identify the start of the clip for
30-fps timecode.
<take ID> [Tab] Under Take heading. Identify the take, using letters and
numbers.
<source tape ID> [Tab] Under Tape heading. Enter the source videotape ID for this
clip only.
106
Understanding Avid Log Specifications
<information> [Tab] Under the headings you created yourself, type the
appropriate information.
[Enter] or [Return] Press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh) after the last
entry for the clip.
Do not press Tab after the last entry for the clip.
107
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
Formatting keys (such as [Tab] and [Enter] (Windows) or [Return] (Macintosh)) are shown
in brackets.
108
Creating Avid Logs
To open WordPad:
t Click the Start button, and select All Programs > Accessories > WordPad.
This is the minimum information required to capture successfully. You can also add other
information such as comments, auxiliary timecodes, or key numbers for film projects. You
can make a separate log file for each videotape, or log clips from several different videotapes
in one log.
c The Avid editing application only accepts text files (ASCII format).
After you double-check the log, import it into your Avid editing application. For more
information, see “Importing Shot Log Files” in the Help.
109
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
If the system detects a discrepancy, it reports the error to the Console and does not bring the
clip into the bin. The best way to ensure that clips are not discarded on import is to
double-check the logs for discrepancies in duration and marks.
n Open the Console by selecting Tools > Console. For more information, see “Using the
Console Window” on page 85.
n For information on specific MediaLog procedures, see the Avid MediaLog Help.
n The version of MediaLog for your platform is included with your Avid system. To order a
different version of MediaLog, contact your Avid representative.
If you log your source footage by using MediaLog, you can transfer the bins directly to the
Avid system for batch capturing by moving the bin files. You can also import the logs by
using the same procedure as you would for other Avid-compatible log formats, as described
in “Importing Shot Log Files” in the Help.
110
Transferring Bins from MediaLog
3. Open the project folder in which you want to store the MediaLog bins.
This folder is usually located in the Avid Projects folder. For information about the
location of the Avid Projects folder, see “Using the Avid Projects and Avid Users
Folders” in the Help.
4. Double-click the My Computer icon and double-click the storage device or disk icon.
5. Ctrl+click the bins in the storage device or disk window, and select Edit > Copy.
6. Click the project folder window, and select Edit > Paste.
The bins you have imported contain master clips only with no associated media files. Before
you can view or manipulate these clips, you must create the associated media files by batch
capturing the source material. For information about batch capturing, see “Batch Capturing
from Logged Clips” in the Help.
111
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
Logging Preroll
Be sure to leave adequate preroll with continuous timecode prior to IN points when logging
your tapes. The recommended minimum preroll is 2 seconds for Betacam® playback,
5 seconds for 3/4-inch U-matic® playback, and 6 seconds for DV playback.
n You set the default preroll for tape playback by using the Preroll menu in the Deck Settings
dialog box. For more information, see “Deck Settings” on page 652.
Logging Timecode
Within an NTSC project, check the timecode format of each tape (drop-frame versus
non-drop-frame timecode) when you are logging without a tape in the deck. Log drop-frame
timecode by using semicolons (;) between the hours, minutes, seconds, and frames. Log
non-drop-frame timecode with colons (:). You can set the timecode format to use in the Deck
Preferences Settings dialog box. For more information, see “Deck Preferences Settings” on
page 654.
n To change the logged timecode format, select Clip > Modify. For information, see
“Modifying Clip Information Before Capturing” on page 132.
112
Logging Directly into a Bin
Naming Tapes
When entering tape names in the Capture tool, consider the following:
• Tape names must be alphanumeric characters (A to Z, 0 to 9). They can include
uppercase and lowercase characters. The maximum length of a name is 32 characters.
• It is possible to have a single tape listed as several different tapes if you alter the case of
the letters. For example, if you type a single name as TAPE, Tape, and tape on three
different occasions, all three names appear. This can cause significant problems in
keeping track of clips when batch capturing, recapturing, and generating an EDL. Select
a case convention and maintain it throughout a project.
n If you want your Avid system to consider master clips as coming from the exact same tape,
you should try to select that tape name from the Select Tape dialog box. If you do not see the
tape you are looking for, but know you have online media from that tape, you should click the
Scan for Tapes button. For more information, see “Logging with Avid-Controlled Decks” on
page 113.
• It is important that you devise a naming scheme for your tapes. For example, tapes with
similar names can be easily sorted and viewed together in a bin. However, it can be
difficult to distinguish among numerous tapes with similar names when trying to locate
a specific tape quickly. Name tapes based upon the amount and complexity of your
source material.
• If you are planning to generate an edit decision list (EDL) for import into an edit
controller for online editing, double-check the controller’s specifications beforehand.
Some edit controllers truncate source tape names to as few as six characters, while
others eliminate characters and truncate to three numbers. Alterations like these at the
EDL stage might cause the system to identify different source tapes with similar names
in the same way, causing you to lose track of source material.
n For information about connecting a compatible deck to your system, see “Connecting
Peripheral Equipment” in the Help.
113
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
Capture/Log Mode
button
Mark IN button
Timecode display
Deck controls
n If you forget to connect and turn on the power to the deck before opening the Capture tool,
you can reinitialize deck control after turning it on by clicking the Deck Selection menu, and
selecting Check Decks.
4. If the Capture tool is not currently in Log mode, click the Capture/Log Mode button
until the LOG icon appears.
114
Logging Directly into a Bin
List of tapes
n Because the media file database does not open when you start your Avid editing application,
tape names of all online media files do not appear automatically.
n If the tape name you are searching for does not appear in the Select Tape dialog box, click
the Scan for Tapes button. Tape and project names are listed.
7. Provide the system with a tape name in one of the following ways:
t Select the name of the tape from the list in the Select Tape dialog box and click OK.
t Click New if the tape is not in the list. A new tape name line appears in the dialog
box. Type the new name and click OK.
The tape name is displayed in the Capture tool.
n For guidelines when naming tapes, see “Naming Tapes” on page 113.
A message that the system is waiting for you to mark an IN point is displayed in the
message bar.
115
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
8. Set either an IN point or an OUT point for the clip you want to log using one of the
following methods:
t If you want to keep the deck running while you log: Start the deck. At the point
where you want to start the clip, click a Mark IN button (you can use either the
Mark IN button in the upper left of the Capture tool or the Mark IN button in the
lower right) or press the F4 key. The deck continues to play.
n If you want to pause the deck while you enter a clip name and comments, see “Pausing the
Deck While Logging” on page 117.
t If you want to cue your source tape to the start or end point: Use the deck
controls in the Capture tool to cue your source tape to the start or end point. Click a
Mark IN button or the Mark OUT button in the lower right of the Capture tool.
t If you want to log using timecode: If the footage starts at a known IN point or ends
at a known OUT point, type the timecode in the text box next to the Mark IN button
or the Mark OUT button. Then enter the mark by pressing the Go to IN button or the
Go to OUT button, which scans the tape forward to the mark, or by pressing Enter
(Windows) or Return (Macintosh).
After you set the mark, the Mark IN button changes to the Mark OUT and Log button or
the Mark IN and Log button, depending on the first mark you set.
c For NTSC film-to-tape transfer or footage downconverted from 1080p/24, you must log
the correct pulldown phase. See “Setting the Pulldown Phase” on page 121 and
“Entering Pulldown Information” on page 126.
9. (Option) Enter a clip name and comment in the corresponding text boxes in the Capture
tool.
10. To finish logging the clip, do one of the following:
t If the deck is running: Click the Mark OUT and Log button or press the F4 key.
The clip is logged into the bin and the deck continues to play.
t If you want to cue the remaining start or end point: Use the deck controls to
locate the start or end point. Set the remaining IN point or OUT point either by
clicking the Mark OUT and Log button or the Mark IN and Log button. The clip is
logged into the bin.
116
Logging Directly into a Bin
t If you want to log using timecode: Type a timecode for the clip’s IN point, OUT
point, or duration in the timecode text boxes next to the corresponding icon.Then
enter the mark by pressing the Go to IN button or the Go to OUT button, which
scans the tape forward to the mark, or by pressing Enter (Windows) or Return
(Macintosh). To log the clip into the bin, click the Log Clip button in the upper left
of the Capture tool.
The clip name, which is automatically named and numbered by the system, is
highlighted in the bin and ready to be renamed.
11. (Option) Rename the clip by typing a new name in the highlighted area.
n Consider changing the clip name immediately, because it is easy to forget the contents of
each clip if you are logging many clips. You can, if necessary, accept the clip name and
proceed with the logging process and change the clip names in the bin at a later time.
12. Repeat these steps until you have logged all your clips.
n While viewing the footage, you can continuously update your marks on-the-fly by clicking
the Mark IN button or the Mark OUT button repeatedly before entering the second mark.
117
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
5. Type a clip name and comment in the corresponding text boxes in the Capture tool.
6. Click the Log Clip button or press the F4 key.
Your Avid editing application logs the clip in a bin, and the deck starts playing again.
You can add one mark per tape. The memory mark is not stored on the tape. When you
remove the tape from the deck and insert another tape into the deck, the mark is cleared.
Go to Memory button
Clear Memory button
n For NTSC projects, when you are logging within the Capture tool, you should leave the deck
empty. If a tape remains in the deck, the system determines drop-frame or non-drop-frame
from that tape whether or not it matches your tape’s timecode format.
118
Logging Directly into a Bin
Capture/Log Mode
button
Channel Selection
buttons
Message bar
Clip Comment
text box
Deck Selection
menu Clear Memory button
7. Click the Capture/Log Mode button in the Capture tool until the LOG icon appears.
c For NTSC film-to-tape transfer or footage downconverted from 1080p/24, you must log
the correct pulldown phase. See “Setting the Pulldown Phase” on page 121 and
“Entering Pulldown Information” on page 126.
n Consider changing the clip name immediately, because it is easy to forget the contents of
each clip if you are logging many clips. You can, if necessary, accept the clip name and
proceed with the logging process and change the clip names in the bin at a later time.
18. Repeat these steps until you have logged all your clips.
120
Setting the Pulldown Phase
For information about the pulldown process, see “Transferring 24-fps Film to NTSC Video”
on page 808.
Set
Pulldown
Phase
option
You set this relationship by selecting the pulldown phase (sometimes called the pulldown
frame or pullin frame), which is the video frame at which the master clip starts. The
pulldown phase is designated A, B, X, C, or D. Film labs and transfer houses typically use
the A frame to start the transfer.
121
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
The following illustration shows the relationship between film frames and video frames.
A1 odd
A A
A2 even
B1 odd
B
B2 even
B
B3 odd
X
C1 even
C C2 odd
C
D1 even
D D2 odd
D
D3 even
n This setting is not available in matchback projects. However, you can modify the pulldown
phase after you log it. See “Entering Pulldown Information” on page 126.
The Set Pulldown Phase setting lets you log, batch capture, and capture-on-the-fly more
easily, because the correct pulldown phase of any IN point for a particular tape is
automatically determined. Setting the correct pulldown phase prevents inaccuracies in cut
lists and matchback EDLs. It also prevents incorrectly captured clips that appear to stutter
when played in 24p NTSC projects.
For example, if you set the pulldown phase of 00:00:00:00 as A (indicating that the A frame
is located at timecodes ending in 0 or 5), any timecode you log calculates its pulldown phase
based on the same sync point, regardless of where you set the IN point. If you use the
Capture tool to log a clip that starts at 01:00:10:01, your Avid editing application
automatically enters B in the Pullin column of the bin. If you capture on-the-fly starting at
01:00:10:01 (a B frame), the system begins to capture at the next A frame, in this case,
01:00:10:05.
c The Set Pulldown Phase feature does not work if you capture from a mark IN.
The pulldown-to-timecode relationship might vary from tape to tape, or within the same
tape, depending on how the footage was transferred. If you find that a tape requires a
different pulldown phase, you can change the setting in the Film and 24p Setting dialog box,
or use the Modify Pulldown Phase dialog box before capturing. See “Modifying the
Pulldown Phase Before Capturing” on page 128.
n For information about fixing an incorrectly logged sync point, see “Modifying the Pulldown
Phase After Capturing” on page 179.
122
Logging Film Information
123
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
124
Logging Film Information
2. To log data under optional headings (such as Ink Number, Auxiliary TC1-Auxiliary
TC5, or Film TC), do the following:
a. Select Bin > Headings.
The Bin Column Selection dialog box opens.
b. Ctrl+click (Windows) or click (Macintosh) the specific headings you want to add.
c. Click OK.
3. You can also track custom information for the job by creating a custom heading. To
create a new heading, type a name that describes the information in the headings bar at
the top of the bin. For more information on customizing bin views, see “Customizing
Bin Views in Text View” on page 213.
125
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
n For information about importing a log file, see “Setting the Pulldown Phase” on page 121.
If you do not have a transfer log, or if the transfer log is incorrect, you need to add the
information manually. If you log clips by using the Capture tool, the Avid system uses the
A frame as the default pulldown phase. You might need to edit this value.
n For 24p projects, you can set a default pulldown phase in the Film and 24p Settings dialog
box. See “Setting the Pulldown Phase” on page 121 (24p projects only).
n For matchback projects, you need to log key-number information before you can log
pulldown information.
By specifying the pulldown phase in the Pullin column, you accomplish the following:
• You ensure that the clips start with the correct frame for the pulldown. Otherwise, you
might experience inaccuracies in key-number tracking and in the cut lists.
• You indicate where the pulldown fields are located so the Avid system can accurately
eliminate the pulldown fields during the capturing process, leaving you with a
frame-to-frame correspondence between your digital media and the original 24-fps
footage (24p projects only).
126
Logging Film Information
To do this, you must indicate whether the sync point at the start of each film clip transferred
to tape is an A, B, C, or D frame, as described in “Determining the Pulldown Phase” on
page 127 and “Modifying the Pulldown Phase Before Capturing” on page 128.
It is easiest to determine the pulldown of a sync point (or pulldown phase) if you ask your
film lab to keypunch (cut a small hole in) the sync frame at the zero frame in the original
film footage before transferring the film to video. Many film labs or transfer houses can also
provide a pulldown frame indicator displayed at the far right of the burn-in key numbers,
depending on the equipment available. Ideally, the A-frame pulldown coincides with
timecode ending in 0 and 5 (:00, :05, :10, and so on).
If the footage has not been keypunched, you can determine pulldown according to clapsticks
or any other distinctive frame at the beginning of the clip. Determining the pulldown is
easier if the frames depict motion.
n For instructions on determining the pulldown phase for material already captured, see
“Modifying the Pulldown Phase After Capturing” on page 179.
127
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
The following illustration shows a keypunch on the A frame. Notice where the timecode
changes.
A1 odd
A
A even
A2
Timecode change
B1 odd
B
B2 even
B Timecode change
B3 odd
X
C1 even
Timecode change
C C2 odd
C
D1 even
Timecode change
D D2 odd
D
even
D3
4. If there are three keypunched fields, or fields without motion, the pulldown is either B or
D. Step through the fields again and note where the timecode changes:
- If the timecode changes from the second to the third field, the fields came from a B
frame.
- If the timecode changes from the first to the second field, the fields came from a D
frame.
5. Enter or edit the information in the Pullin column in the appropriate bin, as described in
“Modifying the Pulldown Phase Before Capturing” on page 128.
After you determine the correct pulldown phase (as described in “Determining the Pulldown
Phase” on page 127) you can modify the pulldown phase before capturing in one of the
following ways.
128
Logging Film Information
To modify the pulldown phase for multiple clips that have the same
pulldown-to-timecode relationship:
1. Ctrl+click (Windows) or Shift+click (Macintosh) the clips you want to modify.
2. Select Clip > Modify Pulldown Phase.
The Modify Pulldown Phase dialog box opens.
3. Click the menu, and select the correct pulldown phase for timecodes ending in 0 or 5.
4. Click OK.
The pulldown phase for each selected clip is changed, based on the pulldown phase you
selected for 00:00:00:00.
The Pulldown Phase setting also appears in the Film and 24p Settings dialog box (24p
projects only). You can override that setting with the Modify Pulldown Phase dialog
box. The selection in the Film and 24p Settings dialog box remains the same. For more
information, see “Setting the Pulldown Phase” on page 121.
n If you want to modify the pulldown phase after capturing, you must first unlink the clips. See
“Modifying the Pulldown Phase After Capturing” on page 179.
n After you capture an NTSC transfer, the timecode shows a loss of every fifth frame of video.
For example, don’t be alarmed if you find that your timecode jumps at one point from
1:00:14:15 to 1:00:14:17. You haven’t lost a frame, just an extra pulldown field.
129
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
c Make sure the correct number appears when you press Enter (Windows) or Return
(Macintosh). For key-number formats other than Keykode, you might need to type the
space, hyphen (-), and plus sign (+) or ampersand (&) to format the number correctly.
130
Logging Film Information
n You can use the Duplicate command to convert timecodes from one format to another. For
more information, see “Duplicating Bin Columns” on page 224.
n You can log different ink number formats in the same project as long as you change the ink
number setting to the appropriate format before you log each type. Changing the ink number
setting affects only the next ink numbers you log, not numbers that are already logged.
131
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
3. Return to the bin and enter numbers under the Ink Number heading.
For example, use Keykode format or use a two-digit prefix to identify the roll, a hyphen,
a four- or five-digit footage count, a plus sign, and a two-digit frame count (for example,
AA-00924+00).
For information on modifying the pulldown phase, see “Entering Pulldown Information” on
page 126.
c Modifying tape names and timecodes affect any key numbers entered for the selected
clips.
132
Exporting Shot Log Files
n ALE and tab-delimited files include information for master clips and subclips only.
Information for other objects, such as group clips, sequences, and precomputes, is not
included.
133
Chapter 3 Logging: Advanced
134
Chapter 4
Capturing Media: Advanced
Capturing is the process of creating digital media from videotape or audio input. When you
capture, you convert source material from videotape into master clips that contain reference
information. You also create associated media files that contain the digital audio and video.
The following topics provide advanced information about capturing:
• Advanced Capture Settings
• Understanding Drop-Frame and Non-Drop-Frame Timecode
• Preparing for Audio Input: Advanced
• Preparing for Video Input: Advanced
• Using Function Keys When Capturing
• Special Capture Procedures
• Understanding DV Capture Offset
• Capturing DV Material with Offset
• Delaying Audio
• Live Capture with External Timecode
• Capturing to the Timeline
• Capturing Video Without Pulldown into a 24p NTSC Project
• Remote Play, Capture, and Punch-In
• Relinking Clips by Key Number
• Modifying the Pulldown Phase After Capturing
• DV and HDV Scene Extraction
• Support for Panasonic VariCam
For basic information about capturing, see “Capturing Media: Basics” in the Help or the
Basics Guide for your Avid editing application.
135
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
For reference information about all settings in the Capture Settings dialog box, see “Capture
Settings” on page 636.
136
Advanced Capture Settings
Best Available Your Avid editing application first checks the tape for timecode to use for preroll.
• If there is no timecode, or not enough timecode, the system uses the control track
for preroll.
• If there is not enough control track for preroll, the system adjusts the specified
preroll time to accommodate the amount of valid control track available.
After the system adjusts the preroll to the individual shot, it returns to using the
user-specified preroll time until it needs to adjust the time again.
• If the adjusted preroll time is too short to sync lock at the IN point, the system
does not capture the shot and displays an error message.
Use this method to capture material as automatically as possible. As the system
makes multiple attempts to preroll, this method is slower at times but almost always
performs the preroll without interruption.
Standard Timecode Your Avid editing application uses timecode to determine the preroll point.
If there is a not enough consecutive timecode (for example, if there is a break in the
timecode), the system does not capture the shot and displays an error message.
Use this method if you know the timecode is consecutive or if you want to determine
if there are timecode breaks.
137
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
Best Available Control Your Avid editing application uses the control track to determine the preroll point.
Track
• If there is not enough control track for preroll, the system adjusts the specified
preroll time to accommodate the amount of valid control track available.
After the system adjusts the preroll to the individual shot, it returns to using the
user-specified preroll time until it needs to adjust the time again.
• If the adjusted preroll time is too short to sync lock at the IN point, the system
does not capture the shot and displays an error message.
Use this method if you know there are timecode breaks and want to capture material
as automatically as possible. Because the system does not use timecode, it might
Standard Control Track Your Avid editing application uses the control track to determine the preroll point.
If there is a break in the control track, the system stops capturing and displays an
error message.
Use this method if you know the control track is continuous or if you want to
determine if there are breaks in the control track.
n For information about other options, see “Capture Settings: OMF Media Files Tab” on
page 640.
138
Advanced Capture Settings
n If you click Clear, all selections are removed. You must select at least one drive before you
can click OK to exit the dialog box.
c For media file management purposes, any clip whose media exceeds the 2-GB limit has
more than one media file associated with it.
n For more information on managing media files, see “Managing Media Files: Basics” in the
Help.
For information about other settings in the General Settings dialog box, see “General
Settings” on page 690.
139
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
• Video Pulldown Cadence: allows you to specify how the application handles pulldown
frames:
- Video rate, no pulldown: Select this option when capturing 24-fps footage that was
transferred MOS (roughly translated as “without sound”) to 30 fps by speeding up
the film, and the audio was brought into the Avid system separately at 100 percent
of the actual speed.
- Standard 2:3:2:3 pulldown: Select this option when capturing 24-fps footage that
was transferred to 30 fps by duplicating frames (pulldown) and the audio is
synchronized to the picture.
140
Advanced Capture Settings
Advanced 2:3:3:2 pulldown: Select this option when capturing 24-fps footage that was
recorded to 60 fields (NTSC) using Advanced Pulldown and the audio is synchronized
to the picture.If you are capturing sound that has been created during an NTSC film-to-
tape transfer, you need to set the pulldown switch before you begin capturing. See
“Setting the Pulldown Switch” in the Help.
For NTSC projects, you can mix footage transferred with pulldown and footage
transferred without pulldown (video rate). You can also mix sound transferred at 0.99
(with pulldown) and 1.00 (without pulldown).
• (PAL only) You define the Audio Transfer Rate in the New Project dialog box when
you create a 24p PAL film project. (It is not needed for a 25p PAL project because there
is no film speedup during the transfer.) It is important to keep the audio transfer rate
constant for the project. However, if there is a specific element that you need to capture
at a different rate, you can use the Film and 24p Settings dialog box to change the rate.
The following options are available:
- Film Rate (100%): Select this option when your 24-fps film footage has been
transferred MOS to 25 fps by speeding up the film, and the audio comes in
separately at 100 percent of the actual speed (PAL Method 2).
- Video Rate (100%+): Select this option when your 24-fps film footage has been
transferred to 25 fps by speeding up the film, and the audio is synchronized to the
video picture. This means that the audio speed is increased by 4.1 percent (PAL
Method 1).
For PAL 24p projects, you can mix audio that has been transferred at 4.1 percent
speedup (video rate, PAL Method 1) with audio that has not been transferred (film rate,
PAL Method 2). However, Avid does not recommend this. See “Audio Transfer Options
for 24p PAL Projects” on page 794.
n The Info tab in the Project window allows you to view the audio transfer rate you selected
when you created the project. The actual audio transfer rate might be different from the
display if you used the Film and 24p Settings dialog box to change the audio transfer rate.
• Audio Source Tape TC Rate allows you to specify the digital audiotape (DAT)
timecode format: either 30 fps or 29.97 fps (NTSC only). This timecode format must
conform to the timecode format on your original DAT tapes. This setting is active when
capturing audio only.
This setting does not appear in 23.976p projects.
• Set Pulldown Phase of Timecode allows you to set a default pulldown phase for a 24p
NTSC project. See “Setting the Pulldown Phase” on page 121.
141
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
To disable resolutions:
1. Select Tools > Media Creation.
The Media Creation dialog box opens.
2. Click one of the tabs that includes a Resolutions menu, and note the exact spelling of
each resolution you want to disable.
n This file must be a plain text file. On a Windows system, use Notepad; do not use Wordpad.
On a Macintosh system, select TextEdit > Preference > Plain Text. Other files might
introduce characters that the application cannot recognize.
142
Advanced Capture Settings
4. Type each resolution you want to disable on a separate line. Do not include OMF® or
MXF.
Windows Macintosh
n The text of the resolution has to exactly match the text in the Media Creation dialog box. If
you want to disable DV 25, for example, you need to type DV 25 411 with DV in capital
letters.
n Do not disable all resolutions supported by the editing application. You need to keep one
resolution available.
143
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
NTSC video (the video format used mainly in the United States) uses one of two formats:
drop-frame timecode and non-drop-frame timecode. Drop-frame (DF) timecode is designed
to match the NTSC scan rate of 29.97 frames per second (fps). Two frames of timecode are
dropped every minute except for the tenth minute. No video frames are actually dropped.
Drop-frame timecode is indicated by semicolons between the digits; for example,
01;00;00;00.
Non-drop-frame (NDF) timecode tracks NTSC video at a rate of 30 fps and is indicated by
colons between the digits; for example, 01:00:00:00. Non-drop-frame timecode can be
easier to work with, but does not provide accurate timing for NTSC broadcast.
For example, a typical 1-hour show uses 52 minutes of video. If your program ends at
01:52:00:00 (non-drop-frame), and it is broadcast at 29.97 fps, it will last 94 frames too long
(approximately 3 seconds). The final credits could be cut off.
The following illustration compares the two types of timecode at the 1-minute mark. No
frames are actually dropped.
Non-drop-frame
timecode
Drop-frame
timecode
PAL video (the video format used in many countries other than the United States) uses a
scan rate of 25 fps. Timecode is indicated by colons. There is no need for drop-frame
timecode in PAL video.
144
Preparing for Audio Input: Advanced
You set the default timecode format for logging clips in the Deck Preferences dialog box.
See “Deck Preferences Settings” on page 654. You set the default starting timecode in the
General Settings dialog box. See “General Settings” on page 690. In both cases, you can
select drop or non-drop.
You can change the starting timecode of a sequence or, for NTSC projects, the type of
timecode. See “Changing the Sequence Name and Timecode” in the Help.
n If you set the tone media frequency to 0, the system generates random noise. Also, a value of
–777 generates a tone sweep.
5. Select the number of tracks of tone you want to create (up to 8 tracks).
6. Click the menus, and select a target bin for the tone master clip and a target drive for the
tone media file.
7. Click OK.
After a few seconds, the media file is created and a master clip appears in the target bin.
The default name reflects the options you selected. You can rename the clip by typing a
new name.
145
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
n The Passthrough Mix tool adjusts monitored audio only and has no effect on the recorded
audio signal. You can adjust volume levels within a clip in the Timeline after you record
audio by using Audio Gain Automation. For information, see “Using the Audio Mixer Tool”
in the Help.
n You can also open the Passthrough Mix tool by clicking the Passthrough Mix Tool button in
the Capture tool or the Audio Punch-In tool. For more information, see “Recording Voice-
Over Narration Using Audio Punch-in” on page 448.
You can use the Number of Mix Panes button to change the display from 4 tracks to 8 tracks.
When you select 4 tracks, a button appears that allows you to display the first 4 or last 4
enabled tracks. With the tool minimized, you can continue to adjust levels by selecting a
track and typing values by using the numeric keypad on the keyboard or by typing a value in
the Volume Level display.
When you record, you can monitor the mix, volume, and pan values of audio channels with
the Passthrough Mix tool.
The Passthrough Mix tool adjusts monitored audio only and has no effect on the recorded
audio signal.
146
Preparing for Audio Input: Advanced
n In Direct Mix mode, the Pan Value display and pop-up sliders at the bottom of the
Passthrough Mix tool are replaced by Channel Menu buttons.
n You can select only channels that exist in the source audio.
6. Adjust the volume as needed. You can adjust the volume of multiple channels by
clicking the appropriate Gang button. See “Changing an Audio Level in the Passthrough
Mix Tool” on page 148.
7. Adjust the pan values as needed. See “Adjusting Pan Values in the Passthrough Mix
Tool” on page 148.
147
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
To change an audio level value in the audio panel in the Passthrough Mix tool, do one
of the following:
t Click a number along the vertical edge of the Volume Level slider.
t Click the Volume Level slider, and type a value.
Values are cumulative until you press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh). For
example, if you want to enter the value 12, type it. However, if you type 1 and then
want to change the value to 2, press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh) before
typing the 2.
t Click the Volume Level slider, and drag the slider to a new position.
t Click the Volume Level display, and type a value.
t Alt+click the Volume Level slider to reset the value to 0 dB.
To adjust the pan values in the audio panel of the Passthrough Mix tool:
t Click the Pan Value display to reveal the pop-up slider, and then drag the slider to a new
position.
Pan Value
display Slider
You can use the Audio Project Settings dialog box to change your default audio hardware
calibration if necessary. However, if you change the application’s default, you must
recalibrate your audio hardware to match. If the settings do not match, the analog VU
(volume unit) scale in the Audio tool displays incorrect values, and the 0 VU display appears
in red.
148
Preparing for Audio Input: Advanced
4. Click OK.
5. Change the calibration of the audio hardware, as described in the following sections.
149
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
6. Select Calibrate from the PH (Peak Hold) Menu button in the Audio tool.
The Audio tool changes to Calibrate mode: the scales display a range of approximately
2 dB, and the meters indicate levels within this range.
Peak Hold
Menu button
7. Adjust the channel 1 input level by inserting a screwdriver into the Channel 1 trim pot
(labeled Gain) on the Avid Adrenaline and turning it until the Audio tool’s on-screen
meter reaches 0 VU.
The input channel is now calibrated.
8. Repeat this procedure for each input channel.
If the input channels for the Avid Adrenaline are calibrated correctly, you can use the input
channels to calibrate the output channels.
151
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
The subsystem used in your Avid system is optimized for use with modern, broadcast-
quality VTRs that contain time-base correctors (TBCs). When presented with a stable input,
the subsystem captures that video by using a high-quality, very-low-jitter clock reference.
However, some sources do not include an internal TBC (including various S-Video decks or
composite VHS, 3/4-inch, or Hi8™ decks). In some cases, due either to the deck
performance or the deck performance in conjunction with a particular videotape, the
subsystem will not lock to non-TBC sources. As a result, the image might be unstable or
might have reduced or missing color, or syncing might not be possible at all.
If you select SignalLock > Consumer in the Video Input tool, a wider bandwidth (more
closely tracking time-base) improves the range of syncing capability. In this mode, the video
input levels are set by automatic gain control. Not all of the Video Input tool’s adjustment
sliders will operate, and the video might be slightly softened, but the syncing in most cases is
more reliable and more stable. The overall image quality is not as high as with normal
operation.
n The Video Input tool is not available on all models. If your model does not have the Video
Input tool, the Avid editing application sets the default input options automatically.
If you continue to experience difficulty with a source that does not include an internal TBC,
Avid recommends the video signal be processed through an external TBC for maximum
image quality. For more information on time-base correctors, contact your Avid Reseller.
Some VHS tape decks do not output the full 240 lines of video normally included in the
VHS format. As a result, after you capture from a device such as a VCR, a green line might
appear at the bottom of the monitors in your Avid editing application.
This line is at the bottom of the visible area of the picture, and is not seen in a standard
consumer monitor in most cases. If you use the video in a circumstance in which the line is
visible, you can remove it by cropping the bottom edge of the picture.
152
Preparing for Video Input: Advanced
The following are the Video Input settings that are saved and restored:
• Level adjustments made with the sliders
• Selection status of the SignalLock or 100% Bars options
n Video Input settings do not restore the source format (Composite, Component, S-Video, DV,
or SDI). Instead, the source format you select in the Video Input tool remains the default for
that project until you select another format from within the project. This allows you to
establish a new format on a project basis when moving between systems, or from the offline
to the online phase.
n The Video Input tool is not available on all models. If your model does not have the Video
Input tool, your Avid editing application sets the default input options automatically.
c If you do not use a name that matches the tape name, the system does not recall the
setting automatically the next time you load the tape.
3. Click OK.
Whenever you batch capture or select a tape name during capturing, the system recalls the
saved settings as follows:
• The system looks for a Tape setting with the same name as the tape. If the setting exists,
the system recalls it.
• If no matching Tape setting exists, the system looks for a setting labeled “Default” and
loads that setting. For information on customizing this default setting, see “Saving a
Custom Default Setting for the Video Input Tool” on page 154.
• If no matching Tape setting or “Default” setting exists, the Video Input tool is left in its
prior state (with the most recent settings applied during the session).
n Tape settings and the Default setting are Project settings, and are available to the current
project only.
153
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
Whenever you mount a new tape that does not have its own setting, the system recalls these
default settings.
n The Video Input tool is not available on all models. If your model does not have the Video
Input tool, your Avid editing application sets the default input options automatically.
The following table describes the criteria for adjusting video levels by eye, without color
bars.
Color Criteria
Blacks Should not seem flat and lacking detail. Find a series of frames in the footage that include
black areas. Shadows work better than black objects. Blacks should fall around 7.5 IRE for
NTSC, 0 IRE for NTSC-EIAJ, or 0.3 V for PAL in the Waveform monitor.
Whites Should not be washed out or lacking detail. Find a series of frames in the footage that include
white areas. Bright, well-lit regions work better than white objects. Whites should peak at
around 100 IRE for NTSC-EIAJ or 1.0 V for PAL in the Waveform monitor.
154
Using Function Keys When Capturing
Color Criteria
Skin colors Should be realistic. Find a series of frames in the footage that include skin colors. Skin colors
should fall generally between the target boxes for the red and yellow vectors in the
Vectorscope monitor.
Pure yellows Should be a rich gold and not reddish or greenish in tone. Find a pure yellow, and adjust both
hue and saturation as necessary.
Chroma Should not exceed 110 or fall below –120 in the Vectorscope monitor.
c Capturing on-the-fly can cause incorrect pulldown and stuttering playback. Do not use
the F1 or F2 keys for capturing 24-fps film that has been transferred to NTSC video
unless you have set the correct pulldown phase. See “Setting the Pulldown Phase” on
page 121.
Press To
F3, F5 through F12 Add a locator to the current frame while capturing. Each
Function key adds a different color locator. See “Adding
Locators On-the-Fly” on page 159.
The Keys tab in the Capture Settings window allows you to customize the commands
mapped to the function keys on your keyboard that are used while capturing.
155
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
n The functions described here apply only in Capture mode. When you are not in Capture
mode, function keys operate with their default mappings. For more information on using
function keys as keyboard shortcut keys, see ¨Shortcuts¨ in the Help.
n The Start Capture function is not included in the menu. F4 always starts capture. You can
map an additional function to F4 to use after capture starts; End Locator Entry is the
default.
3. Click OK.
156
Special Capture Procedures
n For more information about the Console, see “Using the Console Window” on page 85.
Consider the following when selecting whether to log errors to the Console during capture:
• If the option “Log errors to the console and continue capturing” is selected on the Batch
tab of the Capture Settings dialog box, when you batch capture and the system
encounters an error, it aborts the clip, enters error comments into the Console, and
continues capturing the next clip.
• If the option “Log errors to the console and continue capturing” is not selected, a
message appears and the system pauses if an error occurs while capturing. If this
happens, do the following:
a. Click Try Again to retry the operation. The clip might capture successfully.
b. If the clip does not capture the second time you try, the error message appears again.
Click Next Clip to bypass the clip that caused the error, and continue batch
capturing any remaining clips, or click Abort to cancel the entire batch capturing
process.
Note all errors, messages, and steps you have taken. Try to troubleshoot the problem on your
own, or contact Avid Customer Support.
157
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
n For information about creating subclips after capturing, see “Creating Subclips” in the
Help.
When subclips are created in 24p or 25p projects, they are always created as “hard” subclips.
This means you cannot trim past the edges of the subclip when adjusting transitions and
edits. Hard subclips prevent film-tracking information errors for editing and cut lists.
n You can press the F2 key repeatedly as you search for the end point of the subclip. The
system accepts the last occurrence as the end point. You can also press the F1 key at any
time before pressing F2 again to remove the previous subclip marks and to start a new
subclip IN point.
The subclip appears in the target bin when you stop capturing.
When capture is complete, a number appears between the subclip indicators to show the
number of subclips created.
c For NTSC film-to-tape transfers, you must log the correct pulldown phase before you
create subclips. For more information, see “Setting the Pulldown Phase” on page 121.
n If your Avid editing system is an asset manager client in an OMF workgroup, and you are
capturing with shared volume segmentation (“chunking”) enabled, see your Avid Unity
documentation for details on the capture procedure.
158
Special Capture Procedures
n If your Avid editing system is an asset manager client in an MXF/AAF workgroup, you
cannot create subclips while capturing media using the Capture tool. However, you can use
the Frame Chase editing feature when capturing media from a supported external device
using Avid Interplay Transfer. For more information about using Frame Chase editing, see
“Using Frame Chase Editing” in Avid Interplay Best Practices.
For information on mapping capture functions to function keys, see “Using Function Keys
When Capturing” on page 155.
159
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
Locator comments appear in the Locators window. To see the locator comments, open the
Locators window as described in “Viewing Locators in the Locators Window” on page 336.
n If your Avid editing system is an asset manager client in an OMF workgroup, and you are
capturing with shared volume segmentation (“chunking”) enabled, see your Avid Unity
documentation for details on the capture procedure.
n If your Avid editing system is an asset manager client in an MXF/AAF workgroup, you
cannot create locators while capturing media using the Capture tool. However, you can use
the Frame Chase editing feature when capturing media from a supported external device
using Avid Interplay Transfer. For more information about using Frame Chase editing, see
“Using Frame Chase Editing” in Avid Interplay Best Practices.
For more information about locators, see “Using Locators” on page 331.
160
Special Capture Procedures
The J-K-L keys work the same as they do in the Source and Record monitors. See “Playing
Footage with the J-K-L Keys (Three-Button Play)” on page 242, as shown in the following
table.
Press To
L Shuttle the deck at 1x, 2x, 3x, 5x, 8x, 16x, or 24x normal speed.
J Shuttle the deck at –1x, –2x, –3x, –5x, –8x, –16x, or –24x normal
speed.
161
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
n The Record button works for either the Capture tool or the Audio Punch-In tool, depending
on which tool is active.
n You can map the Eject button to any button on the Tool palette or any key on the Keyboard
palette. See “Mapping User-Selectable Buttons” on page 81.
162
Understanding DV Capture Offset
DV Data Transcoder
Avid application
Analog data
RS-422 controller
Analog deck
The DV capture offset can also be used in a configuration where the DV stream is captured
over a FireWire cable, but the timecode of the master clip is not received through an RS-422
controller. When you adjust the DV capture offset in this configuration, results could vary,
depending on the number of devices involved. See the following figure.
DV data
Avid application DV device
n A configuration in which FireWire control is used to control a DV device and the DV stream
is captured does not use this offset. The following figure shows this configuration, where the
DV frames contain the encoded timecode.
FireWire controller
Avid application DV device
DV data
163
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
The range of DV capture offset in the Avid application is from –6 to 24 frames with the
default value set to 0. To use DV capture offset, perform several captures with the DV
capture offset set to 0. Note the first frame of the master clip for each clip. If the first frame
of the master clip is not as expected, the DV capture offset should be adjusted to account for
this variation.
For example, The following figure represents a RS-422-controlled capture where the
timecode for capture comes in through an RS-422 controller. The first frame of the master
clip is the sixth frame from the IN point on the tape.
Tape IN point
Tape frames
To adjust for this device behavior, set the DV capture offset to –6 frames. The result should
be a frame-accurate capture. However, the results are dependent on device behavior. If the
device behavior for sending streams across a FireWire cable is inconsistent, frame-accurate
results on capture will also be inconsistent. See the following figure.
Tape IN point
Tape frames
164
Capturing DV Material with Offset
Delaying Audio
Sometimes the source from which you are capturing provides an audio signal that is one or
more frames ahead of the video. For example, the Panasonic AG-DVX100 DV camcorder
always records audio one frame ahead of the video. Also, the use of a timebase corrector
(TBC) or other video processing devices on your input signal might introduce fixed frame
delays of video.
n If the input signal is not DV when you choose your IN point, the audio that lines up with the
IN point should remain in sync with the captured media. The video is what shifts in the
captured media. If the input signal is a DV signal however, then the audio shifts.
If the audio you are capturing is always at a fixed offset ahead of the video, use the Delay
Audio feature to correct this problem and produce a master clip with correct A/V sync.
165
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
External timecode is especially useful for live events, dramatic multicamera shows, and
video material coming in on routers that do not support timecode through normal RS-422
communication. You can start editing immediately after the shooting without waiting to
capture from the backup reference tapes.
If you are capturing 24p film however, the pulldown phase needs to be accounted for. This
allows for 24p capture to have the same behavior as a video rate. What you select in the Set
Pulldown Phase of Timecode (A, B, X, C, or D) in the Film and 24p Settings window
determines what type of pulldown the system uses during the 24p capture.
n Only non-drop-frame timecode is supported with the Pulldown Phase of Timecode option.
If you are taking a feed from a source based on a time-of-day timecode generator, setting IN
and OUT points is especially useful. When the time of the external timecode source matches
the IN point, the Avid system begins to capture. Capturing stops when the external timecode
matches the OUT point.
n For more information, see “Setting the Pulldown Phase” on page 121.
3. Click OK.
4. Select Tools > Capture.
The Capture tool opens.
166
Live Capture with External Timecode
5. Click the Toggle Source button until the No Deck icon appears.
n LTC is only available with Avid Adrenaline products. If you do not have an Avid Adrenaline
attached to your system, the LTC Input option is grayed out.
n If you notice your captured material is consistently one or more frames off, use the “Latency
for external timecode mode” option in the Capture Settings dialog box to fix the problem.
See “Capture Settings” on page 636.
n You can log an event ahead of time and it automatically starts recording that signal when the
internal clock or external LTC arrives at that timecode. For example, log a clip at
14:00:00:00 to14:30:00:00 sometime before 2:00 pm. The capture starts at 2:00 pm and
ends at 2:30.
167
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
168
Capturing to the Timeline
8. Click the yellow Splice-in button or the red Overwrite button in the Capture tool to
select the type of edit.
Splice-in button
Record
button Overwrite button
When capturing ends, the clip appears in place in the sequence, and a master clip appears in
the bin.
For example, if you want to capture video footage to track V2, click and hold the red V
button in the Capture tool and select V2 from the menu. The Track Selector panel in the
Timeline displays the resulting patch.
The result is
Select the track
displayed in
to patch.
the Timeline.
169
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
n You can also patch tracks in the Timeline in the same way you patch tracks when editing
from the Source monitor. See “Patching Tracks” in the Help.
n Only tracks that are enabled in the Timeline are available for patching. Other tracks appear
dimmed in the menu.
Before capturing the footage, click the Film to Video Transfer menu in the Film and 24p
Setting dialog box, and select Video Rate. The Film-to-Video Transfer setting allows you to
specify the type of film-to-tape transfer you are capturing. For more information, see
“Settings for Film and 24p Projects” on page 140.
n For normal 24-frame capture, click the Film to Video Transfer menu in the Film and 24p
Settings dialog box, and select Pulldown.
External capture control is included in the Remote Play and Capture feature. When you
select Remote Capture or Remote Punch-In in the Remote Play and Capture Settings dialog
box, the Avid editing system performs like a VTR and waits for an external controller to
operate the capture functions.
170
Remote Play, Capture, and Punch-In
n You must be in Deck Offline mode to use Remote Capture. For information on Deck Offline
mode, see “Capturing from a Non-Avid-Controlled Deck” in the Help.
To use Remote Play and Capture, you must connect a supported controller (any controller
that uses Sony® serial control protocol) to the system by using a special Avid 9-pin VTR
emulation cable and a serial adapter.
n If a message appears stating that the Avid Serial Driver is not installed for Remote Play and
Capture, make sure the correct serial driver is installed on your system. If you are running
Avid Media Browse™ and using the Remote Play and Capture option, you need to run the
Avid editor with the Microsoft driver. If you are running the Avid editor (without Avid Media
Browse), the Avid serial driver should be installed. See “Avid Serial Driver and Remote Play
and Capture (Windows Only)” on page 176 for information on how to install the serial
drivers.
2. Click the Mode menu, and select Remote Play, Remote Capture, or Remote Punch-In.
For information about each option, see “Remote Play and Capture Settings” in the Help.
171
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
n The Remote Play and Capture command behaves like a Local/Remote switch on a playback
device, with the VTR in Local mode by default when you start the system.
n Avid recommends that you do not inhibit preloading under normal circumstances. For more
information about the inhibit preloading option, see “Remote Play and Capture Settings” in
the Help.
4. Select Special > Remote Play and Capture when you are ready to use the system for
playing.
A check mark appears next to the command to indicate that the system is ready. A
yellow outline appears around the Play button in the Source/Record monitor to indicate
that Remote Play and Capture is active.
n The Remote Play and Capture command behaves like a Local/Remote switch on a playback
device, with VTR in Local mode by default when you start the system.
5. With a sequence loaded in the Record monitor, use the Play, Cue, and Stop buttons on
the edit controller to control the sequence.
n At this time, fast-forward, rewind, and shuttle and jog are not enabled from the edit
controller.
In addition, all devices controlled by the SR-4 must be genlocked, and your Avid editing
system must be configured as the Master device on the SR-4. For more information on
configuring the Colin Broad SR-4 Serial Remote, see the documentation for your controller.
2. Click the Remote Play and Capture menu, and select the appropriate port.
3. Close the Communication (Serial) Ports tool.
The system saves the setting as a Site setting, effective for all projects.
4. Double-click Remote Play and Capture in the Settings list of the Project window.
The Remote Play and Capture Settings dialog box opens.
174
Remote Play, Capture, and Punch-In
9. Select Clip > Remote Play and Capture when you are ready to use the system for
capturing.
A check mark appears next to the command to indicate that the system is ready. A
yellow outline appears around the Play button in the Source/Record monitor to indicate
that Remote Play and Capture is active.
n The Remote Play and Capture command behaves like a Local/Remote switch on a playback
device, with the VTR in Local mode by default when you start the system.
Input
Channels
buttons
n Some of the features in the Audio Punch-In tool — such as the preroll and postroll options —
do not appear when you open the tool in Remote Play and Capture mode.
11. Select the tracks you want to record to by clicking the Input Channels buttons.
12. Load a sequence in the Source monitor.
13. Using the controls on the external controller, set an IN point in the Timeline.
n If you set the IN point at the first frame of the sequence, you must add filler to the start of the
sequence equal to the amount of preroll. This allows the system to sync lock the Avid editing
application to the external controller.
175
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
n Remote Punch-In does not use preroll or postroll settings, and it does not initiate a loop
playback or audition playback prior to recording. Remote Punch-In begins recording audio
to the selected channels as soon as you start the record operation.
Avid Serial Driver and Remote Play and Capture (Windows Only)
When your Windows installation occurs, two serial drivers are installed: msports.inf and
serial.sys. When an Avid editing application is installed, two additional serial drivers are
installed: msportsAvid.inf and Avidxpserial.sys. When you run the Avid editing system, the
Avid drivers are used. However, if you are using Avid Media Browse and Remote Play and
Capture, you need to change the system’s serial driver to the Microsoft drivers. The steps
below explain how to choose a serial driver for your application.
176
Relinking Clips by Key Number
Relinking by key number eliminates the need for the telecine transfer facility to match the
timecode and pulldown of the second transfer to the timecode of the first transfer.
n For more information about relinking, see “Relinking Media Files” on page 269.
c Duplicate your sequence before relinking. If you relink to the original sequence, you
will lose your links to the original media.
5. Process the new log file through ALE and import it into the bin that holds the duplicated
sequence. (For more information, see “Preparing Log Files for Import” on page 90 and
“Setting the Pulldown Phase” on page 121.)
6. (Option) Batch capture the clips imported from the new log file. Select 1:1 or another
high-quality resolution. (For more information, see “Batch Capturing from Logged
Clips” in the Help.)
7. Select the duplicated sequence and the new clips.
177
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
178
Modifying the Pulldown Phase After Capturing
n For information on the Media tool, see “Using the Media Tool” in the Help.
4. Copy the clips to the bin that contains the duplicated sequence.
5. Select the sequence and the original clips.
6. Relink the clips by key number.
n You can also determine the correct pulldown phase from the original tape. See “Entering
Pulldown Information” on page 126.
179
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
To determine the correct pullin frame, use one of the following approaches:
t If the source footage includes burn-in code with the pulldown phase, go to the start of
the clip and look for the pulldown for the first frame.
t If you want to maintain the start timecode for each clip, review the original tape field by
field, using the procedure described in “Entering Pulldown Information” on page 126.
t If you do not need to maintain the start timecode:
a. Step through the clip frame by frame (using the Step buttons or another method).
Look for two frames that are identical (no movement).
b. Think of these frames as frames B and X of a four-frame series.
No movement
A B X D Incorrect sequence
A B C D Correct sequence
Step backward (either one frame from the B frame or two frames from the X frame)
to locate the correct A frame. Note the last digit of its timecode. Timecode for all A
frames in the clip will start either with this digit or this digit plus 5. For example, if
the A frame has the timecode 1:00:10:20, timecode for all A frames in the clip ends
in either 0 or 5.
c. Compare these digits with the last digit of the start timecode (first frame) of the clip
to determine the correct pullin. For example, if the A frame ends in 0 or 5, and the
start timecode ends in 4, the pullin is D.
d. If the pullin for the clip is the X frame, you need to modify the timecode to produce
a number you can associate with a pullin. For example, if the A frame ends in 0 or 5,
and the start timecode ends in 2, the pullin falls on the X frame and you need to
modify the timecode along with the pullin. Move forward one frame to create a start
timecode ending in 3. Then you can change the pullin to C.
c When you change the timecode of a clip, you lose the key number of the clip and need
to enter it in the bin, adjusting it to match any changes to the timecode.
After you determine the pullin frame, modify the clip information as follows.
180
DV and HDV Scene Extraction
With the new clip information in the bin, batch capture the clip. See “Batch Capturing Clips”
in the Help. If the pulldown phase is accurate, the clip should play smoothly, with no
repeated frames.
n This method might not work for some clips that start with either an A frame or a D frame. If,
after you modify the clip as described previously, the clip still stutters, modify the clip again.
This time, if the pullin is A, change it to D. If the pullin is D, change it to A.
Discontinuities in the DV or HDV TOD metadata indicate each place in a master clip or
subclip where a new take was initiated on a DV or HDV camera. Using this feature, you can
capture an entire DV or HDV tape as a single master clip and have the system automatically
locate all the takes for you, eliminating the need to manually log.
181
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
You can perform a DV Scene Extraction in two ways and an HDV Scene Extraction one
way:
• Set up the DV or HDV Scene Extraction option before capturing. When capturing is
performed, subclips and locator marks appear in the bin.
• Perform DV Scene Extraction after capturing. Select those clips in the bin for which you
want to generate subclips and locator marks.
182
DV and HDV Scene Extraction
8. Click OK.
In the bin, subclips are created with the same source clip name and the file name
extension .sub.01 where TOD information breaks occurred. Locator marks appear in the
master clip where TOD information breaks occurred.
If you select a DVCPRO, a non-DV, or an audio-only clip, an error message appears,
informing you that an incompatible clip was selected. These clips are bypassed during
the DV Scene Extraction process.
183
Chapter 4 Capturing Media: Advanced
The Panasonic VariCam® is a camera that allows the recording of frames rates between 1fps
and 60fps. For example, material captured at 24 frames per second and played back at 24
frames per second will have no speed change, but the same action captured at 48 frames per
second and played back at 24 frames per second will result in playback that is slowed down
50% (a 50% slo-mo).
The 720p format is always recording to a progressive 60 (59.94) frame tape format. The
different frame rates are achieved by selecting the desired frame rate and the camera flags
the “true” frames within the 60 frame sequence. When these flags are detected by the Avid
editing system, only those frames are captured and stored to disk. When played back at the
project’s frame rate, either a slow motion or fast motion will result.
184
Chapter 5
Importing Files: Advanced
When you import files, the system converts them into objects in a bin. You can manipulate
and edit these objects as you would any other clip or sequence. Any corresponding media
files are stored on a target drive that you specify.
For basic information about importing, see “Importing Files: Basics” in the Help or the
Basics Guide for your Avid editing application.
n Your Avid editing application supports graphics created in the following modes: RGB 8-
bits/channel, RGB 16-bits/channel, and grayscale, including alpha channels. For more
information, see “Import Specifications for Supported Graphics File Formats” on page 738.
An alpha channel must be straight; the application does not properly import premultiplied
alphas.
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
When you import a multilayered graphic, you can import each layer as a separate object (a
matte key or master clip). You can then manipulate individual layers like any other matte key
or master clip. You can also import the graphic as a flattened image, or select the layers to
import.
186
Importing Photoshop Graphics
A typical multilayered Photoshop graphic might consist of a collage of still images over a
background image, with a layer of text. Each image is on its own layer in the Photoshop file
(with the background image on the lowest layer), and the text is also on its own layer. The
goal is to edit the collage into a sequence, building it up one image at a time, and then add
the text. The following illustration shows the graphics and layers in Photoshop.
187
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
Your Avid editing application imports each layer as an individual matte key with alpha
channel. In this example, the graphic uses a background image, so the system creates the
background image as a master clip. (If the graphic used a transparent background, the
background layer would be imported as a matte key.)
During the import, your Avid editing application creates a sequence with each layer on a
separate video track; this makes it easy to edit all layers into the final sequence. This
sequence preserves the names and order of the layers as created in the original Photoshop
file, as shown in the following illustration.
188
Importing Photoshop Graphics
You can then edit the tracks to build up to the full collage.
You should be aware of the following requirements for multilayered graphics import and
details of how your Avid editing application handles the import:
• Graphics must be RGB 8 or 16 bits, or grayscale.
• Layer order and layer names are preserved during import.
• Hidden layers are imported as matte keys.
• Opacity is converted to Foreground level in the Matte Key effect.
• Text and shape layers are rasterized (converted from vector-based to bitmap) during
import.
• Not all layer options and types are supported for import.
For information on support for layer options and types, see the following tables.
For information on preserving layer effects during import, see “Preserving Layer Effects
in Multilayered Photoshop Graphics” on page 191.
189
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
Blending Mode No To preserve the blending mode (Dissolve, Multiply, and so on), merge the
layer into another layer that does not use a special blending mode. Only
normal mode is supported.
Opacity Yes The imported layer’s Level is set to the opacity specified in Photoshop. You
can adjust opacity levels with the Foreground Level control in the Effect
Editor.
Layer Group Partial Layer grouping is ignored. All layers, including grouped layers, are imported
as individual layers. To preserve a clipping group, merge the grouped layers
into the base layer.
Layer Set Partial All layers within a set are imported as individual layers.
Layer/Set Mask No Layer and set masks are ignored. To preserve a layer mask, apply it to the
layer. To preserve a set mask, merge the set into an empty layer. To preserve a
special layer’s mask, rasterize the layer.
Layer Style No Layer styles are ignored. To preserve a layer style, you must convert the style
into layers.
Solid Layer Yes Solid layers are imported as a graphic with a full-screen opaque alpha
channel.
190
Importing Photoshop Graphics
Some layer options in Photoshop are not supported for import into your Avid editing
application. See “Support for Multilayered Photoshop Graphics Import” on page 189. For
example, a title with a Drop Shadow and an Outer Glow effect would not keep these effects
when imported.
To preserve the effects in these layers, merge them in Photoshop (as described in the
Photoshop documentation) and then import the file.
You can also preserve layer effects and the original structure of the file by importing the file
in two stages:
1. For the first import, click Select Layers and select all layers except the layers that
contain layer effects.
2. For the second import, open Photoshop, hide the layers you’ve already imported, and
show the layers that contain layer effects. During the import, click Flattened Image. The
resulting image contains only the layers that contain layer effects.
191
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
t If you select a single file, and the number of layers exceeds the number of tracks
supported, the following message box opens.
n Hidden layers are not combined in the flattened image. Make sure all layers you want in the
final image are visible. In addition, layers with partial transparency do not display properly
in the flattened, imported image. See “Importing Single-Layer Photoshop Graphics” on
page 186.
Your Avid editing application displays messages as it creates media for each layer. At the
end of the process, the objects are displayed in the bin you selected.
192
Importing Media from XDCAM Devices
The following table lists the formats and resolutions available when you work with XDCAM
media:
XDCAM Resolutions
DVCAM: 4
DV 25 411 (NTSC and PAL)
DV 25 420 (PAL)
193
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
n The 1394 port on your computer must be on a bus separate from the one used by the Avid
DNA hardware.
You can have multiple XDCAM devices connected to your system at any one time. Each
device appears as a separate optical drive, similar to a CD-ROM or DVD-ROM drive. The
drive’s volume label carries an XDCAM identifier — for example, XDCAM (E:).
To use the XDCAM device with your Avid editing application, you need to install the
appropriate device driver included with the Sony XDCAM deck or camera. For more
information on connecting and configuring your XDCAM device, see the documentation
that came with your Sony product.
XDCAM HD media, like other XDCAM media, is imported at the data rate at which it was
recorded in one of the following resolutions:
• XDCAM HD HQ (17.5 mb/sec)
• XDCAM HD HQ (25 mb/sec)
• XDCAM HD HQ (35 mb/sec)
194
Importing Media from XDCAM Devices
However, when you create new media (create a title, render effects, transcode, and so on),
you need to select a different resolution. The choice of resolutions is based on the project
format. For example, in a 1080i/59.94 project, your can create media as DNxHD 220x,
DNxHD 220, or DNxHD 145.
You can play XDCAM HD media to a Client monitor or output a digital cut as Best
Performance (yellow/yellow) or Draft Quality (yellow/green). However, to play or output as
Full Quality (green/green), you must transcode the XDCAM HD media to a DNxHD
resolution or another compatible resolution.
195
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
You can use these settings to override the selections made in the Select Files to Import dialog
box or to set default behavior for importing XDCAM media. For more information on
Import Settings, see “Import Settings: XDCAM Tab” in the Help. You can also view this
information by clicking the dialog box and pressing the F1 key.
n Low-resolution proxy media have the same number of audio tracks as the high-resolution
formats.
196
Importing Media from XDCAM Devices
For some workflows, you might want to import the proxy media first so you can start
editing. Once you create your sequence, you can use the batch import function to import
only those portions of the high-resolution clips needed for your sequence.
For other workflows, you might want to import the proxy media to an editing workstation,
and then separately import the high-resolution media either to another workstation or to an
Avid Unity server using Avid Interplay Transfer. Your Avid editing application maintains the
connection between the proxy media and the high-resolution media, so you can relink the
edited clips at any time to the high-resolution master clips in a shared storage environment.
n When you relink proxy media to high-resolution media, do not select Specific Resolution as
the Relink Method option. Instead, select either Highest Quality or Most Compressed.
The import process for XDCAM media differs from the standard import in that you can
import XDCAM media only at the native resolution of the XDCAM media (for information
on XDCAM resolutions, see “Importing Media from XDCAM Devices” on page 193).
Audio for high-resolution XDCAM media is imported at a sample rate of 48 kHz. If the
sample rate for your project is different (for example, 44.1 kHz), you need to change the
sample rate for the XDCAM audio before you can monitor it in the Timeline or export the
media as a sequence. For information on changing the sample rate, see “Changing the
Sample Rate” in the Help.
XDCAM cameras record proxy audio at a sample rate of 8 kHz. When you import proxy
media, you can choose to change (upconvert) the sample rate to your project rate. This might
slow the import process a bit, but it greatly improves playback of audio tracks.
197
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
You can use this method to automate the process of importing proxy media from your
XDCAM device to your Avid editing application.
n If you do not select a bin, or if you have more than one bin open, a dialog box opens and
directs you to select from a list of open bins or to create a new bin.
198
Importing Media from XDCAM Devices
Single/Dual
Drives button
n Your Avid editing application uses the disk label for operations such as Batch Import, where
you are prompted to insert a specific XDCAM disc that holds the files you want to import. A
disk label is required in order to import XDCAM media.
8. Click the Single/Dual Drives button, and select a destination drive for the imported file
from the menu.
9. Click Import.
When your application finishes importing the files, the clips appear in the selected bin.
n Your Avid editing application imports XDCAM media at the native resolution of the media
on the XDCAM disc. Your application ignores other resolution settings — for example, in the
Select Files to Import dialog box.
You can repeat this procedure for each XDCAM disc that holds media you want to import.
You can use this method when you want to import all of the proxy media stored on your disc,
but you have not opted to import the proxy media automatically. If you want to import only
some of the files on your disc, use the procedure described in “Manually Importing
XDCAM Media from the XDCAM Disc” on page 201.
n For information on setting the XDCAM import to start automatically, see “Automatically
Importing Proxy Media” on page 198.
199
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
Single/Dual
Drives button
n Your Avid editing application uses the disk label for operations such as Batch Import, where
you are prompted to insert a specific XDCAM disc that holds the files you want to import. A
disk label is required in order to import XDCAM media.
5. Click the Single/Dual Drives button, and select a destination drive for the imported file
from the menu.
6. Click Import.
When your application finishes importing the files, the clips appear in the selected bin.
n Your Avid editing application imports XDCAM media at the native resolution of the media
on the XDCAM disc. Your application ignores other resolution settings — for example, in the
Select Files to Import dialog box.
You can repeat this procedure for each XDCAM disc that holds media you want to import.
You might want to import proxy media when the XDCAM device is not available. For
example, if you want an editor to start editing the XDCAM footage while the actual
XDCAM disc is at another location, you can transfer the proxy media files to an FTP server.
The files then can be downloaded from the server, and an editor can import the proxy media
and begin editing. Later, you can relink the proxy media to the high-resolution media, or use
the batch import function to import the high-resolution media for final editing and finishing.
When you copy the XDCAM media files from the XDCAM device to another system or to a
removable drive, you need to copy only the Sub folder (for proxy media) or the Clip folder
(for high-resolution media).
200
Importing Media from XDCAM Devices
A possible workflow for importing XDCAM proxy media from a non-XDCAM drive uses
the following steps:
1. Copy the proxy folder (Sub) from an XDCAM device to an FTP server.
2. Download the files to a local drive.
3. Import the proxy media to an Avid editing application from a local drive just as you
would from an XDCAM disc, and then begin editing. See “Manually Importing
XDCAM Media from the XDCAM Disc” on page 201.
4. When the XDCAM disc is available, either import or batch import the high-resolution
media to finish editing. See “Importing Files” in the Help or “Batch Importing High-
Resolution Media” on page 205.
You can use the standard Import function to import XDCAM media into your Avid
application. You set the default XDCAM import options in the XDCAM tab of the Import
Settings dialog box. For more information on import options, see “Import Settings: XDCAM
Tab” in the Help.
n Your Avid editing application imports XDCAM media at the native resolution of the media
on the XDCAM disc. Your application ignores other resolution settings — for example, in the
Select Files to Import dialog box.
The MXF media files are located in the following directories on your XDCAM disc:
• High-resolution media — XDCAM drive:\Clip
• Proxy media — XDCAM drive:\Sub
201
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
You can import Essence Marks as locators when you import either proxy media or high-
resolution media. The locators appear in the master clips created by importing XDCAM
media, and you can view them in the Source/Record monitor, in the Timeline, and in the
Locators window. For information on using locator information as you edit, see “Using
Locators” on page 331.
202
Importing Media from XDCAM Devices
XDCAM proxy media is single-field resolution media. For the best performance during
playback, select Draft Quality or Best Performance from the Video Quality Menu in the
Timeline. For more information, see “Optimizing Your Playback Performance” in the Help.
You can improve playback further by using 8-bit processing for your video display. See
“Video Display Settings” on page 722.
203
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
10-bit
Playback
n Some effects, such as IllusionFX and FluidMotion effects, do not play back in real time when
you have Draft Quality selected. For these effects, you must also select the Progressive
Source button in the Effect Editor before rendering.
You can also perform emergency play-to-air operations of the proxy media as a normal
export, as a Send to Playback operation, or as a digital cut.
204
Importing Media from XDCAM Devices
n The Disk Label column in the bin headings displays the XDCAM disk labels created when
you imported the XDCAM media. For information on displaying bin columns, see “Bin
Column Headings” on page 237. If necessary, you can use the Modify command to change
the name in the Disk Label column.
You can also import the high-resolution media files separately. Since importing
high-resolution master clips requires more storage, time, and bandwidth than batch
importing only the necessary parts of clips, you might want to import the master clips to
another workstation or to another system in a shared storage environment — for example, to
an Avid Unity server. Once the high-resolution media is imported, you can use the Relink
command to move between the proxy media and the high-resolution media. For more
information about relinking media, see “Editing and Finishing High-Resolution Media” on
page 208 and “Relinking Media Files” on page 269.
205
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
n If your source media is stored on multiple XDCAM discs, and you have multiple XDCAM
devices, you can insert all the discs at the same time.
206
Importing Media from XDCAM Devices
Single/Dual
Drives button
Video Drive
and Audio
Drive menus
n Your Avid editing application imports XDCAM media using the native resolution of the
XDCAM files.
10. Click the Video Drive and Audio Drive menus, and select a destination drive or drives
for all the media files.
You can separate video and audio onto different drives.
11. Click Import.
The high-resolution files are imported. If the source media is stored on more than one
disc and not all discs are currently attached to your system, the system prompts you to
insert additional discs as needed.
207
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
As you edit your sequence, you can move between the proxy media and the high-resolution
media by relinking your clips with the corresponding media files. When you relink proxy
media to the high-resolution media, select one of the following Relink Method options:
- Highest Quality
- Most Compressed
This allows the audio tracks to relink to the appropriate audio files. For more information
about the Relink command, see “Relinking Media Files” on page 269.
n The Outakes.bin contains clips that were discarded by the Editcam operator. These clips are
generally not imported.
208
Importing Editcam Files
n If the drive or volume is not listed, go back to step 1 and follow the procedure again.
Your Avid editing application creates entries in the selected bin that reference the clips on
the FieldPak.
For more information on importing files, see “Importing Files: Basics” in the Help.
For additional information regarding Editcam, CamCutter technology, and how these
systems operate with nonlinear editors, see the Web site www.nltek.com.
209
Chapter 5 Importing Files: Advanced
210
Chapter 6
Working with Bins: Advanced
Your Avid editing application provides powerful database tools for organizing and managing
your captured material. You can view bins in four different display views. You can rename,
sort, sift, duplicate, and delete clips and sequences. You can also print single-clip frames or
whole bins.
For basic information about bins, see “Working with Bins: Basics” in the Help or the Basics
Guide for your Avid editing application.
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
It is good practice to copy or duplicate clips as you reorganize them in bins. As a result, the
original source clips will remain in the appropriate dailies bin if you ever need to recapture
according to source tape.
212
Advanced Bin Procedures
• Statistics view: Uses the standard statistical column headings derived from information
established during capture, such as start and end timecodes, duration, resolution, and
so on.
Text tab
If you import a log file from your telecine transfer, most of this information is placed in the
bin when you import the log. If you do not have a film log, you can enter this information
manually by highlighting the field in the bin and typing the information.
For more information on bin column headings, see “Bin Column Headings” on page 239.
You can create and save customized bin views that you can easily access from the Bin View
menu. You can customize the bin view by resizing the Bin window and adding, hiding, or
rearranging bin columns. The only required column heading is Name, and it is displayed by
default.
To customize views of the bin, you can add, hide, copy, or rearrange standard or customized
columns in any combination to create your own custom views. You can name and save them
to suit your needs. See “Saving a Custom Bin View” on page 214.
When you create a new bin view, the system saves the settings for this view so that you can
later access and alter, copy, or delete these settings. New bin view settings appear in the
Settings list in the Project window.
213
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
Any time you add, hide, or delete a column, the bin view name changes to an italic name
with the file name extension .n to indicate that it no longer matches the original view. If you
select a new bin view setting while the current setting is untitled or italic, the system discards
the current setting.
n If you do not save the view after adding or deleting headings, it is discarded.
To change a custom bin view with the Bin View dialog box:
1. Click the Settings tab in the Project window.
The Settings list appears.
2. Double-click the custom bin view you want to change.
The Bin View dialog box opens.
3. Select and deselect the columns you want to see.
4. Click OK.
n Clip colors assigned to sequences, groups, motion effects, and title clips do not appear in the
Timeline.
214
Advanced Bin Procedures
n After you assign a custom color, the color appears as Other in the Set Clip Color submenu.
t (Text view only) Click in the Color column and select a color from the menu.
t (Text view only) Alt+click (Windows) or Option+click (Macintosh) in the Color
column in the bin, and then select one of the colors.
When you Alt+click or Option+click in the Color column, the menu of colors that
appears is limited to the colors you are currently using in the bin.The color appears in
the Color column (Text view only) and on the clip icon.
You can also sift on a timecode (or keycode) number within a specific range. For more
information, see “Sifting Timecodes or Keycode Ranges” on page 217.
215
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
Column or Range to
Criterion menu Text to Find text box Search menu
2. Click the Criterion menu, and select one of the sifting options.
3. Click the first Text to Find text box, and type the text that you want to use as a sift
criterion. When sifting by color, type the exact name of the color (using uppercase and
lowercase letters) in the text box.
4. Click the Column or Range to Search menu, and select a column heading to which you
want to apply the criterion.
5. Type additional sift criteria, and make additional column selections as necessary.
6. Click OK.
Only the clips or sequences that meet your criteria remain in the bin, with the word
“sifted” added to the bin name.
After you have sifted the clips in a bin, you can display the bin in a sifted or an unsifted state.
216
Advanced Bin Procedures
The word “sifted” appears in parentheses after the bin name when you view the bin in its
sifted state.
For example, type 01:08:32:00 in the Text to Find text box in the Custom Sift dialog
box, click the Column or Range to Search menu, and select Start to End Range.
217
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
Some column pairs explicitly define a range, for example, Start and End or Mark IN and
Mark OUT. Other columns define the beginning of a range, and the end of the range is
determined by the Duration column. For example, Auxiliary TC1 implies a range that begins
at the value in the Auxiliary TC1 column and ends at that value plus the value in the
Duration column.
If you display any column in the bin that is associated with ranges, either explicit or implicit,
the corresponding range menu item appears in the Column or Range to Search menu in the
Custom Sift dialog box. For example, if you choose to display the Start column and the
Auxiliary TC1 column in the bin, the Start to End Range and Auxiliary TC1 Range menu
choices will appear in the Column or Range to Search menu.
When specifying a timecode or keycode number, you do not need to enter colons or
semicolons, and you can omit the leading zero. For example, you can type 3172000 as a
timecode number.
Keycodes contain letters, numbers, and a dash before the feet and frames; for example, KJ23
6892-0345+13. When sifting on a keycode number, you have to enter only the numbers after
the dash (the actual counter portion). Any information before the dash is ignored. If you do
enter characters before the dash, they must match the corresponding characters in the bin
column exactly.
The following table lists all columns associated with explicit ranges and their corresponding
menu choices.
218
Advanced Bin Procedures
The following table lists all columns associated with implicit ranges and their corresponding
menu choices. The Duration column determines the end of these ranges.
219
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
To lock items:
1. Click a clip, subclip, or sequence to select it. Ctrl+click (Windows) or Shift+click
(Macintosh) additional clips, if necessary.
2. Select Clip > Lock Bin Selection.
A Lock icon appears for each locked clip in the Lock column of the bin in Text view.
Lock icons
n If the Lock column is not displayed, you might have hidden that column. For information on
hiding and restoring bin columns, see “Manipulating Bin Columns” on page 223.
n You can use the clip-locking feature along with archiving software to automatically archive
all locked media files. For more information on archiving locked files, see your archiving
software’s documentation.
220
Advanced Bin Procedures
n To identify offline items in the Timeline, see “Highlighting Offline Media Clips” in the Help.
221
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
n You can also use the Media tool to look at the captured video and audio data files stored on
your media drives. For more information on the Media tool, see “Using the Media Tool” in
the Help.
n The Select Unreferenced Clips command is useful for finding unused footage or media.
n The Select Unreferenced Clips command is effectively the reverse of the Select Media
Relatives command.
222
Using Text View: Advanced
When you align bin columns, the system maintains the same order of columns from left to
right but spaces them according to the length of their contents. This is especially useful for
removing spaces remaining after you move or rearrange columns.
Deleting a statistical column is the same as hiding the column; you can restore the column at
any time by using the Bin Column Selection dialog box. When you delete a custom
column, however, you must re-create the column.
For information on selecting column headings to display or hide them in the bin, see “Using
Text View” in the Help.
You can also duplicate columns, add customized columns, and change the heading name of
columns in a bin, as described in the following procedures.
To delete a column:
1. Click the column heading in a bin.
2. Do one of the following:
t Select Edit > Delete.
t Press the Delete key.
The column disappears from the view, and surrounding columns close to fill the space.
223
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
When you duplicate a timecode column (Start, TC 24, TC 25, TC 25P, or TC 30), the values
for master clips and subclips are converted to the appropriate timecode. For more
information, see “Displaying Timecodes in a 24p or 25p Project” on page 237.
224
Using Text View: Advanced
The naming and counting scheme consists of a prefix (8 character maximum), separated by a
dash (-), and followed by 6 characters that count as total frames. For example, FXS32v01-
000001 identifies the first frame of a series of frames that belong to an FX shot for Scene 32
version 1. As the FX shot progresses during the creative process, the version number
increases.
n To compensate for offsets, you can subtract the number of header and information frames
from 999999 when entering the frame number. For example, if the first frame of picture is 1
and there are 8 frames of header and identification frames you would enter FXS32v01-
999993 for the frame number.
225
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
To display the frame count numbers above the Source or Record monitors in the Avid
editing application:
1. Follow the steps for displaying the frame count numbers in a bin.
2. From the Tracking Information Menu above the monitor, select either Ink Number or
Aux Ink.
You can use the keyboard shortcuts described in the following table to move from cell to cell
in bin columns:
Shortcut Description
Tab Moves the pointer to the parallel cell in the next column. You can
continue to press the Tab key to scroll through the cells to the right until
the cell in the last column is highlighted. The next time you press the Tab
key, the cell in the first column is highlighted.
Shift+Tab Moves the pointer left to the cell in the previous column. You can
continue to press Shift+Tab to scroll through cells to the left until the cell
in the first column is highlighted. The next time you press Shift+Tab, the
cell in the last column is highlighted.
(Windows) Enter Enters any new information typed in the cell and moves the pointer down
(on main keyboard) to the cell in the next row. You can continue to press Enter to scroll down
the column until the last cell in the column is highlighted. The next time
you press Enter, the first cell in the column is highlighted.
(Windows) Shift+Enter Move the pointer up to the cell in the previous row. You can continue to
(on main keyboard) press Shift+Enter until the cell in the top row is highlighted. The next
time you press Shift+Enter, the cell in the last row is highlighted.
(Macintosh) Return Enters any new information typed in the cell and moves the pointer down
to the cell in the next row. You can continue to press Return to scroll
down the column until the last cell in the column is highlighted. The next
time you press Return, the first cell in the column is highlighted.
(Macintosh) Move the pointer up to the cell in the previous row. You can continue to
Shift+Return press Shift+Return until the cell in the top row is highlighted. The next
time you press Shift+Return, the cell in the last row is highlighted.
226
Using Text View: Advanced
You can change or modify the information in certain columns for your master clips,
subclips, tapes, and other objects stored in the bin. This is especially useful if some of the
data is incorrect or if you need to conform information for organizational purposes.
When you modify information in a bin directly, you click a cell and type the new
information. For example, you can type a new name for a clip or correct the start and end
timecodes.
You can directly modify any data in the bin while logging and prior to capture. After the
footage is captured, however, you can directly modify information only in selected headings,
with restrictions, as shown in the following table.
Heading Restrictions
Mark IN Altering the mark IN also alters the IN to OUT duration. This replaces
any previous mark.
227
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
Heading Restrictions
Mark OUT Altering the mark OUT also alters the IN to OUT duration. This replaces
any previous mark.
Cadence Ctrl+click and choose from the menu. All clips with the same tape name
will change according to what is selected.
Color No restrictions.
Color Framing Must be according to tape specifications. See “Tracking Color Frame
Shifts” on page 378.
Comments No restrictions.
Journalist No restrictions.
Production No restrictions.
KN (Key Number) Start Only for 24p projects, 25p projects, and matchback projects. Altering the
starting key number also alters the KN End to maintain the duration. This
can cause discrepancies with any auxiliary timecode information that you
entered manually.
Pullin Only for 24p projects and matchback projects. You can only alter pullin
data imported from a telecine-generated list directly before capturing or
after unlinking. See “Modifying the Pulldown Phase Before Capturing”
on page 128. (NTSC only)
You can directly modify the pullin for sequence; see “Changing the
Default Pulldown Phase for Sequences” on page 575.
Start No restrictions.
Take No restrictions.
TapeID No restrictions.
TC 24 No restrictions.
TC 25 No restrictions.
TC 25PD No restrictions.
TC 30 No restrictions.
228
Using Text View: Advanced
Heading Restrictions
TC 30NP No restrictions.
c Modifying tape names and timecodes affects any key numbers entered for the selected
clips.
The Modify command gives you specialized control over groups of clip information. For
example, you can use the Modify command to change the name of source tapes, or to
increment or decrement the start and end timecodes by a specified length of time for one or
several clips at once.
You can apply changes with the Modify command to master clips only; subclips and
sequences are not altered in this way. In addition, you can perform modifications that only
alter the end timecodes or the tracks before capture, as described in the following table.
229
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
Set Timecode Drop/ Drop, Non-drop Changes the timecode format between drop-frame and
Non-drop non-drop-frame. Setting must match the timecode
format of the tape.
Set Timecode By Field Start or End Changes either the start or end timecode. Only start
timecodes are altered after capture.
Increment Timecode Start or End Changes either the start or end timecode. Incrementing
the start timecode automatically modifies the end
timecode by the same amount. Only start timecode can
be incremented after capture.
Decrement Timecode Start or End Changes either the start or end timecode.
Decrementing the start timecode automatically
modifies the end timecode by the same amount. Only
start timecode can be decremented after capture.
Set Key Number Key Number text box Allows you to enter a custom generic key number.
Generic (Prefix) Only for 24p, 25p, and matchback projects.
Set Tracks V, A1, A2, A3, A4, A5, Changes the clip’s configuration of tracks (film
A6, A7, and A8 track projects only). The clip must be unlinked. See
selector buttons “Unlinking Media Files” on page 277.
Set Source None Opens the Select Tape dialog box. Selects another
source tape name for the clips that should match the
original source tape name.
230
Using Text View: Advanced
Set Disk Label Set label Allows you to change the name assigned to an
XDCAM disk. For more information, see “Importing
Media from XDCAM Devices” on page 193.
Set Format Compatible formats Allows you to change the format of a sequence. The
choice of formats is limited to the compatible frame
rate of the current sequence. This option is useful if
you are working with downconverted HD material in
an offline/online workflow. For more information, see
“Modifying the Format of a Sequence” on page 832
and “Converting a 23.976p NTSC Sequence to
720p/23.976” on page 834.
231
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
5. Select an option or type information into the text boxes (timecode values, for example)
when they appear.
6. Click OK.
The modification takes effect.
The film gauge consists of the film size and either the number of perfs per frame (for 35mm
and 65mm) or the number of frames per foot (for 16mm). You specify the gauge in any of
the film-gauge columns (Aux Ink Film, Ink Film, and Master Film).
232
Using Text View: Advanced
You can track 3-perf counts in film projects. The perf value is an extension of the key
number, and appears in the KN Start, Ink Number, and Aux Ink Number bin columns. A
sample key number might be as follows:
KJ 12 1234-3456-10.3
The “.3” at the end of the key number represents the perf value.
There is one edgecode per foot of film. You enter an edgecode type for a particular place on
the film in any of the edgecode-type bin columns (Aux Ink Edge, Ink Edge, Master Edge).
Select the appropriate edgecode type for a clip so you can track frames in the Timecode
window, above the Source/Record monitor, or in FilmScribe.
233
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
The following table describes the edgecode types and the appropriate format for each.
You can also sort clips by color if you have assigned colors to the clips. For more
information, see “Assigning Colors to Bin Objects” on page 214.
n You can automatically sort clips and sequences in Text view only. If you need to view sorted
clips in Script or Frame view, sort them in Text view first and then return to Script or Frame
view.
If you want to sort clips in a customized order in Text view, you must first rearrange the clips
in Script view, and then return to Text view. For information about Script view, see
“Rearranging Clips in Script View” in the Help.
n If the Sort command appears dimmed in the menu, you have not selected a column.
234
Using Text View: Advanced
This step is especially useful after you have added new clips to a sorted bin.
n For information on displaying timecodes in the Timeline and the Tracking Information
display, see “Displaying Timecode Tracks in the Timeline” on page 320 and “Displaying
Tracking Information” in the Help.
After you add a timecode column (TC 24, TC 25, TC 25P, TC 30, or TC 30NP) to a bin, you
can use the Duplicate command to convert the values for master clips and subclips to the
appropriate timecode for that column.
For example, when working with a 24p NTSC project, if you duplicate the Start column
values to one of the timecode columns and the Start column contains a master clip with the
timecode 01:00:00:15, the timecode is converted to the timecode of that column.
n The TC1 track in the Timeline represents the timecode of the project in which you are
working. For example, when you are working in a 24p NTSC project, the TC1 track displays
the same timecode as the TC 30 track.
235
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
The following table shows the frame count for each timecode. The timecodes are listed as 24
for 24 fps, 25 for 25 fps, 25P for 25 PAL with pulldown, 30 for 30 fps (the count skips six
frames to fit 30 frames into 24 fps), 30NP for 30 fps with no pulldown, and 60 for 60 fps.
Timecode Frames
24 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 00
25 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
25P 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 00
30 00 01 03 04 05 06 08 09 10 11 13 14 15 16 18 19 20 21 23 24 25 26 28 29 00
30NP 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Your Avid editing application provides the ability to track multiple film gauges within a bin
and within a sequence. Bin column headings allow you to display detailed information about
edgecodes, film gauges, and source information such as scanned file type, color lookup
table, resource location, and so on.
If you are working in an Interplay environment, the list of bin column headings include
audio sample rates and video resolutions. Select from these headings to display multiple
sample rates and resolutions in the bin. For more information, see “MultiRez Bin Headings”
in the Help.
The following table describes the bin column headings. Some of the columns allow you to
enter or modify the information.
n This table includes all bin column headings available in Avid editing applications. The
columns that appear depend on the model of your Avid editing application project in which
you are working.
Heading Description
Name Heading does not appear as a column selection, but it always appears in the bin. The
column contains the name of the clip or sequence (you can rename a clip or sequence
after it has been captured).
Audio Bit Depth Audio bit depth used when you work with audio files: 16 bit or 24 bit.
Aux TC 24 Original HDTV sources (1080p/24) or audio DATs created for PAL feature film
productions that use in-camera timecode.
AuxInk Dur Length of the clip, expressed in the auxiliary ink number. You cannot modify this
number.
AuxInk Edge Type of edgecode used in the auxiliary ink number. Ctrl+click the cell, and then select
the type of edgecode. See “Selecting an Edgecode Type” on page 235.
AuxInk End Ending auxiliary ink number for the clip. You cannot modify this number.
237
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
Heading Description
AuxInk Film Film gauge for the auxiliary ink number. Ctrl+click the cell, and then select the gauge.
See “Selecting a Film Gauge” on page 234.
Auxiliary Ink Auxiliary ink format settings allow you to display an additional type of ink number.
This lets you track additional types of film information for different film gauges. Used
for 24p projects, 25p projects, and matchback projects only. Auxiliary Ink is the starting
frame for the clip.
Auxiliary TC1 through You can enter an auxiliary timecode, such as Aaton® or Arri, or another timecode for
TC5 editing film or audio timecode for film. (Not restricted to film projects.)
Cadence Type of pulldown present on the source NTSC tapes when in a 23.976 or 24p project.
Camera Camera used to film this clip. This feature is used in multicamera shoots.
Camroll Camera roll containing this clip. Used for 24p projects, 25p projects, and matchback
projects only.
Creation Date Date and time the clip was logged or captured.
Disk Label For XDCAM media, this heading displays the user-supplied disk label created when the
media file was imported. For other media, the heading displays the disk label of the
drive from which the clip was imported. For more information, see “Importing Media
from XDCAM Devices” on page 193.
DPX Frame-counting field for Digital Picture Exchange, a SMPTE standard describing
frames scanned from film. The format is the following: a descriptor of up to
32 alphanumeric characters, followed by a hyphen (-), followed by a six-digit frame
count, for example, DPXChildDocu-023657.
Drive Last known drive on which the media for that master clip existed.
FPS Play rate: the number of frames to be displayed each second. The default is 29.97 for
NTSC and 25 for PAL for video. The play rate can also be 24 or 23.98.
Film TC Timecode used on film. Used for 24p and 25p projects only.
Format The format of a clip or sequence as determined by the project type, such as 30i NTSC
or 1080i/59.94.This is especially useful if you have both SD and HD clips in the same
bin.
238
Using Text View: Advanced
Heading Description
Frame Displays the same frame that is displayed when you select Frame view for the bin. See
“Using Frame View” in the Help.
n It can take longer for the screen to display frames than text. Therefore, working
with frames can slow down the work that you do with bins.
Ink Dur Length of the clip, expressed in ink number. Used for 24p projects, 25p projects, and
matchback projects only. You cannot modify this number.
Ink Edge Type of edgecode used in the ink number. Ctrl+click the cell, and then select the type of
edgecode. See “Selecting an Edgecode Type” on page 235.
Ink End Ending ink number for the clip. You cannot modify this number.
Ink Film Film gauge for the ink number. Ctrl+click the cell, and then select the gauge. See
“Selecting a Film Gauge” on page 234.
Ink Number Ink number for the clip. Used for 24p projects, 25p projects, and matchback projects
only.
Journalist First and last name of a person associated with the clip. Metadata imported from a P2
file.
KN Film Key number film gauge. Ctrl+click the cell, and then select the gauge. See “Selecting a
Film Gauge” on page 234.
KN IN-OUT Mark IN and Mark OUT key number for the clip.
KN Mark IN Key number for the IN point, if you set one for the clip.
KN Mark OUT Key number for the OUT point, if you set one for the clip.
LUT File name of the color look-up table used for the series of clips or frames.
Mark IN Timecode for the IN point, if you set one for the clip.
Mark OUT Timecode for the OUT point, if you set one for the clip.
239
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
Heading Description
Master Dur Length of the final master sequence, expressed in feet and frames. You cannot modify
this number.
Master Edge Type of edgecode used in the final master sequence. Ctrl+click the cell, and then select
the type of edgecode. See “Selecting an Edgecode Type” on page 235.
Master End Ending key number for the final master sequence. You cannot modify this number.
Master Film Gauge of the final master sequence. Ctrl+click the cell, and then select the gauge. See
“Selecting a Film Gauge” on page 234.
Modified Date Date and time a sequence was last edited or changed.
Offline Track names for any media files that are offline.
Perf Film edge perforations format used for 3-perf projects. Used for projects brought
forward from earlier releases only; now superseded by the film size and perf options
available in Ink Film, AuxInk Film, KN Film, and Master Film.
Production Name of the production associated with the clip. Metadata imported from a P2 file.
Pullin Telecine pulldown of the first frame of the clip (pulldown phase). Pullin can have the
values A, B, X (matchback only), C, or D. Used for 24p projects and matchback
projects only. (NTSC only)
Pullout Telecine pulldown of the last frame of the clip. Pullout can have the values A, B, X
(matchback only), C, or D. Used for 24p projects and matchback projects only. (NTSC
only)
Slip Number and direction of perfs for subclips (audio clips only).
TC 24 24-fps timecode.
240
Working with Restricted Material
Heading Description
Transfer Frame-counting field for sources that have been prepped for transfer. The format is the
following: a descriptor of up to 32 alphanumeric characters, followed by a hyphen (-),
followed by a six-digit frame count, for example, TransferChildDocu-023657.
UNC Path Universal Naming Convention that specifies the location of resources on a server. The
location you enter becomes a hyperlink to that location. Ctrl+click the cell, and then
type the location.
VFX Frame-counting field for visual effects. The format is the following: a descriptor of up
to 32 alphanumeric characters, followed by a hyphen (-), followed by a six-digit frame
count, for example, FXChildDocu-023657.
Video Resolution under which the media for that clip was captured.
Video File Format Clip video format (OMF, AAF, MXF, or none).
241
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
You are also warned about the restriction when you display the restricted material in the
monitor and when you try to perform a digital cut, send the material to playback, or export it.
You can choose to continue, and you can view the reason for the restriction in the
Restrictions tool. You can change restriction comments in Interplay Assist and then view
them in the editing application.
Restricted
marker
When you first open a restricted clip or load a sequence containing restricted clips, a
warning message box opens.
The warning appears every time you perform this operation (that is, opening or displaying a
clip) on restricted material in this session, not just on the present clip.
The same warning appears when you try to do any of the following:
• Perform a digital cut
• Send the sequence to playback
• Export
If you are sending more than one clip to export, the message box lists all the clip names that
contain restricted material.
242
Working with Restricted Material
If you know that you are allowed to use all restricted material in the current project and can
safely ignore the warning for this particular operation, you can continue with your editing or
output task.
To ignore the warning for the rest of the editing session and continue with editing or
output:
t Click the “Don’t warn again” button.
You no longer see restriction warnings for the current clip or any other clip in this
editing session. When you quit your Avid editing application and then open it, you see
the warning again the first time you try to display or output restricted material.
n Clicking “Don’t warn again” in the warning message box stops the warning from appearing
again only for the current operation in the current editing session. For example, if you click
it after displaying a clip in the Source monitor, you can load additional restricted clips
without seeing the message. If you select those clips for Export, however, you see the
warning again.
Disassociating Restrictions
The restriction is tied to the source tape name and timecode. You might disassociate the
restriction from the clip if you change those values in the bin. For more information about
bins, see “Working with Bins: Basics” in the Help.
Comments
from Logger
about
restriction
243
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
The following table lists the Avid Interplay restriction attribute name, its description, and the
values you can enter for it when specifying an extended search.
DRM Digital Rights Management, the cover title for the • Has DRM
use of restrictions.
• Does not have DRM
Printing Bins
You can print entire bins or individual frames.
244
Preparing Digital Bars and Tone
There are several ways to acquire a clip of bars, each with different advantages:
• Record bars and tone from a house generator. This method requires the least effort
with good results because you record high-quality bars and tone simultaneously, with a
minimum of calibration. Not all facilities, however, have a house generator.
• Record bars and tone from a videotape. This method allows you to record bars and
tone simultaneously, but you must calibrate carefully to ensure accuracy. In addition, the
final clip reflects the quality of the source tape recording.
• Record bars from an external color bar generator. This method provides good
results, but you must have a color bar generator available, and you must rearrange your
system inputs to attach the generator. In addition, you must acquire tone separately and
sync it with bars within your Avid editing application.
245
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
• Import a file of bars. This method provides the highest quality results because the
source image is already digital. If the file is accurate, the quality of the clip is ensured.
You must, however, acquire tone separately and sync it with bars within your Avid
editing application. For more information, see “Importing Color Bars and Other Test
Patterns” on page 248.
246
Creating Leader
n Match the resolution of the tone to the audio resolution of the sequence.
11. Load the new color bars clip into the Source monitor, and create a subclip of appropriate
length for use in sequences (1 minute is a common standard).
12. Select the new subclip, Ctrl+click (Windows) or Shift+click (Macintosh) the audio clip
containing the tone, and select Bin > AutoSync.
A new subclip containing bars and tone appears in the bin.
13. Rename the clip as necessary.
Creating Leader
Film editors traditionally use standard head and tail leaders for cueing and syncing material.
You can use digital leaders in your Avid editing application to mark the beginning and
ending of tracks and to help you maintain sync, as described in “Managing Sync with
Multiple Tracks” on page 353. You can create your own leader for video or film. Whatever
you choose for specifications, make all your leader clips the same length, with common sync
points.
247
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
Once the leader is prepared, you can splice the leader during editing onto the tracks that you
want to keep in sync. You can use the sync points for visually aligning tracks.
248
Creating Leader
6. Prepare the sound levels for leader that include a sync point (audio pop) by doing the
following:
a. Find the appropriate sync point.
Step one frame backward and place an add edit before the sync frame; then step two
frames forward and place an add edit after the sync frame.
For information on placing add edits, see “Adding an Edit (Match Framing)” on
page 372.
b. Move the position indicator before the first add edit, and open the Audio Mixer tool.
c. Bring the audio level all the way down.
d. Move the position indicator after the second add edit, and use the Audio Mixer tool
to bring the level all the way down.
After the leader is prepared, you can splice the leader during editing onto the audio tracks
that you want to keep in sync. You can use the sync points for visually aligning tracks.
249
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
250
Creating Leader
251
Chapter 6 Working with Bins: Advanced
252
Chapter 7
Managing Media Files: Advanced
When you capture footage, the system creates digital media files for the video and audio
tracks on the media drives attached to your system. Bin tools allow you to organize the clips
that reference the media files. In addition, your Avid editing application provides tools and
features for directly managing media files for storage and playback efficiency, for backup,
and for transfer between systems.
For basic information about managing media, see “Managing Media Files: Basics” in the
Basics Guide for your Avid editing application.
Panasonic P2 Formats
Avid editing applications support the following resolutions, captured by Panasonic P2
equipment at frame rates of 30i NTSC and 25i PAL:
DV DV 25 411 (NTSC) 2
DV 25 420 (PAL)
DVCPRO HD 720p 4
1080i
Avid editing applications support one video track and up to four tracks of 48 kHz, 16-bit
audio, the maximum you can record on Panasonic P2 equipment.
254
Using Panasonic DVCPRO P2 Equipment
The following illustration shows examples of the MXF audio and video files contained in the
Audio and Video folders.
Audio folder
Video folder
Corresponding
video track
Panasonic P2 devices write individual MXF audio and video media files for each track of
each clip. For example, a P2 clip that includes one track of video and four tracks of audio is
stored on the P2 card as five individual media files. Within the Avid editing application the
five media files are represented as a single clip with audio and video.
255
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
Before you can use Panasonic P2 equipment, you need to load the appropriate drivers. These
drivers are included on a CD that is packaged with your Panasonic P2 equipment.
You can mount P2 cards as drives on your desktop and use the files without importing them
or capturing them through the Capture tool. To your Avid editing application, these mounted
cards function as individual media drives.
n P2 cards can function as media drives even though the MXF files are not contained in an
Avid MediaFiles folder.
256
Using Panasonic DVCPRO P2 Equipment
After installing the appropriate Panasonic driver, you can mount the cards as drives from any
of these devices:
• PCMCIA card slot: Notebook computers typically include a PCMCIA card slot that will
accept individual P2 cards.
• P2 drive: Panasonic offers P2 card-reading peripherals such as the AJ-PCD10 memory
card drive. You can connect this drive, or card reader through a USB port, or you can
install it as an internal drive on a desktop PC. This card reader provides access to five P2
cards at one time.
• P2 camera or deck: Panasonic cameras and decks, such as the AJ-SPD850, provide
access to P2 cards through a USB port.
Before mounting P2 cards as drives on a Macintosh system, you need to set write-protection
on the cards.
Before using a P2 card reader with a Windows system, you need to set Autoplay options.
257
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
n If you don’t have enough cards to fill all the slots, you can reuse a card in multiple slots to
perform the following drive letter setup.
n (Windows only) Some card slots of the P2 drive might require drive letters that have already
been assigned to existing network drives. If your computer does not display all five card
slots as drives, reassign the network drives or restart your system.
After you mount the P2 drives, you have the option of copying the P2 media to a FireWire
drive or a network drive and then ejecting the card. You might find it convenient to copy
several P2 cards to other drives so the cards can be reused quickly. Your editing application
supports P2 copies as though they were actual P2 cards.
You can connect a FireWire drive, for example, and store the contents of several P2 cards on
it so you can keep using the cards in the camera.
n You can work with media on a P2 card or work with media on another drive, but you cannot
work with media that is stored in both places simultaneously. To avoid the problem, eject the
P2 card after you have copied the P2 files to the other drive.
258
Using Panasonic DVCPRO P2 Equipment
After you mount the drives, you have the additional option of copying the media to a local
media drive and then ejecting the card.
n You can work with media on a P2 card or work with media on local storage, but you cannot
work with media that is stored in both places simultaneously. To avoid the problem, eject the
P2 card after you have copied the P2 media files to a local media drive.
n Avid recommends that you use the Copy function to copy files from the P2 drive. Do not use
the Move function. On some systems you might have a problem deleting the files that you
have moved.
259
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
You can change (“hot-swap”) cards while you are working in your Avid editing application.
P2 media files include information (metadata) that lets them appear as master clips in an
Avid editing application session. You can import the P2 clips directly from a P2 card or a
copy of a P2 card on another drive into a bin in your editing application. You can also import
the media associated with the clips if you want to reuse the P2 card, for example, if you want
to capture additional material onto the card in a camera. For more information about copying
P2 cards to another drive, see “Copying P2 Files to a FireWire or Network Drive” on
page 258.
c Do not navigate into the Contents folder or into other folders in the volume. The
editing application navigates into the folders for you.
n The Import P2 option imports all the clips on the card. To import only selected clips, see
“Dragging P2 Master Clips from the Media Tool to a Bin” on page 261.
260
Using Panasonic DVCPRO P2 Equipment
4. Click OK.
A progress box appears as the clips import. When the import is complete, the clips
appear in the active bin. You can play and edit the clips; the media resides on the P2
card. If you leave the application and then restart it, you see the clips in the bin, but the
media is offline. You need to import the clips again to continue working with them.
You can also drag P2 master clips from the Media tool to a bin. You can select particular
clips to bring into the bin.
261
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
Windows
262
Using Panasonic DVCPRO P2 Equipment
Macintosh
263
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
5. Click OK.
The Media tool displays the clips contained on the drives you selected.
n If you do not see any media clips, update the mounted drives and media database again by
selecting File > Mount All and File > Refresh Media Directories. You might also need to
restart the application.
264
Using Panasonic DVCPRO P2 Equipment
The following illustration shows how clips can span multiple P2 cards.
P2 Card 1
P2 Card 2
Clip 1
P2 Card 3
Clip 2
P2 Card 4
Clip 3
P2 Card 5
Clip 4
When you are working with spanned clips, consider the following:
• If you remove a card that contains a spanned clip, for example Card 2 in the above
example, and you try to play Clip 1, it plays until it reaches the portion of the clip that
resides on Card 2. The Media Offline slide appears until you reach the media on Card 3.
Avid recommends that you do not place another card in the removed card’s place unless
you remove all the cards that contain the spanned clip (P1 and P3 in this example).
• Cards containing spanned and unspanned master clips can be mixed. However, if a card
containing a chunk of a spanned clip is ejected and another card is inserted, the master
clips in the newly inserted card are not visible in the Media Tool but the media files are
visible. You can work around this by removing all the cards containing chunks of the
spanned clip and performing a File > Unmount followed by a File > Mount All. All the
master clips will be visible.
265
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
• P2-spanned media covers multiple drives, but the bin displays only one drive letter. The
drive letter in the bin might be any of the drives, but is usually the highest lettered drive
where the media exists.
• If necessary, copy all spanned clips to another drive to ensure a clip’s integrity before
swapping out the P2 cards.
For more information on workgroup support, see the Avid Interplay Help.
n Some card slots of the P2 drive might require drive letters that have already been assigned
to existing network drives. If your computer does not display all five card slots as drives,
reassign the network drives or restart your system.
266
Using Panasonic DVCPRO P2 Equipment
n If you are connected to more than one P2 device, make sure only one is turned on. If more
than one device is turned on, you cannot control which device you export to.
n If you are not connected to a P2 device or camera, the options are not available.
5. (Option) If you are connected to a P2 device and it does not appear in the P2 Device list,
select File > Mount All to update the list of mounted drives.
6. Click Save.
A progress window opens, and the orange light on the P2 card flashes indicating that the
card is being written to. If you have more than one card in the device, the application
writes to the first one in the list. If your sequence is larger than the space available on
that card, the application fills the first card and then writes to the next card.
267
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
Deleting P2 Clips
When you are working in your Avid editing application, you can delete P2 master clips, but
you cannot delete media files that reside on P2 drives. Your Avid application treats P2 files
as read-only devices.
n You can also delete files or reformat the card by using the Panasonic P2 Viewer, which is
available as a free download from Panasonic.
In your Avid editing application, you can delete P2 master clips and media files the same
way you delete other master clips and media files. However, you might not be able to delete
P2 files that you moved rather than copied. If you cannot delete P2 master clips and media
files, first unlock the clips, as described in the following procedure, and then delete them.
To delete P2 files on a local drive when working in the Avid editing application:
1. In a bin, select the clips you want to delete.
2. (Option) Right-click and select Unlock Bin Selection.
3. Press the Delete key.
The Delete dialog box opens.
4. Select Delete master clips and Delete associated media files.
5. Click OK.
268
Relinking Media Files
(Windows only) If more than one file is related to the clip, a message box asks if you
want to see the next file. If you click OK, you need to bring the Explorer window
forward by pressing and holding the Alt key while pressing the Tab key until you select
the OMFI MediaFiles folder or the Avid MediaFiles folder.
n In an Avid Interplay environment, relinking through the Relink dialog box is limited to non-
master clips (subclips and sequences). For more information, see “Using the Relink Dialog
Box in an Avid Interplay Environment” in the Help.
269
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
When you select subclips or sequences and select the Relink command, the system searches
for master clips that contain the same material included in the selection.
You can also relink master clips to appropriate media files or to source tapes with compatible
rates, and you can relink based on resolution. The system compares information such as
source tape name, timecode information, and channels captured. If the search is successful,
the system establishes new links to the available media files. You can instruct the system to
search specific drives or all available drives.
270
Relinking Media Files
The system disregards audio sample rate when matching media files.
n To maintain the original capture settings for a subclip or sequence, use the Batch Capture
command; do not use the Relink command.
Relink Options
The following table describes the options for the Relink dialog box.
Relink offline non-master Relinks subclips and sequences to the master clips that
clips to any online items contain the same material.
Relink all non-master clips Relinks related subclips or sequences to the highlighted
to selected online items clip in the bin. When you select this option, the
suboptions are available.
n
offline items
When you select “Allow relinking to offline items,”
all available drives are searched regardless of the
setting for “Relink to media on volume.”
Relink offline master clips to Relinks master clips to media files that share similar
online media files database information.
271
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
Relink to Media on Volume • All Available Drives: Searches across all media
drives that are online
• A specific drive volume: Relinks to media on a
specific media drive
Create new sequences Leaves existing sequences alone and relinks only to
copies with .relinked appended to their names. This
option is selected by default.
Match case when comparing Makes tape name search case sensitive.
tape names
272
Relinking Media Files
For example, you are editing a sequence in an NTSC 24p sequence. You then change the
project format to 1080p/24, see “Changing the Project Format” on page 830, and modify the
sequence. See “Modifying the Format of a Sequence” on page 832. A new sequence is
created with the master clips appearing offline. If the HD media is already captured (as in a
shared storage environment), you can use the command “Allow relinking to source tapes
with compatible rates,” to link to the HD media.
You can also use this command to link to clips logged without media. Then you can batch
capture the final HD media.
The following table gives project formats that have compatible rates:
n You cannot relink clips if the project format does not match the clip format. For example, if
you have unlinked SD clips in an HD project and try to relink the SD clips, nothing happens.
You need to switch the project format to a compatible HD format in the Format tab of the
Project window. The same holds true for unlinked HD clips in an SD project.
273
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
Relinking by Resolution
You can relink to clips of a specific resolution.
n In an Avid Interplay environment, you can use dynamic relinking to easily switch between
resolutions. For more information, see “Using MultiRez and Dynamic Relinking” in the
Help.
274
Relinking Media Files
275
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
For example, if you consolidated a sequence and forgot to create a duplicate, and later
decide to use the original media files instead of the consolidated media files, you can break
the new link and reestablish the old link to the original files.
n Because subclips and sequences do not point directly to the media files, you can perform this
procedure only by using the source master clips.
For example, if you have a project that requires sharing work between two different sites,
you can capture the source material once at each site and exchange only the project folder at
each stage, rather than move large media drives back and forth. The project folder can be
exchanged on floppy disks or instantly across a network. Because the media files maintain
slightly different parameters at each site, you must relink the material each time.
276
Unlinking Media Files
n Because subclips and sequences do not point directly to the media files, you can perform this
procedure only by using the source master clips.
If you have similar material from different sources, you can duplicate a set of clips, unlink
the duplicates, and then modify the sources of the duplicates before capturing the new
source material.
For example, if you are working with multicamera material, you can capture one reel,
duplicate the clips several times, unlink the duplicated clips, and rename their source tapes
to batch capture the remaining reels.
n The archive to videotape process is not available with progressive media projects.
277
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
When you archive a project, the source media files are archived to videotape, and then you
save the project files. For information about saving the project files, see “Backing Up Your
Project Information” in the Help. You can reconstruct your project with the archived files
and your source tapes.
n The media files experience generation loss when the media is archived and restored because
the target videotape format might include some compression.
The archiving process divides the archive into multiple archive sequences based on the
lengths of the available videotapes. The archiving to videotape process adds handles to the
new clips that allow you to reedit the sequence after you restore the media files from the
videotape.
During the archiving process, the original media is archived to videotape. Media with effects
is not recorded to tape because you can easily re-create the effects after the project is
recaptured. However, the handles for transition effects are included in the archive file. The
final sequence can be linked to the recaptured media to recreate the project.
Each archived master clip is stamped with the archive tape name and archive timecodes
during the restore process. The original source information on the master clips remains
unchanged.
278
Using Videotapes for Archiving and Restoring Media Files
279
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
n If the clips or sequences that you want to archive are not highlighted in the active bin,
Archive to Videotape appears dimmed in the Clip menu.
8. Click OK.
The Tape Lengths dialog box opens.
280
Using Videotapes for Archiving and Restoring Media Files
The Archive Length area displays the calculated length of time required for archiving
the media files. The archiving process might require more time than indicated because
individual clips are not divided between tapes.
9. Under the “Enter the quantity of tapes available for the archive” area, do one of the
following:
t Type the number of blank videotapes needed for the archive next to the length of
time of your blank tapes.
For example, if the archive length is 2 hours and 15 minutes, and you have
30-minute videotapes, you would type 5 in the 30 Minutes text box.
t Type a custom tape length in the Custom text box, and type the number of available
blank videotapes.
n The archiving process uses the tapes in the order listed in the Tape Lengths dialog box. For
example, if you type 10 in the 120 Minutes text box and 5 in the 60 Minutes text box, when
you start the archive your Avid editing application prompts you for each of the ten 120-
minute tapes before using the five 60-minute tapes.
After archiving your project, you can delete the media files from your Avid system to
provide more space on your media drives.
281
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
Option Description
Archive Name Type a name for the archive in the Archive Name text box. ProjectArchive is
the default name. The archive name is numbered incrementally beginning
with 001 to indicate the order of the tapes.
Start Timecode Type a value in the Start Timecode text box to set the starting timecode of the
archive on the videotape. By default, the start timecode is set to 01:00:00:00.
For Subclips and Sequences:
Use handles Select this option, and in the Handle Length text box type the number of
additional frames you want to archive at the heads and tails of the new master
clips. This option provides enough overlap for trimming and adding transition
effects.
Archive entire master clips Select this option if you want to archive entire master clips.
For Sequences:
Archive all clips in a group edit Select this option if you selected a sequence that contains group clips and you
want to archive the media for all the clips in the group.
After restoring an archive, any links to the original master clips are broken, and only the
sequence and its new master clips are linked to the newly captured media files.
282
Using Videotapes for Archiving and Restoring Media Files
4. Select Tools > Capture, and set the following options in the Capture tool:
a. Click the Deck Selection menu, and select a deck.
b. If the Select Tape dialog box opens, click Cancel to leave Tape Name unspecified.
c. Click the Res (Resolution) menu, and select a resolution.
d. Click the Target Drive menu, and select a drive volume.
e. Make sure the audio sample rate is set correctly. See “Selecting the Audio Sample
Rate” in the Help.
n For more information about setting up the Capture tool, see “Setting Up the Capture Tool”
in the Help.
n If you select only the archived sequences, the media is restored during the restore process,
but the new media is not relinked to your original clips. To relink the new media to the
original clips, select the original clips and repeat the restore process. Repeating the restore
process relinks only the selected items to the new media files.
283
Chapter 7 Managing Media Files: Advanced
284
Chapter 8
Script-Based Editing
The lined script is traditionally used as a tool for managing scene and take information
during postproduction on a dramatic feature film or television production. The script-based
editing feature in your Avid editing application allows you to adapt the lined script to the
digital realm for use in any type of production, from drama to documentary to spot
advertising.
The following topics provide information about working with script-based editing:
• Lined Script Basics
• Script Window Basics
• Manipulating Script Text
• Searching Through Script
• Linking Clips to the Script
• Interpolating Position for Script Integration
• Manipulating Slates
• Manipulating Takes
• Using Script Marks
• Finding Clips and Script
• Editing with the Script Window
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
Traditionally, the continuity person creates the lined script on the set at the time of shooting.
All notes are handwritten. The following is an example of a scene from a lined script:
33/1
33A/1 33A/2
286
Lined Script Basics
Explanation of Symbols
Each vertical line drawn through the scene represents a single take from the moment the
director says “Action” to the moment the director says “Cut.” Each scene might require
several camera angles and positions, with one or more takes, all of which are lined and
identified alphanumerically.
The following is a brief summary of the lining techniques and numbering system shown in
the example in “Lined Script Basics” on page 286:
• Master shot: The line labeled 33/1 is the master shot that usually covers all the action in
a wide shot. The first number in the label indicates the scene number as written on the
script (scene 33). The number following the slash indicates that this is the first take
captured on film for the master shot. A second take of the master shot, for example,
would be labeled 33/2.
• Additional setups: The lines for each subsequent camera setup within the scene are
labeled with the scene number (33 in our example) followed by a letter for each setup
(A, B, C, and so forth), followed by a slash and the number of the take within that setup.
These lines can be any length, depending upon what portion of the script is covered by
the particular shot.
• Off-screen dialog: The jagged lines in the script represent the parts of dialog where the
actor is off screen. For example, the character Mary Sue is off camera during the action
described in the second paragraph (when the waitress character enters), so a jagged line
is drawn through the shots that cover Mary Sue (33A/1 and 2).
When the scene is recorded on videotape — for example, in a sitcom shoot — the lined
script can also include timecode notes written next to specific lines of dialog that represent a
sync point between the dialog on the page and the recorded dialog on tape. These sync
points provide assistant editors or chief editors with a quick path to specific points in the
source material.
287
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
Unlike the traditional lining of a script, digital script integration is usually performed after
the shoot — for example, by the assistant editor — using the notes of the continuity person.
The following is an example of the script shown in “Lined Script Basics” on page 286,
prepared and lined using script integration.
Toolbar
Slates
Takes tabs
Takes
Off-screen
indicator
Color indicator
Script mark
288
Lined Script Basics
In addition to the standard lining conventions, script integration includes the following
enhancements:
• Slates: Takes are organized into slates that display a representative frame and clip name
for the take that is currently selected.
• Takes: The Takes tabs and lines extending from the bottom of each slate indicate the
number of takes for that scene. Click a Takes tab to select the take.
• Indicators: You can apply off-screen dialog indicators or colors to indicate such things
as preferred takes, takes used in the current active sequence, or line changes in dialog.
• Script marks: The double arrows marking the takes at various points represent marked
lines of dialog in the script that are synchronized to matching dialog in the source clip.
Script marks are especially effective during editing, allowing the editor to quickly locate
dialog and piece together parts of a scene.
The Script window provides additional controls for matching back to clips in the source
bins, loading and playing back takes, and searching for takes and script text.
289
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
The following is an example of an audiovisual script for a news magazine piece imported
into the Script window, with the basic features of script integration applied.
Music cuts
are linked to
appropriate
sections of
the script.
Before you begin creating Script windows, make sure you have established the proper
defaults in the Script Settings dialog box for font, margin, and display of frames and takes.
For information on Script settings, see “Script Settings Options” on page 291. These
parameters can also be changed manually.
290
Script Window Basics
See “Script Settings” on page 721 for a list of the Script Settings options.
Importing a Script
The first step in script integration is to import a script in the correct format.
c The imported script must be in text format. To maintain the original formatting,
however, export the script from your word processor by using the “Text Only with Line
Breaks” option. If you export the script as “text” only, the formatting is lost.
291
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
4. Locate the file and double-click it, or select the file and click Open.
- A script bin appears in the Bins list in the Project window.
- The script, with its original layout, appears in the Script window.
5. Change the name of the script bin by clicking the title in the Bins list in the Project
window, and typing a new name.
Option Description
None No encoding is specified; the system default is used. Select this option
when the text was created on a system with the same system character
set you are currently using. Use this option for non-Latin-based
encoding where UTF-8 was not used.
Mac (MacRoman) Select this option when the script was created on a Macintosh system
using the MacRoman character set. This is the default encoding on
Macintosh systems for plain text using the Latin character set.
292
Script Window Basics
Option Description
PC (Latin-1) Select this option when the script was created on a Window-based
system using the Latin-1 character set. This is the default encoding on
Windows-based systems for plain text using the Latin character set.
UTF-8 Select this option when the script was created using the Unicode UTF-8
character set.
n Non-native characters might not display correctly even if they are encoded in UTF-8. Even
though the text is encoded correctly, the ability to display non-native characters is limited at
this time.
n When you save a Script window, the saved file is given an .avc file name extension.
• You can select File > Open Bin to open existing Script window (.avc) files and add them
to the Other Bins folder in the Bins list in the Project window.
• You can select File > New Script to open a new script (.txt) file and add it to the Bins list
in the Project window.
• You can select File > Close to close Script windows.
293
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
n You can also use several search features, as described in “Searching Through Script” on
page 299.
The default size of the left margin is established on import, based on the current Script
settings. You can also override the margin setting and adjust the left margin after importing
the script.
294
Manipulating Script Text
n As you enlarge font size, the available sizes for the slate frames also increase. This can be
useful for presentation or screening purposes, when you need to display extra-large text and
slate frames for a large audience or across a room. For information on enlarging slate
frames, see “Resizing Slates” on page 304.
295
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
Selecting Text
Selecting text in the Script window is similar to making selections in a word processor,
except that the smallest unit you can select is an entire line of text.
Selected
lines are
highlighted
296
Manipulating Script Text
Lasso a portion of
script to select it.
Release the mouse button when you finish lassoing the selected lines. The text is
highlighted.
t Click the first line of the selection, and then Shift+click the last line. The entire block of
text is highlighted.
t Press Ctrl+A (Windows) or Command+A (Macintosh) to select all the text and takes.
n You can also extend a selection by pressing the Shift key and clicking a line of text preceding
or following the current selection.
297
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
n To rearrange or rewrite individual words or characters in the script, you should make the
changes in a word processor before importing them into a separate Script window. You can
then use the procedures in this section to copy and paste the new lines into the existing Script
window, overwriting the incorrect lines.
c You cannot undo cut, copy, or paste operations in the Script window.
n If you selected more than one line at the insertion point, no message box opens. When you
select Edit > Paste, the selected lines are replaced with the text you cut or copied in step 2.
You cannot use the Undo command after performing this step.
298
Searching Through Script
Unlike a normal deletion, the text remains in the Windows Clipboard or Macintosh
Clipboard until the next time you copy or cut a selection.
n You can use the Find Bin and Find Script buttons to match back and forth between script and
clips. For more information, see “Finding Script” on page 321.
299
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
3. Type the number for the scene or page, and click OK.
The scene number appears in the left margin and the page number appears in the right
margin next to the first line of the selected region.
New scene
number
Scene/page
status bar
Scene and page numbers both appear in the status bar at the bottom of the Script
window and reflect your current position within the script. Each scene or page number
continues throughout the script until you mark another line as the beginning of a new
scene or page.
You can change a scene or page number to correct any errors that occur when adding
numbers, and to reposition scene and page numbering to match script changes during
postproduction.
300
Searching Through Script
n You can also delete all page or scene numbering throughout a range of the script by
selecting the range of lines or the entire script.
Once you have added scene and page numbers, you can search for them quickly during
editing.
n You can also click in the page or scene display in the status bar at the bottom of the Script
window.
4. Click OK.
The first occurrence of the text is highlighted in the Script window.
5. Select Edit > Find Again to search for the next occurrence of the text.
n Make sure the pointer is over the highlighted text before releasing the mouse button.
302
Linking Clips to the Script
A slate frame appears above the text, with one or more of the takes covering the scene as
lines.
The slate
appears.
6. Continue to apply clips to additional portions of the script until you have finished
creating all your slates.
Alternatively, you can create slates one at a time, place script marks, and fine-tune the
lining of each scene before proceeding to the next portion of the script.
303
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
When you set Interpolate Position, the length of the take in the script is matched to the
length of the clip in the Source monitor. The position indicator in the Source monitor
corresponds to wherever you double-click in the take.
If you set a script mark in the take, the portions of the take on either side of the script mark
are matched to the portions of the clip on either side of the IN point in the Source monitor.
n You can change the default behavior before opening a script in the Script window by
selecting Interpolate Position in the Script Settings dialog box. See “Script Settings
Options” on page 291.
Manipulating Slates
Once you create a slate by dragging a clip into the Script window, you can manipulate the
slate’s appearance and position.
Selecting Slates
To select slates, do one of the following:
t Click a slate to select it.
t Shift+click additional slates to select all the active takes.
t Drag a lasso through a region of the script containing slates. All slates and takes within
the lasso are selected.
n Selecting multiple slates is especially useful when you are adding or deleting color or off-
screen dialog indicators across takes, as described in “Manipulating Takes” on page 308.
Resizing Slates
You can resize the slates the same way you resize frames in the bin in Frame view.
304
Manipulating Slates
n You can enlarge the font size of the script to increase the size of the slate frames. This can be
useful for presentation or screening purposes when you need a large display for an
audience. For information on resizing the font, see “Changing the Font of the Script” on
page 295.
n You can change the default behavior before opening a script in the Script window by
selecting Hold Slates Onscreen in the Script Settings dialog box. For more information, see
“Script Settings Options” on page 291.
n You can change the default behavior before opening a script in the Script window by
deselecting Show Frames in the Script Settings dialog box. See “Script Settings Options” on
page 291.
305
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
306
Manipulating Slates
The Script window shows only the first take in each nonactive slate.
A single take
is shown.
Moving a Slate
You can adjust the position of slates to make room for more slates, to avoid blocking words,
or to display takes over specific lines.
n As you move the slate, the takes continue to cover the same number of lines in the script. To
lengthen or shorten the number of lines covered in the takes at the new location, see
“Adjusting Take Lines” on page 311.
307
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
Deleting a Slate
Occasionally, you might need to delete a slate — for example, when you find that the takes
in the slate are no longer needed.
n When you delete slates and takes from the Script window, the captured source clips remain
in the source bins.
c You cannot undo the deletion of slates. To restore a slate after deletion, you need to re-
create the slate. See “Linking Clips to the Script” on page 302.
To delete a slate:
1. Select all the takes in the slate by pressing the Shift key and clicking the tab for each
take.
2. Press the Delete key.
The Delete dialog box opens.
3. Select Delete Takes, and click OK.
The slate and all its takes are deleted from the script.
Manipulating Takes
Script integration provides a number of tools and techniques for manipulating the
relationship between lined takes in the Script window and their source clips, as described in
this section.
Selecting Takes
To select takes, use one of the following methods:
t Click any take tab to select it. The outline of the take changes to red, indicating that the
take is active.
t Double-click any line in the take to select the take and load it into a monitor.
t Shift+click additional takes in the same slate or across slates to select them.
t Drag a lasso through an entire region of the script. All takes within the lasso are
selected.
n Selecting multiple takes is especially useful when you add or delete color or off-screen
dialog indicators. See “Using Color Indicators” on page 312 and “Indicating Off-Screen
Dialog” on page 311.
308
Manipulating Takes
Adding Takes
To add another take to an existing slate:
1. Select the region of the script that the take covers.
2. Open the bin where the clip for the take is located.
3. Drag the clip to the slate.
The new take appears in the slate and is applied to the selected region of the script.
n You need to manually adjust the take lines if the new take covers a region different from the
existing slate. See “Adjusting Take Lines” on page 311.
Deleting Takes
As you screen clips, you might find that a take has been applied to the wrong scene and
should be deleted from the slate. You might also decide to delete a bad take to simplify the
script interface for the editor.
c You cannot undo the deletion of takes. To restore a take after deletion, see “Adding
Takes” on page 309.
309
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
You can also select multiple takes and advance them all at once.
Loading Takes
To load individual takes into the Source monitor:
t Double-click any Takes tab.
310
Manipulating Takes
Playing Takes
To play back a take, do one of the following:
t Double-click a take to load it into the Source monitor, and then click the Play button or
press the Play key.
The clip plays back and stops when it reaches the end.
t Select a take in the script, and then click the Play button at the top of the Script window.
The clip loads and plays back in a continuous loop until you press the space bar. If you
selected more than one take, each take plays in sequence.
311
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
n You must select the range of the script that contains the off-screen dialog before enabling the
off-screen function.
n You must select the range of the script that you want to highlight with color before enabling
the color indicator function.
312
Using Script Marks
Intersection of
take and line
of dialog
The take is selected in the slate, the selected line of the dialog is highlighted, and the clip
loads into the Source monitor.
313
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
3. Click the Play button, or press the Play key. The take plays in the monitor.
Alternatively, you can step (jog) or shuttle through the footage, place the position
indicator on the exact frame, or scrub the audio to find the exact line of dialog. The clip
does not have to be playing.
4. When the playback reaches the selected line of dialog, click the Add Script Mark button
or press the Add Script Mark key.
The line is marked in the Script window with a small horizontal bar, and play stops.
314
Using Script Marks
Several takes
are selected for
automated playback.
Current playback is
highlighted in green.
3. As you hear a line of dialog (or see a particular clip) that you want to mark, click the
matching line in the Script window.
A script mark appears at that location in the take, and the clip continues to play.
n You can scroll through the Script window without affecting playback.
315
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
4. Continue to mark additional sync points using one of the following methods:
t Click a line that already contains a mark to replace the previous mark and update
the sync point in the clip.
t Click a line in the script before or after the range of the existing take line, and the
mark is added while the take line is extended to include the new line.
t Use variable-speed play controls (J-K-L keys on the keyboard) to shuttle, step, or
pause during playback.
t Press the Tab or Shift+Tab keys on the keyboard to begin playback of the next or the
previous take.
As each take reaches its end, the system automatically loads and plays the next take.
5. Continue to place marks until all takes have been screened.
316
Using Script Marks
ScriptSync Options
Option Description
Language Select the language of your script (this setting is for both the audio and
the text).
Skip lines that only contain Select this option if lines that contain only all-capital letters are not part of the
CAPITAL letters spoken dialog. Dramatic scripts often use all-capital letters to identify the
speaker or for scene descriptions.
317
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
Option Description
Skip text in parentheses ‘()’ or Select this option if parenthetical expressions in your script are not spoken.
brackets ‘[]’
Skip text before colon ‘:’ Select this option to skip all text before the first colon in a line of text. For
example, select this option if your script uses the convention of placing a
character’s name before a colon when the character begins to speak.
Skip lines indented less than Select this option if action is indented less than dialog in your script. If you
dialog select this option, also type the number of characters that dialog is indented in
the Dialog Indent (characters) text box, or click the Select Dialog button, select
a line of dialog from the Script so the application can automatically infer the
correct number of characters, and then click OK.
Overwrite existing marks Select this option if the take you are syncing already contains script marks and
you want ScriptSync to update those marks.
Sync between first and last Select this option to restrict ScriptSync to analyze only the script between the
mark lines of text and the media specified by the first and last script marks in a take.
If there is only one mark in the take, ScriptSync analyzes the script from the
text and the media specified from the first mark to the end of the take and
media. This can be useful if there is non-dialog talking on the audio clip that
you want to exclude from the syncing process.
n If you select this option and the last script mark in the take is not at the
end of the take, ScriptSync operates only until the last mark in the text.
5. Click OK.
The syncing process starts. A thermometer tracks the progress.
6. (Option) Press Ctrl+. (period) to cancel the process after it has started.
318
Using Script Marks
When ScriptSync finishes, your take includes a script mark for every line of text the
application found in the audio.
7. Check through the marks. If ScriptSync missed any, add them manually as described in
“Placing Script Marks Manually” on page 313.
319
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
c You cannot undo the deletion of script marks. To restore a script mark after deletion,
see “Placing Script Marks Manually” on page 313.
n You can select multiple script marks for removal by highlighting an entire region of text and
selecting the takes containing the script marks you want to remove.
320
Finding Clips and Script
Finding Script
The Find Script button allows you to quickly match back from currently loaded clips to
portions of script in the Script window to which the clip has been linked.
321
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
To use the Script window most effectively during a session, make sure:
• The Script window is fully prepared, including preferred takes, alternative takes
(indicated with colors), and script marks for matching lines of text to sync points in the
clips.
• The Single Mark Editing option is selected in the Edit tab of the Composer Settings
dialog box. This option allows you to skip several steps by performing edits on-the-fly
while playing back clips (without marking OUT points). For more information, see
“Single-Mark Editing” in the Help.
322
Editing with the Script Window
To splice a range:
1. Mark an IN point or place the position indicator at the location in the sequence where
you want to splice in the segment.
2. Press the Ctrl key and Alt key (Windows) or the Ctrl key (Macintosh). Notice that the
Splice-in arrow appears when you point to a take.
3. Double-click the preferred take within the range of dialog that has been marked with
script marks.
The marked section of the clip is spliced into the sequence.
Interactive Screenings
The Script window is a valuable tool during screenings of work in progress, allowing you to:
• Quickly search for scenes and pages with clips attached for instant retrieval.
Sequences are not loaded into the Script window. Instead, you can perform a video
mixdown and load the resulting master clips. For more information, see the Help.
• Match back and cue source material to compare alternative takes.
• Quickly find and open bins for retrieval of additional material not included in the Script
window.
• Enlarge script font and slate frames for better viewing by your audience.
The Script window provides a visual, interactive look at the content of the original script
against the elements in the final piece.
323
Chapter 8 Script-Based Editing
Sequences cannot be loaded into the Script window. Alternatively, you can perform a video
mixdown and load the resulting master clips instead. For more information, see “Performing
a Video Mixdown” in the Help.
All alternative takes are Matching colors indicate takes You can mix down alternative
available for viewing and used in the preferred cut as well cuts to form master clips and
comparing. as alternative cuts. place them next to the script.
324
Chapter 9
Viewing and Marking Footage:
Advanced
Before making your first edit, you can review your footage, add locators and comments to
clips, mark IN to OUT points, and create subclips. By viewing and marking your material in
advance, you can concentrate on editing and refining your sequence at a later time without
having to pause and set marks each time you load a new clip.
The following topics describe advanced techniques for playing back, viewing, and
subcataloging clips:
• Displaying the Info Window
• Displaying Timecode in the Timecode Window
• Adjusting the Play Delay Offset
• Using the Tool Palette
• Playing Selected Clips in a Loop
• Using Locators
For basic information about viewing and marking footage, see “Viewing and Marking
Footage: Basics” in the Help or the Basics Guide for your Avid editing application.
You can cut, copy, and paste information from the Info window anytime, but you cannot edit
or change any information within the window.
n If no clip or sequence is loaded in the Source monitor or Record monitor, the Info window is
not available.
Chapter 9 Viewing and Marking Footage: Advanced
326
Displaying Timecode in the Timecode Window
For information on displaying clip or sequence information from the Script window, see
“Displaying Clip and Sequence Information in a Script Window” on page 294.
When you are working with a 24p or 25p project, you can display additional timecode
information in the Timecode window. The output format timecodes TC 24, TC 25, TC 25P,
and TC 30 are available from the Timecode menu, as are the source timecodes for clips and
subclips.
n You need to add the timecode track to the clip or sequence before the timecode tracking
formats appear in the Timecode menu. For more information, see Displaying Timecodes in a
24p or 25p Project.
When displaying TC 30 source or M 30 timecodes, the pulldown phase for NTSC reference
is displayed.
327
Chapter 9 Viewing and Marking Footage: Advanced
Timecode menu
The window displays the timecode you have chosen. The Timecode menu contains the
same options as the Tracking Information menu. For a description of the Timecode
options, see “Displaying Tracking Information” in the Help.
3. To add an additional line of timecode, click Add Line, then click the new line and select
an option.
4. To change the size of the font displayed in the Timecode window, select Size > font size.
5. Click the Close button to close the Timecode window.
If you do have 1394 selected from the Device menu, the Desktop Play Delay option allows
you to adjust the offset between audio and video playback on the Avid system.
328
Using the Tool Palette
With a camera or transcoder connected to your system, when you play a sequence in the
Timeline and the Composer (desktop) monitor plays back video and audio ahead of the
camera or transcoder, you can adjust this offset. Playback on the Composer monitor can be
delayed by the number of frames chosen as an offset so that the video and audio play
simultaneously to the camera or transcoder and the Composer monitor.
You can also map other functions and buttons to the Tool palette for easy access. See “Using
the Command Palette” on page 79.
329
Chapter 9 Viewing and Marking Footage: Advanced
n If a subset of the buttons appears in the Tool palette, click the lower right corner and drag it
to the right and down to reveal the full Tool palette.
If you want to play the clips from start to end, press the Alt key (Windows) or the Option key
(Macintosh) while performing this procedure.
330
Using Locators
Using Locators
Locators are a type of electronic bookmark. They allow you to find and identify specific
frames during editing. Keywords that you enter in the comments attached to a locator allow
you to use standard Find procedures to call up the clips quickly. You can display information
about the locators using the Locators window. For more information about the Locators
window, see “Using the Locators Window” on page 335.
There are eight Add Locator buttons in the More tab of the Command palette. Each Add
Locator button is a different color, which allows you to group locators by color. For
example, you can use the red Add Locator button to identify color correction frames and use
the blue Add Locator button to identify cutaway shots.
You can map Add Locator buttons, as described in “Understanding Button Mapping” on
page 80.
Use Description
Color correction Use locators to mark clips or specify frames that require color correction,
notations noting the specific correction to perform if someone else does the job.
Visual track Use locators at matching points in synchronized audio and video tracks
alignments so that if the tracks lose sync, you can visually realign the locators in the
Timeline to restore sync. For more information on sync, see “Managing
Sync with Multiple Tracks” on page 353.
Music cues Use locators to mark the IN and OUT points for music.
Trim markers Use locators in the Timeline to return directly to an edit you have
designated for further trimming at a later time.
Cutaway markers Use locators to identify cutaway shots with comments so that when you
return to cover jump-frame edits with cutaway footage, you can quickly
call up the shots using basic Find procedures.
Replace markers Use locators to mark filler segments with comments to identify the items
that should replace the filler.
Semi-permanent IN or Use locators with the Mark Locators button to put multiple sets of
OUT points locators on a long clip, and so on.
331
Chapter 9 Viewing and Marking Footage: Advanced
Use Description
Add comments for Use locators to add comments to sequence clips to appear in lists that
EDLs you create, such as an EDL or cut list.
Viewing reviewer Use the Locators window to view reviewer comments and the specific
comments frame. See “Using the Locators Window” on page 335.
Print a list of reviewer Use the Locators window to print a list of changes or comments that you
comments can distribute to other people in the production. See “Using the Locators
Window” on page 335.
Import and export Import or export locators from one sequence or clip into another
locators sequence or clip. See “Exporting and Importing Locators” on page 338.
When you insert a locator, it appears as an oval in the Timeline, in the position bar, and at the
bottom of the frame in the monitor. The color of the oval corresponds to the color of the
locator button you used.
Locator displayed
in the monitor, the
position bar, and
the Timeline
You can add locators to your source material while you are in an editing session, as
described in “Adding Locators While Editing” on page 332.
332
Using Locators
Comment area
n By default, the locator name is the user name logged onto your system. You can change this
by typing a new name in the Name text box.
4. Type your comments in the comment area of the Locator edit entry window.
5. Change the color from the Color menu or change the locator name.
6. To save your information, click OK, or press the Enter (Windows) or Return
(Macintosh) key.
The information is stored with the marked frame.
The locator oval appears in the Timeline, in the position bar, and at the bottom of the
frame in the monitor.
Finding Locators
To quickly go to a frame with a locator while editing:
t Search for a particular comment by selecting Edit > Find.
333
Chapter 9 Viewing and Marking Footage: Advanced
334
Using Locators
Deleting Locators
You can delete locators using the Delete key, or the Locators window.
n To delete locators using the Locators window, see “Working in the Locators Window” on
page 336.
This is especially useful for identifying and listing specific frames to be used in an
effect, for example. You can also make a list of IN and OUT points for adding music.
• Copy and paste locators from one clip or sequence to another.
n The Locators window is monitor specific. If you have selected the Source monitor, the
Locators window displays the locators for the clip in the Source monitor. If you have
selected the Record monitor, the Locators window displays the locators for the sequence in
the Record monitor.
The following table describes a number of basic procedures that you can perform while in
the Locators window, allowing you to select locators, go to the frame marked by a locator,
display locator frames or additional information, sort locators, change locator column
widths, change locator colors, and delete locators.
336
Using Locators
Task Procedure
To select a locator item: t Click anywhere in the locator item’s row except in the Comment
column.
To browse through the list of t Press the Up Arrow and Down Arrow keys.
locator items:
To display the frame associated t Right-click (Windows) or Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh), and select
with a locator: Show Images.
To display XML and Trigger t Right-click (Windows) or Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh), and select
columns: Show MetaSync.
To sort locators: 1. Click the heading of the column that you want to sort.
2. Right-click (Windows) or Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh), and select
Sort Column (to sort in ascending order) or Reverse Sort Column (to
sort in descending order).
To change column widths: 1. Click the heading of the column that you want to resize.
2. Right-click (Windows) or Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh), and select
Enlarge Column or Reduce Column.
To change the color of a Locator t Right-click (Windows) or Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh) the locator
icon: icon, select Change Locator Color, and select a color.
337
Chapter 9 Viewing and Marking Footage: Advanced
Task Procedure
You can export locators from a sequence or a clip. A text (.txt) file is created when you
export the locator and a tab-delimited file displays all the information about the locator. You
can then send the text file to those who need to review and give feedback about the sequence
or clip. They can place additional comments in the text file and send it back for you to
reimport the locator comments back into your sequence.
n You can also import the text file into a spreadsheet program, such as Excel.
You can also use the Locators window to import locators back into your sequence.
For information about creating or editing a locators text file, see “Creating a Locator Text
(.txt) File” on page 339.
To export locators:
1. From the Locators window, right-click (Windows) or Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh) and
select Export Locators.
A dialog box opens, asking if you want to export only the selected locators or export all
locators.
2. Click All or Selected.
The Choose location for Exported Locators dialog box opens.
3. Type a file name and click Save.
The locator is saved as a text file (.txt).
338
Using Locators
To import locators.
1. With a sequence loaded in the Record monitor, right-click (Windows) or
Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh) and select Locators.
2. From the Locators window, right-click (Windows) or Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh) and
select Import Locators.
The Import dialog box opens.
3. Select the tab-delimited file containing the locators you want to import, and then click
Open.
n Another way to import a locator file is to select the tab-delimited locator file and drag it into
the Locators window.
You can create a Locator text file if you don’t have access to an Avid system. This allows
you to make timecode-specific comments offline and give them to an editor to import into a
sequence. The Locator text file is a tab-delimited file which must be created with certain
parameters. This file can be edited in a text editor application or in a spreadsheet program.
The Locator text file can be exported from or imported into the Locators window. See
“Exporting and Importing Locators” on page 338.
You can use the Locators window to copy a single locator or multiple locators and then paste
them into another clip or a sequence. The copied locator is placed in the same frame position
when it is pasted into the new clip. If the frame position does not exist in the new clip, then
the paste does not occur.
339
Chapter 9 Viewing and Marking Footage: Advanced
To copy locators from a clip and paste them into a new clip using the Locators
window:
1. Select the locators in the Locators window by doing one of the following:
t Click a single locator.
t Ctrl+click (Windows) or Shift+click (Macintosh) multiple locators.
2. Do one of the following:
t Select Edit > Copy.
t Press Ctrl+C (Windows) or k+C (Macintosh).
3. Load a new clip in the Source monitor.
4. Click the Locator window and do one of the following:
t Select Edit > Paste.
t Press Ctrl+V (Windows) or k+V (Macintosh).
The locator is pasted into the new clip.
To copy locators from a clip and paste them into a sequence using the Locators
window:
1. Select the locators in the Locators window by doing one of the following:
t Click a single locator.
t Ctrl+click (Windows) or Shift+click (Macintosh) multiple locators.
2. Do one of the following:
t Select Edit > Copy.
t Press Ctrl+C (Windows) or k+C (Macintosh).
3. Load a sequence into the Record monitor or into the Timeline.
4. Click the Locator window and do one of the following:
t Select Edit > Paste.
t Press Ctrl+V (Windows) or k+V (Macintosh).
The locator is pasted into the sequence.
You can also use a text editor to cut and paste locators in the Locators window. This allows
you to move locators easily between clips, sequences, tracks, or different users on your
system.
340
Using Locators
To copy and paste locators using the Locators window and a text editor:
1. Select the locators in the Locators window by doing one of the following:
t Click a single locator.
t Ctrl+click (Windows) or Shift+click (Macintosh) multiple locators.
2. Do one of the following:
t Select Edit > Copy.
t Press Ctrl+C (Windows) or k+C (Macintosh).
3. Open a text editor application, and paste the selection into the document.
The locator information displays in the text document.
Timecode, clip data, color, locator identification, and comments are all associated with a
locator entry. You can edit the entries before pasting them into a new clip or sequence using
the Locators window, or you can save the locator information as a text file and distribute it as
needed.
You can print the complete contents or the current view of the Locators window.
n If you select Show Images to display the frame associated with each locator and you want to
print the frames, you must use the procedure for printing the current view of the Locators
window. Printing the complete contents does not print the frames.
341
Chapter 9 Viewing and Marking Footage: Advanced
342
Chapter 10
Creating and Editing Sequences:
Advanced
After you have viewed and marked your clips or created subclips, you are ready to create a
sequence.
The following topics describe advanced procedures that you use when creating and editing
sequences:
• User Preferences for Creating Tracks
• Using Phantom Marks
• Adding Comments to Sequence Clips
• Playback Performance Tips
• Playing a Limited Duration of a Sequence
• Autosyncing Clips
• Using the AutoSequence Command
• Resyncing Subframe Audio
• Managing Sync with Multiple Tracks
• Ganging Footage in Monitors
• Using Sync Point Editing
• Synchronizing Metadata Using MetaSync
For basic information about editing, see “Creating and Editing Sequences: Basics” in the
Basics Guide for your Avid editing application.
For information on editing with remote assets in an Avid Interplay environment, including
editing with in-progress clips captured using Frame Chase capture capabilities, see “Editing
with Remote Assets” in the Help.
Chapter 10 Creating and Editing Sequences: Advanced
For information on opening and changing settings, see “Using the Settings List” in the Help.
344
Using Phantom Marks
When you enable phantom marks, the system displays blue mark IN or mark OUT icons in
the position bars below both the Source monitor and the Record monitor. These phantom
marks can indicate one, two, or sometimes three edit points calculated by the system to
complete an edit. The following are sample scenarios.
You can see the system calculations instantly and can make the edit after setting just one
mark, when appropriate.
Phantom marks can help you see the results of marks you set before you complete the edit
and are especially useful when doing Sync Point Editing or other complicated replace edits
in which two or more marks are calculated automatically.
345
Chapter 10 Creating and Editing Sequences: Advanced
2. Click the Clip Name menu above the monitor, and select Add Comments.
The Comments dialog box opens.
3. Type your comments in the text box, and click OK.
4. Click one of the Segment Mode buttons again to leave Segment mode.
347
Chapter 10 Creating and Editing Sequences: Advanced
Autosyncing Clips
When you capture footage that includes both audio and video, your Avid editing application
automatically establishes sync when it creates clips in the bin. Autosyncing applies to audio
and video clips that are captured separately, usually from two separate sources. Autosyncing
creates a new subclip that displays sync breaks in the Timeline as though the audio and
video were captured simultaneously.
n For more information on tracking sync breaks, see “Displaying Sync Breaks” in the Help.
Understanding Autosyncing
Autosyncing is often used for 24p and 25p projects in which picture and sound were
captured separately. These clips are often synced based on common film timecode, sound
timecode, or auxiliary timecode.
You can also autosync™ any audio and video clips based on a user-defined IN point or OUT
point relationship that you establish with marks. For example, you can use the slate as a
common visual and audio reference for autosyncing the clips.
348
Using the AutoSequence Command
You can change the name according to preference. You can load an autosynced subclip into
the Source monitor and immediately edit it into a sequence.
349
Chapter 10 Creating and Editing Sequences: Advanced
Understanding AutoSequence
You can use the AutoSync command to create synchronized subclips of the video and audio.
You can then use AutoSequence to build a sequence with timecode that matches your
original videotape.
n For information and procedures for Autosync, see “Autosyncing Clips” on page 348.
To establish syncing with the original videotape, filler is added where gaps in audio exist in
the sequence. After you finish editing the audio, use the Digital Cut command to output only
the audio onto the original videotape. The videotape now has synchronized audio and video
for viewing.
If you do not use AutoSync and the video clip timecode does not match the audio clip
timecode, you should select only video clips when you use AutoSequence. You can then add
audio to the sequence and sync the audio with the video by using the Splice-in and
Overwrite functions.
c Make sure the video tracks are not enabled when you begin recording a digital cut.
n You can build a sequence without filler by pressing and holding the Alt key (Windows) or
Option key (Macintosh) while you select Bin > AutoSequence.
351
Chapter 10 Creating and Editing Sequences: Advanced
n The batch import process does not create new clips; therefore, slipping at the perforation
level is not available when you batch import audio clips from Avid application versions
earlier than v10.5.3.
• You cannot slip beyond the duration boundaries of the source master clip.
• The sync adjustments you make are referenced in any cut list you output for any
sequence that uses the adjusted subclip.
• The number of perfs you slip appears in the Slip column of the project bin when the Slip
heading is selected for display in the bin.
352
Managing Sync with Multiple Tracks
n If you find a subframe sync problem within an edited sequence, be sure to correct the audio
sync in the original subclip used in the edit. The sequence is then updated. For sync
problems with 16mm format, the telecine facility must correct the problem.
Managing Suncy
You activate sync locking by clicking a Sync Lock button in the Track Selector panel to
display the Sync Lock icon. You can also switch all sync locks on or off by clicking the Sync
Lock All button.
353
Chapter 10 Creating and Editing Sequences: Advanced
Film editors traditionally use standard head and tail leaders for this purpose. You can create
your own leader according to any specification, as described in “Creating Leader” on
page 249.
With tail leader added to synchronized tracks, you can go to the end of the sequence after
making a complicated edit and see whether the leaders are lined up. If they are out of line,
this indicates a sync break that you can measure and eliminate.
354
Managing Sync with Multiple Tracks
For more information on using locators, see “Using Locators” on page 331.
355
Chapter 10 Creating and Editing Sequences: Advanced
Locators in sync
Focus button
To add a note that appears in the Record monitor whenever you park on the locator
frame (such as Music sync or Sound Effect sync):
1. Double-click the locator in the Record monitor.
2. Type your comments in the comment entry area of the Locator window.
You can use the Find procedure to go to a locator quickly with text. For more information,
see “Finding Frames, Clips, and Bins” in the Help.
356
Managing Sync with Multiple Tracks
To restore sync:
1. Find the point at which the sync was lost.
2. Add or remove frames by using the appropriate edit function, as described in “Fixing
Sync Breaks” in the Help.
n You can also add an edit to filler. For more information, see “Adding Edits to Filler Clips”
on page 373.
3. Select the transition and trim (be sure to select all the synced tracks).
As you trim, frames are added or removed from the additional tracks as well.
4. When you are finished trimming, remove the add edits from the sync tracks by selecting
Clip > Remove Match Frame Edits.
357
Chapter 10 Creating and Editing Sequences: Advanced
You can gang the Source monitor and any number of pop-up monitors with the Record
monitor. For instance, before editing them into a sequence, you can gang a music track in a
pop-up monitor, source footage in the Source monitor, and a sequence in the Record
monitor. Then you can view the footage, adjust the sync points, and mark them before
completing the edit.
n The Gang button appears by default in the second row of buttons below the monitors and in
the second row of information above the Source and Record monitors.
4. View the footage in any of the monitors using standard playback methods.
As you move through footage in one monitor, the footage in all other monitors freezes.
The footage is updated when the play stops. Simultaneous full-motion playback is not
possible, although sync is maintained at all times.
Like a replace edit, Sync Point editing uses the relative location of the position indicator in
both the source and record material as the sync point. Sync Point editing, however,
determines the duration of the new edit according to marks that you set, as opposed to a
replace edit, which uses the head-to-tail frame duration already established in the Timeline.
You can apply these marks across multiple tracks when marking a sequence. This allows you
to add overlap cuts.
358
Using Sync Point Editing
359
Chapter 10 Creating and Editing Sequences: Advanced
360
Chapter 11
Using the Timeline: Advanced
Your Avid editing application represents each edit and effect in a graphical timeline structure
to help you track and manipulate the elements of your sequence. The Timeline continuously
updates as you work, displaying an extensive array of icons and information that you can
customize in various ways. In addition, the Timeline has its own set of editing tools that you
can use to create and revise edits and transitions across multiple tracks.
For basic information about the timeline, see “Using the Timeline: Basics” in the Help or the
Basics Guide for your Avid editing application.
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
362
Timeline Views: Advanced
n The TC1 track represents the timecode of the project in which you are working. For example,
when you are working in a 24p NTSC project, the TC1 track displays the same timecode as
the TC30 track.
363
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
n Displaying source colors and local colors overrides any track color assigned from the
Timeline Fast menu.
n Clip colors assigned to sequences, groups, motion effects, and title clips do not appear as
source colors in the Timeline.
n If both Source and Local are selected in the Clip Color submenu, the local color overrides
the source color.
n The Background Color command appears only when all tracks are deselected.
If you want to choose a custom color for the tracks, press the Alt key (Windows) or Option
key (Macintosh) while performing this procedure. When you release the mouse button on
the color palette, the Windows Color dialog box or the Macintosh Colors panel opens.
364
Navigating in the Timeline: Advanced
n Show Locators affects only how the locator icons are displayed in the Timeline. The locators
are not affected.
A Timeline with reduced tracks wraps around to show more of the sequence. As you reduce
tracks in a full-screen Timeline, the sequence wraps around, allowing you to examine a long
sequence in greater horizontal detail.
365
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
Resize box
To enlarge tracks:
t Select the tracks, and press Ctrl+L (Windows) or k+L (Macintosh).
To reduce tracks:
t Select the tracks, and press Ctrl+K (Windows) or k+K (Macintosh).
You can also continue to work in Source/Record mode by resizing the Timeline window so
that it overlaps the Composer window.
You can click in either window to activate it and bring it forward at any time, or you can
click in the title bar of the Timeline window and drag it to the Bin monitor to place each
window in its own monitor.
n If the Timeline or Composer window is hidden behind another window, select the window
again from the Tools menu.
366
Navigating in the Timeline: Advanced
By default, the Timeline displays only the available tracks for source material.
When you click the button to display the source material, both the button and the position
indicator turn green to indicate that you are viewing source material.
Source tracks
This feature is particularly useful when you are editing with a sequence or subclip created
from a sequence; you can also use it to look at the contents of any source clip in a Timeline
display.
n Heads and Tails view is disabled when you are displaying material from the Source monitor.
This visual guide helps you monitor track and segment selection more carefully when
mixing or applying effects across multiple tracks and segments.
367
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
For information on editing multiple clips directly from the bin into the Record monitor, see
“Creating an Instant Rough Cut” in the Help.
368
Using Advanced Timeline Techniques
n After the edit is completed, you remain in Segment mode until you click the active Segment
Mode button again to deactivate it.
369
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
A row of film frames appears at the top of the Timeline. The film track displays as many
representative frames as possible within the window.
Film track
To adjust your view of the Timeline quickly for frame-by-frame viewing and editing:
t Click the Timeline Fast Menu button, and select Show Every Frame.
n The film track displays frames for the topmost video track only. You cannot display more
than one film track at a time.
370
Using Advanced Timeline Techniques
c If you rearrange a split edit (in which the audio extends beyond the video, or the
reverse), the system cuts all tracks to the same edit point. To rearrange split edits or
edits on multiple video tracks, or to move audio and video separately, use the Segment
Mode editing techniques described in “Using Segment Mode” in the Help.
Heads view
3. Press and hold the Alt key (Windows) or Option key (Macintosh), click the frames
representing the clip you want to move, and drag the clip to its new position. The
sequence is rearranged to match the changes you made.
371
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
For information about how the Mark Clip button works, see “Marking an Entire Clip or
Segment” in the Help.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
372
Adding an Edit (Match Framing)
This form of edit is also known as a match frame. In traditional analog editing, match
framing accomplishes specific tasks, such as creating a dissolve between two clips. In Avid
editing applications, however, Add Edits (or match frames) function differently. Use match
frames primarily to divide and isolate portions of a clip or sequence to modify that portion
without affecting the rest of the footage. You can also add edits to filler segments to maintain
sync while trimming. Once you make the adjustment, playback of the clip is no longer
seamless because the two portions of the clip are different.
You can add an edit to a single audio or video track, or you can place the Add Edit across
several tracks at once.
The Add Edit button appears in the Edit tab of the Command palette. Depending on the
model of your Avid editing application and your button mappings, it might appear in other
locations such as the Tool palette or the Timeline top toolbar. You can also map the Add Edit
button to a custom location. For information about mapping buttons, see “Mapping User-
Selectable Buttons” on page 81.
n By default, the match-frame indicator is white. If a change in level occurs, the match-frame
indicator changes to red.
373
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
You can also remove individual match frames by using the Undo command, or by selecting
them in Trim mode and pressing the Delete key. For more information on Trim mode, see
“Undoing or Redoing Edits” and “Working in Trim Mode: Basics” in the Help.
c You cannot remove match-frame edits between segments in which segment effects and
audio pan or volume adjustments have been applied.
When you activate Dupe Detection, each set of duplicate frames is tagged with a different
color. (Up to 10 color sets can be distinguished during a single detection process.) Matching
frames have matching colors. You can use any of the Trim Mode options to remove the
duplicate frames, if necessary.
374
Detecting Duplicate Frames
The colored bars that distinguish duplicate frames in the sequence are automatically drawn
above the frames in the Timeline, as shown.
Orange bars mark the first set of duplicate frames, green bars mark the second set, and so on.
You can use Dupe Detection while you are editing to locate duplicate frames, and remove
them as the sequence evolves.
Dupe Detection is instantaneous and retroactive; if duplicate frames already exist in your
sequence, the colored bars appear immediately. As you edit, your Avid editing application
shows duplicate frames as they occur.
n You can change the handle size used by Dupe Detection in the Edit tab of the Timeline
Settings dialog box. For more information, see “Adjusting Handle Length in Dupe
Detection” on page 376.
c Your Avid editing application might mark a special effect optical (such as a blowup) as
a duplicate frame. Double-check your sequence for this possibility before deleting
frames.
375
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
Frames A and C
Splice is made here. Safety frame
can still be used
in a sequence,
but frame B is cut
in the middle.
A B C
• In 16mm film editing (using the multiple-strand method), labs sometimes use the
zero-frame cutting method to avoid seeing each splice in a 35mm blowup print. In this
method, the negative is conformed along with the handles so that the cuts appear as soft
frame handles rather than jumps in the resulting 35mm blowup.
376
Adjusting Handle Length in Dupe Detection
Different labs have different standards depending on the equipment used; usually, a
minimum of four frame handles is needed.
Transition Handles
Adding specific handle lengths to dupes (as they appear both in the sequence and in film
lists) has the following advantages:
• In 35mm single-strand conforming: Editors can better track duplicate frames and
provide the negative cutter with more than one safety frame to avoid losing specific
frames.
• In 16mm multiple-strand conforming: For labs using the zero-frame cutting method,
editors can track the number of handles during editing according to the specific
standards of a particular lab.
When you enable Dupe Detection during editing, the handles are added to the colored dupe
indicators that appear in the Timeline.
377
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
When Color Framing is enabled, green bars appear above the Overwrite and Splice-in
buttons (Source and Record monitors) or above the position bar which blink whenever a
color sync signal is interrupted by an edit. The blinking lights indicate that color framing is
out of phase at the edit transition.
378
Tracking Color Frame Shifts
Color-framing boxes
3. Trim one frame at a time on one side of the transition or the other until the green boxes
are aligned and the color-frame phase bars stop blinking.
If you are careful about color framing while editing, you will not need to think about it when
assembling your master tape. If you ignore color framing during the edit session, you might
have to make adjustments during online editing if your edits interrupted any color-frame
fields in the sequence.
379
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
Black holes are segments of the sequence that consist of one or more frames of filler. Flash
frames are clips that have an extremely short duration, for example, fewer than 10 frames.
380
Printing the Timeline
n The name of the printer and details of the dialog box will vary, depending on your facility.
381
Chapter 11 Using the Timeline: Advanced
382
Chapter 12
Working in Trim Mode: Advanced
After creating a rough version of a sequence, you can enter Trim mode and fine-tune the
transitions between each clip or between whole segments. You can also trim edits as you
build a sequence rather than create a rough cut first.
For basic information about trimming, see “Working with Trim Mode: Basics” in the Help.
You can also create an overlap edit for an audio track by using the Audio Mark buttons. See
“Marking Audio Clips” on page 253.
Extending an Edit
Use an extend edit to perform dual-sided (A-side and B-side) trims on selected tracks. An
extend edit allows you to quickly create a split edit without entering Trim mode. It also
allows you to establish the exact frame that you want to trim to by using the position
indicator. (When you enter Trim mode, the position indicator moves to the nearest transition
by default.)
You can extend edits backward or forward in the Timeline. In either case, like a dual-roller
trim, the extend edit function always maintains sync relationships.
384
Extending an Edit
n To extend multiple tracks, all the tracks must have the same edit point in the Timeline.
Otherwise, you must extend the tracks separately.
2. Find the point in the sequence to which you want to trim. If the trim point is before the
edit, mark an IN point. If the trim point is after the edit, mark an OUT point.
n If you are extending the edit to an OUT point, remove any IN points that might be on the
track. Otherwise, the extend edit goes in the wrong direction.
Mark IN
385
Chapter 12 Working in Trim Mode: Advanced
n Because dual-roller trims do not cause sync breaks, you can add black only while
performing single-roller trims.
386
Maintaining Sync While Trimming
Adding black while trimming Black fills the trim duration and
sync is maintained.
After you have added black filler to a video track, you can replace the filler with footage by
performing a replace edit. For more information, see “Performing a Replace Edit” in the
Help.
After A1
trimming A2
A3
n Sync-locked tracks aid only single-roller trim functions in Trim mode because dual-roller
trims do not cause sync breaks.
387
Chapter 12 Working in Trim Mode: Advanced
n Slip and slide trims are not protected for sync. Select all synced tracks for simultaneous
slipping or sliding to avoid sync breaks.
388
Slipping or Sliding Segments
The type of trim you perform (slip or slide) determines which frames are updated, as
follows:
• In slip trimming, the two inner monitors for the head and tail frames of the clip change
because only the contents of the clip are adjusted. The frames that precede and follow
the clip are not affected.
Before slip 1 2 3 4
Frames
After slip 2 3 4 5
• In slide trimming, the two outer monitors for the outgoing (A-side) and incoming
(B-side) frames change because the clip remains fixed while the footage before and after
it is trimmed.
Before slide 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4
Frames
After slide 1 2 3 4 5 2 3 4
389
Chapter 12 Working in Trim Mode: Advanced
IN OUT
You can also select two or more contiguous segments within a track for slipping or sliding
by dragging the lasso around four or more transitions.
c Be sure to draw the lasso from right to left; if you draw from left to right, you enter
Segment mode.
To select two or more segments on different tracks for simultaneous slip or slide
trimming, do one of the following:
t In Trim mode, press Shift and select the head and tail of a segment for slipping.
t In Trim mode, press Shift and select the outgoing tail frame of the preceding segment
and the incoming head frame of the following segment in a sequence for sliding.
390
Slipping or Sliding Segments
391
Chapter 12 Working in Trim Mode: Advanced
392
Slipping or Sliding Segments
n The Slip Left and Slip Right buttons do not appear on the interface or keyboard by default.
You must map them from the Trim tab in the Command palette to use this procedure.
393
Chapter 12 Working in Trim Mode: Advanced
Transition Corner
Display button
Frames on which the The two frames between which Frames on which the
transition effect starts a cut point defines the transition transition effect ends
Use the Transition Corner Display to trim the transition effect’s start frames, end frames, and
duration in timecode or feet+frames (for 24p and 25p projects). As you trim the transition
effect, you can see the corresponding frame adjustments in all six monitors simultaneously.
c The Transition Corner Display is applicable only to the trimming of transition effects
(for example, dissolves, wipes, picture-in-picture, and so on). It is not designed for
trimming key, image, or segment effects.
n The Transition Corner Display feature is only available when you are in Big Trim mode. To
ensure that you enter Big Trim mode when you click the Trim Mode button, select “Never
use Small Trim mode” in the Features tab of the Trim Settings dialog box. For more
information, see “Trim Settings: Features Tab” on page 725.
394
Using the Transition Corner Display
n To use this button, you must display two rows of buttons in the Composer window or map the
button to a palette or a keyboard key. For more information, see “Using the Command
Palette” on page 79.
3. Trim the transition effect by clicking the outgoing or incoming frame you want to trim,
and then position your pointer on the rollers and drag the transition backward or
forward. Press and hold the Alt key (Windows) or Option key (Macintosh) to roll
forward or backward slowly one frame at a time.
4. To review your edit, click the Play Loop button.
395
Chapter 12 Working in Trim Mode: Advanced
396
Chapter 13
Working with Audio: Advanced
You edit audio by using many of the same techniques and tools you use to edit video,
including Source/Record mode, Segment mode, and Trim mode functions. Your Avid
system also provides several unique features that facilitate audio editing, such as audio
scrub, waveform displays, and tools for adjusting and mixing audio levels and pan between
speakers. In addition, you can adjust the high, low, and midrange frequency ranges of
segments by using the Audio Equalization (EQ) tool.
You can also transfer files to Pro Tools through Avid Interplay, work on them there, and then
import them back into the Avid editing application. For more information, see “Using Pro
Tools and Interplay” in Avid Interplay Best Practices.
For basic information about audio, see “Working with Audio: Basics” in the Help or the
Basics Guide for your Avid editing application.
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
You can set audio volume levels with the Audio Mixer tool. When the Audio Mixer tool is in
Clip Gain mode, values set by the volume level sliders are referred to as system clip gain
values. When the Audio Mixer tool is in Automation Gain and Pan mode, values set by the
Audio Mixer tool are additive to the system clip gain values. This allows you to adjust the
values separately. You typically adjust clip gain values first, as shown in the following
workflow.
Audio Effect
Clip Gain Automation Gain
Processing
This workflow allows you to apply effects to an audio clip in a way that is similar to the
signal flow in a mixing console.
In this workflow, clip gain is like a trim level, where you can lower (attenuate) or increase
(amplify) the levels of a clip before applying any other effects. For example, when importing
a sound file from an audio CD, you notice when the level of the clip is very high and close to
clipping (distortion). If you add an EQ effect to raise the level of the bass, the audio starts to
distort. To solve this problem, you can use clip gain to lower the signal level. Then you can
adjust the bass in the EQ tool without distorting the audio.
For example, you have copied an audio file from a CD-ROM and you want to equalize the
audio, but the overall volume is too loud. To lower volume, do the following:
1. Use the Audio Mixer tool in Clip Gain mode to lower the overall volume.
2. Apply an EQ effect and any other audio effects.
3. Use the Audio Mixer tool in Automation Gain and Pan mode to fine-tune the volume of
different sections of the audio in the sequence.
398
Audio Gain Staging and an Audio Editing Workflow
This workflow also applies to using AudioSuite plug-ins because some AudioSuite plug-ins
affect the level of the audio. Often, if you use clip gain to raise or lower the level before you
apply an audio effect, you can achieve higher quality results.
In this workflow, the Audio Mixer tool in Automation Gain and Pan mode acts like the level
faders on a console for final mixing of the audio material.
Automation Gain and Pan Audio Mixer tool in Automation Gain and Pan mode (real-time)
Render order Clip Gain and Pan Audio Mixer tool in Clip Gain mode (real-time)
The preceding illustration demonstrates how the render order fits into the audio workflow.
Changing an audio effect unrenders any audio effect above it in the render order but does not
affect audio effects below it in the render order. For example, if you have a clip that contains
clip gain, an AudioSuite plug-in effect, and automation gain, and you change the automation
gain, the system does not unrender the AudioSuite plug-in effect. This fits into the workflow
because automation gain is used for finishing the audio levels. You need to hear how changes
in the automation gain affect the rendered effects. You could add, render, and modify EQ and
audio dissolves on the same clip and you still would not unrender the AudioSuite plug-in
effect.
However, if you change the clip gain on the same clip, the system unrenders the AudioSuite
plug-in. This also fits into the workflow because, when you reset the level of the clip, you
need to reprocess any effects applied to the clip.
n If you have an AudioSuite plug-in and an Audio EQ effect applied to the same effect, only the
Audio EQ effect icon is displayed. The AudioSuite plug-in still applies even though the icon
is not visible.
399
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
To turn on the display of clip gain values and automation gain values:
1. Click the Timeline Fast Menu button
2. Select Audio Data.
3. Select Auto Gain, Clip Gain, or both.
n You can also view automation pan values by selecting Auto Pan from the Timeline Fast
menu. You cannot display Auto Gain and Auto Pan values at the same time in the Timeline.
t Click the Clip Gain button in the Effects Bypass panel in the Effects tab of the Audio
Project Settings window. See “Audio Project Settings: Effects Tab” on page 634.
The Audio Loop Play button appears in several of the audio effect tools and is also a
mappable button in the Play tab of the Command palette. For more information on mapping
buttons, see “Mapping User-Selectable Buttons” on page 81.
400
Audio Gain Staging and an Audio Editing Workflow
You can do the following while your Avid editing application plays the loop:
• Adjust audio effects.
• Use the Peak Hold menu in the Audio tool to change between Peak Hold and Infinite
Hold.
• Use the Reset Peak button in the Audio tool.
For more information on the Audio tool, see “Understanding the Audio Tool” in the Help.
For information on improving response time, see “Improving Response Time When
Adjusting Volume” on page 402.
n For additional ways to change the volume while playing an Audio Mix effect, see “Recording
Automation Gain or Automation Pan Information” in the Help.
401
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
If there is no Clip Gain effect on the clip before you start, you do not hear any changes until
you click the Audio Loop Play button to stop and replay the effect.
As you adjust the volume values on an existing Clip Gain effect, you might not hear the
results immediately. It takes a few seconds for your Avid editing application to apply the
changes to the clip. The response time for this feature is considerably longer than it is when
changing EQ parameters while using Audio Loop Play. You might need to click the Audio
Loop Play button to complete the edit and then play the effect to hear the result.
n The Digi 002 and Command|8 are the only controllers that can be used as control surfaces
to control other parts of the application.
402
Using External Fader Controllers
For more information, see “Using the Digi 002 and Command|8” on page 407.
• JL Cooper MCS-3000X MIDI automation controller. This unit supports touch-sensitive
flying faders. This controller is emulated by the JL Cooper FaderMaster 4/100 and by
the Zaxcom Cameo SV.
• JL Cooper FaderMaster Pro MIDI automation controller. This low-cost unit allows you
to make fine adjustments to audio clips. This unit does not support flying faders, which
means that the faders don’t move automatically as you record audio gain information
and they must be zeroed manually prior to recording. For information on setting the
faders manually, see “Interpreting Position Indicator Lights” in the Help.
For more information, see “Using the FaderMaster Pro and MCS-3000X” on page 422.
• Yamaha® 01V/96 and Yamaha 01V digital mixing console. These units are full-feature
digital mixers that also support Audio Gain Automation with flying faders. These faders
are not touch-sensitive. Your Avid editing application uses the MIDI controller portion
of the Yamaha 01V/96 or the Yamaha 01V mixer for automation gain control.
For more information, see “Using the Yamaha 01V/96 or the Yamaha 01V” on
page 425.
n The JL Cooper controllers and Yamaha mixing consoles do not support automation pan
recording.
The following table compares the external fader controllers and mixers.
403
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
404
Using External Fader Controllers
The following list provides additional information on touch sensitivity and automatically
stopping recording:
• Touch sensitivity: As soon as you touch a moving fader on the Digi 002, Command|8,
or MCS-3000X, the unit passes control of the fader to you. For more information, see
“Using the Latch Mode Feature on the Digi 002 and Command|8” on page 417 or
“MCS-3000X Buttons” on page 423.
On the Yamaha 01V/96 or on the Yamaha 01V, you must press the fader’s On button to
gain control of a moving fader. For a description of how to control the faders on the
Yamaha 01V/96 and the Yamaha 01V, see “Operating the Yamaha 01V/96 and Yamaha
01V” on page 429.
• Latch mode: In Latch mode (also known as Snap mode), the fader controller
automatically stops recording as soon as you release the fader. When you release the
fader, it resumes following the volume information in the Timeline. For more
information, see “Using the Latch Mode Feature on the Digi 002 and Command|8” on
page 417 and “Using the Snap Mode Feature on the MCS-3000X” on page 424.
For more information on using these external fader controllers or mixers, see “Recording
Automation Gain or Automation Pan Information” in the Help.
Position
indicator
lights
If the external fader controller or mixer is on and is correctly attached to the system, at
least one of the position indicator lights on each enabled track is blue.
2. Click an audio gain keyframe.
3. (FaderMaster Pro only) Adjust the sliders on the fader controller until both lights for
each enabled track are lit. This indicates that the slider on the fader controller matches
the current volume in the Timeline. For more information, see “Position Indicator
Lights” in the Help.
n On the Digi 002, Command|8, MCS-3000X, Yamaha 01V, and Yamaha 01V/96, the faders
automatically adjust to the volume setting.
4. Move the corresponding fader to adjust the volume for the keyframe.
For information on connecting a fader controller or mixer, see “Using an External Fader
Controller or Mixer to Record Automation Gain” on page 406.
405
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
For information on connecting a fader controller or mixer, see “Using an External Fader
Controller or Mixer to Record Automation Gain” on page 406.
Position
indicator
lights
2. Move the blue position indicator to the section of audio that you want to adjust and mark
IN to OUT points.
3. (FaderMaster Pro only) Note the colors of the position indicator lights for the track you
want to adjust. Move the fader until both lights are blue. If you cannot adjust it to the
exact position where both lights are blue, get it as close as you can.
4. Set Preroll and Postroll values, if necessary.
5. Click the Record button to start recording your actions.
406
Using the Digi 002 and Command|8
6. Depending on the fader controller or mixer, listen to the audio and do the following:
t FaderMaster Pro: When you want to start recording volume information, move
the corresponding fader. The system does not begin recording until you move a
fader.
t Digi 002, MCS-3000X, and Command|8: When you want to start recording
volume information, either touch or move the corresponding fader. The MCS-
3000X faders are touch sensitive.
t Yamaha 01V and Yamaha 01V/96: When you want to start recording volume
information, click the fader’s On button and move the fader.
n If the Yamaha 01V fader or the Yamaha 01V/96 fader is not moving, you can move it without
first clicking the On button.For more information, see “Operating the Yamaha 01V/96 and
Yamaha 01V” on page 429.
n When you record over previously recorded audio volume keyframes, the MCS-3000X, the
Yamaha 01V, and the Yamaha 01V/96 automatically display the changing values. This
allows you to make quick adjustments to existing automation gain recordings.
n If you delete too many keyframes, use the Undo command to restore them.
10. Repeat step 9 until you have decreased the number of keyframes to an acceptable level.
You should remove as many excess keyframes as possible while still maintaining the
volume changes.
On Windows systems only, you can use the Digi 002 as an audio input and output device for
your Avid editing application. You can also make use of its control surface capabilities and
use it as a controller for live mix mode and for automation gain and automation pan
recording.
407
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
n Although the Digi 002 works with Digidesign Pro Tools on the Macintosh operating system,
you cannot use it with an Avid video editing application on a Macintosh system.
The following table compares some of the features of the Digi 002 and Command|8.
Control surface for Avid editing application Yes, when used as an Yes
audio I/O device
Control surface for automation gain and automation pan Yes, when used as an Yes
recording audio I/O device
The following topics provide more information on using the Digi 002 or Command|8:
Using the Digi 002 with Avid DNA Hardware (Windows Only)
Windows systems with Avid DNA hardware (Avid Adrenaline, Avid Mojo, or Avid Mojo
SDI) can use the Digi 002 as an external audio device. This means you can use the Digi 002
to play, record, and output audio.
n You can also use the Digi 002 as a standalone mixer. However, you cannot use the Digi 002
as a mixer while you are using it as the audio input and output device for your Avid editing
application.
When the Digi 002 is attached to the Avid editing system, all of its audio input and output
connections are live. However, the Avid DNA and Digi 002 remain as two separate audio
sub-systems. They are not combined to increase the number of available audio channels.
Audio I/O works as follows:
• The system creates a list of input options based on the audio devices that are present. For
example, Digi 002 analog, Digi 002 S/PDIF, and Avid DNA analog.
• For output, all 8 channels are played to the Digi 002 and the Adrenaline hardware
simultaneously.
408
Using the Digi 002 and Command|8
You might need to make additional cable connections between the Digi 002 and your Avid
DNA hardware in order to maintain sync between audio and video. When the sync cable is
connected correctly between the Digi 002 and your Avid DNA hardware, your Avid editing
application displays a green 002 in the Timeline top toolbar. The following table describes
this connection for each Avid DNA device:
Avid Adrenaline Connect one end of an RCA cable to the RCA S/PDIF connector on the
Avid Adrenaline, and connect the other end to the S/PDIF input on the
Digi 002. This allows the Digi 002 to maintain S/PDIF clock signals and
receive video sync from the Adrenaline and the optional blackburst
generator.
(Option) Connect a black burst generator to the Ref connector on the
Avid Adrenaline.
Avid Mojo Connect one end of an RCA cable to the analog audio output connectors
labeled Clk on the Avid Mojo (white audio output) and connect the other
end to the S/PDIF input on the Digi 002. This allows the Digi 002 to
receive video sync from the Avid Mojo and the optional blackburst
generator.
(Option) Connect a blackburst generator to the Ref connector on the Avid
Mojo.
Avid Mojo SDI Connect one end of a BNC-to-RCA cable to the Word-clock and S/PDIF
Out BNC connector (black cable) on the video output cable from the
Avid Mojo SDI. Connect the other end of the BNC-to-RCA cable to the
S/PDIF input on the Digi 002. This allows the Digi 002 to receive video
sync from the Avid Mojo SDI and the optional blackburst generator.
(Option) Connect a blackburst generator to the Ref connector (black
cable) on the video input cable to the Avid Mojo SDI.
For more information on connecting the Digi 002 hardware to your Avid DNA hardware and
on audio and video synchronization, see “Using the Avid Adrenaline,” “Using the Avid
Mojo,” or “Using the Avid Mojo SDI” in the Help.
n You cannot hear the results of audio scrubbing when the Digi 002 is attached to the Avid
Adrenaline system.
409
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
The following describes some of the analog audio features of the Command|8 that can be
used by Avid editing applications:
• The Command|8 has two stereo inputs, one stereo output, and a headphone jack.
• You can use the stereo inputs as follows:
- Avid Adrenaline users can connect channel 1 and 2 from the Adrenaline hardware
to the first stereo pair input and connect channels 3 and 4 to the second pair. Then
you can switch between the two inputs.
- Avid Mojo or Mojo SDI users can connect the audio outputs to one stereo input pair
n The Digi 002 or Command|8 must be turned on before you start your Avid editing
application. If you start the application when the controller is turned off, you must exit the
application, turn the controller on, and then start the Avid editing application.
410
Using the Digi 002 and Command|8
You can map the buttons in the Digidesign 002 Controller Settings dialog box to buttons on
the Command palette and to menu commands.
To display the dialog box for mapping buttons and menu commands:
t Click the Edit Settings button in the Controller Settings dialog box.
The Digidesign 002 Controller Settings or Digidesign Command|8 Controller Settings
dialog box opens.
The following illustration shows both the Digidesign 002 Controller Settings dialog box and
the layout on the Digi 002 itself. Compare the two layouts to see which buttons are
mappable using the Digidesign 002 Controller Settings dialog box.
411
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
Open Command Palette button Keyboard Modifier switches Transport and Navigation controls
Mic/Line/Inst
Monitor Section
Input controls
Console/channel
view section Status indicators and
(contains a pan Display controls
knob for each
track)
Transport and
Keyboard Navigational controls
Modifier
switches
Fader Section
412
Using the Digi 002 and Command|8
The following illustration shows the Digidesign Command|8 Controller Settings dialog box
as well as the layout on the Command|8 itself. Compare the two illustrations to see which
buttons are mappable using the Digidesign Command|8 Controller Settings dialog box.
Console
View Display Controls
and Foot Switch
Transport and
Navigation
controls
Keyboard
Modifier Monitor Section
switches
Status indicators and
Display controls
Transport and
Navigational controls
The Console/channel
Fader Section
view section contains a
pan knob for each track
a
413
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
The buttons on the Digi 002 and Command|8 can have different functions if you press the
Shift, Control, Option, or Command keys. You can either use the keyboard or press one of
the Keyboard Modifier switches on the controller surface.
Command Command NA
To view the different button settings on the Controller Settings dialog box:
t Press the Shift, Control, Option, or Command key while viewing the Digidesign
Command|8 Controller Settings dialog box.
You can change the Keyboard Modifier switches by selecting a new button from the
appropriate menu in the Keyboard Modifiers area.
Each Controller Settings dialog box has an Open Command Palette button. Use the standard
techniques for mapping buttons and menu selections from the Avid interface to the buttons
on the control surface. For more information, see “Mapping User-Selectable Buttons” on
page 81 and “Mapping Menu Commands” on page 83.
414
Using the Digi 002 and Command|8
7. Click the button on the dialog box that you want to change.
The system highlights the button.
8. Select a menu command. For example, select Tools > Audio Punch-In.
The system maps the menu command to the button.
9. When you finish mapping menu commands, click Active Palette on the Command
palette or Button to Button Reassignment to map buttons.
10. When you finish mapping menu commands and buttons and you want to save your
changes, click OK.
The Digidesign 002 Controller Settings dialog box or the Digidesign Command|8
Controller Settings dialog box closes and the Controller Settings dialog box appears.
11. Click OK.
The system makes the new button assignments.
c The assignments do not take effect until you click OK in both dialog boxes.
Many buttons perform different functions depending on which window in the Avid interface
is active (has focus). For example, if the Timeline is active, pressing Play plays the sequence
in the Timeline. If a bin is in Frame view and a clip is selected, pressing Play plays the
footage in the clip.
To ensure that you perform the correct operation when you press a button on the control
surface, you can map some buttons to menu commands that give focus to a particular
window or tool. For example, on the Digi 002, the F5 key is mapped to Tools > Timeline by
default. Pressing the F5 button on the Digi 002 puts focus on the Timeline.
n To see the function of a mapped button, hold the cursor over the button to view the tooltip.
n You cannot assign a function to the F1 key on a Command|8. The F1 key is a local function
on the device.
c Do not press the Standalone button on the Digi 002 while you are using it as a control
surface for your Avid editing application. This puts the controller in Standalone mode
and closes the FireWire connection. To use the controller again, you must exit the
application, power cycle the controller, and then relaunch your Avid editing
application.
415
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
The Digi 002 and Command|8 each have a connection on the back for a foot pedal. The
system accepts any “normally open” foot pedal. For example, you can use a standard
normally-open sustain pedal for an electronic keyboard.
You can assign any button or menu item to the foot pedal. By default, the system assigns the
foot pedal to the Record button on the Audio Punch-In tool. You could also assign the foot
pedal to the Shift key function.
The button mappings for the Digi 002 carry over to the Command|8. The button-mapping
dialog boxes for the Digi 002 and Command|8 are set up differently to match the layout of
the controllers, but the same settings are used for both controllers.
There are several buttons on the Command|8 that are not on the Digi 002:
• Mon 0
• Default
• MemLock
These buttons appear in the Digidesign Command|8 Controller Settings dialog box and do
not appear in the Digidesign 002 Controller Settings dialog box.
Position
indicator
lights
2. Click the Timeline Fast Menu button and select Audio Data > Auto Pan.
3. Move the blue position indicator to the section of audio that you want to adjust and mark
IN to OUT points.
4. Set Preroll and Postroll values, if necessary.
5. Click the Record button to start recording your actions.
416
Using the Digi 002 and Command|8
6. Listen to the audio and turn the pan knob for the track.
The system displays the values in the Pan Value display for the corresponding track in
the Audio Mixer tool.
7. Click the Record button again to stop recording.
8. Click the Audio Loop Play button to play the clip and test your results.
9. To decrease the number of keyframes, click the Audio Mixer Tool Fast Menu button,
and select Filter Automation Pan on Track — In/Out. (Click the Track Selection button
for a track to enable Filter Automation.)
n If you delete too many keyframes, use the Undo command to restore them.
10. Repeat step 9 until you have decreased the number of keyframes to an acceptable level.
You should remove as many excess keyframes as possible while still maintaining the
pan changes.
Using the Latch Mode Feature on the Digi 002 and Command|8
The Digi 002 and Command|8 have a Latch Mode button for each track that allows you to
easily punch-in and punch-out small sections of automation gain information. The Channel
View buttons on the Digi 002 are used as the Latch Mode buttons. These buttons are directly
above the display on the Digi 002. On the Command|8, the Latch Mode buttons are directly
below the display. The first two buttons are labeled EQ and Dynamics.
When a fader is not in Latch Mode, it automatically stops recording as soon as you release
the fader. When you release the fader, it begins moving again as it follows the volume
information in the Timeline.
n The light inside the Latch mode button is on when a fader is not in Latch mode.
417
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
When the track is in Latch mode, the system continues to record audio volume information
after you release the fader. Press the Latch Mode button to stop recording and snap the
button back to its current Timeline position.
For information on connecting a fader controller, see “Connecting Serial and MIDI Port
Devices” in the Help.
c To reduce traffic on the USB, connect the USB-to-MIDI converter only if you need to
use the JL Cooper FaderMaster Pro, JL Cooper MCS-3000X, Yamaha 01V/96, or
Yamaha 01V fader box.
418
Configuring USB-to-MIDI Software for External Controllers
5. To initiate the driver installation, use a USB connector to connect the MIDISPORT 2x2
USB-to-MIDI converter to the system. You do not need to connect the external fader to
the MIDISPORT 2x2 device.
The system automatically detects that a new device has been connected and opens the
Found New Hardware Wizard dialog box.
6. Follow the instructions in the Install.txt file.
n If you uncompressed the files to a folder on your system, two drivers might appear in the list.
Choose either one.
n The Mac OS X operating system contains automatic support for USB-to MIDI devices.
n MIDI port A is the default port used by the Avid system. To change the port configuration,
see “Switching Between MIDI Connections on the USB-to-MIDI Converter” on page 421.
2. Move the sliders on the fader controller, and confirm that the MIDI IN LED indicator on
the USB-to-MIDI converter turns on and off appropriately.
The USB LED indicator pulses — this is expected behavior.
3. Start your Avid editing application, and open the Project window.
4. Click the Settings tab and double-click Controller Settings.
The Controller Settings dialog box opens.
419
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
5. Choose the appropriate port for the device from the Gain Controller menu.
6. Click OK.
7. Select Tools > Audio Mixer.
8. Do one of the following:
t Click and hold the Audio Mixer Mode button and select Automation Mode from the
menu.
t Click the Audio Mixer Mode button and cycle through the Audio Mix mode settings
to the Automation Mode setting.
9. Click the Audio Mixer Tool Fast Menu button, and select Calibrate Hardware Sliders.
If the external fader controller is connected and the system is using the correct MIDI
port, then the Audio Mixer tool displays the following:
- At least one of the position indicator lights is on (blue).
Position
indicator
lights
Now you are ready to use the fader controller with your Avid editing application. For more
information on using the Audio Mixer tool, see “Understanding Automation Gain and Pan”
in the Help.
420
Configuring USB-to-MIDI Software for External Controllers
421
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
5. (Macintosh only) Use the Apple System Profiler to check whether the system is
recognizing the MIDI device:
a. Select Apple P menu > About This Mac.
b. Click More Information.
The Apple System Profiler opens.
c. Click the Devices and Volumes tab.
The USB Information portion of the display identifies the USB devices that the
system recognizes. The system might not display the name of each device, but the
number of USB devices should match the number of devices you have connected to
the system.
c For the MCS-3000X to recognize the Avid application software, you must set the rear
DIP switch #4 down (ON).
422
Using the FaderMaster Pro and MCS-3000X
3. Click the Audio Mixer Tool Fast Menu button, and select Calibrate Hardware Sliders.
The box changes to blue.
4. Check the color of the position indicator lights. If the external fader controller is
connected, at least one of the lights should be on (blue). If the external fader controller is
not connected properly, the lights will probably appear gray.
Position
indicator
lights
MCS-3000X Buttons
There are four rows of unlabeled buttons at the top of the MCS-3000X fader controller.
Select
Snap Mode
Solo
Mute
• Select buttons: The green light next to the Select button for a track is on when you are
recording Audio Gain Automation on the track. The green light is off when you are
listening to the volume level in the Timeline.
If the track is in Snap mode, as soon as you touch the fader, the Select button light turns
on to indicate that you are recording. When you release the fader, the Select button light
turns off and the fader begins moving with the Timeline volume.
423
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
When the track is not in Snap mode, as soon as you touch the fader, the Select button
light turns on to indicate that you are recording. However, when you release the fader,
the Select button light stays on, indicating that you are still recording. To stop recording,
press the Select button.
• Snap Mode buttons: For information on these buttons, see “Using the Snap Mode
Feature on the MCS-3000X” on page 424.
• Solo buttons: These buttons solo the selected tracks.
• Mute buttons: These buttons mute the selected tracks.
In Snap mode, the fader automatically stops recording as soon as you release the fader. In
addition, the fader continues to display the volume information in the Timeline.
When the track is not in Snap mode, the system continues to record audio volume
information after you release the fader. Press the Select button (top row) to stop recording
and snap the button back to its current Timeline position.
The green light next to the Select button for a track is on when you are recording automation
gain on the track. The green light is off when you are listening to the volume level in the
Timeline.
424
Using the Yamaha 01V/96 or the Yamaha 01V
The ganged faders do not move together physically. For information on ganging the faders,
see the FaderMaster Pro user’s manual.
If you have two stereo tracks and want to gang faders 1 and 2 to respond to movement
on fader 1:
1. On the FaderMaster Pro, press the PROG button to light the Fader LED.
2. Press the Group button, and move fader 2 until 1 is displayed.
3. Press the PROG button to turn off the Fader LED.
Now, when you move fader 1, your Avid editing application will receive identical volume
information for fader 2.
To turn off the group feature, repeat steps 1 to 3, but assign fader 2 to 0.
n You cannot gang faders on the Digi 002, the MCS-3000X fader controller, the Yamaha
01V/96 mixer, or the Yamaha 01V mixer.
For instructions on connecting the Yamaha 01V/96 or Yamaha 01V to your Avid system, see
“Connecting the Yamaha 01V/96 Mixer” in the Help.
425
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
This section describes how to initialize the Yamaha 01V/96 or Yamaha 01V digital mixer.
These procedures should have to be done only once and repeated only if the mixer’s
operational parameters have been manually changed to settings that are incompatible with
your Avid editing application.
You should perform these procedures when you first set up the unit. You might also find it
necessary to perform the steps if the unit stops working correctly with your Avid editing
application. Because you can carry out a wide variety of mixing tasks with the Yamaha
01V/96 and the Yamaha 01V, it is possible that some changes you make to the unit might
cause it to stop working with your Avid editing application. If this happens, use the
following procedures to reinitialize the mixer to the factory defaults.
Memory button
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
CURSOR
10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
+1/inc button
ENTER
The LCD panel displays a message asking if you want to reset the system.
2. Answer yes by pressing the +1/inc button.
After you initialize the mixer, you must configure it to receive and transmit control
messages. The Yamaha 01V/96 and Yamaha 01V can both receive MIDI messages. The
Yamaha 01V can also be controlled via a serial port and must be configured to receive serial
control messages if you are using a serial connection. The Yamaha 01V/96 can receive USB
control messages.
n Configure the mixer whether you are using a USB connection or a MIDI connection.
426
Using the Yamaha 01V/96 or the Yamaha 01V
To configure the Yamaha 01V/96 or Yamaha 01V to recognize MIDI control messages:
1. Press the MIDI button.
The system displays the first pane of the MIDI Options window.
2. Set the following controls in the MIDI Options window:
- Set Control Change TX to ON.
- Set Control Change RX to ON.
3. Set Port to MIDI.
427
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
When you start your Avid system with the Yamaha 01V/96 or the Yamaha 01V attached, you
can use the faders for mixing audio channels or for performing automation gain recording.
Use the following buttons to switch between audio mixing and gain recording:
n The Yamaha 01V supports a digital I/O option that uses channels 17 through 24. If you
intend to use the digital I/O option, you should move the digital I/O option to channels 1
through 8 by using the Swap mode. You can access Swap mode from pane 5 of the OPTION
I/O screen. For more information, see the Yamaha documentation.
428
Using the Yamaha 01V/96 or the Yamaha 01V
For information on audio mixing, see the Yamaha 01V/96 or the Yamaha 01V
documentation.
n The Automation Gain window must be in 8-channel mode and you need to have 8 tracks of
audio to use all 8 faders of the Yamaha 01V/96.
The Yamaha 01V/96 and the Yamaha 01V faders are not touch sensitive in the same way as
the JL Cooper MCS-3000X MIDI fader controller. As soon as you touch a moving fader on
the MCS-3000X, the unit passes control of the fader to you. On the Yamaha 01V/96 or the
Yamaha 01V, you must press the fader’s On button to gain control of a moving fader.
n If a fader is not moving, you can move the fader to take control without pressing the On
button.
c If you attempt to catch a moving fader, the mixer will try to control the fader. Press the
On button to take control of the fader.
429
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
n If Solo mode is on when you are mixing audio, it interferes with the normal operation of the
mixing board functions. If the audio outputs from your Avid system are connected to the
Yamaha 01V, leave the Param Change TX and Param Change RX controls set to OFF.
430
Using the Audio EQ Tool
Low shelf
3-band controls
Parametric midrange
High shelf
EQ Range slider
EQ Parameter graph
431
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
The following table describes the buttons that appear along the top portion of the Audio EQ
tool:
Button Description
Effect Mode Selector Allows you to select among the Audio EQ, Audio Mixer, and
AudioSuite Plug-In tools.
Audio Loop Play Allows you to make adjustments to an EQ effect while you play the
effect. This button is also a mappable button on the Command palette.
For more information about using this button, see “About Adjusting
Volume While Playing a Clip Gain Effect” on page 400.
Render Effect Allows you to render an effect without leaving the Audio EQ tool.
Effect icon Allows you to create an EQ template. Drag the icon to an open bin to
create the template.
Track Selection Menu Allows you to choose which tracks are enabled for the EQ effect.
When you select an item from this menu, the system selects or
deselects the corresponding track in the Timeline.
n If you enable more than one track in the Timeline, the tracks are designated by plus signs (+).
They indicate that the effect will be applied to more than one track.
Display/Hide EG Graph Allows you to display or hide the Parametric Curve display.
Bypass RT EQ Allows you to instruct the system to ignore all the EQ effects. This
button is also available in the Automation Gain tool and the Output tab
in the Audio Project Settings dialog box. If you select this feature in
one place, it is selected in the others as well.
Enable/Disable EQ Effect Allows you to enable or disable the current EQ effect. When the button
is yellow, the effect is enabled. (The button text IN stands for inline.)
432
Using the Audio EQ Tool
EQ-Specific Features
The horizontal center line of the graph is 0 (zero). As you move the curve below the zero
line, the corresponding frequencies are deemphasized. Above the zero line, the
corresponding frequencies are emphasized. The parametric midrange allows a smooth
transition from deemphasized frequencies to emphasized frequencies.
The IN button allows you to turn off an individual EQ effect (the currently selected effect).
The button is yellow when the EQ effect is on (inline) and gray when the EQ effect is off.
The Ignore EQ option turns off all EQ effects for the sequence. Rendered EQ effects still
play correctly.
433
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
The following illustration shows the Audio EQ tool with the frequency response curve
displayed and identifies the related areas of the tool.
EQ Parameter display
Bandwidth around the center point of
the parametric curve – 1/4 octave
(narrow) or 2 octaves (wide)
Current values of the EQ
parameters
The Audio EQ tool allows you to emphasize or de-emphasize audio frequencies. The height
of the curve in the bottom pane shows the amount of emphasis or de-emphasis (also called
boost or cut) that is being applied. The range is from +15 dB to –20 dB.
434
Using the Audio EQ Tool
5. Click and hold the Track Selection Menu button in the Audio EQ tool, and select a track
to be adjusted.
Track Selection
Menu button
The Track Selector panel in the Timeline is updated to reflect your selection.
n If multiple tracks are enabled in the Timeline, then plus signs (+) appear next to the enabled
tracks in the Audio EQ tool.
6. Click the Audio Loop Play button to play the currently selected audio clip within the
current IN to OUT range. To stop playing the loop, click the button again or click
anywhere in the Timeline.
7. Use one of the following methods to change a value in the Audio EQ tool:
t Click a number along the vertical edge of the Low Shelf, Parametric Midrange, or
High Shelf sliders.
t Click the Low Shelf, Parametric Midrange, or High Shelf slider, and type a value.
Values are cumulative until you press Enter (Windows) or Return (Macintosh). For
example, if you want to enter the value 12, simply type it. However, if you enter 1
and then want to change the value to 2, press Enter (Windows) or Return
(Macintosh) before typing the 2.
t Click a slider, and then drag the slider to a new position.
t Click the EQ Parameter display, and type a value on the numeric keypad.
t Set a value of 0 dB by clicking the slider and entering 0, or by clicking 0 along the
vertical edge of the Low Shelf, Parametric Midrange, or High Shelf sliders.
8. Click the Audio EQ Tool Fast Menu button, and select Set EQ to apply the adjustments
to the track. The command works as follows on the selected tracks:
- IN and OUT points: Apply the EQ effect to selected tracks between the points.
- An IN point (no OUT point): Apply the EQ effect to full clips from the IN point to
the end of selected tracks.
- No points: Apply the EQ effect globally (across entire tracks).
The Audio EQ Tool Fast menu also allows you to remove EQ effects from one track or
all enabled tracks and provides access to a number of predefined EQ templates. For a
description of predefined audio templates, see “Using Audio EQ Templates” on
page 441.
435
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
For example, the following illustration shows a segment with one EQ effect applied to
Audio Clip 2 in track A1. If you select Set EQ In/Out, the current EQ effect is also
applied to Audio Clip 1 and Audio Clip 3 on track A1.
After Set EQ In/Out – EQ effect is added to Audio Clip 1 and Audio Clip 3.
If there is no EQ setting on the currently selected clip, selecting Set EQ In/Out deletes
the EQ settings on all clips within the IN to OUT range. For example, because there is
no EQ setting on Audio Clip 3 in the following example, Set EQ In/Out deletes the EQ
effect from Audio Clip 1 and Audio Clip 2.
After Set EQ In/Out – EQ effect is deleted from Audio Clip 1 and Audio Clip 2.
Set EQ In/Out applies only to the audio track currently selected by the Audio EQ tool.
You can change your selected region by eliminating or adding marks in the Timeline, or
by selecting a different track.
9. Play through the audio again, using the Audio Loop Play button.
10. Repeat steps 6 to 9 until you are satisfied with the EQ adjustments.
436
Using the Audio EQ Tool
For more information on using effect templates, see “Working with Effect Templates” in the
Help.
437
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
You can also use the commands from the Audio EQ Tool Fast menu.
Audio EQ Examples
The following examples show two different ways to use the Audio EQ tool to remove excess
bass from an audio track. In these examples, assume that a bass drum in the sound track is
very pronounced and the Audio EQ tool is used to deemphasize it. Also assume that there
are voices on the same track as the music. The human voice covers a wide range of
frequencies, and the challenge is to preserve the bass frequencies of the voices while
deemphasizing the bass drum sound.
Consider that the goal of the adjustments is the final sound. You should use small
adjustments to preserve as much of the original sound track as possible. Do not be overly
concerned about specific parameter values.
438
Using the Audio EQ Tool
This example adjusts the low shelf to deemphasize the bass. By dropping the low shelf to
–20 dB, we are able to deemphasize it. However, there are voices on this track, and simply
dropping the low shelf also removes some bass from the voices.
439
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
This example isolates the particular frequency that we want to deemphasize. In this example,
we do not use the low shelf, but instead use the parametric midrange to isolate the frequency.
Once you locate the frequency you want, you can adjust it as needed.
440
Using the Audio EQ Tool
The Fast menu on the Audio EQ tool provides access to a number of predefined EQ
templates, as shown in the following illustration.
The EQ templates are designed to fix problems that you often encounter with audio clips.
For example, Tape Hiss Filter rolls off frequencies above 4 kHz. NTSC Hum Buster cuts the
bass on frequencies that often cause hum on NTSC systems.
Applying an EQ Template
441
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
The following illustration shows the contents of the Audio EQ tool when you select the
Female Voice with Presence template in the Timeline. As explained in the tool, you cannot
change the parameters of a predefined EQ template.
n To see the parameter values of one of the EQ templates that cannot be edited, view the
Console window after you apply the effect. To open the Console window, select
Tools > Console.
If you create an EQ effect, you can use it again as a template in another sequence or on
another track.
Your Avid editing application stores predefined EQ templates in a special bin named
Site_EQs_Bin.avb. You can add your own EQ templates to the Audio EQ Tool Fast menu by
storing your EQ templates in the same bin as the predefined templates.
442
Using the Audio EQ Tool
n Your Avid editing application does not save the effect to the bin until you close the bin.
8. Click the Audio EQ Tool Fast Menu button, and look for your new template.
Use the same procedure as described in “About Adjusting Volume While Playing a Clip
Gain Effect” on page 400.
If there is no existing EQ effect on the clip before you start, you do not hear any changes
until you click the Audio Loop Play button to stop and replay the effect.
As you adjust the EQ values on an existing EQ effect, you might not hear the results
immediately. It takes a few seconds for the changes to be applied to the clip.
443
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
Recording voice-over narration directly into your Avid editing application saves you the
extra steps of recording the narration to tape first, capturing the narration audio to your Avid
system, and then editing the audio clip into the sequence.
Audio punch-in allows you to record audio directly into the Timeline for voice-over
narration.
For information on connecting the hardware, see “Using the Avid Adrenaline,” “Using the
Avid Mojo,” or “Using the Avid Mojo SDI” in the Help.
444
Recording Voice-Over Narration
You can “rehearse” the voice-over while listening to the sequence. The voice-over is not
recorded while you are rehearsing. You can continue to rehearse until you get it right. While
recording, you can watch and listen to the sequence and hear the playback of edited sound
tracks.
This topic describes the features of the Audio Punch-in tool and several typical scenarios for
its use.
The following illustration shows the features of the Audio Punch-In tool. The following
table describes the features of the tool.
445
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
Feature Description
Play In/Out button Starts playing with the ability to perform a real-time punch-in. The play loops
from the IN point to the OUT point but stops looping once recording is done.
This button blinks bright green while playing.
Record button Starts and stops the recording. If an IN point and OUT point are set, recording
automatically starts at the IN point and stops at the OUT point. This button blinks
bright red while recording.
Stop button Stops playing or recording and saves the last recorded data. This button is bright
blue when recording stops.
Go to Mark IN button Moves the position indicator to the IN point. If there is no IN point, your Avid
editing application goes to where the position indicator was previously located or
to the start of the sequence.
Audio Tool button Opens the Audio tool so you can monitor and adjust the audio levels during
recording.
Passthrough Mix Tool Opens the Passthrough Mix tool so you can monitor the audio levels during
button recording.
Preroll text box Allows you to provide an audiovisual cue before the recording begins. Your Avid
editing application backs up the position indicator for the prescribed number of
seconds. You can hear the audio during preroll.
When starting a punch-in with the Record button, a preroll allows you to provide
the duration, in seconds, of the audiovisual cue before the recording begins.
n The Record button takes precedence over preroll. During preroll, if you press the Record button, the
system starts recording immediately.
Postroll text box Allows you to provide the same kind of audiovisual cue after the recording ends
as that provided by the Preroll text box before the recording begins.
Handles text box Instructs your Avid editing application to record audio at the beginning and end
of the clip. This allows you to perform trim edits on the audio.
This feature applies only when you start recording with the Record button. You
can record real-time punch-in only until the end of the handle.
Input Channels button Identify the channels on the audio hardware that are used for recording. Click the
appropriate button to select the channel. The button changes to pink when it is
selected. Alt+click (Windows) or Option+click (Macintosh) the button to display
a menu and select another channel.
446
Recording Voice-Over Narration
Feature Description
n The selected input channels are not used for playback. Do not select the same channels as mix output on
the Audio Mixer tool.
Input Source menu Includes several optional sources for audio input, depending on your system and
audio board.
n To view the audio input sources available on your system, see the Input Source menu in the Input tab in
the Audio Project Settings dialog box.
Timeline Track menus Allow you to specify where your Avid editing application places the audio in the
Timeline. Select either New Track or an existing track. When you select an
existing track, your Avid editing application overwrites the audio on that track
and silences that portion during playback.
447
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
n When performing an audio punch-in, the video resolution is dropped a quarter-frame due to
bandwidth limitations.
Record button
3. Select the input source and input channels that correspond to your hardware setup, and
set other values in the window as appropriate.
To select the input channels you want, click and hold the appropriate Input Channels
button.
448
Recording Voice-Over Narration
4. Click the Timeline Track menus, and select either New Track or an existing track to
specify where your Avid editing application places the audio voice-over in the Timeline.
You can replace part (or all) of an existing track, or you can create a new track for the
voice-over.
5. (Option) Set IN and OUT points in the Timeline to specify the part of the sequence to
which you want to add narration.
6. Click the Play In/Out button or press the V key.
Loop play begins over the entire sequence. If you set an IN point and an OUT point,
loop play begins from the IN point to the OUT point.
The Play In/Out button blinks bright green while playing.
7. When you are ready to start the voice-over, click the Record button or press the B key.
The Record button blinks bright red while recording, and the Play In/Out button is a
steady green. The Audio Meter Channel button in the Audio tool becomes an I and
changes to orange.
8. Continue to click the Record button to record additional voice-overs.
During the audio punch-in process, you have the ability to record over the duration of
the sequence or from the IN point to the OUT point.
9. Click the Stop button, or press the space bar to stop play and recording.
Your Avid editing application automatically names the voice-over and saves it as an
audio clip. You can change the clip name as you would for any other clip. The position
indicator stops to get ready for your next voice-over.
n Your Avid editing application creates one master clip, regardless of how many punch-ins you
perform.
449
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
n Three Undo functions can be performed during one session. The first undo removes the most
recent punch-in, the second undo removes the second-to-last punch-in, and the third undo
removes all the punch-ins.
450
Using a GPI Device with the Audio Punch-In Tool
For more information about Peak Hold, see “Using the Audio Tool” in the Help.
If you have a V-LAN VLXi deck controller and a GPI device connected to your Avid system
and they are configured correctly, you can use the GPI to control additional external
hardware while you are working with the Audio Punch-In tool. For example, you might want
to control an indicator light in a recording studio to provide a visual cue for performers or a
control light outside the studio that indicates when recording is in progress.
451
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
For more information on using the Audio Punch-In tool, see “Recording Voice-Over
Narration Using Audio Punch-in” on page 448.
GPI signal sequences differ, depending on whether or not you are using the Audoi Punch-In
tool with preroll and postroll.
When you use the Audio Punch-In tool without any preroll or postroll, the following occurs:
• Record Out is sent when recording begins.
• Stop Out is sent when recording (and playback) ends.
When you use the Audio Punch-In tool with preroll and postroll, the following occurs:
• Play Out is sent when preroll begins (the position indicator begins moving in the
Timeline, and the Play In/Out button in the Audio Punch-In tool blinks green).
• Record Out is sent when recording begins (the Record button in the Audio Punch-In
tool blinks red).
• Play Out is sent when recording ends and postroll begins (the Stop button in the Audio
Punch-In tool changes to blue).
• Stop Out is sent when postroll ends (the position indicator stops moving).
n Record Out and Play Out repeat if you perform additional recordings.
452
Using a GPI Device with the Audio Punch-In Tool
You can configure the GPI to respond to each signal sent by your Avid editing application in
a specific manner. For a simple indicator light, you might create a GPI setting linking the
Record Out signal from your Avid editing application to the GPI Set action (to turn the light
on) and a setting linking the Stop Out signal from your Avid editing application to the GPI
Reset action (to turn the light off).
For information on GPI actions, see “Working with GPI Settings” on page 454.
If you are working with preroll and postroll values, you might also link the Play Out signal
to the GPI’s Pulse action to flash the light on and off repeatedly during the preroll and
postroll periods. (Since the Pulse action does not switch between on and off very rapidly,
your preroll and postroll durations might need to be quite long to allow for the light to flash
enough times to be meaningful.)
For more information on configuring the GPI, see “Configuring a V-LAN VLXi Controller
and GPI” on page 454.
1 2 3 4 5 6
TIMECODE A TIMECODE B
SERIAL PARALLEL REF SERIAL A SERIAL B LAN CF
V-LAN VLXi IN OUT IN OUT
AC
VLXi transmitter
serial input
453
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
You must configure the V-LAN VLXi controller to work with the VLXi-GT GPI. Assign the
VLXi-GT to a V-LAN node address between 16 and 19. LAN connections of more than 50
feet (15.24 meters) must have a terminator. For more information on configuring the
V-LAN, see the Videomedia VLXi User’s Guide.
You can also edit an existing GPI setting or delete a GPI setting so that it no longer appears
as an option in the GPI Settings dialog box.
454
Using a GPI Device with the Audio Punch-In Tool
455
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
The following tables describe the GPI settings and GPI Node settings options.
Option Description
Name Keep the default V-LAN VLXi name, or type a new name.
Address Select the V-LAN network address to which the VLXi-GT is assigned.
Valid addresses on the V-LAN network are 16 through 19. This address
must match the internal V-LAN address.
Pulse Duration Leave this setting at its default value; it does not alter the length of the
Pulse action in the GPI.
GPI Control Enable When you deselect this option, you disable the GPI but keep the GPI
settings. This is useful for troubleshooting purposes.
Option Description
Node Click the Node menu, and select a node. Nodes 1 through 6 correspond to
the physical connectors on the back of the VLXi-GT GPI device.
456
Using a GPI Device with the Audio Punch-In Tool
Option Description
457
Chapter 13 Working with Audio: Advanced
458
Chapter 14
Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
This chapter describes how to access and use the AudioSuite plug-ins, including the set of
core plug-ins that comes with your Avid editing application. It also provides a list of other
plug-ins that are supported by this version.
• Understanding Digidesign AudioSuite Plug-Ins
• Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
• Non-Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
For information on Digidesign and third-party plug-ins, go to the Digidesign Web site at
www.digidesign.com.
For information on plug-ins that are not supported by your Avid editing application, see
“AudioSuite Plug-in Limitations” on page 471.
A set of core plug-ins is installed automatically. When you purchase additional plug-ins, the
third-party vendor provides instructions on how to load the plug-ins. Some vendors might
require you to drag the plug-in to the Plug-Ins folder; other vendors might perform the task
automatically for you by using an installation program.
c Your Avid editing application requires the files in this folder named
AvidAppPlugIn.dpm and AvidAppPlugIn.dpm.rsr (Windows) or
Avid_Application_PlugIn (Macintosh). Do not delete them.
n AudioSuite Plug-ins supported by Avid are added to the Plug-In Selection menu in the
AudioSuite window. If you install a plug-in that is not officially supported by Avid, the plug-
in name is still added to the Plug-In Selection menu, but a ~ character precedes the name,
informing you that this plug-in is not supported. If you attempt to use the plug-in, a dialog
box appears informing you that this plug-in is not supported and might cause an error.
460
Understanding Digidesign AudioSuite Plug-Ins
By default, the AudioSuite window displays the controls for applying a plug-in to a clip in
the Timeline. When you drag a master clip into the window, the window expands to display
additional parameters for working with master clips. The following illustration shows the
expanded view.
Status display
Display/Hide Master
Clip Controls button
Plug-In Selection menu
Status display
461
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
n To select multiple tracks, press the Shift key while you select additional tracks from the Track
Selection menu. The tracks are designated by plus signs (+), which indicate that the effect is
applied to more than one track.
n If you want to use plug-ins that operate on stereo pairs or that change the length of the audio
clip, use the methods described in “Creating New Master Clips with AudioSuite Plug-Ins”
on page 464.
462
Understanding Digidesign AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Button Description
Cancel Closes the dialog box and does not save the effect.
Preview Plays back a portion or all of the currently selected audio clip with processing.
Some plug-ins can preview in real time and some cannot. If a plug-in cannot preview in real time,
your Avid editing application plays back the processed audio in 2-second intervals: it processes
2 seconds of audio, plays it, processes the next 2 seconds, plays it, and so on.
Render Renders the effect and creates a new audio media file.
Bypass Plays the selected audio without processing. This is useful for comparing the audio with and
without processing applied.
Find level Performs an analysis pass on the audio. Depending on the plug-in, the text and function of this
button might change.
Some plug-ins require an analysis pass on the audio data before they can process the
information. If so, they perform the first pass automatically. Other plug-ins do not require a
first pass but can achieve more accurate results if you allow them to perform a first pass. If
the plug-in supports the optional pass, this button is available. Otherwise, it is dimmed.
463
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
464
Understanding Digidesign AudioSuite Plug-Ins
When you drag a master clip onto the AudioSuite window, the window automatically
expands to display additional controls. You can also click the Display/Hide Master Clip
Controls button to display or hide the additional parameters.
The following illustration identifies the controls that appear when you expand the
AudioSuite window.
Display/Hide
Master Clip
Activate Current Controls button
Plug-In button
Track Selection Toggle Master
Menu button Clip Mode
button
Clip Selection
menu Mark IN to OUT
Input Source Track indicators
selectors
Processing Mode Find Source From
Selection menu Effect button
Load In Source
Monitor button
Target Bin for New
Master Clip menu
Status display Handle Length for End of
Load Result check box
Master Clip (seconds) text box
465
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Control Description
Track Selection Menu This menu is not active in Master Clip Processing mode.
button
Clip Selection menu This menu allows you to choose the active clip. It lists the current active clip and
other clips you dragged into the AudioSuite window. The window controls change
to reflect the active clip.
Input Source Track These buttons allow you to choose the input source tracks for the effect.
selectors
The system automatically chooses a preview track and displays a blue Speaker icon
on the track. To change the preview track, Alt+click (Windows) or Option+click
(Macintosh) the appropriate source track. If the source track that is set as the current
preview track is deselected, the system chooses the lowest available track.
Processing Mode This menu displays the current processing mode of the AudioSuite effect on a given
Selection menu clip. For more information, see “Mono, Stereo, and Multichannel Processing in
AudioSuite Plug-Ins” on page 467.
Target Bin for New This menu allows you to choose the target bin. The system will place the new media
Master Clip menu and a corresponding AudioSuite effect template in the bin. The template allows you
to modify the effect at a later time.
Toggle Master Clip This button activates the master clip processing mode. The button is yellow when
Mode button master clip processing mode is active.
Mark IN to OUT These lights change to green when a mark IN or mark OUT exists on the current
indicators master clip.
Find Source From Effect his button allows you to find the master clip associated with an AudioSuite
button template. When you drop an AudioSuite effect template into the AudioSuite
window, the system activates this button. Click the button to load the master clip
into the AudioSuite window as the active master clip.
n The template you drop in the window must reference an existing master clip.
Load In Source Monitor This button loads the current source master clip into the Source monitor. This is
button useful if you want to add or change IN to OUT points on the clip.
Load Result check box This check box enables you to instruct the system to automatically load the
resulting master clip into the Source monitor.
466
Understanding Digidesign AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Control Description
Handle Length for End This text box allows you to add filler at the end of a master clip. The value
of Master Clip (seconds) represents the number of seconds to add. For example, use this feature to add filler
text box at the end of a master clip when you use a reverb effect to add a reverb trail to the
end of the clip. Select the value before you run the plug-in.
Status display This display provides information about the current state of the Digidesign Audio
Engine (the software that manages the AudioSuite plug-ins) and the currently
applied effect. For stereo and multichannel processing plug-ins, the Status display
identifies the maximum number of tracks that can be processed. If more than the
maximum are initially selected, the system automatically disables tracks until it
reaches the plug-in’s maximum number.
n On the Macintosh, you can Command+click the status display to close the
Digidesign Audio Engine. This might reclaim a small amount of system
memory, expecially if you have a large number of AudioSuite plug-ins
installed. However, when you close the Digidesign Audio Engine in this way,
the Status display changes to “Must relaunch application to reconnect to
DAE,” and you cannot start the Digidesign Audio Engine again without
quitting and reopening the editing application.
467
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
For mono processing, the system creates a new master clip with the same number of tracks
that you selected in the AudioSuite window.
For stereo and multichannel processing, the plug-in creates a master clip with the number of
tracks equal to the number of output streams from the plug-in. For example, a plug-in that
operates on stereo pairs creates a two-channel master clip. A plug-in such as Normalize, that
operates on multiple channels, creates a master clip with the same number of tracks that
were selected in the AudioSuite window.
The Status display at the bottom of the AudioSuite Plug-in window indicates how many
tracks the plug-in can process. If more tracks are enabled than can be processed, the plug-in
automatically selects the correct number of tracks. You can change the track selection based
on your needs.
Most AudioSuite plug-ins automatically select the appropriate processing mode and label
the values in the Processing Mode Selection menu. For example, the Normalize plug-in
offers two choices: Peak On Each Track and Peaks From All Tracks (default).
You select the processing mode from a menu in the AudioSuite window as described in the
next section.
n If you are using Time Compression/Expansion plug-ins, the plug-ins automatically lengthen
or shorten the clip.
468
Understanding Digidesign AudioSuite Plug-Ins
When you create a new master clip, your Avid editing application also creates an AudioSuite
effect template in the bin. This effect template contains a reference to the original master clip
to which the effect was applied.
The template is useful if you want to modify the effect after it is created.
469
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
n Your Avid editing application does not save the effect to the bin until you close the bin.
8. Click the AudioSuite Fast Menu button, and look for your new template.
Some AudioSuite plug-ins can be used in either mono or stereo. If you plan to use them in
stereo, be aware of the following:
• To process a mono track and obtain a stereo result, select the desired track or mark an IN
point and OUT point, then either select an empty track or add an new one. When you
process the audio, the result will be two tracks or regions that represent the right and left
channels of the processed audio. You should then pan these tracks hard right and hard
left in your mix.
• If you set a plug-in to Stereo mode, then select an odd number of tracks for processing,
the plug-in will process the selected tracks in pairs to create the stereo effect. However,
the last odd, unpaired track will be processed as mono, using the left channel settings of
the stereo plug-in. If you want the last track to be processed in stereo, you must select an
additional track to pair it with — an empty one, if necessary.
470
Understanding Digidesign AudioSuite Plug-Ins
If the Digidesign Audio Engine is not running when you start to render an AudioSuite plug-
in effect, the system displays an error message stating that the DAE connection does not
exist. The dialog box gives you the following options:
• Cancel stops the rendering process. This allows you to open the AudioSuite tool and
then start rendering again.
• Bypass continues the rendering process but doesn’t render the plug-in effect.
In most cases, you should click Cancel and open the AudioSuite window.
If the plug-in is not installed when you go to render a plug-in effect, your Avid editing
application displays an error message and tells you which plug-in is not installed. At that
time, you can cancel or bypass the rendering process as previously described.
n Be careful not to press these keys multiple times. If you press Ctrl+period (Windows) or
Command+period (Macintosh) after the render operation has been stopped [from a
previous Ctrl+period (Windows) or Command+period (Macintosh)], your Avid editing
application closes the window after it cancels the render operation.
471
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
n Other AudioSuite plug-ins might get installed on your system for use with ProTools, or you
might download plugins. These plug-ins might not work correctly with your Avid
application, and are not supported by Avid. Use any unsupported plug-ins at your own risk.
The following table provides a brief description of each of the core AudioSuite plug-ins,
with cross-references to more detailed information in the remaining topics in this section.
You can use some AudioSuite plug-ins in either mono or stereo. For guidance on working in
stereo, see “Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins in Stereo” on page 470.
Plug-In Description
Chorus Provides time-delay and pitch-shift effects, added to the clip to create a multi-layered
sound. For more information, see “Chorus AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 474.
Compressor Reduces the dynamic range of signals that exceed a selected threshold by a specific
amount. For more information, see “Compressor AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 477.
Limiter Prevents signal peaks from exceeding a chosen level so that they don’t overload
amplifiers or recording devices. For more information, see “Limiter AudioSuite Plug-In”
on page 479.
Expander-Gate Performs the same function as the Gate plug-in with the addition of expander features.
Expanders are particularly useful for reducing noise or signal leakage that creeps into
recorded material as the signal level falls, which often occurs with headphone leakage.
For more information, see “Expander-Gate AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 480.
Gate Reduces noise by decreasing the gain of signals that fall below a user-selectable
threshold. For more information, see “Gate AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 482.
472
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Plug-In Description
DeEsser Reduces sibilants (“s,” “sh,” and “ch” sounds) and other high-frequency noises that can
cause distortion in audio signals. For more information, see “DeEsser AudioSuite Plug-
In” on page 483.
EQ Allows you to adjust frequency equalization on individual audio clips. Four EQ plug-ins
are available: 1-Band EQ II, 4_Band EQ II, 1-Band EQ III, and 7-Band EQ III. For more
information, see “EQ AudioSuite Plug-Ins” on page 484.
Flanger Creates a flange effect that approximates a true tape-generated flange. For more
information, see “Flanger AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 489.
Invert Inverts the polarity (phase) of the audio file. For more information, see “Invert
AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 490.
Duplicate Creates a new master clip from a selected audio clip. The plug-in uses the IN and OUT
points on the selected clip to define the boundaries of the new clip. For more information,
see “Duplicate AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 490.
Delay Provides time-delay-based effects. Effects obtained through the use of Delay include slap
echo, doubling, chorusing, and flanging. For more information, see “Delay AudioSuite
Plug-In” on page 491.
Multi-Tap Delay Allows you to control up to four independent delays applied to the audio clip. For more
information, see “Multi-Tap Delay AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 492.
Normalize Finds the peak value in the source audio file and scales the entire file proportionally to
that maximum value. For more information, see “Normalize AudioSuite Plug-In” on
page 493.
Gain Same as Normalize, but allows positive or negative gain adjustment. For more
information, see “Gain AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 493.
Ping-Pong Delay Allows you to add a delay to an audio clip to create a ping-pong echo effect. For more
information, see “Ping-Pong Delay AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 494.
Reverse Rewrites the selected audio in reverse. For more information, see “Reverse AudioSuite
Plug-In” on page 494.
DC Offset Removal Removes an audio artifact that is common in digital audio files. A DC offset is caused by
poorly calibrated analog-to-digital converters (A/Ds), and can produce clicks and pops on
clip edit transitions if not removed. For more information, see “DC Offset Removal
AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 495.
Signal Generator Produces audio test tones in a variety of frequencies, waveforms, and amplitudes. For
more information, see “Signal Generator AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 495.
473
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Plug-In Description
Time Compression Allows you to adjust the duration of a selected clip by creating a new master clip. This
Expansion increases or decreases the selection’s length without changing pitch. For more
information, see “Time Compression Expansion AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 495.
Pitch Shift Changes pitch with or without changing length. For more information, see “Pitch Shift
AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 498.
Time Shift Adjusts both the duration and the pitch of a selected clip. For more information, see
“Time Shift AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 499.
474
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Chorus Parameters
Parameter Description
Gain Allows you to adjusts the input volume of the chorus to prevent clipping or increase the level of
the processed signal. This slider is set to a default of +3 dB. If your source audio has been
recorded very close to peak level, this +3 dB default setting could cause clipping. Use this
control to reduce the input level.
Sum Inputs When you use the Chorus plug-in in Stereo mode, a Sum Inputs button appears next to the right
button channel Gain slider. Clicking the Sum Inputs button sums the source input signals (regardless of
whether the input is mono or stereo) before processing them.The source signal then appears in
the center of the stereo field, and the processed signal is output in stereo. When you click the
Sum Inputs button, the LFO waveform on the right channel is automatically phase inverted to
enhance the mono-stereo effect.
Mix Allows you to adjust the balance between the Dry (source) signal and the Wet (processed)
signal, giving you control over the depth of the effect.
Low Pass Controls the cutoff frequency of the Low Pass Filter, allowing you to attenuate the high
Filter frequency content of the feedback signal. The lower the setting, the more high frequencies are
removed from the feedback signal. The range of the Low Pass Filter is 20 Hz to 19.86 kHz, with
a maximum value of Off (which effectively means bypass).
Delay Sets the delay time between the source signal and the processed signal. The higher the setting,
the longer the delay and the wider the chorusing effect. Delay is adjustable from
0 to 20 milliseconds.
LFO Rate Allows you to adjust the rate of the low frequency oscillator (LFO) applied to the delayed signal
as modulation. The higher the setting, the more rapid the modulation. You can select either a
sine wave or a triangle wave as a modulation source, using the LFO Waveform selector.
LFO Width Allows you to adjust the intensity of the LFO applied to the delayed signal as modulation. The
higher the setting, the more intense the modulation. Use the LFO Waveform selector to select a
sine or a triangle wave as a modulation source.
Feedback Controls the amount of feedback applied from the output of the delayed signal back into its
input. Negative settings provide a more intense effect.
LFO Selects a sine wave or triangle wave for the LFO. This affects the character of the modulation.
Waveform The sine wave has a gentler ramp and peak than the triangle wave.
475
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
D-Verb Parameters
Parameter Description
Mix Allows you to adjust the balance between the Dry (source) signal and the Wet (processed)
signal, giving you control over the depth of the effect.
Algorithm Allows you to select one of seven reverberation algorithms. Selecting an algorithm changes the
preset provided for it.
• Hall — Good, general-purpose concert hall with a natural character
• Church — Dense, diffuse space simulating a church or cathedral
• Plate — Simulation of the acoustic character of a metal plate–based reverberation, which
has the general effect of thickening the initial sound itself
• Room 1 — Medium-sized, natural, rich-sounding room that can be effectively varied in
size between very small and large
• Room 2 — Smaller, brighter reverberant characteristic than Room 1, with a useful
adjustment range that extends to very small
• Ambient — Transparent response useful for adding a sense of space without adding a lot
of depth or density
• Nonlin — Nonlinear reverberation with a natural buildup and an abrupt cutoff similar to a
gate
Size In conjunction with the Algorithm parameter, allows you to adjust the overall size of the
reverberant space. There are three sizes: Small, Medium, and Large. The character of the
reverberation changes with each setting (as does the relative value of the Decay parameter).
476
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Diffusion Sets the degree to which initial echo density increases over time. High settings result in high
initial buildup of echo density. Low settings cause low initial buildup. This control interacts
with the Size and Decay parameters to affect the overall reverberation density.
Decay Controls the rate at which the reverberation decays after the original direct signal stops. The
value of the Decay parameter is affected by the Size and Algorithm parameters. This parameter
can be set to infinity on most algorithms for infinite reverberation times.
Pre-Delay Allows you to determine the amount of time that elapses between the original audio event and
the onset of reverberation.
HF (High Controls the decay characteristic of the high frequency components of the reverberation. It acts
Frequency) in conjunction with the LP Filter control to create the overall high frequency contour of the
Cut reverberation.
LP Filter Controls the overall high frequency content of the reverberation by allowing you to set the
frequency above which a 6-dB-per-octave filter attenuates the processed signal.
Audio material often varies in loudness, and can be above the threshold at one moment and
below it the next. The Attack slider sets the Compressor’s response time, or attack. The
Release slider sets the amount of time that it takes for the Compressor’s gain to return to its
original level.
To use compression most effectively, the attack time should be set so that signals exceed the
threshold level long enough to cause an increase in the average level. This helps to ensure
that gain reduction doesn’t decrease the overall volume.
Release times should be set long enough so that if signal levels repeatedly rise above the
threshold, they cause gain reduction only once. If the release time is too long, a loud section
of the audio material could cause gain reduction that persists through a soft section. Of
course, compression has many creative uses that break these rules.
477
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
The Compressor has built-in metering that allows you to monitor the amount of gain
reduction taking place. The Gain Reduction meter usually remains at 0-dB level when the
input signal is below the threshold, and falls to the left to show the amount of gain reduction
in decibels when the input signal exceeds the threshold.
Compressor Parameters
Parameter Description
Input Indicates the level of the unprocessed input signal to the Compressor.
Output Indicates the output level of the Compressor, including any gain compensation added through
the Gain parameter.
Gain Provides overall output gain adjustment. It allows you to compensate for heavily compressed
signals.
Threshold Allows you to set the threshold level. Signals that exceed this level are compressed. Signals
that are below it are unaffected. A level setting of 0 dB is equivalent to no compression. Unlike
scales on analog compressors, metering scales on a digital device reflect a 0-dB value, which
indicates full scale (FS) — the full-code signal level. There is no headroom above 0 dB.
Ratio Allows you to set the compression ratio. The range is based on decibels above the threshold. If
this parameter is set to 2:1, for example, it compresses changes in signals above the threshold
by one half.
Attack Allows you to set the Compressor’s attack time. The smaller the value, the faster the attack.
The faster the attack, the faster the Compressor applies attenuation to the signal. If you use fast
attack times and heavy limiting, you should use a proportionally longer release time,
particularly with material that contains many peaks in close proximity.
Release Allows you to control how long it takes for the Compressor to be fully deactivated after the
input signal drops below the threshold level. If you use heavy compression, you should use
proportionally longer release times. This prevents pumping, which might occur when the
Compressor is forced to jump back and forth between compressed and uncompressed signal
levels. Lengthening the release time helps smooth these changes in level by introducing a lag
in the ramp-up and ramp-down times of attenuation. Use shorter release times on material with
few peaks that do not occur in close proximity to each other.
Knee Allows you to set the rate at which the compressor reaches full compression once the threshold
has been exceeded. This parameter ranges from 0 (hardest response) to 200 (softest response).
Graph Displays the response curve set by the Compressor’s Threshold, Ratio, and Knee settings. As
you adjust these parameters, refer to the graph to see how the shape of this curve changes. It
allows you to see the effect of your settings.
478
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Limiting is used to prevent short-term peaks from reaching their full amplitude. Used
carefully, limiting allows you to achieve higher average levels while avoiding overload
(clipping or distortion) by limiting some short-term transients in the source audio. To
prevent the ear from hearing the gain changes, use extremely short attack and release times.
Limiting is used to remove occasional peaks because gain reduction on successive peaks
wouldn’t be noticeable. If audio material contains many peaks, the threshold should be
raised and the gain manually reduced so that only occasional, extreme peaks are limited.
The Limiter’s ratio is internally set to 100:1 and the attack time is automatically set to 0
milliseconds. The Limiter is similar to heavy compression. It can be useful for reducing pops
and clicks, or for hard-limiting dynamic range for broadcast or band-limited media such as a
cassette.
Limiter Parameters
Parameter Description
Input Indicates the level of the unprocessed input signal to the Limiter.
Output Indicates the output level of the Limiter, including any gain compensation added through the
Gain parameter.
Threshold Allows you to set the threshold level. Signals that exceed this level are limited. Signals that
are below it are unaffected.
479
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Attack Allows you to set the Limiter’s attack time. The smaller the value, the faster the attack. The
faster the attack, the faster the Limiter applies attenuation to the signal. If you use fast attack
times and heavy limiting, you should use a proportionally longer release time, particularly
with material that contains many peaks in close proximity.
Release Allows you to control how long it takes for the Limiter to be fully deactivated after the input
signal drops below the threshold level. If you use heavy limiting, you should use
proportionally longer release times.This prevents pumping, which can occur when the
Limiter is forced to jump back and forth between limited and unlimited signal levels.
Lengthening the release time helps smooth these changes in level by introducing a lag in the
ramp-up and ramp-down times of attenuation. Use shorter release times on material with few
peaks that do not occur in close proximity to each other.
Graph Displays the response curve set by the Limiter’s Threshold setting. As you adjust this
parameter, refer to the graph to see how the shape of this curve changes. It allows you to see
the effect of your settings.
Expanders can be thought of as soft-noise gates because they provide a gentler way of
cutting off noisy low-level signals than the typically abrupt cutoff of a gate. If you want,
however, you can use this plug-in as a gate by setting the Ratio to its maximum value and
using short Attack, Decay, and Hold settings.
480
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Expander-Gate Parameters
Parameter Description
Threshold Allows you to set the threshold level. Signals that fall below the threshold are reduced in
gain. Signals that are above it are unaffected. (When you adjust the Threshold slider, be
sure that audio material is playing through the Expander-Gate to see changes reflected in
the Reduction meter.)
Ratio Allows you to set the amount of expansion. If this parameter is set to 2:1, for example, it
lowers signals below the threshold by one half. At higher ratio levels (30:1 or 40:1, for
example) the Expander-Gate functions as a gate by reducing lower level signals
dramatically. As you adjust the Ratio parameter, refer to the built-in graph to see how the
shape of the expansion curve changes.
Attack Allows you to set the Expander’s attack time. This parameter determines how quickly a
signal’s level is reduced once it falls below the threshold. This setting, along with the
Ratio setting, allows you to control the softness of the Expander’s gain reduction curve.
Hold Allows you to specify a duration (in seconds or milliseconds) that the Expander-Gate
stays open after the initial attack cycle. This parameter can be used as a one-time
function to keep the Expander-Gate open for longer periods of time with a single
crossing of the threshold. It can also be used to prevent gate chatter, which might occur if
varying input levels near the threshold cause the Gate to open and close very rapidly.
Decay Allows you to control how long it takes for the Gate to close after the input signal falls
below the threshold level and the hold time has passed.
Range Sets the depth of the Gate when closed. This parameter has a maximum depth of –80 dB.
Setting the Gate to higher range levels allows more of the gated audio that falls below the
threshold to peek through the Gate at all times.
Graph Displays the response curve set by the Expander-Gate’s Threshold, Ratio, and Range
settings. As you adjust these parameters, refer to the graph to see how the shape of this
curve changes. It allows you to see the effect of your settings.
481
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Gate Parameters
Parameter Description
Threshold Allows you to set the threshold level. Signals that exceed this level pass through. Signals
that are below it are gated, depending on the settings of the Attack, Hold, Decay, and
Range parameters.
Hold Allows you to specify a duration (in seconds or milliseconds) that the Gate stays open after
the initial attack cycle. This parameter can be used as a one-time function to keep the Gate
open for longer periods of time with a single crossing of the threshold. It can also be used
to prevent gate chatter, which might occur if varying input levels near the threshold cause
the Gate to open and close very rapidly.
Decay Allows you to control how long it takes for the Gate to close after the signal falls below the
threshold level.
Range Sets the depth of the Gate when closed. This parameter has a maximum depth of –80 dB.
Setting the Gate to higher range levels allows more of the gated audio that falls below the
threshold to peek through the gate at all times. This is useful for problems such as drum
leakage, where you might want to suppress the overall drum kit sound by a specific amount
while emphasizing the gated instrument such as a snare.
Graph Displays the response curve set by the Gate’s Threshold and Range settings. As you adjust
these parameters, refer to the graph to see how the shape of this curve changes. It allows
you to see the effect of your settings.
482
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
n For best results, use the DeEsser before any other compressor or limiter plug-in.
Because too much “de-essing” can make audio clips sound lifeless, apply the plug-in to
individual tracks rather than entire mixes. To improve audio quality in your project:
• Set the Frequency slider to remove sibilants (typically in the 4– to 10–kHz range) and
not other parts of the signal. This prevents de-essing from changing the original
character of the audio material.
• Set the Threshold control high enough to trigger de-essing by sibilants only. If you set
the Threshold too low, a loud, nonsibilant section of audio material could cause
unwanted gain reduction or overattenuation of sibilants.
• Automate the Threshold control so that it is lower on soft sections when the audio
material has both very loud and very soft passages.
DeEsser Parameters
Parameter Description
Input Indicates the level of the unprocessed input signal to the DeEsser.
Reduction Indicates the amount of gain reduction in decibels. It remains at the 0-dB level when the
input signal is below the threshold.
Threshold Sets the threshold level. Signals that exceed this level will be compressed; signals that are
below it will be unaffected. A setting of 0 dB is equivalent to no de-essing.
483
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Frequency Sets the frequency band in which the DeEsser operates. Frequencies in the specified range
will be gain-reduced. To find the optimum Frequency setting, slide this control back and
forth during playback.
Key Listen Monitors the sibilant peaks used by the DeEsser as a key input to trigger compression. This
is useful for listening only to the sibilants and fine-tuning settings to remove them.
EQ AudioSuite Plug-Ins
There are four EQ plug-ins:
• 1-Band EQ II
• 4-Band EQ II
• 1-Band EQ III
• 7-Band EQ III
The EQ plug-ins provide a set of high-quality options for adjusting the frequency spectrum
of audio material
484
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
EQ II Parameters
Parameter Description
Input Allows you to control the input gain of the EQ to prevent the possibility of clipping.
Phase Invert Allows you to invert the phase (polarity) of the input signal in order to change frequency
response between “multi-miked” sources (a common technique for “miking” a guitar
amplifier), or to correct for miswired microphone cables.
Type Allows you to select an EQ type (High-Pass, Low-Shelf, Peak, High-Shelf or Low-Pass).
Gain Allows you to control the amount that the selected frequencies are cut or boosted (for Peak,
High-Shelf, and Low-Shelf only).
Freq Allows you to designate the center of the frequency region to be cut or boosted.
Q (Peak only) Allows you to set the bandwidth of the Peak filter. Higher values represent
narrower bandwidths. Lower values represent wider bandwidths.
Bypass Bypasses the EQ. The 4-Band EQ II has individual Bypass buttons for each band (black
buttons with EQ curve icons).
High-Pass Attenuates all frequencies below the selected cutoff frequency setting at a rate of 12 dB per
octave while allowing all others above the frequency to pass through. For this reason, no
gain control is available for this filter. High-pass filters can be useful for removing low-
frequency rumble or for thinning out the lower end of a sound for special effects, such as a
“telephone simulation” effect.
Peak Boosts or cuts only those frequencies around the selected center frequency. The Q button
sets the bandwidth of the Peak filter, which determines the width of the filter’s overall slope
— from a broad “bell” shape to a narrow notch. Broad curves tend to be most useful for
musical applications. Narrow curves are useful for special-purpose processing such as hum
removal. Higher values represent narrower bandwidths. Lower values represent wider
bandwidths.
High-Shelf Produces a lift or a cut at the specified frequency and above it.
485
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Low-Pass Attenuates all frequencies above the selected cutoff frequency setting at a rate of 12 dB per
octave while allowing all others below the frequency to pass through. For this reason, no
gain control is available for this filter.
Parameter Description
Input Sets the input gain of the plug-in before EQ processing, letting you make up gain or prevent
clipping at the plug-in input stage.
Input Polarity Inverts the phase (polarity) of the input signal, to help compensate for phase anomalies
control occurring in multi-microphone environments, or because of mis-wired balanced
connections.
Type Allows you to select an EQ type (High-Pass, Notch, High-Shelf, Low-Shelf, Peak, or Low-
Pass). The name of the type you select appears in the text field.
Filter
Q (Peak and Notch) Controls the width of the EQ band. Higher values represent narrower
bandwidths. Lower values represent wider bandwidths.
(High-Shelf and Low-Shelf) Changes the Q of the shelving filter. Higher Q values represent
steeper shelving curves. Lower Q values represent broader shelving curves.
(High-Pass and Low-Pass) Lets you select from any of the following Slope values: 6 dB, 12
dB, 18 dB, or 24 db per octave.
Freq Allows you to set the center frequency (Peak, High-Shelf, Low-Shelf, and Notch) or the
cutoff frequency (High-Pass and Low-Pass).
Gain Allows you to control the amount that the selected frequencies are cut or boosted (for High-
Shelf, Low-Shelf, and Peak only).
Frequency Graph Shows a control dot that indicates the center frequency or cutoff frequency for the currently
Display selected filter type, and a frequency response curve. You can adjust the parameters by
dragging the control dot.
486
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
In and Out meters Show peak signal levels before and after EQ processing. Green indicates nominal levels.
Yellow indicates pre-clipping levels, starting at –6 dB below full scale. Red indicates full
scale (clipping) levels.
The clip indicators to the right of each meter indicate clipping at the input of output stage of
the plug-in. Click a clip indicator to clear it.
Input Sets the input gain of the plug-in before EQ processing, letting you make up gain or prevent
clipping at the plug-in input stage.
Input Polarity Inverts the phase (polarity) of the input signal, to help compensate for phase anomalies
control occurring in multi-microphone environments, or because of mis-wired balanced
connections.
Output Sets the output gain after EQ processing, letting you make up gain or prevent clipping on the
channel where the plug-in is being used.
Bands The plug-in has separate parameter controls for each of the following 7 bands:
• High-Pass/Low-Notch (HPF)
• Low-Pass/High-Notch (LPF)
• Low Shelf/Low Peak (LF)
• Low-Mid Peak (LMF)
• Mid-Peak (MF)
• High-Mid Peak (HMF)
• High Shelf/High Peak (HF)
Band Enable Toggles the band in and out of the circuit. When a band’s Enable button is highlighted, the
button band is in circuit. When a band’s Enable button is dark gray, the band is bypassed.
487
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Type selectors The HPF, LPF, LF, and HF band sections have type selectors that toggle between the two
available filter types for that section, as follows:
• High-Pass Filter (HPF band) — Attenuates all frequencies below the Frequency setting
at the selected slope while letting all frequencies above pass through.
• Low-Notch EQ (HPF band) — Attenuates a narrow band of frequencies centered around
the Frequency setting. The width of the attenuated band is determined by the Q setting.
• Low-Pass Filter (LPF band) — Attenuates all frequencies above the Frequency setting at
the selected slope while letting all frequencies below pass through.
• High-Notch EQ (LPF band) — Attenuates a narrow band of frequencies centered around
the Frequency setting. The width of the attenuated band is determined by the Q setting.
• Low-Shelf EQ (LF band) — Boosts or cuts frequencies at and below the Frequency
setting. The amount of boost or cut is determined by the Gain setting. The Q setting
determines the shape of the shelving curve.
• Low Peak EQ (LF band) — Boosts or cuts a band of frequencies centered around the
Frequency setting. The width of the selected band is determined by the Q setting.
• High-Shelf EQ (LF band) — Boosts or cuts frequencies at and above the Frequency
setting. The amount of boost or cut is determined by the Gain setting. The Q setting
determines the shape of the shelving curve.
• High Peak EQ (LF band) — Boosts or cuts a band of frequencies centered around the
Frequency setting. The width of the selected band is determined by the Q setting.
Q (Peak and Notch bands) Controls the width of the EQ band. Higher values represent
narrower bandwidths. Lower values represent wider bandwidths.
(Shelf bands) Changes the Q of the shelving filter. Higher Q values represent steeper
shelving curves. Lower Q values represent broader shelving curves.
(High-Pass and Low-Pass bands) Lets you select from any of the following Slope values: 6
dB, 12 dB, 18 dB, or 24 db per octave.
Freq Allows you to set the center frequency (Peak, Shelf, and Notch EQs) or the cutoff frequency
(High-Pass and Low-Pass filters).
Gain Allows you to control the amount that the selected frequencies are cut or boosted (for Shelf
and Peak only).
Frequency Graph Shows a color-coded control dot that corresponds to the color of the Gain control for each
Display band, and a frequency response curve. You can adjust the parameters by dragging one or
more of the control dots.
488
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
The Flanger plug-in combines a time-delayed, pitch-shifted copy of an audio signal with
itself. The Flanger differs from other digital flangers in that it uses a through-zero flanging
algorithm that results in a truer tape-like flange. This technique delays the source signal very
slightly (approximately 256 samples), and then modulates the delayed signal back and forth
in time in relation to the source signal, passing through its zero point on the way.
The Flanger plug-in is ideal for thickening and adding a swirling, moving quality to guitars
and other instruments. The following table lists the Flanger plug-in parameters:
Parameter Description
Input Level Allows you to adjust the input volume of the flanger to prevent clipping or increase the level of
the processed signal. This slider is set to a default of +3 dB. If your source audio has been
recorded very close to peak level, this +3 dB default setting could cause clipping. Use this
control to reduce the input level.
Sum Inputs When you use the Flanger plug-in in Stereo mode, a Sum Inputs button appears next to the
button right channel Input Level slider. Clicking the Sum Inputs button sums the source input signals
(regardless of whether the input is mono or stereo) before processing them.The source signal
then appears in the center of the stereo field, and the processed signal is output in stereo. When
you click the Sum Inputs button, the LFO waveform on the right channel is automatically
phase inverted to enhance the mono-stereo effect.
Mix Allows you to adjust the balance between the Dry (source) signal and the Wet (processed)
signal, giving you control over the depth of the effect.
High Pass Controls the cutoff frequency of the High Pass Filter, allowing you to attenuate the frequency
Filter content of the feedback signal and the frequency response of the flanging. The higher the
setting, the more low frequencies are removed from the feedback signal.
LFO Rate Allows you to adjust the rate of the low frequency oscillator (LFO) applied to the delayed
signal as modulation. The higher the setting, the more rapid the modulation. Use the LFO
Waveform selector to select either a sine wave or a triangle wave as a modulation source.
LFO Width Allows you to adjust the intensity of the LFO applied to the delayed signal as modulation. The
higher the setting, the more intense the modulation.
Feedback Controls the amount of feedback applied from the output of the delayed signal back into its
input. Negative settings provide a more intense effect.
LFO Selects a sine wave or triangle wave for the LFO. This affects the character of the modulation.
Waveform The sine wave has a gentler ramp and peak than the triangle wave.
489
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
490
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Delay Parameters
Parameter Description
Mix Allows you to control the balance between the delayed signal and the original signal. If
you are using a delay for flanging or chorusing, you can control the depth of the effect
somewhat with the Mix setting.
LPF (Low-Pass Controls the cutoff frequency of the low-pass filter. This parameter allows you to attenuate
Filter) the high-frequency content of the feedback signal. The lower the setting, the more high
frequencies are attenuated.
Delay Sets the delay time between the original signal and the delayed signal.
Depth Controls the depth of the modulation applied to the delayed signal.
Feedback Controls the amount of feedback applied from the output of the delay back into its input.
Also controls the number of repetitions of the delayed signal. Negative Feedback settings
give a more intense “tunnel-like” sound to flanging effects.
Tempo Sets the desired tempo in beats per minute. When a specific Duration is selected, moving
this control will affect the Delay setting.
Meter Use this to enter either simple or compound time signatures. The default time signature is
4/4.
Duration Click one or more of the buttons to specify a desired delay from a musical perspective. You
can click one of the note value buttons (whole note, half note, quarter note, eighth note,
sixteenth note). If necessary, click the Triplet modifier or Dot modifier button to dot the
selected note value or make it a triplet.
Groove Provides fine adjustment of the delay in percentages of a 1:4 subdivision of the beat. You
can use this parameter to add “swing” by slightly offsetting the delay from the precise beat
of the track.
491
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
The Multi-Tap Delay plug-in adds up to four independently controlled delays (or “taps”) to
the original audio signal. By allowing you to control the delay time and number of
repetitions of each tap individually, the Multi-Tap Delay plug-in provides greater flexibility
than standard single-delay devices.
The Multi-Tap Delay plug-in is ideal for adding spatialization or complex rhythmic echo
effects to virtually any instrument or sound.
Parameter Description
Gain Controls the input level of each of the four delay lines for individual delay taps. Adjust Gain to
prevent clipping or increase the level of the processed signal.
Feedback Controls the amount of feedback applied from the output of the delay into its input. It also
controls the number of repetitions of the delayed signal. For the feedback parameter to
function, the Gain slider must be raised above its lowest setting.
Pan Controls the apparent location of each tap in the stereo field.
Delay Sets the delay time between the original signal and the delayed signal. The higher the setting,
the longer the delay. This parameter is adjustable from 0 to 1500 milliseconds (1.5 seconds).
Mix Allows you to adjust the balance between the source signal and the processed signal, giving
you control over the depth of the effect.
Sum Inputs When you use the Multi-Tap Delay plug-in in Stereo mode, a Sum Inputs button appears next
button to the Mix sliders. Clicking the Sum Inputs button sums the source input signals (regardless of
whether the input is mono or stereo) before processing them.The source signal then appears in
the center of the stereo field, and the processed signal is output in stereo.
492
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
The controls let you specify how close to maximum level (the clipping threshold) the peak
level of your selection or file is boosted. You can enter this information in the following
ways:
t Enter a numeric decibel value below the clipping threshold.
t Enter a percentage of the threshold.
t Drag the slider.
t Press and hold the Ctrl key (Windows) or the k key (Macintosh), then drag the slider to
fine-adjust.
Use the rms and peak buttons to switch the calibration of normalizing between RMS and
Peak modes. Peak normalizes the signal at the maximum possible level without clipping.
RMS normalizes the input signal at a level consistent with the root-mean-square value, or
the effective average level of the selected material.
Use the rms and peak buttons to switch the calibration of gain adjustment between RMS and
Peak modes. Peak adjusts the gain of the signal to the maximum possible level without
clipping. RMS adjusts the input signal to a level consistent with the root-mean-square value,
or the effective average level of the selected material.
493
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Gain Adjusts the input volume of the Ping-Pong Delay to prevent clipping or increase the level of
the processed signal.
Sum Inputs When you use the Ping-Pong Delay plug-in in Stereo mode, a Sum Inputs button appears next
button to the Gain sliders. Clicking the Sum Inputs button sums the source input signals (regardless
of whether the input is mono or stereo) before processing them.The source signal then
appears in the center of the stereo field, and the processed signal is output in stereo.
Mix Allows you to adjust the balance between the source signal and the processed signal, giving
you control over the depth of the effect.
Delay Sets the delay time between the original signal and the delayed signal. The higher the setting,
the longer the delay. This parameter is adjustable from 0 to 1500 milliseconds (1.5 seconds).
Lowpass Filter Controls the cutoff frequency of the Lowpass Filter, allowing you to attenuate the high
frequency content of the feedback signal. The lower the setting, the more high frequencies are
removed from the feedback signal. The range of the Lowpass Filter is 20 Hz to 19.86 kHz,
with a maximum value of Off (which effectively means bypass).
Feedback Controls the amount of feedback applied from the output of the delay into its input. It also
controls the number of repetitions of the delayed signal.
Cross-Feedback Feeds the delayed signals to their opposite channels. The result is a stereo echo that ping-
pongs back and forth between the right and left channels.
494
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Use the rms and peak buttons to switch the calibration of the generated signal between RMS
and Peak modes. Peak generates the signal at the maximum possible level without clipping.
RMS generates the signal at levels consistent with the root-mean-square value, or the
effective average level of the signal.
n The Signal Generator produces a tone as soon as it is inserted on a track. To mute the tone,
click the Bypass button.
n To change duration (length) and pitch simultaneously, use the Pitch Shift plug-in.
495
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
The Time Compression Expansion plug-in has special parameters that let you enter time
compression or expansion values in different formats. They are located in the Source and
Destination columns, and also include the Ratio slider. Additional controls for fine-tuning
the compression and expansion process are also included.
The following table lists the Time Compression Expansion plug-in parameters.
Parameter Description
Source and The Source text boxes display the length of the current selection before processing in
Destination each of the listed formats. All the text boxes in both columns are constantly active, and a
change made to one value is immediately reflected in the values displayed in the other
text boxes.
The text boxes in the Destination column display and control the length of the selection
after processing using the current settings. You can enter the length of the Destination file
by double-clicking the appropriate text box in the Destination column. Type the number
of samples in min:secs:msec format or type timecode values as start and end locations.
All the Destination text boxes are constantly updated, and a change made to one value is
immediately reflected in the values displayed in the other text boxes.
You can also enter a new tempo, bars:beats:ticks length, or time signature for regions that
have tempo or Bars & Beats settings. This can be any region associated with a MIDI
Metronome value (such as an overdub recorded to a MIDI click) or regions that have been
processed with the Pro Tools Identify Beat command.
The Ratio slider lets you set the destination length in relation to the source length.
Dragging the slider to the right increases the length of the destination file, and dragging
the slider to the left decreases its length.
The controls below the bar line allow you to fine-tune the time compression and
expansion process. They include the Crossfade, Min Pitch, and Accuracy sliders.
496
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Crossfade The Crossfade slider allows you to manually adjust the crossfade length in milliseconds
to optimize performance of the Time Compression Expansion plug-in according to the
type of audio material you are processing. The Time Compression Expansion plug-in
achieves length modification by replicating or subtracting very small portions of audio
material and very quickly crossfading between these alterations in the waveform of the
audio material.
Crossfade length essentially affects the amount of smoothing performed on audio
material to prevent audio artifacts such as clicks. In general, small narrow-range time
(length) changes require longer crossfades while larger changes in length require shorter
crossfades. The disadvantage of long crossfade times is that they smooth the signal,
including any transients. While this can be desirable for audio material such as vocals, it
is not appropriate for material with sharp transients such as drums or percussion.
The default setting for this parameter is Auto (leftmost position), in which crossfade
times are set automatically according to the percentage of change in length for the current
process. This setting should be sufficient for most applications; however, you can use this
slider to manually adjust and optimize crossfade times, if necessary. For audio material
with sharper attack transients, use shorter crossfade times. For audio material with softer
attack transients, use longer crossfade times with a range in values of 1 to 200 ms.
Min Pitch The Min Pitch slider lets you select the minimum (lowest) pitch that is used in the plug-
in’s calculations during the time compression and expansion process. The slider has a
range of 40 Hz to 1000 Hz. By controlling the minimum pitch, you can focus the time
compression and expansion process for maximum efficiency — it all depends on the
audio’s spectral shape.
This slider should be set lower when you process bass guitar or another instrument with a
similarly low range. Set the min pitch higher when processing instruments such as snare
drums, violins, and other higher range instruments and sounds. Experiment with
combinations of the other fine-tune controls in relation to the Min Pitch slider.
Accuracy Use the Accuracy slider to prioritize the processing resources allocated to audio quality
(sound) or timing (rhythm). Dragging the slider toward sound generally results in better
sonic quality and fewer audio artifacts. Dragging the slider toward rhythm puts the
emphasis on keeping the tempo consistent. When working with loops, listen carefully and
adjust accuracy until you find the setting that keeps timing solid within the region. Start
and end times are precise, but the perception of beats might be “shuffled” if the Accuracy
slider’s rhythm setting is too low.
c The smallest time ratio allowed for time compression and expansion is 0.25.
The largest time ratio allowed is 4.0.
497
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Edit the Pitch Shift parameters by double-clicking and typing in any Destination text box or
by dragging a slider to adjust. All Pitch Shift plug-in controls are linked, so that changing
one changes the others.
Parameter Description
Gain The Gain controls set the input level, in tenths of a decibel. The input level should be set
so that the plug-in can adequately handle amplitude peaks in the selection. Dragging the
slider to the right increases gain, and dragging the slider to the left decreases gain.
Coarse and Fine Adjust the pitch by dragging either of the two faders, or by typing values in the Coarse
and Fine text boxes. The Coarse slider transposes in semitones (half steps); the Fine
slider transposes in cents (hundredths of a semitone).
Ratio The Ratio slider lets you set the amount of transposition (pitch change). Dragging the
slider to the right raises the pitch of the processed file, and dragging the slider to the left
decreases its pitch. Press and hold the Ctrl key (Windows) or the k key (Macintosh)
when you drag the slider to fine-adjust.
Crossfade, Min For information on these parameters, see the parameters table in “Time Compression
Pitch, Accuracy Expansion AudioSuite Plug-In” on page 495.
Time Correction Clicking the Time Correction check box allows you to enable or disable time correction.
c You can deselect the Time Correction check box if you are using the Create
New Master Clips feature of the AudioSuite plug-ins. The Time Correction
check box must be selected, however, when you are applying AudioSuite plug-
ins to audio clips in the Timeline.
If the Time Correction check box is deselected, it has the effect of “permanently
varispeeding” your audio file. Like working with tape, the file’s duration is compressed
or extended according to the settings of the Coarse and Fine controls. Playback speed
increases proportionally as the sound file is transposed up in pitch and decreases
proportionally as it is transposed down in pitch, just like a tape recorder that is
varispeeding.
Consider that altering a file in this way has little detrimental effect on the fidelity of
audio files, whereas time correction can affect fidelity in a pronounced way.
498
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Reference Pitch The Reference Pitch feature generates a sine wave tone that you can adjust to match a
selected portion of audio material, and then use as an audible reference when pitch-
shifting other audio material in your session.
To use the Reference Pitch feature:
1. Select the audio material you want to use as a pitch reference. Click the Preview
button to begin playback of the selected audio.
2. Click the Reference Pitch button to activate the reference sine wave tone.
3. Adjust the Note and Detune settings to match the reference tone to the pitch of the
audio playback. Adjust the Level setting to change the relative volume of the
reference tone. It might also be helpful to switch the Reference Pitch on and off to
compare pitch.
4. Select the audio material to be pitch shifted.
Adjust the Coarse and Fine controls to match the pitch of the audio playback to the
reference pitch.
The Time Shift plug-in has special parameters that let you enter time compression or
expansion values in different formats and edit the pitch shift parameters displayed in the
plug-in window. Time Shift plug-in controls are organized in four parts: Audio, Time,
Formant/Transient, and Pitch.
499
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Audio You use the Audio parameter controls to select the most appropriate time compression
and expansion mode for the type of material you want to process, and to attenuate the
gain of the processed audio to avoid clipping.
Audio parameter controls allow you to select the following Mode settings to determine
the correct time compression and pitch shift algorithms:
• Monophonic — for processing monophonic sounds (such as a vocal melody)
• Polyphonic — for processing complex sounds (such as a multipart musical selection)
• Rhythmic — for processing percussive sounds (such as a mix or drum loop)
• Varispeed — for linking time and pitch change for tape-like pitch and speed change
effects, and postproduction workflows
You can also select the following frequency Range settings:
• Low — for low-range material, such as a bass guitar
• Mid — for mid-range material, such as male vocals
• High — for material with a high fundamental frequency, such as female vocals
• Wide — for more complex material that covers a broad frequency spectrum
n In Polyphonic mode, Wide is the default Range setting and is usually best for all
material. In Monophonic mode, Mid is the default Range setting and usually
matches the range of most monophonic material. Range settings are not available
when you select either Rhythmic mode or Varispeed mode.
The Audio Gain control attenuates the input level to avoid clipping. Adjust the Gain
control from 0.0 dB to –6.0 dB to avoid clipping in the processed signal.
The Clip indicator is active when clipping occurs in the processed signal. If the processed
signal clips, remove the AudioSuite plug-in effect, attenuate the input gain using the Gain
control, and then reapply the plug-in.
The Level indicator displays the level of the output signal, which uses the full range of
plasma-level meter colors.
500
Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Time You use the Time parameter controls to specify the amount of time compression or
expansion you want to apply.
The Original column displays the Start and End times, and Length of the edit selection.
Times are displayed in units of the timebase selected in the Units menu.
The Processed column displays the target End time and Length of the processed signal.
Times are displayed in units of the timebase selected in the Units menu. You can click the
Processed End and Length text boxes to type the desired values. These values update
automatically when you are adjusting the Time control.
The Tempo row displays the Original Tempo and Processed Tempo in beats per minute
(bpm). You can click the Original Tempo and Processed Tempo text boxes to type the
desired values. The Processed Tempo value updates automatically when adjusting the
Time control.
You use the Units menu to select the desired timebase for the Original and Processed time
fields:
• Bars|Beats
• Min:Sec
• Time Code
• Feet+Frames
• Samples
The Shift text box displays the target time compression or expansion as a percentage of
the original. You can adjust the Time control, or click the Shift text box and type the
desired value. Time can be shifted from 25.00% to 400.00% of the original speed (or 4 to
1/4 times the original duration). The default setting is 100.00%, or no time shift.
Selecting 25.00% results in 4 times the original duration and 400.00% results in 1/4 of the
original duration.
n The Shift field displays up to 2 decimal places, but you can type in as many
decimal places as you require (up to the IEEE standard). While the display rounds
to 2 decimal places, the actual time shift is applied based on the number typed in
the Shift text box. This is useful for postproduction pullup and pulldown factors.
501
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Parameter Description
Formant/Transient You use the Formant or Transient parameter controls to adjust either the amount of
formant shift or the transient detection parameters, depending upon which mode you have
selected in the Audio section.
n The Formant parameter is available only when you select Monophonic as the
Audio mode. The Transient section is available with slightly different controls,
depending on whether you select Polyphonic or Rhythmic as the Audio mode.
The Formant section provides a single control for transposing the formants of the selected
audio by –24.00 semitones (–2 octaves) to +24.00 semitones (+2 octaves). You can
specify a Formant value by adjusting the Formant Shift control or typing a value in the
Shift text box.
Transient material tends to change its content quickly in time, as opposed to parts of the
sound which are more sustained. You can use the controls in the Transient section to
adjust the following:
• Threshold — the transient detection threshold in the processed audio when you are
time-stretching; you can set the threshold from 0.0 dB to –40.0 dB (the default is –6.0
dB)
• Window — the analysis window length for processing audio (Polyphonic mode
only); you can set the window length from 6.0 milliseconds (ms) to 185.0 ms (the
default is 18.0 ms) by adjusting the Window control or typing in the Window text box
• Decay Rate — the amount of decay, or audio fade, from a transient that is heard in the
processed audio when you are time-stretching (Rhythmic mode only)
The Follow button enables an envelope follower that simulates the original acoustics of
the audio being stretched (Polyphonic mode only). Click the Follow button to enable or
disable envelope following.
Pitch You use the Pitch parameter controls to shift the pitch of the audio. You can pitch shift
audio by using the Transpose and Shift text boxes:
• Transpose — displays the transposition amount in semitones; you can transpose pitch
from –24.00 semitones (–2 octaves) to +24.00 semitones (+2 octaves)
• Shift — displays the pitch shift amount as a percentage; you can pitch shift from
25.00% (–2 octaves) to +400.00% (+2 octaves)
502
Non-Core AudioSuite Plug-Ins
The supplied non-core AudioSuite plug-ins are briefly described in this topic. The plug-ins
have their own detailed documentation. For more information, see the following Web site:
www.digidesign.com.
The BNR feature of the Digidesign Intelligent Noise Reduction™ (DINR™) plug-in provides
broadband and narrow-band noise reduction for suppressing unwanted elements such as tape
hiss, air-conditioning rumble, and microphone preamplifier noise.
503
Chapter 14 Using AudioSuite Plug-Ins
Focusrite d3
The d3 limiter operates as a fast-attack compressor with a high compression ratio. Like the
compressor, the limiter is activated when the signal exceeds a user-selectable threshold. The
limiter then compresses any signal above the selected threshold to the lower threshold limit
that you have set.
Maxim
The Maxim™ plug-in performs peak limiting and sound maximizing. Maxim takes
advantage of the random-access nature of disk-based recording to anticipate peaks in audio
material and preserve their transient attacks when performing reduction. It helps to preserve
the character of the original audio signal without clipping peaks or introducing distortion.
Digidesign D-Fi
504
Chapter 15
Exporting Frames, Clips, or
Sequences: Advanced
You can export files for use with another system, another application, or another platform.
Your Avid video-based editing system provides tools for exporting clips and sequences in
various formats. The following topics provide advanced information on exporting:
• Exporting Using Send To Templates
• Exporting OMFI and AAF Files
• Exporting Projects and Bins Using AFE Files (Windows Only)
• Exporting Video in DV Stream Format
• Exporting QuickTime Movies
• Exporting As an AVI File (Windows Only)
• Installing or Copying the Avid Codecs for QuickTime on Other Systems
• Exporting from a Third-Party QuickTime or AVI Application
• Exporting as Windows Media (Windows Only)
• Exporting Tracks As Audio Files
• Exporting As a Graphic File
• Exporting Media to XDCAM Devices
For basic information about exporting, see “Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Basics”
in the Help or the Basics Guide for your Avid editing application.
c If a power failure or application error occurs during the export process, the entire file
is unusable. You need to repeat the export process.
505
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
The Send To option provides you with a choice of several pre-defined templates to
streamline your workflow. These templates are set to default parameters, customized for the
specific workflow. In many instances you can choose to automatically launch the application
to which you are sending your clip or sequence.
Avid recommends you use the pre-defined template default settings, which have been
qualified by Avid.
For more details about individual Send To options, see the following topics:
• Send To DigiDelivery
• Send To Digidesign Pro Tools
• Send to DVD Authoring
• Send to DVD One Step
• Send to Sorenson Squeeze
• Send To Avid DS
• Send To Third-Party Applications
n An Avid Studio products Send To submenu might appear in your editing application, but is
applicable only when running an Avid Studio package.
506
Exporting Using Send To Templates
Send To DigiDelivery
You can export a sequence directly to DigiDelivery®, the file-exchange service from Avid
Digidesign®. You must have a DigiDelivery account to deliver your exported sequence. For
information about obtaining an account, go to the Avid DigiDesign web site,
www.digidesign.com, and select Products > DigiDelivery.
Option Description
Avid Video - Embed Audio Select this option to send to a Digidesign Pro Tools® system that supports
playing back Avid video. The Pro Tools system has either an Avid Mojo or a
Digi V10 for video playback.
A video mixdown of the tracks is created at DV 25; the audio is consolidated
and embedded into the AAF file.
QuickTime - Embed Audio Select this option to send to a Digidesign Pro Tools system that supports
QuickTime video only. The system does not have an Avid Mojo or a Digi V10.
A QuickTime movie of video is created; the audio is consolidated and
embedded into the AAF file.
507
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
The Send To dialog box opens with the template you selected.
The Filename text box displays the name of the sequence or clip you chose, and Auto
Launch is selected by default to launch DigiDelivery automatically after you click OK.
If the option you chose involves linking to media, Include Linked Media is also selected
by default.
5. (Option) Change the file name.
6. Click Set to browse to the drive and folder to which you want to export the sequence
locally before you upload it to DigiDelivery.
n Whenever you return to a Send To dialog box, the destination folder that was last set appears
in the destination field.
508
Exporting Using Send To Templates
8. (Option) If you need to make any changes, select the Options button, make any
necessary changes, and click Save.
9. (Option) Do the following if your sequence includes MetaSync tracks:
a. Select Export MetaSync tracks, and then select XML or AAF. If you select XML,
the system performs an AAF export, and then automatically opens MetaSync
Publisher, which produces the XML file.
For more information on MetaSync Publisher, see “Using MetaSync Publisher” in
the Help.
b. (Option) If you want to automatically load the XML files in another application,
choose Auto Launch, and select the application.
10. (Option) If you make any changes to the Send To dialog box, do the following if you
want to save these changes as a new template.
a. Click the Save As Template button.
b. Rename the file. Make sure you leave the .stt extension.
c. Click Save.
The new template is saved. The next time you select a sequence, and choose File >
Send To, the new template appears in the list.
11. Click OK.
The sequence is exported, a QuickTime movie or video mixdown is created, and the
audio is embedded into the AAF file.
DigiDelivery opens. The name in the Delivery Name text box is the same name as that
of your sequence.
You can also transfer files to Pro Tools through Interplay. For more information, see “Using
Pro Tools and Interplay” in Avid Interplay Best Practices.
509
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
Option Description
Avid Video - Embed Audio Select this option to send to a Digidesign Pro Tools system that supports
playing back Avid video. The Pro Tools system has either an Avid Mojo® or a
Digi V10 for video playback.
A video mixdown of the tracks is created at DV 25; the audio is consolidated
and embedded into the AAF file.
QuickTime - Embed Audio Select this option to send to a Digidesign Pro Tools system that supports
QuickTime video only. The system does not have an Avid Mojo or a Digi V10.
A QuickTime movie of video is created; the audio is consolidated and
embedded into the AAF file.
510
Exporting Using Send To Templates
Option Description
Link to Video and Audio Select this option to export AAF metadata only (no media is exported). The
Pro Tools links to, or references, the Avid video and audio files located on the
Avid Unity. The Pro Tools user can copy media during the AAF import into
Pro Tools. This is the fastest export from Avid.
Video Mixdown - Link to Select this option to create a flattened video mixdown of the tracks. The AAF
Audio links to the Avid audio media files located on the Avid Unity. The Pro Tools
user can copy media during the AAF import into Pro Tools.
QuickTime - Link to Audio Select this option to send to a Digidesign Pro Tools system that supports
QuickTime video only. The AAF links to the Avid audio media files located on
the Avid Unity. The Pro Tools user can copy media during the AAF import
into Pro Tools.
The Send To dialog box opens with the template you chose.
The Filename text box displays the name of the sequence or clip you chose.
5. (Option) Change the file name.
6. Click Set to browse to the drive and folder to which you want to export the sequence.
511
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
n Whenever you return to a Send To dialog box, the destination folder that was last set appears
in the destination field.
512
Exporting Using Send To Templates
The Filename text box displays the name of the sequence or clip you chose.
4. (Option) Change the file name.
5. Click Set to browse to the drive and folder to which you want to export the sequence.
n Whenever you return to a Send To dialog box, the destination folder that was last set appears
in the destination field.
513
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
514
Exporting Using Send To Templates
The Send To DVD One Step dialog box opens with a default export template.
The Filename text box displays the name of the sequence or clip you chose.
4. (Option) Change the file name.
5. Click Set to browse to the drive and folder to which you want to export the sequence.
n Whenever you return to a Send To dialog box, the destination folder that was last set appears
in the destination field.
515
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
8. Click OK.
The Burn to DVD dialog box opens.
9. Select the capacity of your DVD medium from the Capacity menu.
c The capacity of your DVD medium must match the size you select from the Capacity
menu.
10. For information about the other options, see the Sonic printed or pdf documentation.
11. Click OK.
Your DVD is burned.
516
Exporting Using Send To Templates
When you send directly to Sorenson Squeeze, a QuickTime Reference template is selected.
1. Make sure the Sorenson Squeeze application is installed on your system.
2. Prepare the sequence, as described in “Preparing to Export a Sequence” in the Help.
3. Select a sequence in a bin.
4. Do one of the following;
t Select File > Send To > Encoding > Sorenson Squeeze.
t Right-click (Windows) or Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh) the clip or sequence in the
bin, and select Send To > Encoding > Sorenson Squeeze.
The Send To dialog box opens with a default template.
The Filename text box displays the name of the sequence or clip you chose.
5. (Option) Change the file name.
6. Click the Options button to select Sorenson Squeeze settings. For more information, see
the Sorenson Squeeze documentation.
7. Click Set to browse to the drive and folder to which you want to export the sequence.
n Whenever you return to a Send To dialog box, the destination folder that was last set appears
in the destination field.
517
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
11. (Option) If you make any changes to the Send To dialog box, do the following if you
want to save these changes as a new template.
a. Click the Save As Template button.
b. Rename the file. Make sure you leave the .stt extension.
c. Click Save.
The new template is saved. The next time you select a sequence, and choose File >
Send To, the new template appears in the list.
12. Click OK.
The QuickTime references movie and optional MetaSync files are exported to the
selected destination.
Send To Avid DS
When you choose to send to Avid DS, the sequence is exported as an AFE file (Windows) or
an AAF file (Macintosh).
518
Exporting Using Send To Templates
The filename displays the name of the sequence or clip you chose.
4. (Option) Change the file name.
5. Click Set to browse to the drive and folder to which you want to export the sequence,
and then click OK.
n Whenever you return to a Send To dialog box, the destination folder that was last set appears
in the destination field.
6. (Option) If you need to make any changes, select the Options button, make any
necessary changes, and then click Save.
519
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
7. (Option) Do the following if you want the Avid DS application to automatically launch
after you export.
a. (Option) Click the Auto Launch button, and select Add Item.
b. (Option) Browse to find the Avid DS application.
c. Click OK Open.
d. Select Auto Load Exported File(s) if you want the files you export to automatically
load in the Avid DS application.
e. Select Reveal file if you want the system to search available drives, open Windows
Explorer or the folder (Macintosh), and highlight related media files.
8. (Option) Do the following if your sequence includes MetaSync tracks:
a. Select Export MetaSync Tracks and then select XML or AAF. If you select XML,
the system performs an AAF export, and then automatically opens MetaSync
Publisher which produces the XML file.
For more information on MetaSync Publisher, see “Using MetaSync Publisher” in
the Help.
b. (Option) If you want to automatically load the XML files in another application,
choose Auto Launch, and select the application.
9. (Option) If you make any changes to the Send To dialog box, do the following if you
want to save these changes as a new template.
a. Click the Save As Template button.
b. Rename the file. Make sure you leave the .stt extension.
c. Click Save.
The new template is saved. The next time you select a sequence, and choose File >
Send To, the new template appears in the list.
10. Click OK to save the AFE file.
The file is exported to the selected destination.
n If you are editing and finishing an offline sequence that will be finished on Avid DS, make
sure to consult the Avid DS Nitris Conform Guide. This guide contains important
information about the most efficient way of preparing a sequence for the conform process.
You can download this guide from the Avid Knowledge Base (www.avid.com/onlinesuppport)
or the Avid DS Support Center (www.softimage.com/avidds).
520
Exporting Using Send To Templates
521
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
n Whenever you return to a Send To dialog box, the destination folder that was last set appears
in the destination field.
522
Exporting OMFI and AAF Files
523
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
Any other program that supports OMFI can read OMFI files, even if the program resides on
a different computer platform. As a result, with OMFI, you can transfer between different
applications on different platforms without worrying about cross-platform translations. This
can be very effective for importing animation or audio files created on proprietary platforms.
c To avoid errors and incompatibilities when you import and export OMFI files, observe
the recommendations in “File Format Specifications” on page 735.
n When you export sequences with effects through AAF, certain effect types are not exported to
the AAF file. When you check compositions into an asset manager through AAF, all effects
are exported. For export to Avid DS, use AFE files. See “Exporting Projects and Bins Using
AFE Files (Windows Only)” on page 529.
Avid editing applications can export an OMFI or an AAF file that contains only the editing
information about a selected master clip or sequence. The file also contains links to the
media used in the clip or sequence. You then need to transfer the OMFI or AAF file to the
other system, and either transfer the media files or recapture the media. After you have
transferred or recaptured the media, you can transfer revised composition-only files.
However, if you consolidate the media, you must transport the consolidated media files, as
well. You can consolidate media during the export, see “Exporting As an OMFI or an AAF
File” on page 525, or before the export. See “Consolidating Media” in the Help.
524
Exporting OMFI and AAF Files
Avid editing applications can export an OMFI or an AAF file that contains all the editing
information for the selected master clip or sequence along with the video and audio media
files for that master clip or sequence. See “Exporting As an OMFI or an AAF File” on
page 525.
n You cannot export OMFI files that are larger than 2 GB. If you exceed this limit, an error
message is displayed. For information on exporting large sequences, see “Preparing to
Export a Sequence” in the Help.
n When you export sequences with effects through AAF, certain effect types are not exported to
the AAF file. When you check compositions into an asset manager through AAF, all effects
are exported. For export to Avid DS, use AFE files. See “Exporting Projects and Bins Using
AFE Files (Windows Only)” on page 529.
6. Click the Export As menu, and select OMF 1.0, OMF 2.0, or AAF.
525
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
7. Select other options as described in “Export Settings: OMFI, AAF, and AFE” on
page 669.
n For additional guidelines on suitable export options for AAF export to Pro Tools, see
“Guidelines for Exporting AAF Files to Pro Tools” on page 527.
c If a power failure or application error occurs during the export process, the entire file
is unusable. You need to repeat the export process.
526
Exporting OMFI and AAF Files
Several of the options you can select in the Export Settings dialog box have particular
significance for exports to Pro Tools, so you need to select your options with care. The
following table provides information on these settings. (For complete information on all the
options available in the Export Settings dialog box for AAF export, see “Export Settings:
OMFI, AAF, and AFE” on page 669.)
Setting Guidelines
Media Destinations • Using the Folder option with “Use Same Folder as AAF File” is very convenient for
(Video Details and moving files back and forth between the Avid editing application and Pro Tools.
Audio Details tabs)
If you select Folder and then check “Use Same Folder as AAF File,” your Avid
editing application stores the media in the same folder as the exported AAF files (the
folder that you select in the Export As dialog box when your start the export
operation). For example, you can easily store both the AAF files and the media in a
single folder on a Firewire drive that you can move between the editing application
system and the Pro Tools system.
You can also select Consolidate Media from the Export Method menu to copy
consolidated media instead of all media.
• The Embedded in AAF option is not generally useful for export to Pro Tools because
Pro Tools does not support embedded video media in AAF files.
527
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
Setting Guidelines
Export Method: Video • The Mixdown with Video Edits option is only compatible with Pro Tools v7.2 or
Mixdown later, and takes advantage of the fact that Pro Tools v7.2 or later can display multiple
(Video Details tab) video tracks. This allows you to add a video track that shows the video edits. This
can be very useful to the Pro Tools editors because it allows them to view the edit
points between the various video clips without actually importing the individual
video files into Pro Tools.
The system creates the following tracks as part of the export:
- Video tracks that represent each track and edit in the original sequence
- A “render track” that contains the single video mixdown track
The system stores the metadata for the video mixdown “render track” within the
AAF file. The render track points to the actual mixed-down video media file. If you
open the exported sequence in an Avid editing application, you do not see the video
mixdown track. However, when you import the file into Pro Tools v7.2 or later, Pro
Tools imports the video mixdown track as a separate video track. Pro Tools
composites the edit points from all of the original Avid video tracks into a single
track.
Pro Tools displays the video edit track as well as the video mixdown (render) track.
This allows the Pro Tools editor to view the video edits. One benefit to this method
is that you only bring the video mixdown into Pro Tools. The clips in the edit tracks
do not reference any media. They simply match up with the video mixdown.
• The Mixdown without Video Edits option is compatible with all versions of Pro
Tools, and is the only option suitable for versions of Pro Tools earlier than v7.2. This
option replaces all of the video tracks with a single video track named Video
Mixdown in the Track Panel.
528
Exporting Projects and Bins Using AFE Files (Windows Only)
n You can import an AFE file into Avid DS v6.0 or later only.
AFE files are based on AAF (Advanced Authoring Format) technology. AFE files, however,
are especially designed for sharing project information among Avid applications. AFE files
let you transfer one or more bins, their contents, and information about the contents,
including master clips, subclips, titles, and sequences.
529
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
n The DV Stream format appears after you have installed QuickTime. If you want to use the
QuickTime application for exporting sequences, download the latest version of QuickTime
from the Apple® Web site at: www.apple.com/.
530
Exporting Video in DV Stream Format
9. Select the DV format, video format, and audio format options you want.
n If you select DV as the DV format, you can choose to provide locked or unlocked audio. For
compatibility with DV cameras that require unlocked audio, deselect Locked.
If you select DVCPRO as the DV format, audio is always locked and the Locked option is
grayed out. Also, the audio rate is always 48 kHz and the Audio Rate menu is grayed out.
531
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
c If a power failure or application error occurs during the export process, the entire file
is unusable. You need to repeat the export process.
532
Exporting QuickTime Movies
Option Description
Same as Source This option is available when you select QuickTime Movie from the Export
Settings dialog box. When you select this option, your Avid editing
application copies the media files directly with no resolution change. This
method is fast and creates output that uses the same quality as your source
files. Selecting Same as Source is the best method to use if you plan to process
the video on another system, using a third-party application. See “Exporting
As a QuickTime Movie” on page 534.
Custom This option is also available when you select QuickTime Movie from the
Export Settings dialog box. When you select this option, your Avid editing
application decompresses the files, processes them, and compresses the files at
the requested resolution. This method is slower and often loses quality. In
general, you should only use the Custom option if you have to directly export
a clip or sequence in a particular file format. See “Exporting As a QuickTime
Movie” on page 534.
The Custom format is useful if you plan to export to an older ABVB or
NuVista system.
QuickTime Reference QuickTime Reference is available from the Export As menu in the Export
Settings dialog box. This option is similar to Same as Source, but your Avid
editing application links to the original media files. This is the fastest method
of export, but the movie can only be run or processed on your local system or
in an Avid Unity workgroup environment. If you want to transfer a QuickTime
movie to another system, you must also move the associated media files by
creating a self-contained QuickTime movie. See “Exporting As a QuickTime
Reference Movie” on page 536.
533
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
534
Exporting QuickTime Movies
n If you installed additional QuickTime Export formats, they appear in the menu with tildes (~)
before their names. This indicates they have not been qualified and are not supported by
Avid.
7. Select the Same as Source option to use the resolution of the source file or select the
Custom option to customize your settings.
n Using Same as Source results in the fastest export and is usually the best selection for a
movie that will be processed by another application. See “Exporting QuickTime Movies” on
page 533.
8. Select the remaining options as described in “Export Settings: QuickTime Movie Export
Options” on page 662.
To change the codec (compressor/decompressor) used for compression, click the Format
Options button. For a description of the options, see “Export Settings: QuickTime
Movie Settings” on page 664.
535
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
c If a power failure or application error occurs during the export process, the entire file
is unusable. You need to repeat the export process.
QuickTime reference movies are useful as long as you are working with Avid media files
available on your local system or in an Avid Unity workgroup. Advantages are speed and
small file size because the system does not copy the source media files into the exported
QuickTime file. However, if you expect to move the exported QuickTime file to a system
that doesn't have access to the media, then you should use the standard QuickTime export so
the media files and QuickTime wrapper can be moved as one file.
536
Exporting QuickTime Movies
537
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
c If a power failure or application error occurs during the export process, the entire file
is unusable. You need to repeat the export process.
The Avid codecs create encapsulated media files for export of high-resolution files that are
readable within QuickTime applications. The Avid codec you use to export the file must be
loaded on the system running the QuickTime application for the application to read the
exported file. See “Installing or Copying the Avid Codecs for QuickTime on Other Systems”
on page 543.
n You get the best results by using the Same as Source option. See “Exporting As a QuickTime
Movie” on page 534.
538
Exporting QuickTime Movies
539
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
12. Select the settings that you want, and click OK.
For Color Levels or Color Input, select the color levels of the source media. If you are
exporting from an Avid editing system, use ITU-R 601 (SD) or 709 (HD).
13. Click OK in the Compression Settings dialog box.
14. Click OK in the Movie Settings dialog box.
The Export Settings dialog box reopens.
15. Do one of the following:
t To save your settings in the existing settings file, click Save.
t To create a new settings file, click Save As.
The Save Export Setting dialog box opens. Name the setting by typing a name in the
Setting Name text box, and click OK.
16. In the Export As dialog box, select the destination folder for the file.
17. (Option) Change the file name.
In most cases, keep the file name extension the same.
540
Exporting As an AVI File (Windows Only)
c If a power failure or application error occurs during the export process, the entire file
is unusable. You need to repeat the export process.
541
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
542
Installing or Copying the Avid Codecs for QuickTime on Other Systems
c If a power failure or application error occurs during the export process, the entire file
is unusable. You need to repeat the export process.
You can either install the Avid Codecs directly from the Avid editing application CD-ROM
or copy them from one system to another.
To install the Avid QuickTime Codecs from the application CD-ROM on a system
without an Avid editor:
1. Insert the Avid application CD-ROM.
2. Click Install Products.
3. Click Install Avid QuickTime Codecs.
4. Follow the instructions in the installation program.
The Avid QuickTime Codecs install on your system.
543
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
To copy the Avid QuickTime Codecs from one system to another system:
1. On your Avid system, open one of the following folders:
(Windows) drive:\Program Files\QuickTime\QTComponents
(Windows) drive:\Windows\System32
(Macintosh) MacintoshHD/Library/QuickTime
2. Copy the codecs you need to a removable device or network server.
The following table describes the codecs:
3. On the other system, copy the files to one of the following folders:
(Windows) drive:\Program Files\QuickTime\QTComponents
(Windows) drive:\Windows\System32
(Macintosh) MacintoshHD/Library/QuickTime
n Once the Avid Codecs for QuickTime are installed on the system, you can export files from
the QuickTime compatible application for reimport into the Avid editing system.
544
Exporting from a Third-Party QuickTime or AVI Application
n If you select a nonstandard frame size, your Avid system does not import the file quickly.
545
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
n A .prx file is basically a saved template. You can create and save .prx files to share with
others.
547
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
3. Click Options.
The Export Settings dialog box opens.
Add Button
549
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
550
Exporting as Windows Media (Windows Only)
3. Click Options.
The Export Settings dialog box opens.
551
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
552
Exporting Tracks As Audio Files
7. Select the options you require. Use the “Export Settings: Audio” on page 680 to make
your selections.
8. Do one of the following:
t To save your settings in the existing settings file, click Save.
t To create a new settings file, click Save As.
The Save Export Setting dialog box opens.
Name the setting by typing a name in the Setting Name text box, and click OK.
9. In the Export As dialog box, select the destination folder for the file.
10. (Option) Change the file name.
In most cases, keep the file name extension the same.
11. Click Save.
The file is exported to the selected destination.
c If a power failure or application error occurs during the export process, the entire file
is unusable. You need to repeat the export process.
553
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
554
Exporting As a Graphic File
6. Click the Graphic Format menu, and select a format. Use “Export Settings: Graphic
Format” on page 682 to make your selection.
7. Select other options as appropriate. Use “Export Settings: Graphic” on page 681 to
make your selection.
8. Do one of the following:
t To save your settings in the existing settings file, click Save.
t To create a new settings file, click Save As.
The Save Export Setting dialog box opens.
Name the setting by typing a name in the Setting Name text box, and click OK.
9. In the Export As dialog box, select the destination folder for the file.
555
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
When you are working with the Format Options settings, you can click Defaults to return the
settings to their default values.
c If a power failure or application error occurs during the export process, the entire file
is unusable. You need to repeat the export process.
You can export a clip, subclip, or sequence. You cannot export titles, effects, group clips, or
rendered effects. The export mixes down the sequence and creates an XDCAM clip. All
clips are given a new sequential name of Cxxxx.mxf, for example, C0019.mxf. This
sequential file name system is created by the Sony deck. If you want to change the file name,
your Sony deck needs Sony’s firmware version 1.5 or higher.
For information on connecting your XDCAM device, see “Connecting the XDCAM
Device” in the Help.
The following table lists the formats and resolutions you can export to the XDCAM device:
XDCAM Resolutions
DVCAM: 2
DV 25 411 (NTSC and PAL)
DV 25 420 (PAL)
556
Exporting Media to XDCAM Devices
Exporting to XDCAM
You can export NTSC and PAL projects. Depending on the format (SD or HD), you need to
use the appropriate XDCAM device (if you export SD media, use an XDCAM SD device; if
you export HD media, you must use an XDCAM HD device).
n You can also right-click the clip or sequence in a bin and select Export to Device.
557
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
558
Exporting Media to XDCAM Devices
559
Chapter 15 Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced
560
Chapter 16
Generating Output: Advanced
Your Avid editing application provides tools for generating output for individual tracks or
entire sequences to various videotape or audiotape formats. You can also generate an edit
decision list (EDL) for use in an online suite and a cut list for creating film negatives.
For basic information about output, see “Generating Output: Basics” in the Help or in the
Basics Guide for your Avid editing application.
c You cannot set separate calibration levels for S-Video output, Composite output, and
Component output. When calibrating video output, select one video output for
calibration. The two other outputs are not guaranteed to be properly calibrated. If you
need to send output to more than one SD device, Avid recommends that you use one
analog output (Composite, Component, or S-Video) and one digital output (SDI).
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
This advanced form of calibration is an alternative to Video Input tool Calibration settings
for each source tape, and involves calibrating tapes at the source device, using external time-
base correction. You need a signal generator and external Waveform and Vectorscope
monitors to calibrate the system with passthrough.
562
Advanced Video Output Calibration
n You can precisely match only one output format at a time in phase with the reference signal.
In most cases, you should select either Composite or Serial Digital.
9. Calibrate any of the available controls in the Video Output tool while checking the
external Waveform and Vectorscope monitors. For example, composite output provides
Gain and Saturation controls.
n For more information on using the Video Output tool, see “Preparing for Output” in the
Help.
10. In the Video Output tool, click the Test Patterns menu, and select a test pattern.
The test pattern appears and is sent to the output channels (the input signal is no longer
passed through). Additional controls are enabled in the Video Output tool for phase
control.
11. Make any necessary adjustments to H phase, SC phase, and Hue by using the sliders in
the Video Output tool while checking the external Waveform and Vectorscope monitors.
n Whenever the Capture tool is active, hue, horizontal phase (H phase), and subcarrier phase
(SC phase) are set to values determined by the input circuitry and are not available to
control the outputs. These controls appear dimmed during passthrough.
The Video Output setting, a Site setting, applies to all users and all projects on the system.
The Video Input setting you saved and named Default is recalled each time a new tape is
loaded for capturing in the current project only.
563
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
The output mode menu in the Digital Cut tool displays the relevant resolution options,
depending on your project type and the output device. The connected output device is
displayed in the Digital Cut tool.
Connected
Output Device
n There are restrictions for progressive formats. See “Output Mode Resolutions with
Progressive Projects” on page 566.
564
Using the Digital Cut Tool: Advanced
30i and 25i, or Adrenaline, RT DNA (8-bit or 10-bit) With RT DNA selected, you can output
25p SD Project Mojo, RT DV 25 (8-bit or 10-bit) through the following connectors:
Mojo SDI DV 25 Composite, S-Video, Component, SDI, or
DNA-1394.
With RT DNA selected, output is 1:1
uncompressed.
With RT DV 25 selected, full real-time
effects playback is supported.
With DV 25 selected, real-time effects
playback is not supported. All media must
be DV 25.
30i, 25i, or 25p Separate RT DV 25 (8-bit or 10-bit) With DV 50 selected, real-time effects
SD Project IEEE 1394 RT DV 50 (8-bit or 10-bit) playback is not supported. All media must
board or DV 25 be DV 50.
Mojo SDI DV 50
n Performing a digital cut to a serial-controlled deck might not be frame-accurate if the output
resolution is set to RT DV 25 or DV 25. When performing a digital cut to a serial-controlled
deck, set the output resolution to RT DNA and make sure your output device is connected to
a connection other than 1394 (for example, SDI or Composite).
565
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
The availability of the Output Mode resolutions for progressive projects depends on the
Output Format play rate in the Digital Cut tool.
The following table describes the Output Mode resolutions for progressive projects.
n Performing a digital cut to a serial-controlled deck might not be frame-accurate if the output
resolution is set to RT DV25 or DV25. When performing a digital cut to a serial-controlled
deck, set the output resolution to RT DNA and make sure your output device is attached to a
connection other than 1394 (for example, SDI or Composite).
566
Using the Digital Cut Tool: Advanced
t Click the DNA/1394 button above the Timeline to display the 1394 label.
t Select Special > Device > IEEE 1394.
The 1394 icon displays above the Timeline, and a check mark appears next to IEEE
1394 in the Device menu.
4. Select Output > Digital Cut.
The Digital Cut tool opens.
5. Select other Digital Cut options.
For more information, see “Using the Digital Cut Tool” in the Help.
6. Perform the digital cut.
567
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
Selecting Output and Timecode Formats for 23.976p, 24p, and 25p
Projects
When you are working in a 23.976p, 24p, or 25p project, you can output multiple formats
from the same progressive media. You click the Output Format menu in the Digital Cut tool
to select the formats you want, as described in “Selecting Output Formats for 23.976p, 24p,
and 25p Projects” on page 568.
Output Format
menu
568
Using the Digital Cut Tool: Advanced
A brief description of each output format is displayed in the Digital Cut tool. “23.976p, 24p,
and 25p Project Output Options” on page 569 provides more extensive descriptions.
The play rate you select determines how the digital cut is recorded. For example, if you
select 23.976, you tell your Avid editing application to slow down the play rate to match the
play rate used during an NTSC telecine transfer. When your application records the digital
cut, it adds the pulldown frames and re-creates a telecine transfer to an NTSC videotape.
For NTSC output, your Avid editing application automatically sets the pulldown if necessary
and turns on an indicator on the Avid Adrenaline.
Digital Cut
Tool Output Pulldown
Format (Play Indicator on Output Format and
Rate) Target Project or System Adrenaline Recording Media
23.976 (NTSC) NTSC TV; video screenings; On (0.99) Picture and sound to NTSC tape;
digital audio workstations sound to video-referenced
(DAWs) that support pulldown audiotape
24 (NTSC) Audio for film projection; Off (1.00) Picture and sound to NTSC tape;
DAWs (video for sound to DAT or mag tape
reference only)
29.97 (NTSC) Animation projects; negative On (0.99) Picture and sound to NTSC tape
cutting with lockbox; some (sound for reference only)
kinescope printing
24 (PAL) Audio for film projection; Off (1.00) Picture and sound to PAL tape;
DAWs (video for sound to DAT or mag tape
reference only)
25 (PAL) PAL TV; video screenings Off (1.00) Picture and sound to PAL tape;
sound to DAT or mag tape
569
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
The following information describes what happens when you select each of these options:
• 23.976 (NTSC): Plays back the sequence at 23.976 fps (film rate). This play rate tells
the Avid system to replicate a telecine transfer with perfect 2:3 pulldown. The system
adds frames and slows the playback speed to create a digital cut to 29.97 fps. Use this
option for NTSC video output, such as broadcast masters.
• 24 (NTSC): Plays back the sequence at 24 fps (film rate). This play rate tells the system
to record audio at the film rate. If the system records video, it maintains sync by adding
pulldown fields and dropping every 1000th frame. This video should be used for
reference only. Use this setting for direct audio output to be used in sync with film
projection. Also use this setting when audio media files are being used in a digital audio
workstation (DAW) and you need a digital cut for picture reference.
Before you output the digital cut, make sure you select the correct destination timecode
rate. See “Indicating the Destination Timecode Rate” on page 573.
• 29.97 (NTSC): Plays back the sequence at 29.97 fps. This play rate tells the system to
speed up the playback speed without adding pulldown fields. As a result, the sequence
plays faster (25 percent faster for 24p, 20 percent faster for 25p). Use this option for
animations and tape-to-film transfers where the pulldown needs to be removed to have
an exact frame-to-frame relationship between the film and video.
• 24 (PAL): Plays back the sequence at 24 fps. This play rate tells the system to record
audio at the film rate. For 25p projects, audio is slowed down 4 percent. Video, when
output to tape, can be used only for reference because, to maintain sync, the system
replicates a pulldown telecine transfer with one extra pulldown field occurring every
12th and 24th frame. Use this option when audio media files are being used for film
projection (PAL Method 2) or in a DAW, and you need a digital cut for picture
reference.
• 25 (PAL): Plays back the sequence at 25 fps. For 24p projects, this play rate tells the
system to speed up the sequence by 4.1 percent, creating a frame-to-frame relationship
between film and video (PAL Method 1). For 25p projects, there is no change in
playback speed. There are no pulldown frames with this setting. Use this option for PAL
video output, such as a broadcast master.
570
Using the Digital Cut Tool: Advanced
If you are working in a 24p or 25p project, changes in audio rates are as described in the
following table:
Output Play Rate 24p NTSC Source 24p PAL Source 25p Source
24 NTSC No change — —
If you are working in a 23.976 project, all output play rates are available, but only
23.976 NTSC maintains the original audio quality. For 23.976 NTSC, the audio rate is not
slowed down for output and remains at 48 kHz. For 29.97 NTSC, the audio rate is sped up
25 percent and is not usable. Use this output rate for animations and other special
applications. 24 fps NTSC requires a sample-rate conversion, so high-quality audio is not
guaranteed.
The following table summarizes the change in audio rates for 23.976p output options.
If you select one of the three NTSC output formats, you need to indicate the timecode format
for output: drop-frame or non-drop-frame.
You can designate drop-frame or non-drop-frame timecode for devices connected to one or
both of the following outputs:
• RS422 Output (serial port on the computer)
• LTC (LTC OUT on the Avid Adrenaline hardware)
571
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
n To output LTC timecode, you need to select the option “Generate LTC on Playback” in the
General Settings dialog box. For more information, see “Using LTC Timecode for Output”
in the Help.
By default, the menus display the timecode format of the sequence you loaded into the
Timeline.
n Your Avid editing application can generate LTC at 29.97 fps only. See “Indicating the
Destination Timecode Rate” on page 573.
You can output drop-frame and non-drop-frame NTSC timecode simultaneously from a
23.976, 24p, or 25p project. A broadcast production company might need to output drop-
frame timecode for a broadcast master while outputting non-drop-frame timecode to track
NTSC film pulldown.
Tracking the pulldown is important because some networks require the 2:3 pulldown phase
to be inserted in the VITC (vertical interval timecode). Inserting the pulldown phase enables
downstream encoding of various compression formats (like MPEG-2) to be faster and of
higher quality.
n For information about 2:3 pulldown, see “Transferring 24-fps Film to NTSC Video” on
page 808.
When you select 24 (NTSC) as your output format, the Destination Timecode Rate menu
(labeled Dest. TC Rate) opens. Select a timecode rate that matches the timecode rate of the
recording device, such as a DAT deck.
If you select 29.97 fps as your Dest. TC Rate, the sequence duration displayed in the
Timecode Duration display of the Digital Cut tool is slightly shorter than the duration shown
in the Timeline. This shorter duration occurs because the video play rate is sped up in
comparison with the audio timecode rate. If you select 30.00 fps, the sequence duration in
the Digital Cut tool matches the sequence duration in the Timeline.
The value you select (29.97 or 30.00) also sets the rate for LTC output, if any, without
changing the play rate of the media being output (24 NTSC).
n Your Avid editing application can generate LTC at 29.97 fps only. No LTC will be output if
you select 30.00.
573
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
n You cannot control some analog audio decks from the Digital Cut tool. If the deck does not
have a serial control port, you need to select Local when you record the digital cut.
Your output choice in the Digital Cut tool automatically sets the pulldown switch).
If you perform an audio-only digital cut, your Avid editing application plays the video tracks
in the Client monitor to ensure the most accurate audio sync. A message appears at the
bottom of the Digital Cut tool.
Information on connecting decks and cabling varies depending on the Avid DNA device you
use. See the appropriate “Connecting Peripheral Equipment” topic for your Avid DNA
device in the Help, within the “Using the Avid Adrenaline,” “Using the Avid Mojo,” or
“Using the Avid Mojo SDI” sections.
574
Using the Digital Cut Tool: Advanced
n If your sequence contains audio clips with different sample rates, use the Change Sample
Rate dialog box to ensure that all the clips have the same sample rate. For more information,
see “Changing the Sample Rate for Sequences and Audio Clips” in the Help.
For example, if one cut ends on an A frame, before performing the digital cut of the next
sequence, change the pullin for the next sequence to the B frame. You can determine the
frame that ends a sequence by checking the Pullout column in the bin that holds the
sequence.
Now you can perform a digital cut to append the new sequence.
575
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
Before setting this delay, you should perform several digital cuts to determine the frame-
accuracy behavior of the recording device. Begin with the DV digital cut delay set to 0
frames. If the digital cut frame accuracy of the device is inconsistent, the results of using the
delay are also inconsistent. If the sequence is missing frames at the beginning of the digital
cut on the tape, increase the delay. If the first frame of the sequence is repeated, decrease the
DV digital cut delay. The starting frame of the sequence should change according to your
delay.
For example, suppose the DV digital cut delay is set to 0 frames. The digital cut is expected
to begin with the first frame of the sequence being recorded on the IN point designated on
the tape. In this example, the IN point is set to frame number 6. This is where the recording
would begin on the tape. However, due to the behavior of the particular DV device, the
digital cut does not perform as expected. The first frame of the sequence recorded on the
tape is actually the fourth frame, as shown in the following figure.
576
Using the Digital Cut Tool: Advanced
Sequence frames
Tape frames
Tape IN point
Sequence frames
Tape frames
Tape IN point
577
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
4. Determine the approximate delay and type the delay in the Digital Cut Delay (frames)
text box.
5. Click OK.
6. Perform a digital cut.
See “Using the Digital Cut Tool” in the HelpUsing the Digital Cut Tool.
7. Repeat this process until you achieve the appropriate delay.
Your Avid editing application includes EDL Manager, an application with powerful features
and sorting capabilities to help you prepare an EDL.
For more information on specific features and capabilities of EDL Manager, see the EDL
Manager Help.
n Your system might not include the Matchback option. To purchase the Matchback option,
contact your Avid sales representative.
578
Using the Matchback Option
If you plan to use matchback, you must select the Matchback option when you first create
the project. See “Creating a New Project” in the Help.
n Editors working in a film matchback project for the first time should pay extra attention to
duplicate material in the final edited piece. Use Dupe Detection in the Timeline and verify
any dupes flagged when delivering a cut negative. For information on dupe detection, see
“Detecting Duplicate Frames” on page 374.
Because of the difference in frame rates between video and film (30 fps or 25 fps for video
versus 24 fps for film), the conversion of video edit points might fall within a film frame,
requiring the addition or subtraction of a frame in that edit event in the resulting cut list.
For example, with a ratio of 24 film frames to 30 video frames, a 7-frame video edit
corresponds to approximately 5.6 film frames. However, film cuts cannot include partial
frames, so the edit must be rounded to 5 or 6 frames.
NTSC
Shot X Shot Y Shot Z
video
.................................................................................................................................
Film
.................................................................................................................................
579
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
Matchback Limitations
Matchback is subject to the following limitations:
• The Matchback option uses key numbers to conform the negative, so you must have
key-number information entered into the bins for the project.
• You can generate cut lists but not change lists in a matchback project.
• The matchback information applies to the picture only. You must generate a separate list
(an EDL, for instance) for conforming the audio source tapes.
• Be sure to remove unwanted match frames (add edits) from your sequence before
generating the cut list. Otherwise, the calculation of matchback frames will include
these edits. For information about removing match-frame edits, see “Removing Match-
Frame Edits” on page 374.
Using FilmScribe
The FilmScribe application provides tools for creating frame-accurate cut lists and change
lists from 23.976p, 24p, 25p, and matchback projects. You can use these lists to conform a
work print, a film negative, audio tracks, or videotape transfers.
To start FilmScribe:
t Select Output > FilmScribe.
For information on how to use FilmScribe, see the Avid FilmScribe User’s Guide or the
FilmScribe Help.
n Your system might not include the FilmScribe application. To purchase FilmScribe, contact
your Avid sales representative.
580
Preserving Information in the Vertical Blanking Interval
c You can preserve VBI information for JFIF, uncompressed, and MPEG IMX
resolutions. You cannot preserve VBI information for DV resolutions.
n In the majority of cases, you should not preserve these extra lines when you perform a
digital cut. Only do so if you have a special need for the information.
Line Ranges
Your Avid editing application is capable of capturing 248 lines per field in NTSC or 296
lines per field in PAL. For NTSC, only 243 of these lines are in RP-187’s production
aperture. For PAL, the number is 288. The additional lines in each field are located
immediately above the active part of each of the two fields. These lines (5 per field in NTSC
and 8 per field in PAL) can be used for carrying additional data.
The following table lists the extra vertical blanking lines for both NTSC and PAL:
581
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
n Your Avid editing application does not interpret the vertical blanking information (i.e.,
encoded data). It treats the coded values simply as pixels in the video frame. If you want to
read the vertical blanking information during editing, you must connect an external vertical
blanking information reader to the Avid system.
To display VBI information and preserve VBI information for a digital cut:
1. Select Tools > Video Output Tool.
The Video Output tool opens.
VBI menu
n If you select Blank, your Avid editing application fills the vertical blanking interval with
video black (R=G=B=16).
582
Preserving Information in the Vertical Blanking Interval
Any VBI information that is present in your clips or sequences will now be displayed. If you
perform a digital cut, any VBI information that is in your sequence will be output.
c The VBI value resets to Blank each time you launch the application. If you want to
preserve VBI information on output, set the value before you perform a digital cut.
Your Avid editing application uses the following rules when applying effects to material
containing VBI information:
• Single track effects do not alter the VBI information. For example, if you apply a color
correction effect to the sequence, the VBI lines are not affected.
• Multi-track effects such as picture-in-picture effects or 3D Warp effects use the VBI
information of the track on the lowest layer. (Swap sources is ignored in the VBI area).
n If you apply a multi-track effect such as a 3D Warp effect to a sequence with a single track,
the VBI information will not be visible. One way to work around this problem is to create a
second video track and duplicate that portion of the sequence on the second track. Then
apply the 3D Warp effect to the top track. The VBI information will display on the bottom
track.
n You cannot add or remove VBI information from a sequence. However, you can use the
Blank option to turn off the VBI display for the entire sequence.
n You cannot preserve VBI information for DV resolutions. You can only preserve VBI
information for JFIF, uncompressed, and MPEG IMX resolutions.
583
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
Your Avid editing application performs the following operations when capturing a frame:
1. It captures the entire frame (including the 5 or 8 extra lines per field) as an
uncompressed frame.
2. It compresses the frame if compression is selected.
If you want to preserve vertical blanking information, either use the 1:1 (uncompressed)
resolution or experiment with different compression ratios to make sure the captured footage
or the vertical blanking information is not unacceptably affected by the compression.
584
Preserving Information in the Vertical Blanking Interval
When does the system give you the opportunity to During capture and during a During playback and
blank VBI information? digital cut during a digital cut
n In order to view VBI on a Meridien system you must disable the 3D hardware.
What dialog box or tool do you use to set VBI General Settings dialog box Video Output tool
blanking?
Is VBI information preserved when you apply Not always Yes (see “Editing a
n
effects? Sequence with VBI
For example, a color
Information” on
effect can modify the
page 583.)
VBI information on a
Meridien system.
For details on how Meridien systems support VBI, see the white paper entitled Preserving
Information in the Vertical Blanking Interval on the Avid Knowledge Base.
585
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
These packets are transferred in the HD-SDI data stream, unlike SD closed captioning,
which is transferred in the VBI (vertical blanking interval).
This console command is persistent: it remains active until you disable it by entering the
command again.
c HD ancillary data is preserved only when playing a clip or sequence at full quality, and
in cuts-only sequences. Other actions will make the ancillary data unusable and
prevent it from being preserved.
The following tasks prevent the ancillary data from being preserved:
• Playing back clips in draft quality or best performance quality.
• Adding or rendering effects.
• Transcoding media.
• Downconverting HD media (SD downconverts do not preserve closed captioning).
• Cross-converting HD media.
• Outputting through the DVI port of the Adrenaline. Output must be through the HD-SDI
port.
586
Preserving HD Closed Captioning and Ancillary Data
You can play HD media that contains ancillary data in the following applications:
• Media Composer Adrenaline v2.2.2 or later
• NewsCutter Adrenaline and NewsCutter XP v6.2.2 or later
• Avid Xpress Pro v5.2.2 or later
• Symphony Nitris v1.0.1 or later
c Earlier versions of these applications cannot play HD media that contains ancillary
data. The application displays an error message if you try to play this media.
Although you can play clips in these applications, ancillary data is preserved on output only
through the HD-SDI port of the Adrenaline hardware connected to a system running Media
Composer 2.5 or later.
587
Chapter 16 Generating Output: Advanced
588
Chapter 17
MultiCamera Editing
The Avid MultiCamera editing features allow you to incorporate multiple camera angle
sources into the nonlinear editing process. Techniques for using these features are described
in the following topics:
• Understanding Grouping and Multigrouping Clips
• Creating Group Clips
• Creating Multigroup Clips
• MultiCamera Displays
• MultiCamera Editing Techniques
• Selective Camera Cutting
• The MultiGroup function is designed primarily for situation comedies and similar
productions that record multiple takes sequentially on the same source tapes.
Multigrouping does not provide any benefit when you edit with clips that do not share
common timecode or were not recorded sequentially, and might even cause the wrong
clips to be grouped together.
• Because the Group function allows you to sync the clips based on customized IN points
or OUT points, you can group any collection of clips for quick cutting of montage
sequences or music-video sequences.
The last two options are generally used in smaller multicamera projects. Sorting, marking,
selecting, and grouping individual takes of a larger project can be very time-consuming.
590
Creating Group Clips
n For multicamera video or film shoots, you typically use a slate for marking IN and OUT
points; however, you can use any visual or aural event that is recorded by all cameras
simultaneously.
Option Description
Film TC/Sound TC Use this option if you are syncing clips with
matching film and sound timecode recorded in the
field. This option appears dimmed if you are not
working in a 24p or 25p project.
Source Timecode Use this option if the clips have matching timecode.
Auxiliary TC1–TC5 Use this option if the clips have matching timecode
in the same Auxiliary Timecode column. Select an
Auxiliary TC, 1 through 5, from the menu.
INK Number Use this option if the clips have matching ink
numbers. This option appears only with 24p and 25p
projects.
Auxiliary Ink Use this option if the clips have matching ink
numbers in the same Auxiliary Ink column. This
option appears only with 24p and 25p projects.
591
Chapter 17 MultiCamera Editing
5. Click OK.
A group clip appears in the bin, with the name of the first clip in the group, followed by
the file name extension Grp.n.
The n is the incremental number of group clips with the same name in the same bin. You
might want to rename them for easier reading, such as name.Group.
Option Description
Film TC/Sound TC Use this option if you are syncing clips with
matching film and sound timecode recorded in the
field. This option appears dimmed if you are not
working in a 24p or 25p project.
Source Timecode Use this option if the clips have matching timecode.
Auxiliary TC1–TC5 Use this option if the clips have matching timecode
in the same Auxiliary Timecode column. Select an
Auxiliary TC, 1 through 5, from the menu.
INK Number Use this option if the clips have matching ink
numbers. This option appears only with 24p and 25p
projects.
592
MultiCamera Displays
Option Description
Auxiliary Ink Use this option if the clips have matching ink
numbers in the same Auxiliary Ink column. This
option appears only with 24p and 25p projects.
5. Click OK.
Your Avid editing application creates several group clips for each take in the bin, and
then creates a multigroup clip from the groups. The multigroup clip has the same icon as
the group clips, but the icon is preceded by a plus sign.
MultiCamera Displays
There are several displays that allow you to view and edit with multiple camera angles. You
can edit with either group clips or multigroup clips in all of the displays.
• Full-Monitor Display—The Source monitor displays a single frame from one clip in
the group clip. You can view each angle in full-monitor size as you edit. Editing with
this display is similar to editing in Source/Record mode.
• Quad Split Source View—This display allows you to view four different camera angles
of a group clip in the Source monitor. The Quad Split button switches the Source
monitor from Full-Monitor display to Quad Split Source view. The Record monitor and
Source monitor are not synchronized in Quad Split Source view.
• Nine Split Source View—This display allows you to view nine different camera angles
of a group clip in the Source monitor. The Nine Split button switches the Source
monitor from Full-Monitor display to the Nine Split Source view. The Record monitor
and Source monitor are not synchronized in Nine Split Source view.
You can switch the Nine Split Source view from one bank of nine camera angles to a
second bank of nine camera angles by using the Swap Cam Bank or Quad Split button.
• MultiCamera Mode: MultiCamera Quad Split Edit and MultiCamera Nine Split
Edit—After you create a sequence that includes group clips, you can display the
sequence in MultiCamera mode. MultiCamera mode is similar to Quad Split Source
view or Nine Split Source view, except that it gangs the Source and Record monitors
under one set of controls. All camera angles displayed in the Source monitor are
synchronized and update when stopped or scrubbing through the timeline.
593
Chapter 17 MultiCamera Editing
Full-Monitor Display
When you first load a grouped or multigrouped clip, the Source monitor displays a single
frame from one clip in the group in Source/Record mode. This is called Full-Monitor display
when working with group clips because you can view each angle in full-monitor size as you
edit.
594
MultiCamera Displays
595
Chapter 17 MultiCamera Editing
596
MultiCamera Displays
597
Chapter 17 MultiCamera Editing
• Allows you to use the Swap Cam Bank button to switch the Nine Split Source view from
one bank of nine camera angles to another bank of nine camera angles. The Multi-angle
View menus allow you to change the camera angles of the split displays.
• Does not gang the Record monitor with Nine Split Source view.
MultiCamera Mode
After loading a group clip into the Source monitor and editing it to create a new sequence,
select MultiCamera Mode from the Special menu to activate the features. The MultiCamera
Quad Split Edit or MultiCamera Nine Split Edit is displayed, depending on whether you
were in Quad Split Source view or Nine Split Source view before entering MultiCamera
mode.
n You can also enter MultiCamera mode by clicking the Quad Split button or the Nine Split
button if you have previously mapped the button to one of the toolbars in the Timeline or the
Source/Record monitor.
MultiCamera mode takes the Nine Split Source view and Quad Split Source view one step
further: it gangs all clips in the group clip displayed in the Source monitor with the sequence
displayed in the Record monitor. All clips are synchronized and continuously updated
during playback and editing.
n You see the best real-time playback performance when you play material that was recorded
at 10:1m, 4:1m, or 1:1 resolutions. Also, you see better performance when you play in Best
Performance mode rather than in Full Quality mode. For more information about these
modes, see “Playing Back at Different Video Qualities” in the Help.
When you play back multicamera material, you can cut by using the MultiCam keys to
select different camera angles when stopped. The camera angles you selected with the
MultiCam keys are recorded as cuts in the Timeline and are displayed in the Record monitor.
598
MultiCamera Displays
Group Menu icon Source monitor controls are disabled. Gang icon changes to green.
Your Avid editing application remembers your most recent Video Quality setting for
multicamera or group clips separately from your most recent Video Quality setting for
normal clips, and automatically switches to the appropriate setting when you open or close
clips in monitors.
For example, you might be working with group clips and set the Video Quality menu to Best
Performance, then close all group clips and work with single clips. When you reopen a
group clip in a monitor, your Avid editing application remembers your last group clip setting
and switches to Best Performance, regardless of the video quality you were using for single
clips.
Whenever you have a multicamera or group clip open in a monitor, your Avid editing
application uses the Video Quality setting for multicamera or group clips, even if the clips
you are currently playing are single clips. To change the Video Quality setting, you can
make a new selection from the Video Quality menu, or you can close all multicamera or
group clips to revert to your most recent Video Quality setting for single clips.
600
MultiCamera Editing Techniques
• In an SD project, multicamera editing works only with 8-bit resolutions. If you use
media with a 10-bit resolution, your Avid editing application automatically plays the
media at the appropriate 8-bit resolution.
The system uses the name of the clip within the group to identify the clip in each cut, and
adds a G in parentheses to indicate the group.
Using various keys and functions, you can switch and edit the displayed group clip at any
point in the sequence. These techniques apply to both group and multigroup clips.
If the group contains more camera angles than the multi-split display, the Up Arrow and
Down Arrow keys cycle through all the clips. Only the first four clips are shown in the Quad
Split display and only the first nine clips are shown in the Nine Split display.
When the Record monitor is active, you can place the position indicator within any segment
and use the arrow keys to switch the group clip selected for that segment.
n Whenever you switch camera angles, you also switch the frame representing the group in the
bin. You can use this method to change the representative frame for bin display and
storyboarding.
601
Chapter 17 MultiCamera Editing
n The client monitor displays only SD multicamera sequences. You can view playback of HD
multicamera sequences in the Source monitor only.
n If you notice frames are dropping during playback, decrease the size of the Composer
window until playback becomes smooth.
This method is especially useful when editing to music because it allows you to concentrate
on the beats and ignore camera angles until the edits are placed.
To use this method, you must first map the Add Edit button onto the keyboard. Consider
mapping the Add Edit button to a function key next to the default MultiCam keys. For more
information on mapping keys, see “Understanding Button Mapping” on page 80.
602
MultiCamera Editing Techniques
To add edits:
1. Load the group or multigroup clip into the Source monitor and splice it into a sequence.
2. Play the sequence. Each time you want to make an edit, stop and press the Add Edit key.
The edits appear in the Timeline.
Play the sequence repeatedly to add more edits, or remove edits in Trim mode by
lassoing them in the Timeline and pressing the Delete key.
3. After adding the edits, place the position indicator within each segment and use the
arrow keys to switch camera angles.
Click the
Group
Menu icon
to display
the menu.
n Select the Second Row of Info option in the Composer Settings dialog box for the Group
Menu icon to be displayed above the Source monitor.
In addition, you can select the Audio Follow Video option from the Group menu to instruct
the system to switch both audio and video for each camera angle or selective camera style.
The Group Menu icon changes to green when you select the Audio Follow Video option.
Audio Follow Video overrides the track selection beside the Timeline and switches audio in
track A1 only. Audio-Follow-Video edits appear in the Timeline as match frames (that is, the
transition contains an equal sign).
603
Chapter 17 MultiCamera Editing
To select an additional clip from the group to appear in one of the multi-split displays:
1. Press the Ctrl key to activate the display of clip names in the multi-split displays.
2. Ctrl+click the multi-split display where you want to show the new clip.
The clips in the group are listed in the Multi-angle View menu.
Select
additional
angles
from the
Multi-angle
View menu.
3. Select the clip you want to display from the Multi-angle View menu.
The new clip appears in the multi-split display.
604
Selective Camera Cutting
n If the group contains more clips than are displayed and you match a clip that is not visible
(for example, clip 5 and above for the Quad Split display), your Avid editing application
selects the clip but does not display it.
The advantage of selective camera cutting with grouped clips is that all the clips are
synchronized, which simplifies the selection of camera angles. Selective camera cutting
generally requires the use of a detailed line script or detailed notes that enable you to select
clips and assemble the sequence one clip at a time.
605
Chapter 17 MultiCamera Editing
606
Chapter 18
Using Settings
The Settings list is displayed when you click the Settings tab of the Project window. If you
select a setting in the Settings list and make changes, the new parameters remain the default
settings until you change them again. To view or modify the parameters, double-click the
setting.
For information on using the Settings window, see “Using the Settings List” on page 609.
For information on each of the settings, see the following topics:
• Audio Settings
• Audio Project Settings
• Bin Settings
• Capture Settings
• Communication (Serial) Ports Tool Settings
• Composer Settings
• Controller Settings
• Correction Settings
• Deck Configuration Settings
• Deck Preferences Settings
• Effect Editor Settings
• Export Settings
• Film and 24P Settings
• Full Screen Playback Settings
• General Settings
• Grid Settings
• Import Settings
• Interface Settings
• Interplay Folder Settings
Chapter 18 Using Settings
608
Using the Settings List
Settings tab
Settings
Settings Fast menu type
Settings list
609
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Understanding Settings
Three types of settings appear in the Settings list in the Project window, as indicated in the
third column of information: User, Project, and Site.
n For information about the location of the settings files, see “Using the Avid Projects and
Avid Users Folders” in the Help.
• User settings are specific to a particular editor. User settings reflect individual
preferences for adjusting the user interface in your Avid editing application. Individual
User settings are stored in each user folder.
• Project settings are directly related to individual projects. When you change a Project
setting, it affects all editors working on the project. Specific Project settings are stored in
each project folder. Project folders are stored in the following locations, which depend
on whether your project is private or shared:
• Site settings establish default parameters for all new users and projects on a particular
system. They can apply to particular configurations of equipment installed at the site
(for example, specification and node settings for an external switcher). They can also
include other User or Project settings that you copy into the Site Settings window. Site
settings are stored in a separate Settings folder. See “Using Site Settings” on page 622.
n For information about navigating in the Settings dialog boxes, see “Navigating in Dialog
Boxes and Menus” in the Help.
The following table briefly describes each item in the Settings list and where you can find
additional information on a particular item.
610
Using the Settings List
Settings List
Audio Sets the default audio pan; contains audio See “Audio Settings” on page 625, and
scrub options. “Adjusting Clip Gain and Pan Values”
and Adjusting Digital Scrub
Parameters in the Help.
Audio Project Defines the audio settings for the project See “Audio Project Settings” on
and defines the audio input and output page 626.
methods.
Bin Sets the auto-save interval, double-click See “Bin Settings” on page 635.
preferences for bins, edit clips from bins
parameters, and enables SuperBins.
Bin View Selects and formats the information See “Displaying Custom Bin Views”
displayed in bins. on page 212.
Capture Defines how the Avid system captures and See “Capture Settings” on page 636.
batch captures in specific situations.
Communication Sets a port for Remote Play and Capture. See “Remote Play, Capture, and
(Serial) Ports Punch-In” on page 170.
Composer Configures the display and behavior of See “Composer Settings” on page 643.
buttons and information in the Playback,
Source, and Record monitors.
Controller Settings Sets the default controller, port selection, See “Controller Settings” on page 649.
and custom controller buttons.
Correction Sets the parameters for the Color Correction See “Correction Settings” on page 650
tool. and the Avid Color Correction User’s
Guide.
Deck Configuration Configures channels and decks into the See “Deck Configuration Settings” on
system. page 652.
Deck Preferences Sets preferences that affect all decks See “Deck Preferences Settings” on
configured into the system. page 654.
Dynamic Relink Sets parameters that determine to which See “Dynamic Relink Settings” on
media files your clips should be linked page 604.
when you are working in a MultiRez
environment.
Effect Editor Changes effect parameters by adjusting the See “Effect Editor Settings” on
appearance and operation of effects. page 655.
611
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Export Sets parameters for file export. See “Export Settings” on page 657.
Film and 24p Sets parameters for edit play rate, ink See “Film and 24P Settings” on
number format, and transfer rate. page 687.
Full-Screen Playback Sets parameters for viewing your video on a See “Full Screen Playback Settings”
full-screen monitor. on page 689.
General Defines default values such as the default See “General Settings” on page 690.
starting timecode and temporary file
location for your project.
Grid Defines the grid to use when you create See “Grid Settings” on page 691 and
effects. “Setting the Effect Grid Options” in
the Help.
Import Sets parameters for file import. See “Import Settings” on page 694.
Interface Defines the appearance and function of See “Interface Settings” on page 703
certain interface elements. and “Customizing the Appearance of
the Avid User Interface” on page 56.
Interplay Folder Allows you to specify a project directory on See “Interplay Folder Settings” on
the asset manager to use for checking in page 705 and the Avid Interplay
media objects. Installation Guide.
Interplay Server Allows you to specify the Avid Interplay See “Interplay Folder Settings” on
Server location on the network. page 705 and the Avid Interplay
Installation Guide.
Interplay User Allows you to set the preference for See “Interplay User Settings” on
accessing Avid asset manager. page 706 and the Avid Interplay
Installation Guide.
Keyboard Used to map commands from the Command See “Keyboard Settings” on page 707
palette to the keyboard. and “Using the Keyboard” in the Help.
Marquee Title Allows you to select the Title tool for See “Marquee Title Settings” on
creating titles and provides options for page 708 and the Avid Marquee Title
promoting titles. Tool User’s Guide.
Media Creation Sets parameters for video resolution and See “Media Creation Settings” on
selects the drives for capturing, creating page 709.
titles, importing, performing audio and
video mixdown, and motion effects.
612
Using the Settings List
Media Services Configures your Avid editing application to See “Media Services Settings
work with the Avid Interplay Media (Windows Only)” on page 713 and the
Services Broker. Avid Interplay Media Services Setup
and User’s Guide.
Mouse Allows you to set the speed of scrolling with See “Mouse Settings” on page 714 and
the mouse wheel within the editing Mouse Scroll Wheel Support” in the
application. Help.
PortServer Sets up the LANshare client so its See “PortServer Settings” on page 714.
workspaces are recognized.
Remote Play and Lets you use your editing application like a See “Remote Play and Capture
Capture videotape recorder. Settings” on page 715 and “Remote
Play, Capture, and Punch-In” on
page 170.
Render Controls the size of imported graphics and See “Render Settings” on page 716
rendered effects to ensure that the graphic or and “Creating and Using Render
effect will be playable. Settings” in the Help.
Safe Colors Sets the safe color parameters for the Color See “Safe Colors” in the Help.
Correction tool.
Script Sets the default display options for scripts See “Script Settings” on page 721.
imported using script integration.
Sound Card Allows you to map audio input sources See “Sound Card Configuration
Configuration directly to the output sources available with Settings” on page 1525.
(Windows only) your audio hardware
Timecode Window Displays various timecodes in an adjustable See “Displaying Timecode in the
window. Appears in the Settings list to Timecode Window” on page 327.
facilitate copying settings.
Timeline Contains general Timeline preferences. See “Timeline Settings” on page 723.
Trim Customizes the Trim mode environment. See “Trim Settings” on page 725.
Video Display Allows digital camera video input; enables See “Video Display Settings” on
support of cameras with video input; sets page 726.
the mode and source for desktop video;
enables Client monitor; sets effects preview
options.
613
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Video Input Opens the Video Input tool. See “Video Input Tool Settings” on
page 728 and “Preparing for Video
Input” in the Help.
Video Output Opens the Video Output tool. See “Video Output Tool Settings” on
page 729 and “Selecting a Video
Output Signal” in the Help.
Workspace Allows you to associate settings and See “Workspace Settings” on page 734
windows with a workspace. and “Linking User Settings and
Workspaces” on page 64.
Defining Settings
You can use the Settings list to establish a hierarchy of settings that address the specific
needs of each production phase.
n Never use a user settings file that was opened in the MediaLog™ application.
By establishing these settings once, and selecting the appropriate setting or bin view in
context, you can save time and effort that would be spent searching for information or
adjusting bin headings on-the-fly. You can also save these settings along with your template
for use on similar projects, as described in “Managing Folders and Bins” on page 45.
For information on some of the most commonly-used system settings, see the following
topics in the Help: “Bin Settings,” “Film and 24p Settings,” “General Settings,” and
“Interface Settings.”
614
Using the Settings List
Settings menu
The selected settings group has a check mark in the Settings menu, and the Settings list
displays only the settings in that group.
The following table describes the different Settings display groups.
Option Description
Base Settings Displays Project, User, and Site settings only; no views are displayed
Bin Views Displays all the Bin View settings you created
Timeline Views Displays all the Timeline View settings you created
615
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Title Styles Displays all the templates you created for the Title tool
Video Tools Settings Displays the Video Input Tool and Video Output Tool settings only
Because User settings are not project or site specific, you can display another set of User
settings in the Project window.
User Selection
menu
The previous user’s settings are saved, and the new user’s settings are loaded into your Avid
editing application and the Project window.
616
Using the Settings List
Modifying Settings
You can alter the default options for various settings to reflect the specific needs of a project
or to customize your Avid editing application based on personal preferences.
You can have multiple versions of settings in your Settings list in the Project window that
apply to several users at various stages of production.
617
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Duplicating Settings
n If you are duplicating settings with custom setting names, a period followed by a version
number appears at the end of the custom setting name of the duplicated settings.
4. Name your settings to indicate their functions. See “Naming Settings” on page 618.
Naming Settings
You can give settings custom names to differentiate among copies or to indicate a specific
use.
Custom setting
name column
618
Using the Settings List
With multiple settings, only one setting at a time is active. Settings that are currently active
have a check mark to the left of the setting name.
Deleting Settings
You can delete settings from the Settings list in the Project window at any time. For example,
you might choose to delete one or more versions of a particular setting, or you might want to
delete all but a few settings for transfer into another Settings window.
c You cannot undo a deletion. You can, however, restore the default settings or copy
settings from other files, as described in “Restoring Default Settings” on page 620 and
“Copying Settings Between Settings Files” on page 620.
To delete a setting:
1. Click the Settings tab in the Project window.
The Settings list appears.
2. Click a setting to select it. Ctrl+click (Windows) or Shift+click (Macintosh) each
additional setting you want to delete.
3. Do one of the following:
t Press the Delete key.
t Select Edit > Delete.
The selected settings are removed immediately.
619
Chapter 18 Using Settings
620
Using the Settings List
Settings list
The copied settings are saved when you close or save the file or project.
You can also drag settings from the settings window into the Settings list in the Project
window.
To copy a setting from a settings file into the Settings list with the setting active:
1. Drag the setting into the Settings list.
A message box opens.
2. Do one of the following
t Click Add to add the new settings to the project without affecting the project’s current
settings.
t Click Replace to replace the current version of each setting with the new settings.
Additional versions of each setting are not affected.
621
Chapter 18 Using Settings
When your Avid editing application opens a new project, it first searches the Site_Settings
file and loads site settings and any settings placed here. The system then proceeds to load
any Project and User settings not included in the Site_Settings file.
Adding settings to the site settings files is useful if you need to establish global settings for
all new users and projects, such as switcher settings, a specific start timecode for all
sequences, or various customized features of the interface.
All new users and projects opened from the Select Project dialog box use these settings as
the default settings.
622
Using the Settings List
Experienced users are accustomed to going to the desktop and moving settings and project
files around manually, but there is an easier and more reliable way of doing this. The User
Profile menu, in the Settings tab of the Project window, has two items: Create User Profile,
and Import User or User Profile. If you have another user’s settings on your system or on a
storage medium that you would like to use, select User Profile Menu > Import User or User
Profile. This option allows you to navigate to the user folder, select it, and establish it as
another user profile, accessible from the same menu. It brings all the requisite files and puts
them in the right place. For more information about using and creating User Profiles, see
“Working with User Profiles” on page 41.
If you choose, instead, to copy the folder, make sure you copy the entire folder, not just the
individual settings files. Place the copied folder in your user folder.
Avid Users
EMaxwell
EMaxwell Settings.avs
EMaxwell.ave
MCState
User2
User2 Settings.avs
User2.ave
MCState
623
Chapter 18 Using Settings
If you use the User Profile option to import User1 and User2 (turning them into User
Profiles), you see something like this:
Avid Users
EMaxwell Settings.avs
EMaxwell.ave
MCState
UserProfile1
UserProfile1 Settings.avs
UserProfile1.ave
MCState
UserProfile2
UserProfile2 Settings.avs
UserProfile2.ave
MCState
UserProfile1
UserProfile1 Settings.avs
UserProfile1.ave
MCState
For more information about selecting projects, see “Opening and Closing a Project” in the
Help.
624
Audio Settings
Audio Settings
The following table describes options available in Audio Settings.
Audio Settings
Option Description
Source Monitor Scrub Select the number of outgoing and incoming frames you hear as you scrub.
Record Monitor Scrub Select the number of outgoing and incoming frames you hear as you scrub.
Default Pan Select the way you want sound to pan between speakers.
• Alternating L/R Allows you to send the odd tracks to the left channel and send the even tracks to the
right channel.
• All Tracks Centered Centers the pan of all tracks between the two speakers for monitoring and output.
Play Buffer Size in Allows you to change the size of the host audio play buffer during playback and
Samples (Software-only digital cut. Use this option if you experience performance problems with playback to
Models) the host audio device. Avid recommends that this setting be left in its default position.
Tool Buffer Size in Allows you to change the size of the host audio play buffer during audio loop play and
Samples (Software-only audio tools play (such as automation gain record). Reducing the tools play buffer size
Models) decreases the overall latency between the time you adjust an audio parameter in your
Avid editing application and the time that you hear those changes through the speaker.
625
Chapter 18 Using Settings
You can save multiple Audio Project settings and select one as the active setting. If you edit
an inactive setting, your Avid editing application does not display items that are not saved.
For example, Mix Mode is not displayed in an inactive setting because it can’t be saved in
the Project settings.
n The Direct Out mode is saved in the Audio settings, not the Audio Project settings. You set it
in the Output tab of the Audio Project window but the system saves the value in the active
Audio settings.
626
Audio Project Settings
Sample Rate 32 kHz Allows you to select audio rate settings for the entire system for playing
44.1 kHz and recording.
48 kHz
The broadcast standard for most high-end video postproduction houses
is 48 kHz. Select the rate based on the requirements of your facility.
For information on changing the sample rate for individual sequences
and audio clips, see “Changing the Sample Rate for Sequences and
Audio Clips” in the Help.
Audio File Format WAVE (OMF) Select the file format for the audio:
AIFF-C (OMF)
• WAVE (OMF) is compatible with Windows applications.
PCM (MXF)
• AIFF-C (OMF) is compatible with many third-party applications,
including Pro Tools.
• PCM (MXF) enables easy exchange of material between servers,
tape streamers, and digital archives.
Select the WAVE or AIFF-C for all audio media when you need to
transfer audio media files directly to a Pro Tools system for audio
sweetening.
Sample Bit Depth 16 Bit Select this option to set the sample size used when you work with audio
24 Bit files:
• 16 Bit is for CD-quality audio.
• 24 Bit is for work with higher resolution audio.
627
Chapter 18 Using Settings
DV Audio Pattern Unlocked Audio This option is only available for you to select from when your Avid
Locked Audio editing application is in a software-only configuration.
When an Avid DNA device is attached, this option is grayed out. The
option is automatically selected for you depending on the deck template
you have chosen. Unlocked audio is selected for all device templates,
with the exception of DVCPro device templates, which select Locked
Audio.
DV Audio Pattern works with all devices. However, because some
devices check the DV Audio Pattern setting before transferring or
recording, you should select the DV Audio Pattern setting expected by
your device.
• Unlocked Audio allows some imprecision in the audio sample rate,
with a variation of up to +/– 25 audio samples per frame.
• Locked Audio keeps the audio clock locked precisely to the video
clock, so exactly the same number of audio samples and video
frames are recorded or transmitted in each cycle of the phase
relationship.
Convert Sample Always Allows you to choose whether or not to perform the conversion rate:
Rates When Never
• Never plays the segments not set at the sample rate as silence.
Playing
• Always makes the system attempt to perform a sample rate
conversion on-the-fly. Although the resulting audio quality might
not be useful for a finished project, it can be useful during an editing
session since it prevents audio from playing back with silence.
For information on changing the sample rate for individual sequences
and audio clips, see “Changing the Sample Rate for Sequences and
Audio Clips” in the Help.
Show Mismatched Yes Allows you to identify a specific sample rate by color if you have a
Sample Rates as No sequence with several different sample rates.
Different Color
628
Audio Project Settings
Remove Extra Remove Allows you to remove any extra filler added during an audio punch-in
Filler After Keep recording.
Punchin
Optical ADAT Allows you to select an output for use with an optical connection.
Connection — S/PDIF
available when you
are using
Avid Adrenaline
hardware
629
Chapter 18 Using Settings
n The options that appear in this tab depend on your audio configuration and the audio
hardware installed on your system. Your options might differ from those listed here.
The following table describes options available in the Audio Projects Settings: Input tab.
Input Gain slider — A slider that controls your computer’s volume settings.
available with software-
(Windows only) If you select the +20 dB check box, gain is
only configurations
additionally boosted.
Input Source Input options depend Allows you to select the type of audio input.
n
on the audio
If you select IEEE 1394 as your input device, the
hardware installed in
input source is automatically set to Host-1394. For
or connected to your
more information, see “Connecting and Selecting a
system.
DV Device” in the Help.
Passthrough Mix Tool — Opens the Passthrough Mix tool, which allows you to adjust
available when you are the mix of tracks for monitoring audio input.
using Avid DNA hardware
Input Gain menu— Allows you to calibrate the volume of global audio input.
available when you are Select 0dB for most situations, or +6 dB in case of low gain
using Avid Mojo or inputs.
Avid Mojo SDI hardware
n The options that appear in this tab depend on your audio configuration and the audio
hardware installed on your system. Your options might differ from those listed here.
The following table describes options available in the Audio Projects Settings: Output tab.
630
Audio Project Settings
Monitor Volume — Allows you to adjust the volume of the desktop speakers.
available with software- Use the Mute button to mute audio output to speakers or
only configurations headphones.
Mix Mode Selection Stereo Modifies the way that the system interprets audio values
Menu button Mono during playback:
Direct Out — available
• Stereo mixes the currently monitored audio tracks
when you are using
into a stereo pair. When you are using Avid
Avid Adrenaline or
Adrenaline or Avid Mojo SDI hardware, you can
Avid Mojo SDI hardware
customize the mix using the Stereo Mix Tracks
option.
• Mono pans all the currently monitored tracks to
center. This mode also ignores pan effects.
• Direct Out maps tracks directly to up to eight
channels of output. By default, Direct Out maps all
audio tracks in numerical sequence to existing output
channels. You can remap a track to any channel by
clicking the Channel Assignment pop-up menu and
selecting another channel.
Stereo Mix Tracks— Mix To 1 & 2 Allows you to customize the mix of tracks with Stereo
available when you are Mix To 3 & 4 selected in the Mix Mode Selection Menu button.
using Avid Adrenaline or Mix To 5 & 6
Your Avid editing application sends a stereo mix to the
Avid Mojo SDI hardware Mix To 7 & 8
two channels you select. Material panned to the left will
be sent to the odd channel, and material panned to the
right will be sent to the even channel. The number of
channels available depends on the audio output you select
or on the options you select in the SD SDI tab of the
Output tab.
631
Chapter 18 Using Settings
All or Timeline Track All Available when you select Direct Out with the Mix Mode
Maps Timeline Selection Menu button.
Allows you to map the track and output channels:
• All allows you to choose between all available tracks.
• Timeline allows you to assign output channels to the
tracks monitored in the Timeline.
Which Set of Track Grp 1 Available when you select Direct Out with the Mix Mode
Maps Grp 2 Selection Menu button.
Grp 3
Allows you to select which set of output tracks to map to
audio channels. Groups of tracks display in multiples of
8, up to the maximum of 24 available audio tracks.
Reset Available when you select Direct Out with the Mix Mode
Selection Menu button.
Reassigns the audio tracks of the sequence to the default
channels that are currently available.
Output type option tab: On/Off Turn this option on to embed the audio with the video in
SD SDI — available when SDI output.
you are using
4 channels 20 bits Select an option based on the number of channels you
Avid Adrenaline or
4 channels 24 bits want and the sample rate you want on the outgoing SDI
Avid Mojo SDI hardware
8 channels 20 bits signal.
8 channels 24 bits
Output type option tab: On/Off Turn this option on to embed the audio with the video in
HD SDI — available HD SDI output.
when you are using
4 channels 24 bits Select an option based on the number of channels you
Avid Adrenaline hardware
8 channels 24 bits want on the outgoing SDI signal.
with an HD project
632
Audio Project Settings
Sync Mode Sync is used for audio input and output to ensure the
audio sample clock is always in sync with the video
clock. This prevents long-term drift between audio and
video.
When you are working with video and digital audio
simultaneously, set your digital audio equipment to the
same video reference signal as your video equipment.
633
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Bypass panel Clip Gain Allows you to have your Avid editing application ignore
RT EQ the volume settings established with the audio tools when
Auto Gain playing back or recording a sequence:
• Clip Gain bypasses the clip gain mode of the Audio
Mixer tool.
• RT EQ bypasses all unrendered EQ effects set in the
Audio EQ tool.
• Auto Gain bypasses all Automation Gain and Pan
effects set in the Automation Gain and Pan mode of
the Audio Mixer tool.
These buttons function the same as the Bypass buttons in
the audio tools.
Render Sample Rate High and Slow Allows you to set the conversion quality of all
Conversion Quality Balanced non-real-time sample rate conversions.
Low and Fast
Real-Time Audio Disabled Allows you to play audio dissolves (also called
Dissolves Enabled crossfades) as real-time effects. Select Disabled if you
experience an audio performance delay in your Avid
editing application.
Dissolve Midpoint Const Power –3dB Sets the method used for audio dissolves:
Attenuation Linear –6dB
• Const Power –3dB uses constant power to maintain a
consistent sound level through the midpoint of the
dissolve.
• Linear –6dB uses a linear gradient to maintain a
consistent amplitude through the midpoint of the
dissolve.
634
Bin Settings
Bin Settings
The following table describes options available in Bin Settings.
Bin Settings
Option Description
Auto-Save interval n minutes Specifies the length of time between attempts to auto-save project files. The
default is 15 minutes.
To avoid interrupting an edit, the Avid system waits until the system is inactive
before auto-saving. Use the option “Force Auto-Save at” to specify an interval
at which the system interrupts an edit to make the auto-save.
Inactivity period n seconds Specifies the length of time the Avid system waits when the system is inactive
before automatically saving the project files. The default is 0 seconds.
Force Auto-Save at n minutes Specifies the maximum length of time between auto-saves. When the system
reaches this time, it auto-saves the project files even if it must interrupt an edit
to do so. The default is 30 minutes.
Maximum files in a project’s Specifies the total number of files stored in the Avid Attic folder. When a bin is
attic saved, the Avid system copies the current version of the bin to a special folder
called the Avid Attic. The default is 30 files.
Keep more files if there are many editors working on the system. This ensures
that all the bins are backed up.
Max versions of a file in the Specifies the total number of single-bin copies stored in the Avid Attic folder.
attic This setting prevents filling the Avid Attic with too many copies of one bin, at
the risk of losing the others. The default is five copies.
Double-click loads object in Determines what happens when you double-click an object in the bin.
New Pop-up Creates a new Source pop-up monitor and automatically loads the clip when
Monitor you double-click an object in the bin.
Source or Record • When you have the Composer monitor stretched into two monitors, loads
Monitor the clip into the Source monitor or the sequence into the Record monitor.
• When you are using the single Composer monitor, loads the clip or
sequence into the existing Source pop-up monitor.
Enable edit from bin (Splice, Allows you to edit clips directly from a bin by selecting a clip and clicking the
Overwrite) Splice-in or the Overwrite button.
Enable Enables the SuperBin and its functions. See “Conserving Screen Real Estate
SuperBin with the SuperBin” in the Help.
635
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Capture Settings
Capture settings include essential options for capturing, batch capturing, auto capturing,
capturing to multiple media files, DV scene extraction, and setting key commands.
Option Description
Stop deck after capture Select this option if you want to stop the deck when the capture operation is
complete.
Pause deck after capture Select this option if you want to pause the deck when the capture operation is
complete.
Preroll Method Select one of four methods from the menu. For more information, see
“Selecting the Preroll Method” on page 137.
Force unique clip names Select this option if you want your Avid editing application to automatically
assign a clip name based on the bin’s name and to make sure this name, or
another name you select, is not already used by any other object in the bin.
Activate bin window after Select this option if you want your Avid editing application to change the
capture focus from the Capture Tool window to a bin window after capturing or
logging is complete. This allows you to immediately start working in the bin.
Space bar stops capture Select this option if you want to use the space bar to create clip names during
the capturing process. When you press the space bar during a capture
operation, your Avid editing application stops capturing, creates a clip from
the capture material, and places the clip in the active bin.
Capture across timecode breaks When this option is selected, your Avid editing application captures sections
of discontinuous timecode on a tape as separate clips.
Deselect this option to make your Avid editing application stop capturing and
report an error when it encounters a timecode break.
Stop capture if a bad frame is When this option is selected, your Avid editing application stops capturing if
detected a corrupt frame is detected. This setting is enabled by default.
636
Capture Settings
Option Description
Latency for no deck mode n Use this setting to compensate for problems that could occur when capturing
frames with external timecode, as described in “Live Capture with External
Timecode” on page 166.
If you notice that your captured media consistently starts on the wrong frame
(usually one or two frames off), use this option to ensure that capturing starts
on the correct frame. The option is set to zero by default.
This option is not available in software-only configurations.
Capture a single video frame Select this option if you want your Avid editing application to capture a
only single frame of video from your clip. When you click the Record button, the
Avid editing application captures the currently displayed frame.
Ask before discarding a canceled Select this option if you want your Avid editing application to query whether
clip to discard the canceled clip, keep it, or try again.
Ask for name when a new tape is Select this option if you want your Avid editing application to query you for a
seen name when it detects a new tape.
Display incoming video in the When this option is selected, incoming video is displayed in the Client
client monitor monitor as soon as you open the Capture tool.
Pause deck while logging When this option is selected, the deck pauses after you set an OUT point
while you log clips; this allows you time to type the name of the clip. See
“Logging Directly into a Bin” on page 112. Deselect this option to allow the
camera or deck to continue playing after you set an OUT point.
637
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Optimize for disk space When this option is selected, your Avid editing application captures
only the exact amount of material in the master clips plus any
additional handles. The tape pauses and prerolls independently for
each master clip that is batch captured.
Optimize for batch speed When this option is selected, your Avid editing application speeds up
batch capturing by allowing the deck to continue to roll forward
between adjoining clips. To qualify for this operation, the two
adjoining clips must meet the following criteria:
• There must be 5 seconds or less between the OUT point of the
first clip and the IN point of the second clip.
• The two clips must have the same video resolution and the same
audio rate.
Switch to emptiest drive if current drive When this option is selected, your Avid editing application switches
is full to the target media storage drive with the most available space when
the current target drive becomes full during batch capturing. YOur
application switches before starting to capture the clip, based on the
number of minutes in the clip. For complete instructions, see “Batch
Capturing Clips” in the Help.
If you do not select this option, capturing stops when a drive becomes
full.
Rewind tape when finished When this option is selected, your Avid editing application
automatically rewinds tapes after batch capturing is finished.
Eject tape when finished When this option is selected, the tape ejects as soon as the last shot
from that tape has been used. This adds to efficiency since you can do
other tasks while the tape is being used and yet still be alerted at the
moment the tape is no longer needed.
Log errors to the console and continue Select this option if you want your Avid editing application to
capturing continue capturing if an error occurs during the capture process.
Capture the tracks logged for each clip Select this option if you want your Avid editing application to capture
the tracks logged for each clip.
638
Capture Settings
Option Description
Use the audio sample rate logged for Select this option if you want your Avid editing application to use the
each clip audio sample rate logged for each clip.
Use the audio sample bit depth logged for Select this option if you want your Avid editing application to use the
each clip audio sample bit depth logged for each clip.
Use the video compression logged for Select this option if you want your Avid editing application to use the
each clip video compression logged for each clip.
Option Description
Enable edit to timeline (splice, overwrite) Select this option to display the Splice-in Edit and Overwrite Edit
buttons in the Capture tool.
Handles Indicate the amount of footage you want to capture before and after
the IN and OUT points of the clips (when capturing to the Timeline
only).
639
Chapter 18 Using Settings
n If you select OMF in the Media Type tab of the Media Creation dialog box, this tab in the
Capture Settings dialog box is labeled OMF Media Files. If you select MXF, the Capture
Settings tab is labeled MXF Media Files.
The following table describes options available in the Capture Settings: OMF Media Files
tab.
Option Description
Capture to a single file, 2 GB limit When this option is selected, capturing stops when the media captured has
taken up 2 gigabytes (GB) of storage space on the media drive.
Capture to multiple files When this option is selected, your Avid editing application writes
captured video or audio to multiple files across multiple drive partitions.
Select this option for clips that might exceed the 2-GB file-size limit.
Maximum (default) capture time n Before a capture begins, your Avid editing application preallocates
minutes (reserves) space on the target drive or drives. Your application uses this
setting to determine how much space to preallocate. The default capture
time is 30 minutes.
This setting applies only to capture-on-the-fly and capture from an IN
point without an OUT point. Capture from an IN point to an OUT point
overrides this setting. Change this setting only if you intend to capture on-
the-fly for longer than 30 minutes. In this case, your Avid editing
application captures for only the specified number of minutes, so be
careful not to underestimate.
Switch to emptiest drive When this option is selected, your Avid editing application switches to
when n minutes left another storage drive when the specified amount of time remains.
640
Capture Settings
n If you select MXF in the Media Type tab of the Media Creation dialog box, this tab in the
Capture Settings dialog box is labeled MXF Media Files. If you select OMF, the Capture
Settings tab is labeled OMF Media Files.
The following table describes options available in the Capture Settings: MXF Media Files
tab.
Option Description
Maximum (default) Before a capture begins, your Avid editing application preallocates (reserves) space
capture time n minutes on the target drive or drives. Your application uses this setting to determine how
much space to preallocate. The default capture time is 30 minutes.
If Frame Chase capture is enabled (the “During capture, clip is updated in Interplay
option is selected), this option defines the expected duration in minutes for a Frame
Chase clip that you create during on-the-fly or open-ended capture (that is, when no
IN and OUT marks are set in the Capture tool).
This setting applies only to capture-on-the-fly and capture from an IN point without
an OUT point. Capture from an IN point to an OUT point overrides this setting.
Change this setting only if you intend to capture on-the-fly for longer than 30
minutes. In this case, your Avid editing application captures for only the specified
number of minutes, so be careful not to underestimate.
During capture, clip is When this option is selected, Frame Chase capture is enabled. An initial check-in
updated in Interplay takes place 10 seconds after a capture begins. Subsequent Interplay updates occur at
intervals defined by the Update Interval option. For more information, see “Enabling
Frame Chase Capture” in the Help.
Update Interval Select an update interval from the menu to determine how frequently updates to
Interplay occur during a Frame Chase capture.
In most circumstances it is preferable to keep the update interval low (1 minute or 2
minutes). This ensures that information added during capture (for example,
comments or locators) is available as quickly as possible.
Switch to emptiest drive When this option is selected, the system switches to another storage drive when the
when n minutes left specified amount of time remains.
641
Chapter 18 Using Settings
DV Scene Extraction When this option is selected, you can automatically generate
subclips and locators based on time-of-day (TOD) information
contained in the DV video format. See “DV and HDV Scene
Extraction” on page 181.
Add Locators Creates locator marks where the TOD information breaks occur
while capturing.
Create Subclips Creates subclips where the TOD information breaks occur while
capturing.
Both Creates locators and subclips where the TOD information breaks
occur while capturing.
Use software DV25 Select this codec when you are in an NTSC 23.976p or 24p project
codec capturing DV25 from analog or SDI. This allows you to capture
standard or advanced pulldown. If you are in an NTSC 23.976 or
24p project and you do not select this DV software codec, you can
capture only advanced pulldown.
Option Description
Function Key Commands (while Allows you to change the commands mapped to the function keys on
capturing/logging) your keyboard. These mappings apply to Capture mode only.
Timed Subclip Allows you to specify a preset duration for subclips created while
capturing.
642
Communication (Serial) Ports Tool Settings
The following table describes options available in the Communication (Serial) Ports Tool
settings dialog box.
Option Description
Remote Play and Capture Choose a port for an edit controller that uses the Sony serial control
protocol. For more information, see “Remote Play, Capture, and Punch-
In” on page 170.
Composer Settings
The following topics describe options available in Composer Settings.
Option Description
First (lower) Row of Info When this option is selected, your Avid editing application displays one row of
tracking, duration, and clip or sequence title information above the Source and
Record monitors.
Second Row of Info When this option is selected, your Avid editing application displays a second row
of information above the first row. The second row includes Fast Menu icons,
duration information, and when applicable, ganging and multicamera icons.
Digital Scrub Parameters When this option is selected, your Avid editing application displays the numbers
for incoming and outgoing frames played during digital audio scrub. This
information is displayed for both source-side and record-side material within the
second row of information. These values are set in the Audio Settings dialog box.
643
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Center Duration When this option is selected, your Avid editing application displays duration data
(Mark IN/OUT) for the material loaded in the Source or Record monitor,
depending on which monitor is active.
16:9 Monitors When this option is selected, your Avid editing application displays media in the
Source and Record monitors in 16:9 format for standard NTSC and PAL signals.
This preference allows you to display the full aspect ratio of wide-screen video
and film transfers in the Source and Record monitors during editing.
First Row of Buttons When this option is selected, your Avid editing application displays only the top
row of Monitor command buttons.
Second Row of Buttons When this option is selected, your Avid editing application displays a second row
of buttons under the Source and Record monitors and includes mode buttons in
the lower center of Source/Record mode beneath the Splice-in and Overwrite
buttons.
Tick Marks in Position Bars When this option is selected, your Avid editing application switches the display
of tick marks (duration indicators) that appear incrementally along the position
bars located directly beneath the Source and Record monitors. When deselected,
the tick marks are invisible.
644
Composer Settings
The following table describes the Color Framing options. For more information on color
framing, see “Tracking Color Frame Shifts” on page 378.
Color Framing Off This option prevents the color framing indicator lights from
appearing above the Overwrite and Splice-in buttons. Select this
option if you are not performing an online edit with material
captured from 1-inch, reel-to-reel tapes. This value is the default.
If you turn the Color Framing option Off, you might have to make
adjustments during online editing if your edits interrupt the color-
sync, signals-per-frame fields in the sequence.
Sync Point Editing When this option is selected, your Avid editing application
(Overwrites) overwrites material onto your sequence so that a particular point in
the source material is in sync with a particular point in the
sequence.
Single Mark Editing When this option is selected, you can mark an IN or OUT point in
the Source monitor and then perform a splice, overwrite, or replace
edit. Your Avid editing application uses the current position of the
position indicator as the corresponding OUT or IN point.
645
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Phantom Marks When this option is selected, your Avid editing application provides
visual guidance when you set fewer than four IN or OUT points
while editing. Phantom marks (shaded IN or OUT mark icons)
appear, indicating the remaining edit points calculated by the
system to complete the edit. For more information on editing
according to the three-mark rules, see “Using Phantom Marks” on
page 344.
Auto-create New When this option is selected, whenever you load new source
Tracks material into the Source monitor, your Avid editing application
automatically creates any new tracks in the sequence that match
existing tracks in the source material. This is the default setting.
Auto-enable When this option is selected, whenever you load new source
Source Tracks material into the Source monitor, the system automatically enables
all existing source tracks. This is the default setting.
Copy Source Locators When this option is selected, if you have locators in a clip in the
Source monitor, the system copies the locators when you edit the
clip into the Record monitor. This is the default setting.
Undo Only Record When this option is selected, you can limit the Undo command to
Events undo only record actions. For more information, see “Undoing or
Redoing Edits” in the Help.
646
Composer Settings
n The Fast Forward and Rewind buttons in the Avid system monitors behave differently from
the equivalent buttons on a tape deck. When you have a sequence loaded in a monitor, the
Fast Forward or Rewind button causes a jump (forward or backward) to the next edit that is
common to all selected tracks in the Timeline. When you have a clip loaded in a monitor, the
Fast Forward or Rewind button causes a jump to the beginning or end of the clip.
Option Description
Stop at Head Frames When this option is selected, the position indicator stops at the first frame (head
frame) of the clip on the selected track.
This option is the default Fast Forward and Rewind key setting. Each time you press
either key, the position indicator moves to the next consecutive head frame.
Stop at Tail Frames When this option is selected, the position indicator stops at the last frame (tail frame)
of the clip on the selected track.
Stop at Locators When this option is selected, the position indicator moves to the next consecutive
frame containing a locator. For more information on using locators, see “Using
Locators” on page 331.
Ignore Track Selectors When this option is selected, your Avid editing application ignores the selected tracks
and cues directly to the start (head) frame of the next edit, regardless of the track on
which it occurs.
The position indicator’s final location depends on whether the Stop at Head Frames
and Stop at Tail Frames options have been selected.
647
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Quad or Nine Split Allows playback in the Source monitor of all camera angles in either
quad split view or nine split view.
Fullscreen Allows playback in the Source monitor of real-time effects for the
active camera angle, which displays in full-monitor size.
MultiCam Mode
Client Monitor
Off Disables the client monitor during playback of group clips and
multigroup clips.
Quad or Nine Split Allows the client monitor to display group clips and multigroup clips
during playback
648
Controller Settings
Controller Settings
The following table describes options available in the Controller Settings.
Controller Settings
Option Description
Controller Click the Controller menu, and select one of the following:
• No Controller
• Digidesign 002
• Digidesign Command|8
Port Click the Port menu, and select the port used to connect your controller.
Edit Settings If you have selected a port and controller, click Edit Setting to map the controller
functions.
Gain Controller Port Select a port for a fader or a mixer to record audio gain information. The options on
this menu differ depending on the ports you have configured on your Avid editing
application.
649
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Correction Settings
The following topics describe options available in the Color Correction settings.
For more information about options in the Correction Settings, see “Customizing Color
Correction Mode Settings” in the Help.
Saved Color Labels Select an item from the menu to control how custom colors are
named in bins. For information on saving custom colors, see
“Assigning Colors to Bin Objects” on page 214.
None When selected, your Avid editing application does not supply a
name.
RGB When selected, your Avid editing application uses the 8-bit
values for the red, green, and blue components as the name.
Name When selected, your Avid editing application uses the name
from the standard HTML color scheme that most closely
matches the color you are saving.
Name and RGB When selected, your Avid editing application uses both the
Name and the RGB information as the name. This is the default
option.
Show Eyedropper Info When this option is selected, the numerical RGB values appear
on the color swatches in the Color Match controls.
Eyedropper Picks from When this option is selected, you can pick colors from anywhere
Anywhere in Application in the application, not only from video images in the
Source/Record monitor, using the Color Match eyedroppers.
650
Correction Settings
When applying Color Select an option from menus to define the first, second, and
correction from the third automatic color correction that Avid Color Correction
Effect Palette, perform makes when you apply the Color Correction effect from the
the following operations: Effect Palette.
HSL Auto Balance Makes adjustments to the three ChromaWheels to balance the
colors in the image. The equivalent of clicking the Auto
Balance button in the Hue Offsets subdividing tab of the HSL
tab.
HSL Auto Black Adjusts the Setup slider in the Hue Offsets subdividing tab of
the HSL tab to make the darkest areas of the image as dark as
possible. The equivalent of clicking the Auto Black button in
the Hue Offsets subdividing tab of the HSL tab.
HSL Auto Contrast Adjusts the Gain and Setup sliders in the Hue Offsets
subdividing tab of the HSL tab to maximize the tonal range in
the image. The equivalent of clicking the Auto Contrast button
in the Hue Offsets subdividing tab of the HSL tab.
HSL Auto White Adjusts the Gain slider in the Hue Offsets subdividing tab of
the HSL tab to make the brightest areas of the image as bright
as possible. The equivalent of clicking the Auto White button
in the Hue Offsets subdividing tab of the HSL tab.
Curves Auto Balance Makes adjustments to the Red, Green, and Blue curves to
balance the colors in the image. The equivalent of clicking the
Auto Balance button in the Curves tab.
Curves Auto Contrast Makes an adjustment to the Master curve to maximize the
tonal range in the image. The equivalent of clicking the Auto
Contrast button in the Curves tab.
651
Chapter 18 Using Settings
For information on the Deck Settings options, see “Deck Settings” on page 652.
Option Description
Add channel Click to add a new channel box. Opens the Channel dialog box.
Add deck Click to add a deck or DV device. Opens the Deck Settings dialog box.
Verify configuration against actual Select if you want your Avid editing application to check the deck
decks configuration against the devices physically connected to the system.
Deck Settings
To access the Deck Settings dialog box, do one of the following:
t Click the Add Deck button in the Deck Configuration dialog box.
t In the deck controller section of the Capture tool, click the Deck Selection menu, and
select Adjust Deck.
t Double-click the deck name in the Deck Settings dialog box.
Name Type your custom name for the tape deck. The default name matches the deck
type.
652
Deck Settings
Device Click the Manufacturer menu, and select your device manufacturer. Click the
Model menu, and select your device model.
If your device does not appear in the list, click the Manufacturer menu, and
select Generic, and click the Model menu, and select the type of device.
While you are capturing, if you continually see a message box that reads “Fail
to find preroll,” click the Model menu, and select GenericDVBasicDevice-
NTSC or GenericDVBasicDevice-PAL
Address For VLXi use only, see your VLXi documentation. If you are using direct
serial port deck control, this option is unavailable.
Show All Devices Displays all devices by manufacturer and model in the Device menu.
Decks Displays only decks by manufacturer and model in the Device menu.
Transcoders Displays only transcoders by manufacturer and model in the Device menu.
Preroll Specifies how many seconds the tape rolls before capturing or digital cut
starts. The default is based on the type of videotape recorder (VTR).
Fast Cue Speeds up long searches if your decks can read timecode in fast forward or
rewind mode.
Switch to ff/rew When this option is selected, your Avid editing application switches to fast
(seconds): n forward or rewind if the target timecode is beyond the specified number of
seconds from your current location on the tape.
By default, the deck switches to fast forward or rewind to reach a target
timecode that is more than 60 seconds away.
If your deck shuttles very quickly, you can increase this number so that the
system uses fast cue only for long searches.
Switch to Search When this option is selected, your Avid editing application switches out of fast
(seconds): n forward or rewind when it is within the specified number of seconds of the
target timecode. By default, your Avid editing application switches to search
mode when it is 60 seconds from the target timecode.
653
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
When the deck contains Select the timecode format (Drop Frame or Non-drop Frame) for logging clips when
no tape or drop frame no tape is in the deck or when drop frame or non-drop frame cannot be detected.
cannot be detected set When a tape is in the deck, your Avid editing application automatically uses the
timecode to existing timecode format on the tape.
Allow assemble edit & When this option is selected, you can use the assemble-edit and crash-record
crash record for digital cut features in the Digital Cut tool, along with the assemble-editing and manual
recording capabilities of your record deck. Select this option to record frame-
accurate digital cuts quickly and without striping entire tapes in advance while using
the assemble edit feature. Select this option also if you want to operate the deck
manually. For more information about digital cuts and assemble editing, see
“Generating Output: Basics” in the Help. For information about crash recording, see
“Crash Recording” in the Help.
Stop key pauses deck This option defines the function of the Stop key (space bar) on the keyboard. Select
this option to map the space bar to the Pause button on the deck. Deselect this option
to map the space bar to the Stop button.
If the videotape heads are down in “Stop key pauses deck” mode, pressing the space
bar brings up the heads and pauses the deck.
The Stop button in the Capture tool always stops the decks.
Shuttle holds speed When this option is selected, the Shuttle button continues shuttling at a constant
speed instead of stopping when you release it.
Stop any paused decks When this option is selected, any paused decks are stopped when you quit your Avid
when quitting editing application. Selecting this option saves wear on the deck heads.
Poll deck during digital When this option is selected, your Avid editing application checks the deck for the
cut current timecode and displays it in the timecode window of the deck controller. If
you see degraded image quality on your digital cut (particularly visible as noise
during black), deselect this option and record the digital cut again. With the option
deselected, the Record button does not flash and the timecode display in the deck
controller is not updated for the duration of the digital cut.
654
Effect Editor Settings
Option Description
DV Capture Offset & Capture Offset (frames) (software-only systems) — Type the number of frames by
Digital Cut Offset which you want to offset while you capture. For more information, see
(software-only systems) “Understanding DV Capture Offset” on page 163.
Digital Cut Offset Override Recommended Digital Cut Offset — Select this option to set a digital cut
(systems with Avid DNA delay. For more information, see “Understanding DV Digital Cut Delay” on
hardware attached) page 576.
Digital Cut Offset (frames) — Type the number of frames by which you want to
delay the digital cut.
Option Description
Indent Rows When selected, parameter rows are indented from the parameter group row, and any
parameter subgroups are indented again. When deselected, the left edges of parameter
rows line up with the parameter group row.
Large Text When selected, text in the Effect Editor appears in 12-point size. When deselected,
text in the Effect Editor appears in the default size, 10 points (Windows) or 9 points
(Macintosh).
Thumbwheels When deselected, variable controls in the Effect Editor appear as the default sliders.
When selected, variable controls appear as thumbwheels. For information on using
thumbwheels, see “Changing a Parameter with a Slider” in the Help.
Real Time Update When selected, your Avid editing application updates the rendered effect image in real
time. Because the update can be slow for complex effects, you have the option to
deselect updating in real time.
655
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Set Position To With Set Position To Keyframe selected, when you click a keyframe indicator, your
Keyframe Avid editing application moves the position indicator to the keyframe. With Set
Position To Keyframe deselected, when you click a keyframe indicator, the position
indicator does not move. Deselecting Set Position To Keyframe allows you to align a
keyframe to the position indicator. See “Aligning and Slipping Advanced Keyframes”
in the Help.
Update Position When selected, the position indicator in the Effect Editor moves while you play the
While Playing effect. Because using Update Position While Playing can cause video underrun
problems in complex real-time effects, the option is deselected by default.
Show Add Keyframe When selected, the Add Keyframe Mode menu (or the Delete Keyframe Mode menu)
Mode Menu appears when you use the Add Keyframe button to add (or delete) keyframes. See
“Keyframe Mode Menu Commands” in the Help.
With Show Add Keyframe Mode Menu deselected, using the Add Keyframe button
performs the default command from the following list (Add Keyframe button
commands), without displaying the Add Keyframe Mode menu or the Delete
Keyframe Mode menu.
Add Keyframe button Select one as the default command for the Add Keyframe button.
commands
• When you deselect Show Add Keyframe Mode Menu, clicking the Add Keyframe
• Add Keyframe To button once performs the default command.
Active Parameter
• When you select Show Add Keyframe Mode Menu, clicking the Add Keyframe
• Add Keyframes To button twice performs the default command. (The first click displays the Add
Active Group Keyframe Mode menu, at which point you can select another command.)
• Add Keyframes To
Open Groups
n The selection you make for the Add Keyframe mode is mirrored in the Delete
Keyframe Mode menu, and vice versa. That is, when you change one, you
change both.
• Add Keyframes To
Enabled Groups For a description of each command, see “Using the Add Keyframe Mode Menu and
the Delete Keyframe Mode Menu” in the Help.
• Add Keyframes To
Open Graphs
• Add Keyframes To
All Parameters
Automatic Start and End With Automatic Start and End Keyframes selected, when you promote an effect to
Keyframes advanced keyframes, all keyframe tracks initially appear with a start keyframe and an
end keyframe. With Automatic Start and End Keyframes deselected, newly promoted
effects initially appear with no keyframes.
This option is available only in the Effect Editor settings dialog box.
656
Export Settings
Export Settings
The following topics describe options available in Export Settings.
Option Description
OMFI 1.0 Select one of these options to export a standard OMFI composition for transfer to a third-party
OMFI 2.0 workstation that supports OMFI. You can choose to export composition only, or embed the
video and audio, or both. See “Exporting Through OMF Interchange” on page 523.
AAF Select this option to create an Advanced Authoring Format (AAF) file.You can choose to
export composition only, or embed the video and audio, or both. See “Exporting OMFI and
AAF Files” on page 523.
AFE (Windows Select this option when exporting as AFE. This is compatible when exporting to systems such
only) as Avid DS. See “Exporting Projects and Bins Using AFE Files (Windows Only)” on
page 529.
QuickTime Select this option to create a QuickTime reference movie. A QuickTime reference movie
Reference contains pointers (links) to movie files. This is similar to exporting as composition only. See
“Exporting As a QuickTime Reference Movie” on page 536.
HDV Select this option to create a transport stream. See “Exporting an HDV Transport Stream” on
page 846.
DV Stream Select this option to create a standard DV stream. The DV Stream format is often used for
distribution on a CD-ROM or over the Web. Use this option when exporting video that will be
combined or processed with other DV-formatted media. Requires a video track. See
“Exporting Video in DV Stream Format” on page 530.
QuickTime Select this option to create a self-contained QuickTime movie. See “Exporting QuickTime
Movie Movies” on page 533.
n If you installed additional QuickTime Export formats, they appear in the menu with
tildes (~) before their names. This indicates they have not been qualified and are not
supported by Avid.
AVI (Windows Select this option to export an AVI file through the Avid Codec for AVI or other compression
only) tool. For more information, see “Export Settings: AVI (Windows Only)” on page 672.
Windows Media Select this option to export your sequence as native Windows Media. You can export your
(Windows only) media using one of the Avid-supplied templates or using a custom audio and video template.
See “Exporting as Windows Media (Windows Only)” on page 545.
657
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Audio Select this option to export audio tracks in the WAVE format, SD II (Macintosh only), or
AIFF-C audio format. See “Exporting Tracks As Audio Files” on page 552 and “Export
Settings: Audio” on page 680.
Graphic Select this option to export a single frame, a series of frames, or a file type that supports
multiple frames as a graphic file. Select a file type from the menu. See “Exporting As a
Graphic File” on page 554. For information about supported file types, see “File Format
Specifications” on page 735.
P2 Select this option to write your sequence to a P2 card or cards. See “Exporting Your Clip or
Sequence to a P2 Card” on page 266 and “P2 Export Settings” on page 686.
Avid Log Select this option to export the selected bin as a shot log file that complies with Avid Log
Exchange Exchange (ALE) specifications. For information about Avid Log Exchange, see “Converting
Log Files with Avid Log Exchange (Windows)” on page 90.
n ALE and tab-delimited files include information for master clips and subclips only.
Information for other objects, such as group clips, sequences, and precomputes, is not
included.
Tab Delimited Select this option to export the selected bin as a shot log file in the form of a tab-delimited
ASCII text file.
658
Export Settings
Option Description
Use Marks When this option is selected, your Avid editing application uses current IN and OUT
points in the selected clip or sequence to determine starting and ending frames for the
export. To export the entire clip or sequence, deselect this option or mark the entire
clip or sequence.
Use Enabled Tracks When this option is selected (default), your Avid editing application uses tracks that
are enabled in the Timeline. To export all the tracks in the sequence, deselect this
option.
Fast Draft Defaults Select this option for a faster export. This option automatically selects Flatten Video
Tracks and Fill Spaces with Black. It automatically deselects Render All Video
Effects and Premix Audio Tracks.
Digital Mastering Select this option to render all video effects and to premix audio tracks before
Defaults exporting the file. This option automatically selects Flatten Video Tracks, Fill Spaces
with Black, Render All Video Effects, and Premix Audio Tracks.
Flatten Video Tracks When this option is selected, the composition is exported as one video track. When
this option is deselected, one QuickTime video track is generated for each video track
in the composition, and you cannot select Fill Spaces with Black. Because most
third-party applications do not understand multiple QuickTime video tracks, it is a
good idea to select this option. This option is automatically selected if you selected
the Fast Draft Defaults and the Digital Mastering Defaults options.
Fill Spaces with Black When this option is selected, blank spaces in video tracks are filled with black in the
QuickTime reference movie. Because QuickTime reference movies do not recognize
blank spaces, it is a good idea to select this option. When this option is deselected, a
QuickTime reference movie might interpret spaces in the video track as gray or as the
background of the player. This option is automatically selected if you selected the
Fast Draft Defaults and Digital Mastering Defaults options.
Render All Video Effects When this option is selected, all unrendered video effects, including matte keys and
titles, are rendered before export. When this option is deselected, any unrendered
effects are ignored. This option is automatically selected if you selected the Digital
Mastering Defaults option.
659
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Display Aspect Ratio This menu lets you select an image size for the video you want to export: Native, 4:3,
or 16:9. This allows you to control the display format without modifying the source
file.
This feature creates metadata — additional data that is stored with the QuickTime
movie. Some applications, such as the QuickTime Player, can interpret this metadata
and scale the image at display time.
Display Aspect Ratio is useful for QuickTime reference movies because you do not
modify the source files of referenced movies. For example, if your source movies are
stored at the standard 720 x 486 for NTSC (720 x 576 for PAL), you can create two
different QuickTime reference movies that use the same referenced source files —
one that uses 4:3 and another that uses 16:9.
The menu selections depend on how you open the Export Settings dialog box and
whether you have done a prior export.
Mixdown Audio Tracks When this option is selected, the audio tracks in the composition are mixed to stereo
files created at the same location as the movie. When this option is deselected, the
Quick Time Reference movie references the original audio media. This option is
selected automatically if you select the Digital Mastering Defaults option.
If you select the Mixdown Audio Track option, you can also select an audio format, a
sample rate, and a sample bit depth.
Audio Format Select the format that is supported by the application into which you will be
importing the QuickTime reference movie.
WAVE is compatible with Windows applications.
AIFF-C is compatible with many third-party applications, including Pro Tools.
Select the AIFF-C format for all audio media when you need to transfer audio media
files directly to a Pro Tools or an AudioVision® system for audio sweetening.
660
Export Settings
Option Description
Use Network Media When this option is selected, the exported movie uses the machine and drive share
References name of the media drive in the QuickTime reference movie instead of a drive letter.
Select this option when the media files referenced by the movie are accessed remotely
over the network. If the media files are stored on the same drive as the QuickTime
reference movie, you do not need to select this option. When this option is deselected,
you cannot select Add Shares for Media Drives.
Add Shares for Media When this option is selected, your Avid editing application creates a new drive share
Drives for referenced media files stored on unshared network drives. The drive share is
hidden; that is, other users do not see the shared drive when browsing your computer.
You do not need to select this option when media is stored on the same drive as the
QuickTime reference movie.
Use Avid DV Codec Deselect this option when you are working in a cooperative environment where one
or more non-Avid systems also have access to the media. This option is selected by
default. Select this option if the non-Avid systems have the Avid DV Codec.
Color Levels Select this option to set the color to RGB or 601/709.
661
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Use Marks When you select this option, your Avid editing application uses
current IN and OUT points in the selected clip or sequence to
determine starting and ending frames for the export. To export the
entire clip or sequence, deselect this option.
Use Enabled Tracks When you select this option, your Avid editing application exports
only the currently enabled tracks for a selected sequence or clip. To
export all tracks in the sequence, deselect this option.
Same as Source When you select this option, your Avid editing application copies the
media files directly with no resolution change. This method is fast and
creates output that uses the same quality as your source files.
Selecting Same as Source is the best method to use if you plan to
process the video on another system, using a third-party application
like After Effects® or media cleaner®.
Use Avid DV Deselect this option when you are working in a cooperative
Codec environment where one or more non-Avid systems also have access to
the media. This option is selected by default.
Custom When you select this option, your Avid editing application
decompresses the files, processes them, and compresses the files at
the requested resolution. This method is slower and often loses
quality. You should only use the Custom option if you have to directly
export a clip or sequence in a particular file format.
Format Options Appears when you select Custom. Click the Format Options button to
open the Movie Settings dialog box. For more information, see
“Export Settings: QuickTime Movie Settings” on page 664.
Video and Audio Select this option if you want to export both the audio and video.
662
Export Settings
Video Only Select this option if you want to export only the video. For example,
use this option if you want to add effects in a third-party application
or to use only the video in a multimedia project.
Audio Only Select this option to export only the audio. For example, use this
option if you want to use or enhance audio in a third-party application
or you want to use the audio in a multimedia project.
Video Format Width x Height Appears when you select Custom. Select this option to set the width
of the clip.
• Size to Fit: This option sizes to fit the specified width and height.
You can type in values or select from the predefined values in the
Fast menu.
n The values in the Fast menu suggest a typical use for each size.
For example, 320 x 240 (Internet video, large).
• Crop/Pad: This option instructs your Avid editing application not
to scale or resize the frames. If necessary, it adds black lines to the
top and bottom of the frame to achieve the correct size.
Color Levels Select this option to set the color to RGB or 601/709.
File Field Order Appears when you select Custom. These options allow you to select
the field that is the upper field during export. For 23.976p, 24p, or 25p
projects, these options do not appear; all fields are automatically
exported as progressive (still) frames.
• Odd (Upper Field First): Select this option if you are in a PAL
project. In forming the export frame, Field 1 becomes the upper
field, that is, Field 1's lines become the odd-numbered lines in the
frame (counted starting from 1). Field 2's lines become the even-
numbered lines.
• Even (Lower Field First): Select this option if you are in an
NTSC project. In forming the export frame, Field 1 becomes the
lower field, that is, Field 1's lines become the even-numbered
lines in the frame. Field 2's lines become the odd-numbered lines.
• Single Field: Select this option if you want the output file to
consist of only Field 1. In this case, the single field of 243 lines
for NTSC (288 lines for PAL) is resized to fit the frame as
specified in the width and height selection.
Create Preview Select this option if you want to create a preview of the QuickTime
movie.
663
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Display Aspect The display aspect ratio allows you to apply a scaling to the video:
Ratio Native, 4:3, or 16:9. The display aspect ratio lets you control the
display format without modifying the source file.
This feature creates metadata — additional data that is stored with the
QuickTime movie. Some applications, such as the QuickTime Player,
can interpret this metadata and scale the image at display time.
Display aspect ratio is useful for the Same as Source option because
that option also preserves the original format. When you select Same
as Source, the selections in the Display Aspect Ratio area are based
on the resolution of the media you are exporting and the project type
(NTSC or PAL).
When you select Custom, your Avid editing application calculates the
Display Aspect Ratio selections on the values you enter for Width x
Height in the Video Format tab.
Video
Filter Choose Video Filter Allows you to apply a single effect filter during an export.
Size Export Size Settings Select Use current size or Use custom size. QuickTime allows you
to set a size, but Avid recommends you set the size in the Width and
Height text boxes of the Export Settings dialog box. Both settings
have the same effect, and the QuickTime size setting overrides the
Avid size setting.
Sound
Settings Compressor Allows you to select a sound compression setting for your export,
along with other options.
664
Export Settings
Prepare for Fast Start Allows a movie to begin playing over the Internet without
Internet downloading the entire movie first. This method of playing movies
Streaming over the Internet is referred to as progressive download or HTTP
streaming. It does not require a streaming video server.
Fast Start - A better choice for progressive downloading. This option works the
Compressed Header same as Fast Start (see previous entry), but compresses the header
information. The header is the portion of the file that allows the
movie to start playing before the entire movie is downloaded.
Compressing the header allows it to download faster. This is
important for large movies (movies that are longer than several
minutes).
Hinted Streaming Select this option if you are putting the exported file on a streaming
video server. The file does not stream without a hint track for each
track in the movie. The hint tracks allow the streaming video server
to split the file into packets for the streaming.
A file with hinted streaming also plays as a progressive download.
However, it will probably play more slowly than a Fast Start movie
because it contains additional information and is therefore larger.
For additional options, click Track Hinter Settings. The RTP (Real
Time Protocol) Track Settings dialog box opens. For more
information, see your QuickTime documentation.
The list of codecs includes Avid codecs, which create encapsulated media files for export of
high-resolution files that are readable within QuickTime applications. The Avid codec you
use to export the file must be loaded on the system running the QuickTime application for
the application to read the exported file. See “Installing or Copying the Avid Codecs for
QuickTime on Other Systems” on page 543.
665
Chapter 18 Using Settings
The following table describes the Avid codecs available in the Standard Video Compression
Settings dialog.
Codec Description
Avid 1:1x For high quality, 8-bit or 10-bit, lossless compression (in which no picture information is
lost); available for use with MXF media files. This format cannot be used by Meridien
systems. It can be used by both Avid DS and Avid DNA-based systems. It uses 4:2:2
sampling.
Avid DNxHD™ For DNxHD encoding with 8-bit and 10-bit resolutions; available for use with MXF media
Codec files. This format cannot be used by Meridien-based systems. It can be used by both
Avid DS and Avid DNA-based systems.
Avid DV For compression compatible with Avid Xpress DV and Avid NewsCutter products or with
Avid Meridien products with the DV/MPEG option.
Avid DV100 For DVCPRO HD encoding. This format cannot be used by Meridien systems. It can be
Codec used by both Avid DS and Avid DNA-based systems. It uses 4:2:2 sampling.
Avid MPEG2 50 For MPEG-2 IMX 50,40,30 encoding; an interframe compression used in Sony IMX VTRs
mbit and cameras. It uses 4:2:2 sampling.
Avid Packed For high quality, 10-bit, lossless compression (in which no picture information is lost);
Codec available for use with MXF media files. This format cannot be used by Meridien-based
systems. It can be used by both Avid DS and Avid DNA-based systems. It uses 4:2:2
sampling.
666
Export Settings
Option Description
Use Marks When you select this option, your Avid editing application uses current IN and OUT
points in the selected clip or sequence to determine starting and ending frames for the
export. To output the entire clip or sequence, deselect this option.
Use Enabled Tracks When this option is selected (default), your Avid editing application uses tracks that
are enabled in the Timeline. To output the entire clip or sequence, deselect this option.
Video Quality Select one of the following qualities. The quality level inversely trades off with the
time required to complete the export: Draft is fastest, while Best takes the longest
time to complete. If you have a slower system, you might want to see if the Better or
Draft quality is good enough for your needs.
• Draft
• Better
• Best
667
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Use Marks When you select this option, your Avid editing application uses current
IN and OUT points in the selected clip or sequence to determine starting
and ending frames for the export. To export the entire clip or sequence,
deselect this option.
Use Enabled Tracks When this option is selected (default), your Avid editing application
uses tracks that are enabled in the Timeline. To export the entire clip or
sequence, deselect this option.
Format Options Click this button to select a video format and an audio format for export.
Video and Audio Select this option if you want to export both the audio and the video.
Video Only Select this option if you want to export only the video.
Audio Only Select this option if you want to export only the audio. For example, use
this option if you want to use or enhance audio in a third-party
application or use the audio in a multimedia project.
Video Format Color Levels Select this option to set color to RGB or 601/709.
File Field Order These options allow you to select the field that is the upper field during
export. For 23.976p, 24p, or 25p projects, these options do not appear;
all fields are automatically exported as progressive (still) frames.
• Odd (Upper Field First): Select this option if you are in a PAL
project. In forming the export frame, Field 1 becomes the upper
field, that is, Field 1's lines become the odd-numbered lines in the
frame (counted starting from 1). Field 2's lines become the even-
numbered lines.
• Even (Lower Field First): Select this option if you are in an NTSC
project. In forming the export frame, Field 1 becomes the lower
field, that is, Field 1's lines become the even-numbered lines in the
frame. Field 2's lines become the odd-numbered lines.
• Single Field: Select this option if you want the output file to consist
of only Field 1. In this case, the single field of 243 lines for NTSC
(288 lines for PAL) is resized to fit the frame as specified in the
width and height selection.
668
Export Settings
Export As: AAF Select this option if the application to which you are exporting
supports AAF.
OMF 1.0 Select this option if the application to which you are exporting does
not support OMFI Version 2.0.
OMF 2.0 Select this option if the application to which you are exporting
supports OMFI Version 2.0. If you are not sure, select OMF 1.0.
AFE (Windows Select this option if the application to which you are exporting
only) supports AFE.
Use Marks When you select this option, your Avid editing application uses
current IN and OUT points in the selected clip or sequence to
determine starting and ending frames for the export. To export the
entire clip or sequence, deselect this option.
Use Enabled Tracks When you select this option, your Avid editing application exports
only the currently enabled tracks for a selected sequence or clip. To
export all tracks in the sequence, deselect this option.
Include All Video Select this option to include all video tracks from the sequence in
Tracks in Sequence the AAF or the OMFI file. The Video Details tab appears.
Include All Audio Select this option to include all audio tracks from the sequence in
Tracks in Sequence the AAF or the OMFI file. The Audio Details tab appears.
The following options appear in both the Video Details tab and the Audio Details tab:
Export Method: Select an export method. Other options in the dialog box change
depending on which method you choose.
Link to (Don’t Select this option when you want to export an AAF or an OMFI
Export) Media composition with links to the media in its current location. Media is
not embedded in the file and is not exported.
Copy All Media Select this option when you want to copy media to another drive or
folder and export an AAF or an OMFI composition.
669
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Consolidate Media Select this option when you want to export an AAF or an OMFI
composition with links to media that you have consolidated. For
more information about consolidating media, see “Consolidating
Media” in the Help.
Handle Length: nn Enter the number of frames you want to use as handles for
Frames consolidated clips. Handles refer to material outside the IN and
OUT points and are used for dissolves and trims with the new,
shorter master clips. The default is 60.
The following options appear in the Video Details tab only, depending on the export method:
Export Method: Creates a new video mixdown track for the sequence. For more
Video Mixdown information about video mixdown, see Performing a Video
Mixdown” in the Help.
Mixdown with Compatible with Avid Digidesign Pro Tools v7.2 or later.
Video Edits
Mixdown without Compatible with all Avid Digidesign Pro Tools versions.
Video Edits
Render Video Effects Select this option to render video effects during export.
Transcode Video to: Resolution menu Select a resolution to which you want to transcode the video to
during export.
The following options appear in the Media Destinations area for Video and Audio, depending on the
export methods:
Media Drive Specify a media drive as the destination for newly created or copied
media.
Use Media Select Use Media Creation Settings to use the drive you selected in
Creation Settings the Media Creation dialog box. If you deselect Use Media Creation
Settings, you can select a different destination drive.
Embedded in Media files are embedded in the exported an AAF or OMFI file
AAF/OMF specified in the Export dialog box.
670
Export Settings
The following options appear in the Audio Details tab only, depending on the export method:
Include Rendered Select this option to include rendered audio effects during export.
Audio Effects
Render All Audio Select this option to render all audio effects during export.
Effects
Add Audio Mixdown Mono, Stereo Select this option to add an audio mixdown track, and then select
Track(s) the type of track you want. For more information about audio
mixing, see “Using Live Mix Mode” in the Help.
Convert Audio Project rate, Select this option if your sequence has a mix of sample rates and
Sample Rate to: 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, you need to create a single sample rate. (You set the project rate in
or 48 kHz the Audio Project Settings window. For more information see
“Audio Project Settings” on page 626.) You can also use this option
to change the sample rate if the application to which you are
exporting does not support the current sample rate.
Convert Audio Project rate, 16 bit, Select this option if your sequence has a mix of sample bit depths
Sample Bit Depth to: 24 bit and you need to create a single sample bit depth. (You set the
project bit depth in the Audio Project Settings window. For more
information see “Audio Project Settings” on page 626.) You can
also use this option to change the sample bit depth if the application
to which you are exporting does not support the current sample bit
depth.
Convert Audio File If your sequence has a mix of audio file formats, and you want to
Format to: embed media, you must choose a single audio file format. (You set
the project format in the Audio Project Settings window. For more
information see “Audio Project Settings” on page 626.) Audio files
are converted to this format during export. This choice is optional if
you want to consolidate and link media.
Project rate Select Project to use the rate that matches the project format.
WAVE Select WAVE (.WAV file name extension) to link to or embed audio
tracks in the WAVE format. Nearly all Windows applications that
support sound use WAVE files. QuickTime also supports the WAVE
format.
PCM PCM is the only audio file format available for AAF export.
671
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Use Marks When this option is selected, your Avid editing application uses current IN
and OUT points in the selected clip or sequence to determine starting and
ending frames for the export. To export the entire clip or sequence, deselect
this option.
Use Enabled When this option is selected, your Avid editing application exports only the
Tracks currently enabled tracks for a selected sequence or clip. To export all tracks
in the sequence, deselect this option.
Video and Audio Select this option if you want to export both the audio and the video.
Video Only Select this option if you want to export only the video.
Audio Only Select this option if you want to export only the audio. For example, use
this option if you want to use or enhance audio in a third-party application
or use the audio in a multimedia project.
Video Format Codec Options When you click this button, the Video Compression dialog box opens. For
more information, see “Export Settings: AVI Video Compression
(Windows Only)” on page 674.
Width x Height This option allows you to set the width and height of the clip. Click the Fast
Menu button, and select from a list of standard dimensions.
• Size to Fit: This option sizes to fit the specified width and height.
• Crop/Pad: Crop/Pad never scales or resizes frames. If necessary, the
system adds black lines to the top and bottom to achieve the correct
size.
Color Levels This option allows you to set color to RGB or 601/709.
FPS This option sets the frame-per-second (fps) rate for AVI export.
672
Export Settings
File Field Order These options allow you to choose the field that will be the upper field
during export. For 23.976p, 24p, or 25p projects, these options do not
appear; all fields are automatically exported as progressive (still) frames.
• Odd (Upper Field First): Select this option if you are in a PAL
project. In forming the export frame, Field 1 becomes the upper field,
that is, Field 1's lines become the odd-numbered lines in the frame
(counted starting from 1). Field 2's lines become the even-numbered
lines.
• Even (Lower Field First): Select this option if you are in an NTSC
project. In forming the export frame, Field 1 becomes the lower field,
that is, Field 1's lines become the even-numbered lines in the frame.
Field 2's lines become the odd-numbered lines.
• Single Field: Select this option if you want the output file to consist of
only Field 1. In this case, the single field of 243 lines for NTSC (288
lines for PAL) is resized to fit the frame as specified in the width and
height selection.
Sample Bit Depth Select this option to select the sample bit depth.
8 bit: When this option is selected, the system exports an 8-bit audio
sample depth for use in third-party systems that do not support 16-bit. This
option is also used to minimize the data throughput requirements (for
example, to improve playback in multimedia projects).
16 bit: When this option is selected, the system exports a 16-bit audio
sample depth (currently the industry-standard bit rate for audio).
673
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Compressor Cinepak Codec For export at low resolution where high quality is not an issue, such as
by Radius presentations or educational uses, or for small-screen-size playback
from CD-ROM or hard drive. This codec uses a compression algorithm
optimized for CD-ROM playback.
Click Configure to open the Cinepak for Windows 32 configuration
dialog box. You can then choose to compress to color or to black and
white.
Microsoft Video 1 Use this option when you create files that will play with Video for
Windows.
Click Configure to open the Configure dialog box. You can then adjust
the quality of the compressed file using the Temporal Quality Rate
slider.
Full Frames For high-quality export in which no picture information is lost. This
(Uncompressed) option does not compress the file and can result in very large files. To
export an uncompressed file at 1:1, use the Avid Codec for AVI.
Compression Use this option to adjust compression quality for certain codecs. This
Quality slider slider does not adjust quality for the Avid AVI codec.
Key Frame Use this option to have your Avid editing application use keyframes as
Every n frames a reference for subsequent frames. Enter a numeric value to specify the
frequency of the keyframes. This option is not available for the Avid
Codec for AVI or for uncompressed files.
Data Rate Use this option to set a specific data rate for the compressed file, in
n KB/sec kilobytes per second. This option is not available for the Avid Codec
for AVI or for uncompressed files.
674
Export Settings
The following table describes options available in Windows Media Legacy Template.
Option Description
Use Marks When Use Marks is selected, the current IN and OUT points in the selected clip or
sequence determine starting and ending frames for the export.
Use Enabled Tracks When Use Enabled Tracks is selected, your Avid editing application uses tracks that are
enabled in the Timeline. To export all the tracks in the sequence, deselect this option.
Version This refers to the available versions (v8, v7, or v4) Windows Media templates.
Templates Allows you to choose one of the Avid supplied Windows Media templates. See
“Exporting Using an Avid Supplied Template (Windows Only)” on page 545.
The following table describes options available in Existing Windows Media Custom Profile.
Option Description
Use Marks When Use Marks is selected, the current IN and OUT points in the selected clip or
sequence determine starting and ending frames for the export.
Use Enabled Tracks When Use Enabled Tracks is selected, your Avid editing application uses tracks that are
enabled in the Timeline. To export all the tracks in the sequence, deselect this option.
Set Allows you to browse to find an existing .prx file on your system. See “Exporting Using
an Existing Windows Media Profile (Windows Only)” on page 547.
675
Chapter 18 Using Settings
The following table describes options available in Windows Media Options Video Settings.
Option Description
Use Marks When Use Marks is selected, the current IN and OUT points in the selected clip or
sequence determine starting and ending frames for the export.
Use Enabled Tracks When Use Enabled Tracks is selected, your Avid editing application uses tracks that are
enabled in the Timeline. To export all the tracks in the sequence, deselect this option.
Width This option sets the width of the clips for export.
Height This options sets the height of the clips for export.
FPS This option sets the frame-per-second (fps) rate for the export.
Video Type Choose Progressive or Interlaced. Progressive media is composed of single frames, each
of which is vertically scanned as one pass.
Interlaced media is composed of two fields, each of which contains one-half the scan
lines of the frame. Interlaced frames are standard for NTSC and PAL video media.
Pixel Aspect Ratio Select this option to apply a scaling to the video. The pixel aspect ratio allows you to
control the display format without modifying the source file.
Uncompressed Select this option for high-quality export in which no picture information is lost. This
option does not compress the file and can result in very large files.
676
Export Settings
Option Description
(This option is not Windows Media MPEG-4 Video V3 — Creates high-quality video for streaming,
available when you download and play. Enables playback of interlaced content on televisions.
select Uncompressed.)
ISO MPEG-4 Video V1 — The MPEG-4 standard was defined by the Moving Picture
Experts Group (MPEG), the working group within the International Organization for
Standardization (ISO). MPEG-4 was designed to deliver DVD (MPEG-2) quality video
at lower data rates and smaller file sizes.
Windows Media Video V7 — Enables Windows Media Player 7 to view encoded video
content without first having to download the latest codecs. This is the best choice when
the encoding computer cannot support the performance requirements of the newer
Windows Media Video codecs.
Windows Media Screen V7 — Specially optimized for use for screen captures and
some animations
Windows Media Video 9 Screen — For content that needs to be captured from the
computer screen. This codec is ideal for delivering demos or demonstrating computer
use for training. Windows Media Video 9 Screen delivers better handling of bitmap
images and screen motion, even on relatively slow CPUs.
Windows Media Video 9 — Offers improved quality over Windows Media Video 8,
with the highest gains seen at the higher bit rates; provides improved interlaced support.
Windows Media Video V8 — Supports a wide variety of network bandwidths.
Deinterlaces interlaced content before encoding.
Windows Media Video 9 Advanced Profile — Use this profile to deliver either
progressive or interlaced content at data rates as low as one-third that of the MPEG-2
codec—with the same quality as MPEG-2.
Passes Select either 1 Pass or 2 Pass. With 1 Pass encoding, the content passes through the
encoder once, and compression is applied as the content is encountered. With 2 Pass
(This option is not
encoding, the content is analyzed during the first pass, and then encoded in the second
available when you
pass based on the data gathered in the first pass. 2 Pass encoding can result in better
select Uncompressed.)
quality but it takes longer because the encoder goes through the content twice.
VBR Variable Bit Rate. Allows you to set the quality of the video profile setting.
(This option is not
available when you
select Uncompressed.)
Quality Choose Constrained or Unconstrained. Choose constrained when playing either locally
or on a device that has a constrained reading speed, such as a CD or DVD player.
Bit Rate The bit rate represents the size of the data stream in megabits per second.
677
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Buffer Size Type the number of seconds that you want content to be stored before encoding begins.
A larger buffer results in better quality content, but requires more memory. When you
encode content, the encoding process is delayed by the amount of time specified in the
buffer; the content is also delayed by the same amount of time when streaming to a
player.
Quality The setting can range from 0 to 100, with 100 being the highest quality.
Keyframe Amount of keyframes used as part of the encoding sequence. The value is the number of
keyframes used for every second of video. A lower number results in higher quality, but
larger files.
The following table describes options available in Custom Profile Audio Settings.
Option Description
Use Marks When Use Marks is selected, the current IN and OUT points in the selected clip or
sequence determine starting and ending frames for the export.
Use Enabled Tracks When Use Enabled Tracks is selected, your Avid editing application uses tracks that are
enabled in the Timeline. To export all the tracks in the sequence, deselect this option.
Uncompressed Select this option for high-quality export in which no picture information is lost. This
option does not compress the file and can result in very large files.
678
Export Settings
Option Description
Passes Select either 1 Pass or 2 Pass. With 1 Pass encoding, the content passes through the
encoder once, and compression is applied as the content is encountered. With 2 Pass
(This option is not
encoding, the content is analyzed during the first pass, and then encoded in the second
available when you
pass based on the data gathered in the first pass. 2 Pass encoding can result in better
select Uncompressed.)
quality but it takes longer because the encoder goes through the content twice.
VBR Variable Bit Rate. When you select this option, the formats available are VBR formats. If
you deselect this option, the formats available are CBR formats.
(This option is not
available when you
select Uncompressed.)
Format You can encode audio and video content at either a constant bit rate (CBR) or a variable
bit rate (VBR). Use CBR if you plan to stream the content. Use VBR when you plan to
(These options change
distribute the content for downloading and playing either locally or on a device that has a
when you select
constrained reading speed such as a CD or DVD player. Choose from one of the format
VBR.)
options.
Buffer Size Type the number of seconds that you want content to be stored before encoding begins.
A larger buffer results in better quality content, but requires more memory. When you
encode content, the encoding process is delayed by the amount of time specified in the
buffer; the content is also delayed by the same amount of time when streaming to a
player.
679
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Use Marks When Use Marks is selected, the current IN and OUT points in the selected clip or
sequence determine starting and ending frames for the export.
Use Enabled Tracks When Use Enabled Tracks is selected, your Avid editing application uses tracks that are
enabled in the Timeline. To export all the tracks in the sequence, deselect this option.
Mono Select this option to export audio tracks in either mono or stereo.
Stereo
Audio Format WAVE: Select this option to export audio tracks in the WAVE format (.wav file name
extension). Nearly all Windows applications that support sound use WAVE files.
QuickTime also supports the WAVE format.
AIFF-C: Select this option to export audio tracks in the industry-standard AIFF-C
format, which is compatible with many third-party sound editing and multimedia
applications.
SDII (Macintosh only): Select this option to export audio tracks in the Sound Designer
II format, which is compatible with Pro Tools and other third-party applications.
680
Export Settings
Use Marks When this option is selected, your Avid editing application uses current IN
and OUT points in the selected clip or sequence to determine starting and
ending frames for the export. To export the entire clip or sequence,
deselect this option.
Use Enabled Tracks When this option is selected, your Avid editing application exports only
the currently enabled tracks for a selected sequence or clip. To export all
tracks in the sequence, deselect this option.
Graphic Format Format This option allows you to select a graphic format for export. The Format
Options Options button allows you to set export parameters.
Width x Height This option allows you to set the width and height of the clip. Click the
Fast Menu button, and select from a list of standard dimensions.
• Size to Fit: This option sizes to fit the specified width and height.
• Crop/Pad: Crop/Pad never scales or resizes frames. If necessary, the
system adds black lines to the top and bottom to achieve the correct
size.
Color Levels This option allows you to set color to RGB or 601/709.
Sequential Files This option produces a series of still images, numbered sequentially. The
fps rate of the source file determines the number of still image files that
are produced.
Select Locators only to produce images only for those frames that contain
locators.
681
Chapter 18 Using Settings
File Field Order This option allows you to choose the field that will be the upper field
during export. For 23.976p, 24p, or 25p projects, these options do not
appear; all fields are automatically exported as progressive (still) frames.
• Odd (Upper Field First): Select this option if you are in a PAL
project. In forming the export frame, Field 1 becomes the upper field,
that is, Field 1's lines become the odd-numbered lines in the frame
(counted starting from 1). Field 2's lines become the even-numbered
lines.
• Even (Lower Field First): Select this option if you are in an NTSC
project. In forming the export frame, Field 1 becomes the lower field,
that is, Field 1's lines become the even-numbered lines in the frame.
Field 2's lines become the odd-numbered lines.
• Single Field: Select this option if you want the output file to consist of
only Field 1. In this case, the single field of 243 lines for NTSC (288
lines for PAL) is resized to fit the frame as specified in the width and
height selection.
Alias™ This option creates files that are compatible with Alias™/Wavefront™
systems.
BMP Windows This option creates files that are compatible with systems running the
Microsoft Windows operating system.
OS/2 This option creates files that are compatible with systems running the
IBM® OS/2® operating system.
Chyron® Developed by Chyron Corporation for use with video frame buffers
of Chyron® character generator titles.
Cineon™ Blackpoint This option allows you to adjust a film exposure value that
(Windows) corresponds to filming a 2% black card. Values can be between 0 and
Black Point 1022. The default value of 0 is adequate for most uses.
(Macintosh)
682
Export Settings
Whitepoint This option allows you to adjust a film exposure value that
(Windows) White corresponds to filming a 90% white card. Values can be between 1
Point (Macintosh) and 1023.
If the files came from and will be transferred back to a Cineon™
system, use a white point of 1023. The default value of 685 is
appropriate if the final destination is not a Cineon system — for
example, a video display.
ERIMovie Pack 24 bits This option controls whether the image data is packed into 24-bit
color depth (compressed) or is saved as 32-bit (raw) color depth.
Framestore The Framestore format is a 16-bit video image format used on the
Amiga® in conjunction with Newtek's Video Toaster™ hardware.
HIIP supports both compressed and uncompressed Framestore
formats.
JPEG Quality This option controls the output file size and quality. Higher values
produce better images but larger file sizes. Conversely, lower values
reduce the image quality but result in smaller file sizes.
Baseline This option is selected by default. To see if this option is required, see
the documentation that came with your JPEG-supported applications.
Progressive This option allows you to save progressive JPEG files, which divide
the file into a series of scans of the image that increase in quality.
Each scan progressively improves the recognizability of the image.
Progressive JPEG files can be recognized only by applications with
progressive JPEG support, such as some Web browsers.
OMF NTSC/PAL These options appear when you select a compression ratio that allows
you to select either NTSC or PAL. When you select an option, the
Frame Rate
system displays the required image size and the default frame rate.
683
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Compression This option controls the compression ratio and, therefore, the size of
the file. You can choose from all the compression ratio options used
by your Avid editing application when recapturing. For more
information on Avid compression ratios, see “Resolutions and
Storage Requirements” on page 755.
Photoshop Color Depth The 8 bits option saves 8-bit files. The 16 bits option saves 16-bit
files. The Automatic option saves the image in the same depth as the
original loaded image.
Compression This option controls the size of the file on disk. Disabling
compression creates larger files on disk
PICS
Pixar® This option allows you to save the file in the Pixar® format.
PNG Color Depth The 8 bits option saves 8-bit files. The 16 bits option saves 16-bit
files. The Automatic option saves the image in the same depth as the
original loaded image.
Interlaced This option allows you to save the file for progressive display, similar
to progressive JPEG files. As the file is transmitted, the
recognizability of the image improves.
Interlaced PNG files can be recognized only by applications with
interlaced PNG support, such as some Web browsers.
684
Export Settings
SGI® Color Depth The 8 bits option saves 8-bit files. The 16 bits option saves 16-bit
files. The Automatic option saves the image in the same depth as the
original loaded image.
TARGA® Color Depth This option controls how images are saved. The 5-bit option saves
(Windows only) data in Targa 16 format. The 8-bit option saves data in Targa 24/32
format.
Compression This setting controls the size of the file on disk. Disabling
compression creates larger files on disk.
TIFF Color Depth The 8 bits option saves 8-bit files. The 16 bits option saves 16-bit
files. The Automatic option saves the image in the same depth as the
original loaded image.
Compression This setting controls the size of the file on disk. With None, image
data is not compressed and can produce large file sizes. RLE (run
length encoded) produces relatively small and fairly portable files.
JPEG produces files that can vary in size, depending on the quality
you have set using the JPEG quality slider. The higher the quality
setting, the larger the file size.
JPEG Quality This option adjusts the image quality of the JPEG file on a sliding
scale from 0 to 100. The higher the number you set, the higher the
image quality of the JPEG file.
Wavefront™ Format Type This option specifies one of two output file formats supported by
Wavefront (either RLA or RLB).
Color Depth The 8 bits option saves 8-bit files. The 16 bits option saves 16-bit
files. The Automatic option saves the image in the same depth as the
original loaded image.
685
Chapter 18 Using Settings
YUV Format This option controls the video format of saved images. If set to
NTSC, NTSC video format (720 x 486) is used. If set to PAL, PAL
video format (720 x 576) is used. Images are either padded with black
or cropped.
Smooth YUV This option enhances the fidelity of images saved in YUV color space
(if originating in RGB color space).
P2 Export Settings
The following table describes options available in the P2 Export Settings dialog box.
P2 Export Settings
Option Description
Use Marks When Use Marks is selected, the current IN and OUT points in the selected clip or
sequence determine starting and ending frames for the export.
Use Enabled Tracks When Use Enabled Tracks is selected, your Avid editing application uses tracks that are
enabled in the Timeline. To export all the tracks in the sequence, deselect this option.
686
Film and 24P Settings
Option Description
Use Marks When Use Marks is selected, the current IN and OUT points in the selected clip or
sequence determine starting and ending frames for the export.
Use Enabled Tracks When Use Enabled Tracks is selected, your Avid editing application uses tracks that are
enabled in the Timeline. To export all the tracks in the sequence, deselect this option.
Target XDCAM Select the connected XDCAM disk to which you want to export.
Disk
Option Description
Edit Play Rate Select the play rate for your project.
n Edit play rate options differ for PAL and NTSC projects.
Master Default Film Type Select one of these industry-standard film types to meet your production lab
standards and your film type for your master.
Master Default Edge Type Select the edge type for the master display in bins and cut lists.
Ink Number Default Film Type Select one of these industry-standard ink number film types to meet your
production lab standards and your film type.
Ink Number Default Edge Type Select the edge type for the ink number display in bins and cut lists.
687
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Auxiliary Ink Default Film Type Select the film type for a second ink number (this is useful for tracking
additional information for different film gauges). The choices are the same as
for Ink Number Default Film Type.
Auxiliary Ink Default Edge Type Select the format for the auxiliary ink number edge type. The choices are the
same as for Ink Number Default Edge Type.
Video Pulldown Cadence Specify how the Avid application handles pulldown. The choices are:
(NTSC only)
Video Rate, no pulldown. For 24-fps footage transferred MOS (without
sound) to 30 fps by speeding up the film and using audio brought into the
Avid system separately at 100% of the actual speed.
Standard 2:3:2:3 pulldown. For 24-fps footage transferred to 30 fps using
Standard Pulldown with the audio synchronized to the picture.
Advanced 2:3:3:2 pulldown. For 24-fps footage recorded to 60 fields
(NTSC) using Advanced Pulldown with the audio synchronized to the
picture.
Audio Transfer Rate Set the transfer rate for audio in 24p PAL film projects. The choices are:
(PAL only)
Film Rate (100%). For 24-fps film footage transferred MOS to 25 fps by
speeding up film with the audio coming in separately at 100% of the actual
speed.
Video Rate (100%+). For 24-fps film footage transferred to 25 fps by
speeding up the film with the audio synchronized to the video picture.
n It is important to keep the audio transfer rate constant for the project.
Audio Source Tape TC Rate Select the source audio rate. The choices are:
(NTSC only)
30 fps
29.97 fps
Set Pulldown Phase of Timecode Set a default pulldown phase for a 23.976p or 24p NTSC project.
(NTSC only)
688
Full Screen Playback Settings
Option Description
Display Both Fields Select this option when your Avid editing application is connected to an interlaced
display.
If a progressive display (for example, an LCD monitor) is connected to the graphic
card's video output and you select this option, toothcombing will appear in an
interlaced image.
Current Monitor Position You can choose the monitor where you want to see the full screen playback. Drag the
entire Full Screen Playback Settings dialog box to the desired monitor, and then click
Select Monitor.
(Macintosh only) If two or more graphics cards are installed, choose a monitor that is
connected to the primary graphics adapter.
689
Chapter 18 Using Settings
For information on using Full Screen Play, see “Playing Video to a Full-Screen Monitor” in
the Help.
General Settings
The following table describes options available in General Settings.
General Settings
Option Description
Project Format This option displays the format currently selected for the project (NTSC or PAL).
You cannot change it.
Temporary File Directory When you use the Drag and Drop Export or an export that creates an intermediate
movie file, your Avid editing application must store the intermediate file, which
can be as large as the final export. By default, the Temporary File Directory is
located in the same directory as your Avid editing application.
To improve efficiency or to avoid DISK_FULL errors when exporting, you can
type in a different directory for these temporary files. The ideal setting for this
field is to type in a directory on the drive to which you are exporting, or simply one
with plenty of free space.
Default Starting TC This option specifies the timecode value you want your Avid editing application to
use as the default starting timecode for each new sequence.
Default Starting EC This option specifies the edgecode value you want your Avid editing application to
use as the default starting edgecode for each new sequence.
Effect Apertures The Effect Apertures option allows you to control the number of horizontal lines
of an image that are used to create an effect.
DV25: Select this option when you are using DV media exclusively. For more
information, see “Effect Aperture” in the Help.
ITU 601 (default): Select this option when you are using uncompressed media or
mixed resolutions.
NTSC Has Setup This option allows systems using NTSC-EIAJ to use the correct color mapping.
NTSC-EIAJ users should not select this option. All other users should select this
option.
Use Windows compatible Prevents you from using the characters /\:*?”<>| and adding leading spaces,
file names trailing spaces, or a trailing period in bin, project, or user names. These characters
(Macintosh only) are not allowed in Windows file names. This option is useful for moving bins and
projects from Macintosh to Windows platforms.
690
Grid Settings
Option Description
Allow file names to exceed Lets you override the Windows file name limit of 27 characters (not including the
27 characters four characters reserved for the file type extension). Set this option if you do not
(Macintosh only) plan to move your bins or projects to a Windows system, and if you want to use
file names longer than 27 characters.
Generate LTC On Playback This option allows you to output LTC timecode through the Adrenaline
hardware.For more information, see “Using LTC Timecode for Output” in the
Help.
Grid Settings
The following topics describe the options available in the Grid Settings dialog box.
Scale Mode Normal This setting allows you to work with a grid that indicates
boundaries for a format other than the one in which you
4:3 Inside 16:9 Monitor
are working. This is useful when you are creating graphics
4:3 Outside 16:9 Monitor (like titles) that must remain safe in other formats. Select
1.66 Inside 4:3 the appropriate option for the current and target formats
you need. When you do not specifically need a grid that
1.77 Inside 4:3 represents another format, use the Normal option, which is
1.85 Inside 4:3 the default.
Increments
Fields Sets the number of tick marks along the grid axes as well
as the number of visible grid points. The default value is
12.
691
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Sub Fields Sets the number of divisions between visible grid points
for the snap-to-grid feature. Setting Sub Fields to 1 snaps
objects to visible points only. A value of 2 provides 1/2-
field jumps. A value of 4 (the default value) provides 1/4-
field jumps, and so on. Setting Sub Fields to 0 turns off the
snap-to-grid feature.
Source Scan Size For film projects, where an optical house scans film for the
addition of visual effects.
Source Grid
Adjustments
Hor. Offset Moves the grid on the image. These values are intended
mainly for film projects.
Vert. Offset
692
Grid Settings
Type Square Selects a different grid for each standard film type. For video projects,
use the Square grid type. The grid for the Academy option includes a
Standard Film
safety margin on the left that is used for adding the optical sound track.
Academy
Super 35
Anamorphic
Color Sets a color for the grid axes and the grid points.
Show Safe Title Displays the safe title area. Create video titles within this area to ensure
that they are viewable on a regular television screen.
Show Safe Action Displays the safe action area for video display. This box is self-adjusting
for PAL and NTSC projects.
Show 14x9 Zone Select one or more of these options to display the grid you want.
Show 1.66 Aspect
Show 1.85 Aspect
Show 1.77 Aspect
Show Tick Marks Shows tick marks along the axes. Use the Fields parameter to set the
number of tick marks.
Show Thirds Divides the screen into three sections. This is especially useful if you are
creating titles for the lower third of the screen.
Show Points Shows the grid points. Use the Fields parameter to set the number of
grid points.
Show Position Info Displays the position coordinates of any point in the Effect Preview, or
Record monitor. Your Avid editing application uses compass
coordinates and X, Y coordinates. For compass coordinates, the point
(0, 0) is the center of the axes. For X, Y coordinates, the point (0, 0) is
the top left corner of the monitor. X values increase to the right, and
Y values increase as you move down. For more information, see
“Displaying Position Coordinates” in the Help.
693
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Import Settings
The following topics describe options available in Import Settings.
Aspect Ratio, 601/709, non- Select this option to import images with the dimensions used by your
Pixel Aspect square Avid editing application: 720 x 480 (NTSC) or 720 x 576 (PAL). Also
use this option for 720 x 540 images, or for other images that fit the 4:3
aspect ratio. You can use this option to maintain field data when you
import two-field media that follows exact NTSC or PAL dimensions.
n HD projects use the ITU-R 709 color space instead of ITU-R 601.
Your Avid editing application converts the existing pixel dimensions, if
necessary, so that the image fills the screen.
If the aspect ratio of the original frames does not match the
4:3 aspect ratio used by your Avid editing application, the imported
frames might appear distorted.
For best full-screen resolution of files created in a square-pixel
environment, use 648 x 486 (NTSC), 648 x 480 (NTSC DV) or
768 x 576 (PAL). To create a single resolution for both NTSC and PAL,
use 720 x 540.
Maintain, non- Select this option for an image that was created in a non-square-pixel
square environment, but does not match exact NTSC or PAL dimensions.
Maintain, non-square preserves up to 486 (NTSC), 480 (NTSC DV), or
576 (PAL) lines, and either removes additional lines or pads with video
black if there are fewer lines.
Maintain, non-square never scales or resizes.
694
Import Settings
Maintain, square Select this option for an image that was created in a square-pixel
environment, such as a graphics application. Use this option primarily
for icons, logos, and other graphics that cannot be resized and are not
intended to fill the entire screen.
Your Avid editing application fills the rest of the screen with video
black. If the image has an alpha channel, this black is keyed out in the
alpha channel.
Do not use this option if you are importing:
• Images in the 720 x 480 (NTSC DV), 720 x 486 (NTSC) or
720 x 576 (PAL) non-square-pixel dimensions
• A full-screen square-pixel image that has already been stretched to
non-square-pixel dimensions
Maintain and Select this option for an image that was created in square-pixel terms.
Resize, square
Your Avid editing application fits the longest dimension to the screen
size and fills in the missing pixels in the shorter dimension with video
black, creating a border. If the image has an alpha channel, this black is
keyed out in the alpha channel.
For example, a 540 x 300 image would have its longer dimension
resized to 720, and the shorter dimension resized in proportion (to 400).
The remaining “short side” pixels are replaced with black.
For best full-screen resolution of files created in a square-pixel
environment, use 648 x 480 (NTSC) or 768 x 576 (PAL). To create a
single resolution for both NTSC and PAL, use
720 x 540.
Do not use this option if you are importing:
• Images in the 720 x 480 (NTSC DV), 720 x 486 (NTSC) or
720 x 576 (PAL) non-square-pixel dimensions
• A full-screen square-pixel image that has already been stretched to
non-square-pixel dimensions
695
Chapter 18 Using Settings
File Field This section allows you to select the field ordering (sometimes referred
Order to as field dominance) of the media you are importing. For 23.976p,
24p, or 25p projects, these options do not appear; all fields are
automatically exported as progressive (still) frames.
When the field ordering (or spatial field position) of the imported media
matches the field ordering of the project format, no special processing is
required. For more information, see “Field Ordering in Graphic Imports
and Exports” on page 752.
This setting does not apply to OMFI imports when the import resolution
matches the OMFI file.
Non-interlaced This option allows you to import still images to all formats without
concern for the temporal ordering of the fields.
Odd (Upper Field Select this option for the odd field to occur temporally first during
First) import. The first line in the image belongs to the odd field.
Even (Lower Select this option for the even field to occur temporally first during
Field First) import. The first line in the image belongs to the even field.
Color Levels RGB Select this option if the imported graphics file uses RGB graphics levels.
Most computer-generated graphics use RGB graphics levels. The RGB
color values are remapped to ITU-R 601 (formerly CCIR 601) or
ITU-R 709 video color values appropriate for the Avid system.
RGB, dithered Select this option if the imported graphics file uses complex color
effects, such as a gradation, and you are importing at a high resolution
(2:1). Do not use this option to reimport an image that has already been
imported with dithering.
601/709 Select this option if the imported graphics file uses video levels based
on the ITU-R 601 (formerly CCIR 601) or ITU-R 709 (HD) standard.
These graphics include Avid color bars or images that include
superblack (zero black) for keying purposes.
Alpha Use Existing Select this option to import the image, using the existing alpha channel
information.
Invert Existing Select this option to reverse the black and white elements of the alpha
channel if they differ from the matte key requirements of your Avid
editing application: a white background, a black foreground, and a gray
transparency blend between the two.
696
Import Settings
Ignore Select this option to import an image that contains alpha channel
transparency information as one opaque graphic. The imported graphic
appears as a single master clip in the bin.
Single Frame Duration n Select this option to specify the duration of the single frame created
Import seconds from the import. The default is 10 seconds. This option does not apply
to importing sequential image files because each file represents one
frame of the clip; therefore, the total number of files determines the total
duration.
Importing an image with alpha channel creates a matte key effect as a
single frame, with no associated media file.
Importing as a single frame takes less time and requires less storage
than importing as a media file. However, a single frame has limited
real-time playback capabilities, particularly at high resolutions. This
occurs because your Avid editing application loads the frame into
memory and handles it in real time, rather than playing it back from a
disk.
Autodetect Select this option if you are importing sequential files and you want
Sequential Files your Avid editing application to recognize that a sequence of connected
files is present and to automatically import the whole sequence.
When this option is deselected, your Avid editing application does not
automatically import a whole sequence of files that have sequential
extensions. You can then select any single file for import.
You can import sequential files for any of the supported still-image
formats. For information on preparing a sequence of image files, see
“Animation Files” on page 744.
697
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Resolution
Use the source file’s resolution. Select this option to maintain the source file’s resolution. Your Avid editing
application disregards the resolution setting in the Select Files to Import
dialog box as well as the resolution set in the Import tab of the Media
Creation dialog box.
Use the current import resolution. Select this option to use the current import resolution setting. Your Avid
editing application disregards the source file resolution.
Ask me to set the resolution for Select this option to have your Avid editing application display a query
each file that is different from the about resolution selection for each imported file when the resolution of the
current import resolution setting. source file is different from the current import resolution setting.
Option Description
Events
Maintain events as logged. Select this option to maintain all events as originally logged.
Combine events based on Select this option to combine all the events for a scene into a single master clip and
scene and automatically then link the master clip to subclips that represent the original events for that scene.
create subclips. To use this option, you must have scene numbers logged in a scene column in the
bin.
Combine events based on Select this option to combine all the events from a camera roll into a single master
camera roll and clip and then link the master clip to subclips that represent the original events for
automatically create that camera roll. To use this option, you must have camera roll numbers logged in a
subclips. camera roll column in the bin for a film project.
698
Import Settings
Option Description
Merge events with known Select this option to create subclips for events that are merged or relinked to their
sources and automatically source clips upon import. Use this option if you have already entered master clips
create subclips. in a bin for each camera roll or master scene, and have subsequently logged all the
events related to those clips for import.
n You must select the clips that you want to merge before selecting this option.
Merge events with known Select this option to merge information in the shot log onto selected master clips
master clips. based on the matching tape name. Use this option if you have already logged (or
captured) master clips in a bin for each take.
n You must select the clips that you want to merge before selecting this option.
Sample Rate: Convert source Select this option to convert incoming media to the sample rate of the
sample rate to current project (deselected by default).
project sample rate
Deselect this option to import audio media at the source sample rate. If
on import
your Avid editing application does not support the source sample rate,
your application autoconverts it to the current project sample rate.
Convert source Select this option to convert incoming media marked with pull-up or
sample rates with pull-down sample rates to the sample rate of the current project
audio pull-up or (deselected by default).
pull-down to
Deselect this option to import audio media at the source sample pull-up
project sample rate
or pull-down rate, but with the file marked at a rate your Avid editing
on import
application supports.
Sample Bit Depth: Convert source Select this option to covert the incoming media to the bit depth of the
sample bit depth to current project (deselected by default).
project sample bit
Deselect this option to import audio media at the source sample bit
depth on import.
depth. If your Avid editing application does not support the source
sample bit depth, your application autoconverts it to the current project
sample bit depth.
699
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Force import of both Proxy & Select this option to import both proxy and high-resolution versions of the
High-resolution selected file or files. If this option is not selected, only the selected files (proxy
or high-resolution) are imported. Proxy files are imported first.
Only import clips with Good Select this option to restrict XDCAM imports to only those clips described with
Shot Flag the OK or KP (keep) flag. You can flag clips with these and other descriptive
values in the Sony proxy browser software.
Batch import High-resolution Select this option if you want to use the Batch Import function to import high-
Video resolution media from the XDCAM device and automatically conform it with
the low-resolution proxy media.
• Handle Length: nn Frames Type the number of frames you want to use as handles for batch imported clips.
Handles refer to material outside the IN and OUT points and are used for
dissolves and trims with the new, shorter master clips. The default is 30.
Automatically import Proxies Select this option if you want to import all proxy media stored on the XDCAM
when disk is inserted disc when the disc is inserted in the XDCAM device. Deselect this option if you
want to import only selected media files.
Import Essence Marks as Select this option to import XDCAM Essence Marks as locators that can be
Locators displayed in the Source/Record monitor or in the Locators Window.
Convert Proxy Audio to Select this option if you want to convert the sample rate for proxy media
Project Rate during Import (8 kHz) to the project rate when you import the media. The option is selected by
default.
Import Audio Channels Select this option to set the maximum number of audio channels to import: 2, 4,
6, or 8. For example, if a file has 8 channels of audio, you can select 8 to import
all 8 channels or you can select 2 and only the first 2 channels of audio will be
imported.
700
Interface Settings
Interface Settings
The following topics describe options available in Interface Settings.
Option Description
Show Labels in Tool Palette When you select this option, your Avid editing application displays text
labels with the icons on the Tool palette. This is the default option.
Show ToolTips When you select this option, your Avid editing application displays
labels for buttons and icons when you position the mouse pointer over
them. This is the default option.
You can also turn ToolTips on and off from the Help menu.
Delay n seconds before showing If you select Show ToolTips, you can delay the label display by entering
a value in this text box. A delay allows you to move the mouse pointer
across the interface without displaying the labels on items between the
starting point and the destination of the mouse pointer.
Windows Standard Alt Key Behavior This option switches between standard Windows Alt key behavior and
(Windows only) Avid system Alt key behavior. When you select this option, pressing and
holding the Alt key together with another key works as a keyboard
shortcut for certain Windows actions (for example, opening menus).
When you deselect this option, pressing and releasing the Alt key and
then pressing another key works as the Windows keyboard shortcut,
while pressing and holding the Alt key together with another key works
as a keyboard shortcut for certain Avid functions. This is the default
option.
For more information on Windows shortcuts, see the Windows
documentation.
For more information on Avid shortcuts, select Help > Shortcuts.
Automatic Num Lock Activation When you select this option, your Avid editing application automatically
(Windows only) sets the numeric keypad in numeric mode the next time you start the
application. If you deselect this option, the Num Lock key on the
keyboard controls the mode of the numeric keypad.
With either selection, you can use the Num Lock key to change the
mode of the numeric keypad.
701
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Automatically Launch Last Project at Opens your last project when the application starts.
Startup
Color Background Controls the color of the given interface component. See
“Changing Interface Component Colors” on page 56.
Button
Button Contents
Button Highlight
Button Spotlight
Text
Timeline Background
Timeline V Tracks
Timeline A Tracks
Timeline TC Tracks
Project Background
Bin Default
Background
Shading Style Convex Controls the shading of buttons and toolbars. See
“Changing Button and Toolbar Styles” on page 58.
Dim Radial
Convex Radial
Bright Radial
702
Interplay Folder Settings
Monitor Button Separation Maximum Controls the spacing of the Monitor buttons. See
“Changing Button and Toolbar Styles” on page 58.
Moderate
None
Timeline Button Maximum Controls the spacing of the Timeline buttons. See
Separation “Changing Button and Toolbar Styles” on page 58.
Moderate
None
Button Style Oval Controls the shape of the buttons. See “Changing Button
and Toolbar Styles” on page 58.
Octagonal
Rounded
Square
Swoosh
Antique
Option Description
Interplay Root Folder Lists the default directory for your workgroup project, where the asset
manager checks in media assets.
Set Allows you to navigate to a directory on the Interplay Server and set a new
default Interplay Root Folder.
Append project to directory path Automatically adds the name of your project to the directory path specified
in the Interplay Root Folder text box.
703
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Interplay Server name Allows you to enter the computer name of your Interplay Server.
Option Description
User Name Allows you to enter a user name. This name must be a known workgroup user.
Automatic Login at Project Logs you in to the asset manager automatically every time you open a project.
Selection
704
Keyboard Settings
Keyboard Settings
The following illustration displays the default keyboard settings.
Play key
Home key
End key
Arrow keys
Stop
To view the name of a button in the Keyboard settings window, rest the pointer on the button.
To get help for the button, right-click (Windows) or Ctrl+Shift+click (Macintosh) and select
What’s This?
For information on mapping buttons, see “Mapping User-Selectable Buttons” on page 81.
When you open the Keyboard palette from the Settings list and select Map Foreign
Keyboard, you can map user-selectable buttons to the keyboard. If the Windows operating
system is set to French or German regional settings, and you click the center of the Enter key
in the Keyboard palette, a message box opens that says foreign keyboard mapping mode has
been turned off. To return to foreign keyboard mapping mode, Select Standard, and then
select Map Foreign Keyboard again.
705
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Marquee Your Avid editing application always opens Marquee when you select
Clip > New Title or Tools > Title Tool.
Title Tool Your Avid editing application always opens the Title Tool when you
select Clip > New Title or Tools > Title Tool.
Ask me Your Avid editing application displays the New Title dialog box when
you select Clip > New Title or Tools > Title Tool. You can then select
either Marquee or the Title Tool. This is the default setting.
Yes Your Avid editing application always promotes a Title Tool title to a
Marquee title when you open the title for editing from a bin or from
within a sequence. For more information, see “Promoting Title Tool
Titles to Marquee” in the Marquee Help.
Ask me Your Avid editing application displays the Edit Title dialog box when
you open a title for editing from a bin or from within a sequence. You
can then choose whether to promote the title to Marquee. This is the
default setting.
Backup Title on Promote When this option is selected, your Avid editing application creates a
backup Title Tool version of any title that it promotes to Marquee. The
backup copy is a fast-saved (unrendered) title. Your Avid editing
application adds [TT] to the name of the backup copy to differentiate it
from the newly created Marquee version.
706
Media Creation Settings
For more information about options in the Media Creation Settings dialog box, see
“Selecting Video Resolutions and Media Drives” in the Help.
Option Description
Filter Network Drives Based on Removes as a storage choice network drives that cannot support the selected
Resolution resolution or cannot play back the selected resolution.
Filter Out System Drive Removes as a storage choice the drive on which the operating system resides.
Filter Out Launch Drive Removes as a storage choice the drive on which your Avid editing application
resides.
Auto-index local drives as they Enables automatic indexing of local drives by the Media Indexer, a
come online (using filtering background service that keeps track of the media files in storage locations that
rules) you identify. Auto-indexing uses filtering selections on the left side of the tab,
so that if you have selected “Filter Out System Drive,” any media on that drive
will not be indexed. For more information about configuring the Media
Indexer, see the Avid Interplay Software Installation Guide.
Manual Storage Scan Enables immediate indexing of local drives by the Media Indexer. If the Auto-
index option is turned off, you can click this button to index local drives and
folders. You can then use the Interplay Service Configuration tool to remove
specific drives or folders, if desired.
On indexing failure Determines how indexing failure messages are reported. For information on
using the Console, see “Using the Console Window” on page 85.
707
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Media Creation Settings: Capture, Titles, Import, and Mixdown & Transcode Tabs
Option Description
Apply to All This sets your chosen resolution for all the Media Creation dialog box tabs. It also
sets it for any place in the application where you select a resolution.
Video/Audio Drive Select a drive or drives. In the Titles tab, only a Video Drive option is available.
Apply to All This sets your chosen video and audio drives for all the Media Creation dialog box
tabs. It also sets them for any place in the application where you select drives.
Option Description
Apply to All This sets your chosen video drives for all the Media Creation dialog box tabs. It also
sets them for any place in the application where you select drives.
708
Media Creation Settings
Apply to All This sets your chosen resolution for all the Media Creation dialog
box tabs. It also sets it for any place in the application where you
select a resolution.
Apply to All This sets your chosen video and audio drives for all the Media
Creation dialog box tabs. It also sets them for any place in the
application where you select drives.
Same as Source Select this option if you want the application to render the effect
using the resolution of the clip or clips used to create the effect. If
an effect is created from clips that use different resolutions, the
application uses the highest quality resolution.
Effects Processing 8-bit Select this option when rendering time is more important than
image quality. Also use this option if you are mainly working with
effects that don’t support 16-bit precision.
Select this option for the best overall image quality. Use this
16-bit
option if you use 10-bit resolutions, use many levels of nested
effects, or want the best color fidelity for rendered effects.
Automatic Select this option if you want the media source to determine the
effects resolution. This is the default.
709
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Video File Format Select a file format: Open Media Format (OMF) or Material Exchange Format
(MXF). This setting applies to all video format menus (in the Capture tool, the
Consolidate/Transcode dialog box, and other places in your Avid editing application).
For more information, see “File Format Specifications” on page 735.
n If your project uses an HD resolution, you cannot select OMF as a file format.
MXF is selected by default.
File Format Select a file format: Open Media Format (OMF) or Material Exchange Format
(Media Type tab only) (MXF). This setting applies to all video format menus (in the Capture tool, the
Consolidate/Transcode dialog box, and other places in your Avid editing application).
For more information, see “File Format Specifications” on page 735.
n If your project uses an HD resolution, you cannot select OMF as a file format.
MXF is selected by default.
710
Media Services Settings (Windows Only)
Option Description
Media Services Broker is Select to make sure you are connected to the Media Services Broker. You can
available deselect this option to disconnect without losing your setting information.
Media Services Broker Type the Broker name as it appears in the Media Services Broker application
window. For example:
http:\\myBrokerPC:8080
You may need to check with your Media Services Broker administrator for this
information.
Shared Storage Type the directory where you intend to save the QuickTime reference movie
created by the service. You can click the Browse button to locate the directory.
Email address (Option) If you select “Notify me of job completion by email.” Type your e-mail
address.
n You can also check the Avid Interplay Media Services Broker Jobs window
to see the status of your job.
711
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Mouse Settings
The following table describes options available in Mouse Settings.
Mouse Settings
Scroll Wheel Behavior Vertical Scroll Speed Selects the speed of scrolling with the mouse wheel within
menu your Avid editing application — Normal, Moderate, or Fast.
For more information, see “Mouse Scroll Wheel Support” in
the Help.
PortServer Settings
The following table describes options available in PortServer Settings.
PortServer Settings
Option Description
Auto-connect to LANshare at Launch LANshare workspaces are recognized when you start your Avid editing
application.
712
Remote Play and Capture Settings
The following table describes options available in Remote Play and Capture Settings.
Option Description
Mode Use Remote Capture when you want to perform a quick capture. This mode is also
known as crash record. It allows your Avid editing application to capture the
media being sent to it immediately without setting up parameters like IN and OUT
points. Remote Capture supports record and stop with the controller.
Use Remote Play when you want to control sequences via an edit controller.
Remote Play supports play, cue, and stop.
Use Remote Punch-In when you want to perform a quick audio punch-in. Remote
Punch-In allows your Avid editing application to record the audio being sent to it
immediately without setting up all parameters, such as OUT points. Remote
Punch-In supports play, cue, record, and stop with an external controller.
Device Code Select the device code that identifies the VTR the system will emulate. The edit
controller adjusts to this choice. The default value is a Sony PVW-2800, which
performs all the common play and capture functions.
You do not need to change the device code value unless your edit controller does
not recognize the VTR or you want to emulate a specific VTR.
Runup (frames) This option is only available with Remote Play. Specify the time (measured in
frames) it takes the deck to start playing from a cued position. The default value is
1 frame.
When the runup times of two video devices are similar, it is easier for the edit
controller to synchronize the devices during preroll. If your Avid VTR does not
sync up as often as you want, try adjusting this value so the two devices attain full
speed at nearly the same time.
713
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Inhibit preloading when This option is only available with Remote Play and Remote Punch-In. Avid
cueing by single frame. recommends that you do not inhibit preloading under normal circumstances.
Preloading occurs by default in your Avid editing application. It improves
playback performance by preparing the digital media for playback each time you
cue a new frame.
Selecting this option causes your Avid editing application to match the behavior of
a tape deck when you step through footage frame by frame. Avid recommends this
option only for projects that require quick cueing of one frame after another; for
example, when you are using your Avid editing application to present a sequence
of still images as in a slide presentation.
Render Settings
The following table describes options available in Render Settings.
Render Settings
Render Completion Sets a sound for your Avid editing application to activate
Sound once the rendering process is complete. This is useful
when you are rendering multiple effects.
System Beep Sets the rendering completion sound to match the sound
set for your operating system.
Motion Effects Render Determines the processing method when existing motion
Using effects are rendered or rerendered.
714
Render Settings
Duplicated Field Displays a single field in the effect. For two-field media,
this reduces the information stored by half because it drops
one field of the image, resulting in a lower quality image.
For single-field media, this is usually the best choice
because of its speed (the other options do not improve
effect quality for single-field media).
With JFIF resolutions, selecting this option causes the
effect to render in the shortest amount of time. With DV
and MPEG resolutions, the effect renders approximately as
quickly as it would if you selected Both Fields as the
rendering option.
You can use this option to remove unwanted field motion
in interlaced material brought into a progressive project.
Both Fields Displays both fields in the effect. For example, the first two
frames of a half-speed (50%) slow-motion effect repeat the
original Frame 1 (both fields) twice. This option is good
for shots without inter-field motion, NTSC or PAL film-to-
tape transfers, and still shots. With footage that includes
inter-field motion, this method might result in minor
shifting or bumping of the image because it disturbs the
original order of fields: a Field 1 will appear both before
and after the corresponding Field 2.
The effect renders relatively quickly. For best results, you
should use evenly divisible frame rates with this option.
Interpolated Field Creates a second field for the effect by combining scan line
pairs from the first field in the original media. This option
calculates the motion effect at the field level rather than the
frame level. Because your Avid editing application
considers all fields and does not disturb the original order
of fields, the smoothest effect results.
Effects created using this option take the longest amount of
time to render.
715
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Timewarps Render Original Preference Select an option to determine the processing method when
Using Timewarp effects are rendered or rerendered.
Duplicated Field
Both Fields These rendering options are the same as those for Motion
Effects Render Using. See the preceding descriptions.
Interpolated Field
VTR-Style
Blended Interpolated
Your Avid editing application blends, or averages, pixels
from the original frames or fields to create intermediate
frames or fields. For example, at 25% speed, your Avid
editing application creates three blended images between
outgoing Image A and incoming Image B. The first
blended image weights the pixels from Image A at 75%
and Image B at 25%. The second blended image weights
the pixels from Image A at 50% and Image B at 50%. The
third blended image weights the pixels from Image A at
25% and Image B at 75%. Objects in motion from Image A
to Image B appear to fade out of Image A and fade in to
Image B. Timewarp effects created using Blended
Interpolated or Blended VTR render less quickly than
Interpolated Field or VTR-Style.
716
Render Settings
Blended VTR Your Avid editing application first creates a second field
for the effect by shifting selected video fields of the
original media by a full scan line. Then it blends, or
averages, pixels from the original frames or fields to create
intermediate frames or fields. For example, at 25% speed,
your Avid editing application creates three blended images
between outgoing Image A and incoming Image B. The
first blended image weights the pixels from Image A at
75% and Image B at 25%. The second blended image
weights the pixels from Image A at 50% and Image B at
50%. The third blended image weights the pixels from
Image A at 25% and Image B at 75%. Objects in motion
from Image A to Image B appear to fade out of Image A
and fade in to Image B. Timewarp effects created using
Blended Interpolated or Blended VTR render less quickly
than Interpolated Field or VTR-Style.
Effects Quality Render Sets a global override for effects that have HQ (Highest
Using Quality) software implementations. You select the HQ
implementation or the standard implementation for
individual effects by clicking the HQ button in the Effect
Editor.
Quality Set in Each Causes effects to render at the quality determined by the
Effect HQ setting in the individual effects. This is the default.
717
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Composite Sets safe color values for the composite video signal.
Units buttons Define the units of measurement for the three types of safe color values.
The Composite Units menu allows you to select either IRE or mVolts (millivolts).
The Luminance and RGB Gamut menus allow you to select from the following
options:
8 Bit — Measures the adjustment on a scale from 0 to 255.
n The RGB value for a color in the Color Correction tool will not be identical to
the RGB value for the same color in a graphics application such as Adobe
Photoshop. For example, the 8-bit RGB values for reference black and
reference white are 16 and 235 respectively.
% — Measures the adjustment on a percentage scale from 0 to 100.
IRE — Measures the adjustment in IRE units.
mVolts — Measures the adjustment in millivolts.
Actions buttons Define how your Avid editing application implements the safe color settings. The top
menu controls both the Composite and the Luminance limit types; the bottom menu
controls the RGB Gamut limit type. Each Actions menu allows you to select from the
following options:
Ignore — The system does not limit based on these settings. This is the default
setting.
Warn — The system provides warnings when these limits are exceeded. For more
information on safe color warnings, see “Understanding Safe Color Warnings” in the
Help.
718
Script Settings
Script Settings
The following table describes options available in Script Settings.
Script Settings
Option Description
Size This option selects the font size. The default is 12 points.
Left Margin (pixels) This option specifies the left margin size. The default is 40 pixels.
Take Coloring This option specifies the color that your Avid editing application will apply to
takes.
Show Frames When this option is selected, your Avid editing application shows frames in take
slates.
Show All Takes When this option is selected, your Avid editing application shows all takes in each
slate. If you deselect this option, your Avid editing application displays only one
take per slate.
Interpolate Position When this option is selected, you can click in a take line within a script, and the
image in the Source pop-up monitor updates to the approximate position in the take
where you have clicked. If you deselect this option, the Source pop-up monitor does
not respond when you click in a take line.
Hold Slates Onscreen Set this option to keep the slates on the screen when you scroll through a script in
the Script window. Each slate remains on the screen as long as the take lines to
which it is linked remain on the screen.
719
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Record/Input list Lists the input sources available with the audio
hardware installed on your system.
Playback/Output list Audio output sources Maps input sources to the output sources available
<No Match> with the audio hardware installed on your system.
The options available on your system determine
which sources are listed as sub-options.
Override Source menu Audio output sources Allows you to override settings made by your Avid
editing application and to accept the default settings
of the Windows Master Volume control. The options
available on your system determine which sources
are listed as sub-options.
Use Windows Mixer Select this option to deselect all options in the dialog
box and allow the Windows mixer to map input
sources to output sources.
Audio device name Lists the sound card installed on your system.
720
Timeline Settings
Timeline Settings
The following topics describe options available in Timeline Settings.
Option Description
Show Marked Region Highlights the region from the IN point to the OUT point.
Show Marked Shows waveforms drawn between an IN point and an OUT point instead of over the
Waveforms entire composition.
Scroll While Playing Scrolls over the position indicator while you play a sequence.
Highlight Suggested This option allows you to display thin colored indicator lines in the Timecode track of
Render Areas After the Timeline. These thin colored lines display information about the real-time effects
Playback in your sequence. For more information, see “Real-Time Playback of Video Effects”
in the Help.
Show Position Bar When this option is selected, the blue position bar is displayed in the Timeline.
Show Effect Contents When this option is selected, your Avid editing application displays effect
information.
Double-Click to Show When this option is selected, your Avid editing application allows you to double-click
Nesting segments in the Timeline to display the nested effects.
Show Four-Frame When this option is selected, your Avid editing application shows the head and tail of
Display incoming or outgoing frames of video when you drag a segment.
721
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Start Filler Duration Type a default duration for the filler added at the start of a sequence. For more
information, see “Adding Filler” in the Help.
Find Flash Frames Type the maximum number of flash frames you want your Avid editing application to
Shorter Than n frames detect. The default is 10, which tells your Avid editing application to detect clips with
9 frames or fewer. See “Finding Black Holes and Flash Frames” on page 380.
Auto-Patching When this option is selected, your Avid editing application automatically patches the
enabled source tracks to the tracks enabled in the Timeline sequence.
Auto-Monitoring When this option is selected, the track you patch to is monitored. This option is
selected by default.
Segment Drag Sync When this option is set and you click the Sync Lock buttons in the Track Selector
Locks panel, you can drag clips in Segment mode while maintaining audio and video
synchronization. Your Avid editing application adds filler where necessary. For more
information, see “Maintaining Sync in Segment Mode” in the Help.
Default Snap-To Edit Allows a clip, when dragged from a bin to the Timeline, to either snap to a transition
point or move freely on the track. If the option is selected, the clip snaps to an
existing transition endpoint. If the option is deselected, the clip moves freely to any
position on the track.
New Sequences Allows you to set the number of video and audio tracks displayed in the Timeline for
new sequences. You can select a maximum of 24 video tracks and 24 audio tracks.
Dupe Detection Handles Select the size of the handles, in frames, to use for dupe checking. The chosen
number of frames is added at the beginning and the end of each clip before checking
for overlap. The handles are used only for internal calculations.
722
Trim Settings
Trim Settings
The following topics describe options available in Trim Settings.
Option Description
Intermission Allows you to type a transition effect duration for a playback loop.
Option Description
Never use Small Trim mode Sets your Avid editing application to enter Big Trim mode when you perform
any operation that activates Trim mode. In Big Trim mode, both Source and
Record monitors are replaced by displays of outgoing and incoming frames.
“Go to Transition” uses Small Sets your Avid editing application to enter Small Trim mode only when you
Trim mode click the Go to Previous or Go to Next button.
Always use Small Trim mode Sets your Avid editing application to enter Small Trim mode when you
perform any operation that activates Trim mode. Small Trim mode leaves the
Source monitor display, Information Row displays, user tool palettes, and
some Monitor menu functions intact.
This option allows you to continue to perform basic editing functions.
Auto focus when entering Sets your Avid editing application to enlarge the Timeline at the transition
Trim mode selected for trimming.
Arrows at selected transitions Sets your Avid editing application to replace the standard trim rollers with
arrows at selected transitions in the Timeline.
Render On-the-Fly Sets your Avid editing application to display the results of effects as soon as
you create them. Note that this can slow down the editing of the sequence.
723
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Dual Image Play Enables dual-image play while trimming (also known as dual-roller trim). It
displays outgoing and incoming frames in real time while you trim your edit
(adding or shaving the same number of frames on both sides of a transition).
DV Output Setting Output to DV Device Select this option if you have connected a DV
(not applicable to DV devices device to a software-only system or an Avid
connected to an Avid Mojo SDI and you have selected Device >
Adrenaline or an Avid Mojo) IEEE 1394.
10-bit Playback
n This option is only available under
certain circumstances when you are
using Avid Adrenaline hardware.
Select 10-bit Playback to allow your effects to
process using 10-bit components. Deselect this
feature and your effects process using 8-bit
components, which might result in better
performance. For more information, see
“Choosing Bit Depth for Effects Processing”
in the Help.
724
Video Display Settings
Pre-Filled Frames Seconds of Video to Pre-Fill: Type the number of seconds by which to delay
n seconds the beginning of playback. By accepting a
delay at the beginning of playback, you
increase the likelihood that your Avid editing
application will play the material successfully.
The maximum delay you can specify is 10
seconds. See “Prefilling the Video Display
Buffer” in the Help.
Open GL® Hardware Video boards installed on your Select the Open GL board for your video
Preview DVE effects with: system display. For more information, see “Selecting
the OpenGL Mode” in the Help.
Maximum Real Time Streams Stream Limit n Select the number of video streams you want
the application to use during playback. See
“Limiting the Number of Real-Time Streams”
in the Help.
725
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Option Description
Input menu Lets you select the video input for SD projects: Composite, Component, S-Video,
SDI, or DNA-1394. For HD projects, the menu displays HD-SDI. For SD or HD
projects, if you are capturing DV media through a 1394 port on your computer, the
menu displays Host-1394. For more information, see “Capturing DV Media Directly
from a DV Device” in the Help.
Waveform Monitor and Opens or hides the Waveform monitor and the Vectorscope monitor.
n
Vectorscope Monitor
Your Avid editing application supports the SMPTE/EBU component standard
buttons
for 625 timing and Betacam component levels for 525 timing. Your application
does not support the MII component video standard.
Preset buttons The preset buttons are highlighted when the factory preset levels are displayed.
Settings menu Lets you save the settings for an individual tape each time you calibrate bars.
100% Bars button This option is used when the source tape has color bars with 100% (versus 75%)
chrominance levels.
726
Video Output Tool Settings
Hue SVideo and Composite An attribution of color perception based on varying proportions of
red, green, and blue in the video signal. Also known as color
phase.
Sat SVideo and Composite Saturation: a measurement of chrominance or the intensity of color
in the video signal.
SC Phase SVideo and Composite Subcarrier phase: The color-burst portion of a composite or
S-Video signal used to synchronize the timing of two or more
video signals.
Brightness SVideo and Composite Brightness is the relative lightness or darkness of the image.
Contrast SVideo and Composite The variation of the lightest or brightest in comparison to the
darkest portions of the image.
727
Chapter 18 Using Settings
H Phase SVideo, Component The horizontal blanking interval used to synchronize the timing of
and Composite two or more video signals.
Y Gain Component A measurement of luma (Y) in the video signal that is the whitest
point in the visible picture. Color bars are used to set the white
level.
RY Gain Component The red (R) minus luminance (Y) color-difference signal of an
analog component system in the SMPTE NTSC video standard.
The signal consists of the following base equation for red (R),
green (G), and blue (B) components:
R–Y = –0.587G – 0.114B + 0.701R
BY Gain Component The blue (B) minus luminance (Y) color-difference signal of an
analog component system in the SMPTE NTSC video standard.
The signal consists of the following base equation for red (R),
green (G), and blue (B) components:
B–Y= (–0.587G + 0.886B – 0.299R) * gain value
728
Video Output Tool Settings
Test Patterns Allows you to choose a test pattern for calibrating during output.
Sync Lock Internal Use this feature to lock your output connection to the reference or
an internal signal on the Avid DNA hardware.
Reference
Settings menu Lets you save the settings for an individual tape each time you
calibrate bars.
729
Chapter 18 Using Settings
Overall Gain HD Component RGB and A measurement of luma (Y) in the video signal that is the
HD Component YPbPr whitest point in the visible picture. Color bars are used to set
the white level.
B Gain HD Component RGB The blue (B) minus luminance (Y) color-difference signal of
Pb Gain HD Component YPbPr an analog component system in the SMPTE NTSC video
standard. The signal consists of the following base equation
for red (R), green (G), and blue (B) components:
B–Y= (–0.587G + 0.886B – 0.299R) * gain value
R Gain HD Component RGB The red (R) minus luminance (Y) color-difference signal of
Pr Gain HD Component YPbPr an analog component system in the SMPTE NTSC video
standard. The signal consists of the following base equation
for red (R), green (G), and blue (B) components:
R–Y = –0.587G – 0.114B + 0.701R
HD Test Patterns Allows you to choose a test pattern for calibrating during
output.
Sync Lock Use this feature to lock your output connection to the
reference or an internal signal on the Avid Adrenaline.
Settings menu Lets you save the settings for an individual tape each time
you calibrate bars.
730
Workspace Settings
Workspace Settings
The following table describes options available in the Workspace Settings.
Option Description
Activate Settings Linked By Select this option to link other settings to the workspace.
Name
Continually Update This Select this option to automatically preserve the workspace in its most recent
Workspace arrangement. Future changes to the arrangement of the tool windows are
saved.
Manually Update This Select this option to save the workspace in its current arrangement when you
Workspace click Save Workspace Now (which appears only after you select Manually
Update This Workspace). Future changes to the arrangement of the tool
windows are disregarded unless you return to the Workspace Settings dialog
box and click Save Workspace Now again.
731
Chapter 18 Using Settings
732
Workspace Settings
733
Chapter 18 Using Settings
734
Chapter 19
File Format Specifications
To be compatible with a variety of imaging standards, your Avid editing application can
accommodate many file types and formats. The following topics contain descriptions,
specifications, and notes for importing and exporting specific file formats including:
• Graphics (Image) Files
• Animation Files
• Audio File Formats
• MXF Files
• OMFI Files
• BWF Files
• Field Ordering in Graphic Imports and Exports
To ensure usability and high quality, the files in some formats require preparation before
being imported to your Avid editing application. Consequently, this section contains many
more notes for import than for export. When you export a file, you select a file format from
the Export Settings dialog box and select options appropriate for the format. For descriptions
of the dialog box options, see “Export Settings Dialog Box Options” on page 657.
For information on import and export procedures, see the following topics in the Help:
• “Importing Files: Basics”
• “Importing Files: Advanced”
• “Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Basics”
• “Exporting Frames, Clips, or Sequences: Advanced”
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications
Format Description
Alias Alias PIX image format, developed by Alias Research, Inc. (now Alias|Wavefront, a
division of Silicon® Graphics Limited) for use with their animation and visualization
software.
BMP Developed by Microsoft Corporation as the standard image file format used by Microsoft
Windows.
Chyron Developed by Chyron Corporation for use with video frame buffers of Chyron character-
generator titles.
Cineon Developed by Eastman Kodak™ for use in the Cineon Digital Film System. It is a subset of
the SMPTE DPX (Digital Picture Exchange) format.
Framestore Developed by NewTek for use with their Video Toaster system.
IFF Developed by Electronic Arts. IFF (Interchange File Format), or more specifically
IFF-ILBM (InterLeaved BitMap), is the standard file format by which applications on the
Amiga platform transfer image files.
JPEG Developed by the Joint Photographic Experts Group (JPEG). This format is highly suited
for image storage and transmission purposes because of its ability to dramatically reduce the
storage requirements for a file. JFIF files (JPEG File Interchange Format, the standard for
constructing JPEG files) can also be imported and exported.
OMFI Developed by Avid Technology, Inc. and many industry and standards partners for the
(import only) interchange of digital media data between platforms and applications.
PCX Developed by Zsoft Corporation for use with its PC Paintbrush paint software.
(Macintosh only) Developed by Kodak for use with the Kodak Photo CD storage medium. If you have
Photo CD difficulty importing this format directly into your Avid system, open the file in an
(import only) application such as Photoshop, and use the Save As feature to save the file in a format that
can be imported (such as TARGA, PICT, or TIFF).
736
Graphics (Image) Files
Format Description
Photoshop Developed by Adobe Systems Incorporated for use with its Adobe Photoshop image-editing
software.
PICT Developed by Apple Computer, Inc. as the format for Macintosh QuickDraw® images.
PNG Developed by the PNG Development Group originally as an alternative to the GIF image
format. PNG is an acronym for Portable Network Graphics and is pronounced “ping.”
QRT Developed on the Amiga personal computer to run on several operating systems. Used by
many ray tracing programs, such as DKB Ray Trace and the QRT ray tracer.
SGI Developed by Silicon Graphics, Inc. for use as the standard format on their line of
workstations.
Softimage Developed by Softimage, Inc. (now a division of Avid Technology, Inc.) for use in their
Softimage software.
Sun Raster™ Developed by Sun Microsystems, Inc. and supported mainly in Sun applications.
Targa Developed by Truevision, Inc. (now Pinnacle Systems) and originally intended for support
of the Truevision image-capturing hardware.
TIFF Developed by Aldus Corporation (now Adobe Systems Incorporated) and Microsoft
Corporation. TIFF is an acronym for Tag Image File Format.
XWindows Developed by the MIT X Consortium and supported by many X Window System
applications on workstations and some personal computers.
YUV Defined by Abekas Video Systems (now Accom, Inc.), the YUV format is the raw data sent
to the Abekas® machines.
737
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications
n An alpha channel must be straight and not premultiplied. Your Avid editing application does
not properly import premultiplied alphas.
For other requirements, see “Preparing Graphics Files for Import” on page 741 and “Frame
Size for Imported Graphics” on page 743.
Default Alpha
File Name Bit Depth Channel
Format Extension Support Support Notes
BMP .bmp 1-, 4-, 8-, and 24-bit No Four-bit BMP files saved with RLE (run-length
encoded) compression are not supported.
Photoshop does not support four-channel BMP
files.
738
Graphics (Image) Files
Default Alpha
File Name Bit Depth Channel
Format Extension Support Support Notes
IFF .iff 1-bit to 24-bit color; 1-bit alpha Pixel aspect information is saved with image
1-bit to 8-bit only data.
grayscale;
64-color EHB;
4096-color HAM;
262,144-color
HAM8;
SHAM;
A-HAM;
A-RES
PCX .pcx Color-mapped and NA PCX files with 1-bit color depth or
24-bit color odd-numbered pixel widths are not
supported.
Photoshop .psd RGB 8-bits/channel, Yes Multilayered graphics are supported for import.
RGB16 See “Importing Photoshop Graphics” on
bits/channel, page 185.
grayscale, indexed
Duotone files are loaded as grayscale.
color, and duotone
variations Multichannel (greater than four channels) files
are not supported.
CMYK files not supported.
739
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications
Default Alpha
File Name Bit Depth Channel
Format Extension Support Support Notes
PNG .png 1-bit to 32-bit Yes Transparent areas in a PNG file are interpreted
as an alpha channel on import.
Softimage .pic 24-bit plus Yes Pixel aspect information is saved with the image.
c Windows
8-bit alpha
only) Double-clicking a
Softimage file starts the application
associated with PICT files because they
use the same file name extension. Avoid
double-clicking Softimage files to view
them.
TIFF .tif 8-bit color-mapped; Yes The following types of files are not supported:
8-bit or 16-bit Multichannel (greater than four channels) files;
grayscale; Group 3-compressed (fax) files; CMYK files
24- and 48-bit color; with extra channels; and JPEG-compressed files.
24-bit color plus
Four-channel files from Avid Matador™ are
8-bit alpha;
imported as three-channel files.
36-bit color plus
12-bit alpha;
42-bit color plus
14-bit alpha;
48-bit color plus
16-bit alpha
740
Graphics (Image) Files
Default Alpha
File Name Bit Depth Channel
Format Extension Support Support Notes
Graphics Requirements
Frame size Square pixels: These are the preferred sizes for NTSC and PAL. 720 x
(4:3) 648 x 486 (NTSC) 540 can also be used, in some situations, for both NTSC
640 x480 (NTSC DV) and PAL. These are stored by the application as non-square
768 x 576 (PAL) pixels. For more information, see “Frame Size for
Imported Graphics” on page 743.
Frame size Square pixels: Preferred sizes. SD media is stored by the application as
(16:9) 864 x 486 (NTSC non-square pixels.
anamorphic)
1024 x 576 (PAL
anamorphic)
1280 x 720 (HD)
1920 x 1080 (HD)
Alpha channel White foreground This is the standard used by graphics, animation, and
(transparent), black compositing packages. The graphics need to have the alpha
background (opaque) channel inverted on import.
741
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications
Color mode RGB Other formats, including CMYK, can cause import errors.
ITU-R 601 ITU-R 601 is used for SD and ITU-R 709 is used for HD.
ITU-R 709 In HD projects, your Avid editing application
automatically converts the media.
File format Various Your Avid editing application accepts many file formats for
input. TIFF (.tif), PICT (.pct), and PNG (.png) are
commonly used formats. See “Import Specifications for
Supported Graphics File Formats” on page 738.
File field order Odd (Upper field first) For interlaced media, your Avid editing application uses
Even (Lower field the following order:
first)
• NTSC (601 and DV): lower field first
• PAL 601: upper field first
• PAL DV: lower field first
• HD Interlaced: upper field first
If the field order of the graphic is not correct, select the
field order of the graphic during import and the application
will reverse the fields appropriately.
Field order does not apply to progressive media. See “Field
Ordering in Graphic Imports and Exports” on page 752.
Before you import a graphics file to your Avid editing application, you can also use third-
party image-editing software to make adjustments such as the following:
• Create the file in the appropriate size, resolution, and bit depth.
• Crop or color-correct an image.
• Eliminate jagged edges in an image by using the image-editing application’s
anti-aliasing or high-quality option.
• Add transparency (to some formats) by adding an alpha channel.
• In some cases, convert an image file that does not support an alpha channel to a format
that does, in order to add transparency.
n You can import and key the image over video by using key effects within the Avid application.
However, importing an image with an existing alpha channel provides the best results.
For specific procedures and file formats, see the documentation that accompanies the image-
editing software.
742
Graphics (Image) Files
Computer display cards usually use square pixels, and as a result most graphic and
animation programs also use square pixels.
Standard-definition (SD) digital video does not use square pixels. The ITU-R 601 standard
specifies a 720-pixel width for both NTSC and PAL. However, because NTSC and PAL each
has a different number of scan lines (486 for NTSC, 576 for PAL), digital video pixels are
stretched vertically for NTSC and horizontally for PAL. These stretched pixels are referred
to as non-square pixels. Your Avid editing application stores SD video as non-square pixels.
High-definition digital video uses square pixels.Your Avid editing application stores HD
video as square pixels, except for DVCPRO HD, which is stored as non-square pixels.
Some graphics programs allow you to render a graphic or animation in either square or
non-square pixels. As a general guideline, render standard-definition animations and
composites in non-square pixels. For still graphics, you can simply export in square pixels.
Your Avid editing application will convert these into non-square pixels during the import
process.
The numbers in the following table describe the recommended width and height, in pixels, to
create a source image that will be displayed full-screen after import. An image with smaller
dimensions will take up less of the screen or will be distorted, while an image that exceeds
these dimensions might appear distorted, depending on your choices when importing. See
“Import Settings: Image Tab” on page 694.
Frame size (16:9) 864 x 486 (NTSC anamorphic) 720 x 486 (NTSC)
1024 x 576 (PAL anamorphic) 720 x 576 (PAL)
1280 x 720 (HD) Not applicable
1920 x 1080 (HD) Not applicable
743
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications
Animation Files
This topic describes the animation file formats that your Avid editing application supports.
In addition to the specific formats described below, your Avid editing application also
supports sequences of image files. You must name image file sequences appropriately for
your Avid editing application to handle them correctly on import. Name each file in the
sequence NameN.ext, with Name identifying the animation, N indicating the file order, and
.ext indicating the file type (for example, Image1.jpg, Image2.jpg, Image3.jpg). The
numbering can start at any number except 0, or use any numbering format (for example,
Image010.jpg, Image012.jpg, or Imagef28.jpg, Imagef29.jpg).
n Your Avid editing application imports the file at the frame rate that is set in the project. Set
the appropriate frame rate for the project when you export from a third-party application.
ERIMovie
Developed by Elastic Reality, Inc. (now a division of Avid Technology, Inc.) for quick
playback of rendered movies on Silicon Graphics, Inc. platforms.
ERIMovie files use the .mov or .eri file name extensions. QuickTime for Windows also uses
the .mov file name extension. However, QuickTime does not support ERIMovie, and
double-clicking an ERIMovie file will cause an error.
n There is no player for ERIMovie on Windows or Macintosh platforms; the mview program
supports ERIMovie on Silicon Graphics systems.
Developed by Apple Computer, Inc. A PICS file is a sequence of PICT images. Many
applications that handle multiple image formats on the Macintosh platform also support
PICS files.
Only uncompressed data can be stored in PICS format. PICS export does not allow PICS
containers larger than 16 MB.
QuickTime
QuickTime files use the .mov file name extension. After you import a QuickTime file, the
file maintains the .mov file name extension, which is visible in a bin. The .mov file name
extension is the default for export.
744
Audio File Formats
Avid QuickTime codecs enable you to fast import and export QuickTime files. To use the
codecs in a third-party application, see “Exporting from a Third-Party QuickTime or AVI
Application” on page 545.
To take advantage of the speed of Avid QuickTime codecs, you must export the files from
the QuickTime application at the appropriate frame size for the project you plan to import to
in your Avid editing application.
Developed by Microsoft for storing video and audio information as part of its Video for
Windows standard.
AVI files use the .avi file name extension. After you import an AVI file, the file maintains the
.avi file name extension, which is visible in a bin. The .avi file name extension is the default
for export.
Avid AVI files can be quite large, especially at high video resolutions. They require adequate
storage and transfer capabilities.
Format Description
Audio Interchange File Format for audio files developed by Apple Computer, Inc.
Format (AIFF-C)
(Macintosh only) Native format of the Sound Designer II application developed by Digidesign, Inc., a
Sound Designer II division of Avid Technology, Inc.
(SDII)
n Media Composer has limited support for Sound Designer II audio. See
“Working with Sound Designer II Audio Files on Macintosh Systems” in the
Help.
Wave Format (WAVE) Format for audio files developed jointly by Microsoft and IBM. WAVE files are
playable by nearly all Windows applications that support sound.
PCM (MXF) PCM (Pulse Code Modulation) is an industry-standard audio format. Avid MXF
files store audio as PCM data. See “MXF Files” on page 746.
n You can capture, render, and edit audio in any of these formats.
745
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications
MXF Files
Material Exchange Format (MXF) is a wrapper or container format which encapsulates
media and rich production metadata into a single file, which is useful for media storage and
exchange. It is an open technology that can be implemented by any manufacturer.
MXF has been designed to be flexible enough for use in all stages of content creation, from
acquisition, to authoring, to distribution.The primary benefit of MXF is that it provides
greater workflow efficiency by preserving useful metadata as media files make their way
through the content creation process.The MXF format is independent of the type of content
that it contains, so an MXF file can contain video and/or audio at any resolution or
compression. In many instances MXF files will encapsulate media which is already
formatted to one of the existing industry standards.
MXF allows for easy exchange of material between file servers, tape streamers and digital
archives. MXF is an ideal interchange format to enable workflow efficiencies in news
broadcasting, post production, asset management, and archiving applications. For example,
Avid|DS and ProTools support MXF files.
You can select the MXF format when capturing, importing, creating titles, or rendering
effects. See “Media Creation Settings” on page 709.
OMFI Files
OMFI was developed by Avid Technology, Inc. and many industry and standards partners
for the interchange of digital media data between platforms and applications. For
information about creating an OMFI file on a non-Avid application, see the documentation
for the application.
OMFI File
Import
Specifications Notes
Resolution For optimum import speed and quality, export or render the file from the source
application at the resolution you want, and then import the file into your Avid editing
application at that resolution. For more information, see “Import Settings: OMFI
Tab” on page 700.
746
OMFI Files
OMFI File
Import
Specifications Notes
Frame or Edit rate You must import sequences and clips to projects that have the same edit rate (29.97
fps or 23.976 fps for NTSC, 25 fps for PAL, 24 fps for film). If the edit rates do not
match, you will receive an error message.
n Your Avid editing application cannot import an OMFI audio file that was
produced with an edit rate equal to the audio sampling rate. Trying to import
such a file results in an “Unrecognized file type” error message. Create the
source file with an edit rate at the project edit rate (29.97 fps, 25 fps, 24 fps, or
23.976 fps).
OMFI version Avid editing applications recognize and support OMFI 1.0 composition and media
files and OMFI 2.0 composition files.
The following OMFI 2.0 effects are supported generally:
• Video effects: dissolves, wipes, freeze frame, film pulldown, slow motion, fade to
black
• Audio effects: pan and volume, audio dissolves
Other effects can be imported from other Avid applications.
Film pulldown To import audio media, set the pulldown switch to 1.0.
Audio sample rate Audio media is imported at the sample rate that is set in the Avid editing application.
n Avid editing applications cannot import an OMFI audio file that was produced
with an edit rate equal to the audio sampling rate. Trying to import such a file
results in an “Unrecognized file type” error message. Set the edit rate to the
project edit rate (29.97 fps, 25 fps, 24 fps, or 23.976 fps).
Avid MCXpress™ for If you are importing OMFI compositions from Avid MCXpress for Windows NT,
Windows NT® files you might receive an error if the sequence includes video or audio effects. If this
happens, create a cuts-only version of the sequence in Avid MCXpress and export it
again. You cannot import video media from Avid MCXpress for Windows NT; if you
import a composition, you must recapture the media.
File transfer If you are transferring an OMFI file over a network, transfer it as a binary file.
Reimporting Avid If you import OMFI files that contain media you exported from the same system, you
media files need to delete the original media. Otherwise, the new media will not overwrite the
original media. To learn how to find related media files for a sequence, see “Finding
a Related Media File” on page 268.
747
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications
BWF Files
Avid editing applications support any BWF files that adhere to the BWF specification. Some
BWF information always appears in bin columns.
You can use Avid-specific coding to add additional information. Currently, the following
vendors have products that can provide this additional information:
• Aaton
• Zaxcom
• Nagra
• Fostex
Avid editing applications support 24-bit audio data, and up to 16 tracks in a single file. You
can use the AutoSync™ feature to sync these tracks. You can also use AutoSync to sync
picture and sound.
748
BWF Files
uKEYWORD=data[CR/LF]
Syntax Definition
For example,
uSCENE=1A[CR/LF]
after importing, displays “1A” in the Scene column of the bin into which it was imported.
The following table describes how to code BWF information for particular bin columns:
749
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications
In addition, to assign a file to a particular track number, the file name needs to end in _n, -n,
or a space followed by n (where n is the track number). For example, a file named
Orchestra_1.bwf would create the audio on track A1.
To avoid display of a dialog box during import, you can specify the frame rate using the
following syntax:
uFRAMERATE=nDF or
uFRAMERATE=nND
where nn is the frame rate (25, 29.97, or 30), DF is drop-frame, and ND is non-drop-frame.
During import of NTSC BWF files, if no frame rate is specified in the file, a dialog box
appears and asks if the conversion should use 29.97 fps or 30 fps, and drop-frame or non-
drop-frame. Your choices depend on how the audio was recorded.
After you capture video, use the AutoSync™ feature to sync picture and sound or multiple
tracks of sound. If you are using BWF files from a 24-fps shoot in a PAL project, you must
use the PAL Method 2 approach, in which picture and sound are captured separately.
If you are working in a PAL 24p project, you need to take an extra step to make sure the
picture and sound are correctly synced.
Use Auxiliary TC 1 only as a sync point reference for AutoSync. Do not use it for data
tracking or EDL generation.
Use the Aux TC24 column to generate a 24-frame EDL for audio only. Use the Film TC
column to generate a 24-frame EDL for video only. This timecode field represents the
video timecode of a HD downconvert to standard definition video.
5. Make sure all entries in the Shoot Date column use the same syntax. Currently, some
BWF files use the format 2003/10/03 as the Shoot Date while some ALE files use
2003-10-03. This field is used as part of the AutoSync process to guarantee the
uniqueness of the timecode. To fix this problem, do one of the following:
- Manually change the format of one set of clips to match the other.
- If you do need the information, create a custom column with a different name,
select Edit > Duplicate to copy the information into the custom column, and delete
the Shoot Date column.
6. Highlight the picture and audio clips and select Bin > AutoSync.
7. For 24p PAL projects, use Auxiliary TC1 as a sync point. For other projects, use the
Start timecode.
Your Avid editing application creates new subclips with synced picture and sound,
which are ready for editing.
751
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications
Field 1 Time
&
Field 2
Frame Unit
• Upper field is first: The upper field in the frame (odd-numbered lines, when the frame
lines are numbered starting from 1) occurs temporally before the lower field, as shown
in the following illustration. This arrangement is termed “upper field first” (or “lower
field second”).
f1 f2
• Lower field is first: The lower field in the frame (even-numbered lines) occurs
temporally first, as shown in the following illustration. This arrangement is termed
“lower field first” (or “upper field second”).
f2
f1
The following table shows the proper spatial field position for each of the common video
formats in Avid editing applications.
n In the following table, Odd Field or Even Field specifies whether the temporally first field in
the frame has the odd or even numbered lines, starting from 1.
Graphics utilities, such as Adobe After Effects, permit selection of either spatial relation for
the fields when rendering a sequence of interlaced fields. If the rendering is performed as
shown in the preceding table, then the import is correct.
If the spatial positions of the two fields are reversed (for example, the upper field should be a
lower field), the import cannot be done without correcting the spatial relationship. In this
spatial mismatch situation, Avid editing applications convert the upper field to a lower field
by deleting the top line of the upper field and replicating the bottom line. The field is thus
converted to a lower field relative to the other field. The import operation can now proceed.
n When exporting to DVD for TV playback, it is recommended to transcode any clips that do
not match the field ordering of the majority of the clips. Not doing this results in field
ordering being swapped during playback.
The default export operation is automatically carried out as shown in the preceding table.
The fields are properly interleaved in the export frames (one frame per file).
If an import comes in mismatched and the dropping of the top line and repeating of the
bottom line is performed, you might decide to have the export operation performed to
prevent a shift up or down by a line. The Export Settings dialog box permits you to select the
spatial arrangement that is the opposite of what is otherwise recommended. This option
should rarely be used.
753
Chapter 19 File Format Specifications
The spatial field selection options do not apply for 24p and 25p projects because the frames
in these projects are already in progressive or still-image form.
Field Dominance
Editing in Avid applications is frame based. All timecode is expressed in frame numbers,
and all cuts are at frame boundaries. A raw video stream has no concept of frames (ignoring
color framing) until the frame unit is defined. Defining the dominant field for the system
defines the “frameness” of the video stream, as shown in the following figure.
f2 f1 f2 f1 f2 (Time) f1 f2 f1 f2 f1
Field-1 Field-2
Dominant Dominant
Frame Frame
Avid editing applications all use field 1 as the dominant field. This means that the first field
temporally in the edit frame will always be field 1. Field 2 will always be the second frame
in the edit frame. Cuts will always precede field 1.
Fields in Video
In the video signal, fields have a temporal position that is unambiguously and uniquely tied
to the details of the video signal, regardless of whether the signal is analog or digital (SDI).
This means that working around a field spatial mismatch should be done by correcting the
spatial relation between the two fields rather than the temporal position. In some cases, it is
possible to modify the field dominance of the input image files, but this is cumbersome,
results in the loss of two fields, and is more difficult to carry out than either the workaround
provided in Avid editing applications or rerendering properly to the other spatial
relationship.
754
Chapter 20
Resolutions and Storage
Requirements
This section describes the different resolutions available in your Avid editing application and
lists their specifications. It also explains how to estimate the drive space you will require to
store your captured media. This section includes the following topics:
• Compression and Avid Editing Systems
• Monitor Display Resolutions
• Compression and Resolutions
• Storage Requirements
• Maximizing Drive Space
• Managing Storage to Improve Playback Performance
n The resolutions available in your Avid editing application depend on its model and options.
When an Avid editing application captures and stores video at a compressed resolution, it
employs compression techniques that affect the size of the resulting files and the resolution
of the images they contain. The less the data is compressed, the higher the image resolution,
and the more drive space the file requires.
Large media files at high resolutions can use very large amounts of drive space. When you
are choosing an image resolution for your project, you need to balance your requirements in
terms of image quality with your available drive resources.
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
You can use lower resolutions when your work does not require very high image quality (for
example, in offline work, or in CD-ROM or Web authoring projects), and higher resolutions
when you need excellent image quality. You can also mix different resolutions within the
same project as long as those resolutions are compatible with one another. See “Mixing
Resolutions” on page 766.
Avid editing applications also support the capture and storage of video that is not processed
by a data compression scheme:
• Uncompressed video (1:1) is available as standard definition (conforming to the ITU-R
601 standard) or as high definition (conforming to the ITU-R 292M standard). The
image quality of uncompressed video is very high, but uncompressed files require very
large amounts of drive space.
• DV (digital video) is a compressed media format. SMPTE standards specify how to take
601 video and convert it to a compressed format. When capturing through a 1394
connection, your Avid editing application records DV media in its native format, and
does not compress it further.
PAL JFIF (ITU-R 601) 720 x 576 non-square 16 lines of blanking or VITC
PAL 1:1 (Uncompressed) per frame (8 lines per field)
PAL MPEG IMX
756
Compression and Resolutions
n For more information on blanking or VITC, see “Preserving Information in the Vertical
Blanking Interval” on page 580.
n For information on resolutions to use when importing graphics or sequences from a third-
party application, see “Screen Resolution for Imported Graphics and Sequences” in the
Help.
Resolution Specifications
The following tables provide information about HD resolutions, Avid JFIF resolutions,
multicamera resolutions, DV resolutions, and MPEG resolutions:
• “Resolution Specifications: HD” on page 758
• “Resolution Specifications: JFIF Interlaced” on page 760
• “Resolution Specifications: JFIF Progressive” on page 762
• “Resolution Specifications: Multicam” on page 763
• “Resolution Specifications: Digital Video (DV)” on page 763
• “Resolution Specifications: MPEG” on page 764
For information on drive striping requirements for different resolutions, go to the Avid
online Knowledge Base at www.avid.com/onlinesupport and search for “Drive Striping
Tables.”
n The resolutions available on your Avid editing application might vary from this list,
depending on the model and the hardware used in your system.
757
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
Resolution Specifications: HD
Your Avid editing application includes support for the capture, editing, and output of high-
definition (HD) media in Avid DNxHD™ and DVCPRO HD resolutions. It also supports
play, edit, import, render, transcode, and export of high-definition (HD) media in 1:1
(uncompressed) resolution. See “Support for Uncompressed HD Media” on page 765.
The following table provides information about HD resolutions for interlaced and
progressive media. HD resolutions are available only in MXF format.
758
Compression and Resolutions
n The data rate (bandwidth) for Avid DNxHD resolutions is calculated per second for each
frame rate. For example, DNxHD 220 has a compressed data rate of 220 Mb/sec at 29.97
fps. DNxHD 185, which is an equivalent resolution, has a compressed data rate of
185 Mb/sec at 25 fps. For more information, see “Resolution Specifications: HD” on
page 758.
A good guideline for selecting a resolution is to use the Avid DNxHD resolution that
matches the megabit data rate of the acquisition format. For HDCAM-originated material,
for example, select DNxHD 145, which closely matches the data rate of HDCAM but
provides better mastering results with significantly less storage required. The following table
compares Avid HD formats to the HDCAM format.
759
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
Avid DNxHD 36 Avid DNxHD 145 Avid DNxHD 220 Sony HDCAM ™
Avid resolutions use a simple notation — x:1 — to identify the level of compression. The
value of x indicates the level of compression that is applied to the image data. For example, a
3:1 compression ratio compresses the original data to one-third of its uncompressed size.
A lower compression ratio (a lower number to the left of the colon) results in better image
quality but requires more drive space to store the captured media. A lower compression ratio
might also require drive striping to keep up with the high volume of data.
The following table provides information about the Avid resolutions for interlaced media
(30i NTSC and 25i PAL projects). Field size does not include blanking or VITC lines.
Fields
Field Size Per
Resolution (Visible Pixels) Frame Quality
760
Compression and Resolutions
Fields
Field Size Per
Resolution (Visible Pixels) Frame Quality
761
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
The following table provides information about the Avid resolutions for progressive media
(24p NTSC and 24p PAL projects). Frame size does not include blanking or VITC lines.
Frame Size
Resolution (Pixels) Quality
762
Compression and Resolutions
n In previous releases of the editing application with the Meridian hardware, m resolutions
were recommended for Multicam. With Adrenaline hardware, this is no longer the case. The
m resolutions remain for compatibility reasons, but are not recommended for use with the
current product.
DV, originally known as DVC (Digital Video Cassette), uses a 1/4-inch tape to record very
high quality digital video. The video is sampled at the same rate as D1, D5, or Digital
Betacam video (720 pixels per scan line). The color information in DV 25 is sampled at the
D1 rate of 4:1:1 in 525-line (NTSC) and 4:2:0 in 625-line (PAL) formats. DV 50 is defined
as 720 x 480, 50-megabit-per-second (Mb/s) 4:2:2 DV. DVCPRO HD is an HD format
(DVCPRO HD), which is available in both 720p and 1080i resolutions, at 100 Mb/sec.
763
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
The following table provides DV resolution specifications for Avid applications with the
DV/MPEG option or the HD option.
MPEG resolutions are resolutions specifically intended to support the SMPTE Type D-10 bit
stream produced and recorded by devices such as Sony MPEG IMX VTRs. It uses 4:2:2
sampling.
764
Compression and Resolutions
The following table provides MPEG resolution specifications for Avid editing applications
with the DV/MPEG option. Frame size does not include blanking or VITC lines.
765
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
Mixing Resolutions
In a single sequence, you can mix resolutions. However, you cannot mix the following:
• NTSC and PAL resolutions
• Media captured at different frame rates
c Avid recommends you do not mix interlaced resolutions with progressive resolutions.
Mixing interlaced resolutions with progressive resolutions might result in problems
with scrolling titles, exporting, and performing digital cuts.
n For information on resolutions to use when importing graphics or sequences from a third-
party application, see “Frame Size for Imported Graphics” in the Help.
Single-field resolutions work with smaller amounts of original image data than two-field or
progressive resolutions. They use only half the image width of two-field resolutions, and
they use only one of the two fields in the standard video signal.
For example, there is a 2:1 resolution for both single-field and two-field resolutions. In both
cases, the image data is compressed to one-half of its original size. However, the image
quality of these two resolutions is different. The single-field 2:1 resolution has lower image
quality because it processes only one-quarter of the original image data used by the two-field
2:1 resolution.
766
Storage Requirements
Storage Requirements
You should plan the use of drive volumes in advance, especially when you capture numerous
reels or tapes.
The information in the storage tables is approximate, so it’s a good idea to slightly
overestimate the amount of drive space you require.
767
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
Before using this table, read the information in “Estimating Drive Space Requirements” on
page 767.
This table does not include estimated storage requirements for audio.
768
Storage Requirements
769
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
Before using this table, read the information in “Estimating Drive Space Requirements” on
page 767.
770
Storage Requirements
771
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
772
Storage Requirements
Before using this table, read the information in “Estimating Drive Space Requirements” on
page 767.
773
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
774
Storage Requirements
775
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
The following table provides information to help you estimate the storage requirements for
DV media.
Before using this table, read the information in “Estimating Drive Space Requirements” on
page 767.
This table does not include estimated storage requirements for audio.
776
Maximizing Drive Space
The following table provides information to help you estimate the storage requirements for
MPEG media.
Before using this table, read the information in “Estimating Drive Space Requirements” on
page 767.
This table does not include estimated storage requirements for audio.
n For more information on batch capturing and recapturing, see “Batch Capturing from
Logged Clips” in the Help.
777
Chapter 20 Resolutions and Storage Requirements
778
Chapter 21
Working in a Film Project
This section presents suggested workflows and other information that can help you plan
your film-originated project. This chapter includes the following topics:
• Working with 24p Media
• Working with 25p Media
• Planning a 24p or 25p Project
• Planning a 23.976p NTSC Project
• Film Project Considerations
• Understanding the Film-to-Tape Transfer Process
• Transferring 24-fps Film to NTSC Video
• Transferring 24-fps Film to PAL Video
• How Avid Editing Applications Store and Display 24p and 25p Media
• Film-to-Tape Transfer Guidelines
• Film-to-Tape Transfer Options
For information about working with film source footage transferred to HD, see “Working
with HD Media” in the Help.
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
Progressive media is composed of single frames, each of which is vertically scanned as one
pass. Avid editing applications create 24p media by combining (deinterlacing) two video
fields into a single full, reconstructed frame. For NTSC film-to-tape transfers, Avid
applications creates 24p media by removing the extra fields inserted by the 2:3 pulldown
process and by creating progressive frames.
n For more information about the film-to-tape transfer process, see “Understanding the Film-
to-Tape Transfer Process” on page 808.
Working in 24p simplifies digital editing of film or other 24-fps-originated content, such as
HDTV video that has been downconverted to ITU-R 601 digital video. In addition, 24p
media requires less storage and processing power than 30-fps media. Because 24p provides a
common production format for multiversion, multiformat delivery, it promises to become
the new universal format for all film and video content.
For more information, see “How Avid Editing Applications Store and Display 24p and 25p
Media” on page 815.
780
Planning a 24p or 25p Project
The source for 25p is typically 25-fps film or 25-fps HDTV format. The methods for
creating and storing 25p media are the same as for 24p. For an example of a 25p project
workflow, see “25-fps Film or HD Video Source, SDTV Downconversion, Multiformat
Output” on page 790.
n You can capture the audio directly from the original Nagra reels or DAT tapes, and sync
within your Avid editing application. For more information, see “Audio Transfer Options for
24p PAL Projects” on page 794.
The following sections describe two possible workflows for 24p projects:
• “24-fps Film Source, SDTV Transfer, Multiformat Output” on page 782
• “24-fps Film or HD Video Source, SDTV Downconversion, Multiformat Output” on
page 786
For information about a typical 25p workflow, see “25-fps Film or HD Video Source, SDTV
Downconversion, Multiformat Output” on page 790.
For information about 24p PAL workflows, see “Audio Transfer Options for 24p PAL
Projects” on page 794.
781
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
For film productions that screen dailies, the paths might be somewhat different. For more
information, see “Viewing Dailies” on page 805.
For information about editing and outputting HD media, see “HDTV Workflows” on
page 823.
With this workflow, the sound recording is synchronized as part of the telecine transfer. For
alternative audio workflows, see “Audio Transfer Options for 24p PAL Projects” on
page 794.
For details on the telecine transfer process, see “Film-to-Tape Transfer Guidelines” on
page 817.
For information about editing and outputting HD media, see “HDTV Workflows” on
page 823.
The following steps describe the offline stage of the workflow for 24-fps Film Source with
SDTV Transfer:
1. The telecine process uses one-light or best-light transfer and syncs picture and sound to
create ITU-R 601 video. The process adds 2:3 pulldown to film footage to create an
NTSC videotape, or uses 4.1% speedup for PAL videotape. The telecine process also
creates a shot log (for example, a FLEX file).
2. Convert the shot log file with Avid Log Exchange (ALE), then import the shot log file
into Media Composer or Film Composer to create a bin or bins.
3. Batch capture the footage in an offline resolution, based on the shot log. The Avid
system removes the 2:3 pulldown and creates 24p media.
4. Edit at 24 fps, apply Pan and Scan and other effects, and create a final sequence.
5. Create a floppy disk with project information for transfer to the Avid Symphony Nitris
online system. Create a 24p pull list for another telecine process, to retransfer footage
used in the final edit.
782
Planning a 24p or 25p Project
Nagra or DAT
playback system
DAT
Film shot
Sound at 24 fps
recording
(Nagra or Telecine controller
DAT) and record deck
(Step 1)
Media Composer
or Film Composer
offline system
(Step 4)
Pull list
(Step 5)
Proj
783
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
The following steps describe the online stage of the workflow for 24-fps Film Source with
SDTV Transfer:
6. The telecine process uses the pull list and a full color-corrected transfer to create NTSC
or PAL videotape with selects from the original negative (picture only). The process also
creates a new shot log file.
7. Copy the project information from the floppy disk to the
Symphony Nitris online system.
8. Convert the new shot log with ALE and import it into the
Symphony Nitris system.
9. Batch capture in an online resolution, based on the new shot log file.
10. Relink the sequence and clips by key numbers (FTFT) and
complete any other
finishing.
11. Generate multiple formats. For NTSC and PAL, the system reinserts the pulldown or re-
creates the speedup. For conforming film, it creates a 24p cut list.
784
Planning a 24p or 25p Project
Pull list
Film shot
at 24 fps
From the
offline
(Step 7)
system
Avid
Symphony
(Step 10) Nitris
system
Cut list
(Step 11) Beta- or Beta- or
cam cam
Conformed
film cut
785
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
“Offline Workflow: 24-fps Film Source, SDTV Transfer” on page 783 shows the offline
stage of the workflow, using a Media Composer or Film Composer system. “Online
Workflow: 24-fps Film Source, SDTV Transfer, Multiformat Output” on page 785 shows the
online stage, using a Avid Symphony Nitris system with Universal Mastering and multiple
output formats.
With this workflow, the sound recording is synchronized as part of the telecine transfer. For
alternative audio workflows, see “Audio Transfer Options for 24p PAL Projects” on
page 794.
For details on the telecine transfer process, see “Film-to-Tape Transfer Guidelines” on
page 817.
For information about editing and outputting HD media, see “HDTV Workflows” on
page 823.
The following steps describe the offline stage of film or video footage shot at 24 fps and
planned for HDTV:
1. Source videotape comes either from a telecine transfer or a 24-fps video camera. The
telecine process transfers 24-fps film footage at 1:1 (no pulldown). It also creates a shot
log (for example, a FLEX file).
2. For telecine transfer projects, convert the shot log file with ALE and import it into
Media Composer or Film Composer to create a bin or bins.
3. Batch capture the footage in an offline resolution, based on the shot log. Use a 24p deck
to downconvert HDTV to ITU-R 601 video. The deck adds 2:3 pulldown (NTSC) or
4.1% speedup (PAL). The Avid system removes the extra pulldown fields and creates
24p media.
4. Edit at 24 fps, apply Pan and Scan or other effects, and create a final sequence.
5. Create a 24p pull list for another telecine process, to retransfer footage used in the final
edit. Create a floppy disk with project information for transfer to the Avid Symphony
Nitris online system
786
Planning a 24p or 25p Project
Nagra or DAT
playback system
DAT
Film shot
Sound at 24 fps
recording
Telecine controller
(Nagra or
and record deck
DAT)
HD 24
(Step 1)
Video shot by
1:1 transfer
24-fps camera
(Step 2) 24-fps HD
HD 24
Log format
Media Composer
or Film Composer
offline system
(Step 4)
Pull list
(Step 5)
Proj
787
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
The following steps describe the online stage of film or video footage shot at 24 fps and
planned for HDTV:
6. For film-originated projects, the telecine process uses the pull list and full
color-corrected transfer to create HDTV videotape with selects from the original
negative (picture only). The process also creates a new shot log file.
7. Copy the project information to the Symphony Nitris online system.
8. For telecine transfer projects, convert the new shot log file with ALE and import it into
the Symphony Nitris system.
9. Batch capture in an online resolution, based on the new shot log file. Downconvert
either the telecine transfer tape or HDTV source tape.
10. Relink the sequence and clips by key numbers (FTFT) and
complete any other finishing.
11. Generate multiple formats for output. For NTSC and PAL, the Avid Symphony Nitris
system reinserts pulldown or re-creates the speedup. For conforming film, it creates a
24p cut list. For HDTV, it creates a 24p EDL for use in an online suite.
788
Planning a 24p or 25p Project
Pull list
Film shot
at 24 fps
From the
(Step 7) offline
system
HD 24
HD 24
Proj
Video shot by
(Step 8) Log 24-fps camera
(Step 9)
Avid
Symphony
Nitris
system
(Step 10)
Conformed HD
film cut
Conformed
HDTV master
789
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
“Offline Workflow: 25-fps Film or HDTV Source, SDTV Downconversion” on page 791
shows the offline stage of the workflow, using a Media Composer or Film Composer system.
“Online Workflow: 25-fps Film or HDTV Source, SDTV Downconversion, Multiformat
Output” on page 793 shows the online stage, using a Symphony Nitris system with
Universal Mastering and multiple output formats.
With this workflow, the sound recording is synchronized as part of the telecine transfer. For
more information about capturing and synchronizing audio, see “Audio Transfer Options for
24p PAL Projects” on page 794.
n For NTSC output this method slows the audio by 4 percent. If you plan to output to both
NTSC and PAL, you might want to shoot at 24 fps and use 24p instead of 25p.
For details on the telecine transfer process, see “Film-to-Tape Transfer Guidelines” on
page 817.
For information about editing and outputting HD media, see “HDTV Workflows” on
page 823.
The following steps describe the offline stage of film or video footage shot at 25 fps and
planned for HDTV:
1. Source videotape comes either from a telecine transfer or a 25-fps video camera. The
telecine process transfers 25-fps film footage at 1:1 (no pulldown). It also creates a shot
log (for example, a FLEX file).
2. For telecine transfer projects, convert the shot log file with ALE and import it into
Media Composer or Film Composer to create a bin or bins.
3. Batch capture the footage in an offline resolution, based on the shot log. Use a 25p deck
to downconvert HDTV to ITU-R 601 video. The deck does not need to add pulldown or
speed up the audio since the footage will remain at 25 fps. The Avid system creates 25p
media.
4. Edit at 25 fps, apply Pan and Scan or other effects, and create a final sequence.
5. Create a 25p pull list for another telecine process, to retransfer footage used in the final
edit. Create a floppy disk with project information for transfer to the Symphony Nitris
online system.
790
Planning a 24p or 25p Project
Nagra or DAT
playback system
DAT
Film shot
Sound at 25 fps
recording
Telecine controller
(Nagra or
and record deck
DAT)
HD 25
(Step 1)
Video shot by
1:1 transfer
25-fps camera
(Step 2) 25-fps HD
HD 25
Log format
Media Composer
or Film Composer
offline system
(Step 4)
Pull list
(Step 5) Proj
791
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
The following steps describe the online stage of film or video footage shot at 25 fps and
planned for HDTV:
6. For film-originated projects, the telecine process uses the pull list and full
color-corrected transfer to create HDTV videotape with selects from the original
negative (picture only). The process also creates a new shot log file.
7. Copy the project information to the Avid Symphony Nitris system.
8. For telecine transfer projects, convert the new shot log file with ALE and import it into
the Symphony Nitris system.
9. Batch capture in an online resolution, based on the new shot log file. Downconvert
either the telecine transfer tape or HDTV source tape.
10. Relink the sequence and clips by key numbers (FTFT) and
complete any other finishing.
11. Generate multiple formats for output. For NTSC, the system inserts 2:3 pulldown and
slows down the audio by 4%. No adjustment is needed for PAL. For film, it creates a
25p cut list. For HDTV, it creates a 25p EDL for use in an online suite
792
Planning a 24p or 25p Project
Pull list
Film shot
at 25 fps
From the
(Step 7) offline
system
HD 25
HD 25
Proj
Video shot by
(Step 8) Log 25-fps camera
(Step 9)
Avid
Symphony
Nitris
online
(Step 10) system
Conformed HD
film cut
Conformed
HDTV master
793
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
n The Audio Transfer options are also located in the Film and 24p Settings dialog box and can
be changed after the project is created. See “Settings for Film and 24p Projects” on
page 140.
n The Info tab in the Project window allows you to view the audio transfer rate you selected
when you created the project. The actual audio transfer rate might be different from the
display if you used the Film and 24p Settings dialog box to change the audio transfer rate.
794
Planning a 23.976p NTSC Project
• Your audio and video sources have been shot at a camera rate of 23.976 fps. This rate is
used for film (film-based television) or 24p HD video (television or feature film). These
sources can be downconverted to standard NTSC without further audio slowdown.
Audio recorded at 48 kHz can remain at 48 kHz throughout the project.
• This rate is also used for film (film-based television) or 24p HD video (television or
feature film). These sources can be downconverted to standard NTSC without further
audio slowdown. Audio recorded at 48 kHz can remain at 48 kHz throughout the
project.
n The 23.976 fps frame rate is sometimes referred to as 23.97 fps or 23.98 fps.
n The 23.976 fps frame rate is in direct proportion to the NTSC broadcast frame rate of 29.97
fps, which is used for film-to-tape transfer to the Avid editing system. For more information,
see “Transferring 24-fps Film to NTSC Video” on page 808.
The Edit Play Rate and Audio Source Tape TC Rate options do not appear in the Film and
24p Settings dialog box. Edit Play Rate is automatically set at 23.976 fps. The Audio Source
Tape TC Rate does not apply to 23.976p projects because you cannot capture 30 fps audio in
a 23.976p project.
795
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
Capturing
Audio from digital videotapes can be directly input and output through the AES/EBU
connections on the Avid Adrenaline.
The pulldown indicator on the Avid Adrenaline never lights when working in a 23.976p
project.
The pulldown switch in the Capture tool is not used and does not appear.
Bins
Import
All output play rates are available, but only 23.976 NTSC maintains the original audio
quality. For 23.976 NTSC, the audio rate is not slowed down for output and remains at 48
kHz. For 29.97 NTSC, the audio rate is sped up 25 percent and is not usable. Use this output
rate for animations and other special applications. 24 fps NTSC, 24 fps PAL, and 25 fps PAL
all require a sample-rate conversion, so high-quality audio is not guaranteed. For more
information about output audio rates, see “Selecting Output Formats for 23.976p, 24p, and
25p Projects” on page 568.
With this workflow, the sound recording is synchronized as part of the telecine transfer. For
a workflow in which video and audio are captured separately, see “NTSC Audio and Video
Captured Separately (23,976p Project)” on page 802.
796
Planning a 23.976p NTSC Project
For details on the telecine transfer process, see “Film-to-Tape Transfer Guidelines” on
page 817.
The following steps describe the offline stage of film transferred at 23.976 or video footage
shot at 23.976 fps and planned for HDTV.
1. Source videotape comes either from a telecine transfer or video shot at 23.976. The
telecine process syncs audio and transfers film footage at 1:1 (no pulldown). It also
creates a shot log.
2. For telecine transfer projects, convert the shot log file with ALE and import it into
Media Composer or Film Composer to create a bin or bins.
3. Batch capture the footage in an offline resolution. Use a 24p deck to downconvert
HDTV to ITU-R 601 video. The deck adds 2:3 pulldown for video but maintains audio
at 48 kHz. The Avid system removes the extra video pulldown fields, maintains audio at
48 kHz, and creates 23.976p media.
4. Edit at 23.976 fps, apply Pan and Scan or other effects, and create a final sequence.
5. For film, create a pull list for another telecine process, to retransfer footage used in the
final edit. Create a floppy disk with project information for transfer to the Symphony
Nitris online system.
797
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
Nagra or DAT
playback system
DAT
Film shot
Sound at 24 fps or
recording 23.976 fps
Telecine controller
(Nagra or
and record deck
DAT)
(Step 1) 23.976
Media Composer
or Film Composer
offline system
(Step 4)
Pull list
(Step 5)
Proj
798
Planning a 23.976p NTSC Project
The following steps describe the online stage of film transferred at 23.976 or video footage
shot at 23.976 fps and planned for HDTV.
6. For film-originated projects, the telecine process uses the pull list and full color-
corrected transfer to create videotape with selects from the original negative (picture
only). The process also creates a new shot log file.
7. Copy the project information to the Symphony Nitris online system.
8. For telecine transfer projects, convert the new shot log file with ALE and import it into
the Symphony Nitris system.
9. Batch capture in an online resolution, based on the new shot log file. Downconvert
either the telecine transfer tape or HDTV source tape.
10. For film, relink the sequence and clips by key numbers and
complete any other finishing.
11. Generate multiple formats for output. For NTSC video, the Symphony Nitris system
reinserts pulldown. For conforming film, it creates a 24p cut list. For HDTV, it creates a
24p EDL for use in an online suite.
799
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
Pull list
Film shot at
24 fps or
23.976 fps
From the
(Step 7) offline
system
23.976
23.976
Proj
Video shot at
(Step 8) Log 23.976 fps
(Step 9)
Avid
Symphony
Nitris
online
(Step 10) system
Conformed HD
film cut
Conformed
HDTV master
800
Planning a 23.976p NTSC Project
The following steps describe the online stage of NTSC audio and video captured separately
(23,976p project) illustrates a workflow in which you capture audio and video separately,
and then synchronize them in the Avid system.
801
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
p (p y)
.
(Step 1)
Film shot at
24 fps or
23.976 fps
DAT
24p HD VTR
such as an HDW-
(Step 3) F500 VTR
Avid video
editing
system
(Step 4)
802
Planning a 23.976p NTSC Project
c Because of the way project information is stored, previous versions of Avid editing
systems do not recognize 23.976p projects as being different from 24p projects. You can
open 23.976p projects in previous versions, however, none of the media can play
because of the different internal edit rates. Projects are not corrupted by opening them
in older versions of the software (unless you try to modify clips or edit sequences). If
necessary, you can recapture the media in the 24p project.
803
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
35mm: 2, 3, 4, and 8 perf 16mm, 35mm 4 perf, and 35mm 3 perf are
supported as projects in the Avid system. The
65mm: 5, 8, 10, and 15 perf
remaining formats are supported through ink
numbers and auxiliary ink numbers, which you
select in the Film and 24p Settings dialog box.
For more information, see “Film and 24P
Settings” on page 687.
Film wind B-wind Always use camera rolls with key numbers in
ascending order.
Audio timecodes 30-fps drop-frame or non-drop-frame Use for NTSC transfer projects, and for
generating audio EDLs.
Audio sync to in-camera timecode Use for automatic syncing of sound with
(Arri® 24-fps timecode) picture in the Avid system.
In-camera timecode, with audio sync Use for automatic, “slateless” syncing in the
telecine.
804
Film Project Considerations
Slate information Camera roll, scene and take, shoot Mark sound-roll ID as a backup.
date, sound-roll ID
Sound-roll cues Sound-roll ID, date, start and end Include verbal time-of-day cues as a backup.
time-of-day timecode
Viewing Dailies
Viewing dailies is a critical part of the film production process. With an Avid system, there
are two different ways to produce dailies.
• The film dailies method relies on work print for screening, transferring, and creating
conformed cuts during editing.
• The video dailies method relies on videotape transfers from negative for screening,
transferring, and creating conformed cuts during editing.
The film dailies method involves the procedures shown in “Film Dailies Method” on
page 806. Specifics, such as tape formats, vary depending on facilities and needs.
When you work with film dailies and work print, the advantages are:
• You can screen the dailies immediately after the lab work.
• You can use work print previews to view the full film aspect ratios, resolutions, and
contrast ranges. For this reason, film dailies are often preferred for feature film projects.
805
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
The disadvantage is that the magnetic track and work print require additional facilities,
procedures, and costs.
(Step 3)
Screening
Telecine
(Step 5)
Beta-
cam
Transfer
Conformed cut
The video dailies method involves the procedures shown in “Video Dailies Method” on
page 807. Specifics, such as tape formats, vary depending on facilities and needs.
806
Film Project Considerations
4. Import existing key numbers and timecode information into the Avid system, then
capture.
5. Edit using the Avid system.
6. Record a digital cut to preview the sequence with effects, or generate EDLs for editing
the videotape transfers. Alternatively, generate a matchback list of selects for printing
selects and conforming negative
....................
.................... Nagra or DAT
Negative playback system
Assembled
(Steps 1 and 2) takes
Telecine controller
and record deck
Sound
recording
1”
Screening Beta-
(Step 3) cam
Transfer
Transfer
(Steps 4 and 5)
(Step 6)
Cut list
Beta-
1”
cam EDL
The advantage of working with video dailies and film negative is that you can avoid the cost
of work print until the finishing stages, or altogether. The disadvantage is you are limited to
the aspect ratio, resolution, and contrast range of video previews. For this reason, video
dailies are preferred for television projects, but you can also use this method to economize
on a feature film production.
807
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
After you’ve decided on a telecine facility and have supplied your requirements, see “Film-
to-Tape Transfer Guidelines” on page 817 and “Film-to-Tape Transfer Options” on
page 818, the telecine facility performs the film-to-tape transfer. The steps in the process
differ, depending on whether you include audio and whether the transfer produces NTSC or
PAL videotapes. The following topics describe these steps.
The following illustration shows a simplified view of the NTSC film-to-video transfer
process. For information about this workflow, see “Planning a 24p or 25p Project” on
page 781.
Telecine
2:3 pulldown Capture and reverse
23.976 fps pulldown to 24 fps.
Beta-
cam
Stage 1 Stage 2
Betacam or
Film shot at 24 fps Digital Betacam
video signal 29.97 fps Avid editing system at 24 fps
808
Transferring 24-fps Film to NTSC Video
To understand how the telecine transfers film to videotape, you need to understand the
relationship between frames and fields.
An NTSC video image consists of 525 horizontal lines of information. The electron gun on a
video monitor displays the odd-numbered lines first and then the even-numbered lines. Each
full scan of odd-numbered or even-numbered lines constitutes a field. At 30 fps, each field
takes 1/60th of a second to display; therefore, an entire frame of two fields is scanned each
1/30th of a second. The combination of these two fields (odd and even) is called interlacing.
A film frame, in contrast, is one full picture; it has no fields. The telecine process takes each
film frame and creates a two-field video frame.
Film runs at 24 fps, and NTSC video runs at 30 fps. The difference in frame rates between
film and video prevents a direct frame-to-frame transfer.
To compensate, the telecine process creates an extra six frames every second (the difference
between 24 and 30). That is, it creates five video frames for every four film frames. But
remember, each video frame is subdivided into two video fields. To be more precise, the
telecine creates ten video fields (the equivalent of five video frames) for every four film
frames. This is referred to as a 4:5 ratio. The following table states this relationship between
film and video.
Film Video
24 fps 30 fps
The telecine uses a method known as pulldown to create the extra frames. As each film
frame moves through the telecine projector, it is held in place (pulled down) while a specific
number of fields are recorded on videotape. To transfer four film frames to ten video fields,
the telecine process alternates between creating two and three video fields per film frame
809
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
(referred to as 2:3 pulldown). To transfer four film frames to ten video fields, the telecine
pulls down the first film frame and records two video fields, pulls down the second film
frame and records three video fields, and repeats the process.
The four frames in each series are referred to as A, B, C, and D. The standard method for
identifying the resulting fields is to label them as A1, A2, B1, B2, and so forth. The
following diagram illustrates the 2:3 pulldown process.
A1 odd
A even
A2
Timecode change
B1 odd
B2 even
B Timecode change
B3 odd
C1 even
Timecode change
C C2 odd
D1 even
Timecode change
D D2 odd
D3 even
The telecine alternates between capturing odd-numbered and even-numbered fields. For
example, B1 and B3 both contain the odd-numbered scan lines of the B film frame. Later in
the transfer process, when the Avid editing application captures the fields, it must capture an
odd-numbered and an even-numbered field for each frame.
When you view the resulting video, you get the impression that you are watching the video
at 24 fps even though it is playing at 30 fps (or more precisely, at 29.97 fps).
NTSC video, the broadcast standard used in the United States, Japan, and other countries,
plays at an actual rate of 29.97 fps, although it is usually referred to as 30 fps.
An accurate conversion requires exact adherence to the 4:5 ratio, but this ratio breaks down
when you compare 24 fps to 29.97 fps. To achieve a true 4:5 ratio, the film frame rate is
slowed down to 23.976 fps. The telecine process makes this correction automatically,
slowing NTSC video 0.1 percent from the original film speed, so that the video plays at
99.9 percent of its original speed.
810
Transferring 24-fps Film to NTSC Video
Film Video
24 fps 30 fps
In most cases, the sound for your production has been recorded on a digital audio system,
such as a DAT (digital audiotape), or ¼-inch tape system, such as a Nagra recorder. You
need to synchronize the sound with the picture and make sure they are in sync in your Avid
editing application. You can take one of three basic paths:
• Transfer the original sound recording to mag track, sync the mag track to the film work
print, and transfer both to videotape through a telecine process.
• Sync the original sound recordings to picture during the telecine process, and transfer
both to videotape.
• Transfer only the picture through the telecine process, capture picture and sound
separately, and sync them in the Avid editing application.
If the telecine transfers sound along with picture (one of the first two paths), the sound is
slowed by 0.1 percent to maintain sync with the picture. The reference signal slows from 60
Hz to 59.94 Hz and the rate at which the audio is recorded changes from 44100 Hz to
44056 Hz, or from 48000 Hz to 47952 Hz.
During the digitizing process, your Avid editing application reverses the pulldown procedure
to capture the film footage at 24 fps. It removes the extra fields added by the pulldown
process to create full-frame, 24p media. The capture process captures video and audio at the
slowed-down speed (0.999).
n To capture audio transferred at 29.97 fps (video rate) you must set the pulldown switch to
0.99 in the Capture tool. For more information, see “Setting the Pulldown Switch” in the
Help.
811
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
Four film frames Five NTSC video frames (ten fields) Four captured frames
A1 odd
A A
A2 even
B1 odd
B2 even B
B
B3 odd Skip this field.
C1 even
C C
C2 odd
D1 even
D D2 odd D
If you have transferred sound along with picture, your Avid editing application captures
audio at the slowed-down speed. Then during editing and playback, your application speeds
up the play rate by 0.1 percent to play in sync with the 24-fps video. Audio plays at 44100
Hz (44.1 kHz) or 48000 Hz (48 kHz).
Now you can edit the material at 24 fps in your Avid application. This approach ensures that
all your edits correspond to true film frames so you see an accurate representation of the
finished film.
812
Transferring 24-fps Film to PAL Video
The following illustration shows a simplified view of the PAL film-to-video transfer process.
For information about this workflow, see “Planning a 24p or 25p Project” on page 781.
Telecine
transfer with Capture
4.1% speedup Beta-
cam
Stage 1 Stage 2
Betacam or
Film shot at 24 fps Digital Betacam
video signal 25 fps Avid editing system at 24 fps
There are two approaches to synchronizing sound, which are often referred to as PAL
Method 1 and PAL Method 2.
PAL Method 1
With PAL Method 1, you synchronize sound with picture during the telecine process.
As with an NTSC film-to-tape transfer, the telecine process creates two video fields for each
film frame. However, because the film rate of 24 fps is close to the PAL video rate of 25 fps,
most PAL film-to-tape transfers involve simply speeding up the frame rate. This speedup
changes the frame rate from 24 to 25 (an increase of 4.1 percent). There is no pulldown that
creates extra fields.
n Some PAL film-to-tape transfers use pulldown. This method is not currently supported in
Avid editing applications.
With PAL Method 1, there are two ways to sync sound with picture in the telecine process:
• Transfer the original sound recording to mag track, sync the mag track to the film work
print, and transfer both to videotape through a telecine process.
• Sync the original sound recordings to picture during the telecine process, and transfer
both to videotape.
In either case, the telecine process speeds up sound at the same rate as picture: 4.1 percent.
813
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
After you’ve received the PAL transfer tapes, the next step is capturing the footage in a 24p
PAL project. During the capturing process, your Avid editing application captures the
material at the PAL rate of 25 fps, capturing every picture frame. It stores the two video
fields as a single progressive frame, which you edit at 24 fps.
n You must capture audio along with video at the PAL rate of 25 fps if you want to use audio
that was transferred along with picture during the telecine process. You set the Audio
Transfer rate as Video Rate (100+%) in the New Project dialog box. For more information,
see “Audio Transfer Options for 24p PAL Projects” on page 794.
You have the option of playing back the footage at 24 fps or 25 fps. If you select 24 fps, the
system slows both the picture and the sound by 4.1 percent for playback. This approach lets
you edit at the original film rate, but the slowdown creates a limitation for audio. Because
you capture the audio at a rate faster than playback, some audio samples are duplicated
during playback, and sound quality is compromised.
n Select the Edit Play Rate option in the Film and 24p Settings dialog box. For more
information, see “Film and 24P Settings” on page 687 and “Displaying Project Settings”
on page 615.
If you select 25 fps, there is a different limitation with audio. Because you are playing back
at the sped-up rate (4.1 percent), the audio pitch rises slightly. This is usually acceptable for
broadcast, so PAL Method 1 is primarily used for PAL television broadcast.
PAL Method 2
With PAL Method 2, you capture sound and picture separately.
With PAL Method 2, you use the same telecine process for picture (create a video frame of
two fields for each film frame, speed up rate by 4.1 percent). The difference is that you do
not synchronize sound as part of the telecine process.
n Some PAL film-to-tape transfers use pulldown. This method is not currently supported in
Avid editing applications.
814
How Avid Editing Applications Store and Display 24p and 25p Media
Now that you have your picture-only videotapes (at the rate of 25 fps) and your source
recording tapes, you need to follow a two-step process:
1. Capture the picture to create 24p media.
2. Capture the sound at the film rate of 24 fps.
n When you created the project, you set the Audio Transfer rate as Film Rate (100%) in the
New Project dialog box. For more information, see “Audio Transfer Options for 24p PAL
Projects” on page 794.
In most cases, you will choose to edit at 24 fps. The sound maintains source quality
(44.1 kHz and 48 kHz) and plays in sync with 24-fps video.
You typically use 25p media when capturing film or video shot at 25 fps. In this case, the
system also stores the media as a fully reconstructed, progressive frame. The difference is
that there is no need for pulldown fields because there is a 1:1 correspondence between the
source tape and the captured frames.
815
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
n Choose your preference for playback in the Film and 24p Settings dialog box. For more
information, see “Displaying Project Settings” on page 615.
For more information, see “Selecting Output and Timecode Formats for 23.976p, 24p, and
25p Projects” on page 568.
816
Film-to-Tape Transfer Guidelines
n Do not mix 24-fps and 30-fps transfers on the same transfer tape.
- For PAL projects, you cannot mix audio that has been transferred at 4.1 percent
speedup (PAL Method 1) with audio that has not been sped up (PAL Method 2).
n PAL film-to-tape transfers that use pulldown are not currently supported in Avid editing
applications.
817
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
Transfer Quality
The quality of the film-to-tape transfers depends upon several options for the telecine
transfer. The transfer-quality options available from a telecine facility include:
• One-light: This transfer involves a single setting of color correction values, resulting in
the simplest, fastest, and least-costly type of transfer. One-light transfers are often used
during offline stages of editing.
• Best-light: This transfer involves optimum settings of the color-grade controls, but
without scene-by-scene color correction. Best-light transfers are an intermediate level in
terms of both quality and cost.
• Timed (scene-by-scene): This transfer involves color correcting each scene or shot
during transfer. Timed transfers are the most expensive and time consuming. This option
sets up the proper black and white levels so that you can perform a tape-to-tape color
correction from the source tapes, if needed.
You can use the film-tape-film-tape feature to perform two separate telecine processes for a
project:
• Perform a one-light or best-light transfer to obtain the most material for the initial edits.
• After editing is complete, perform a timed, fully color-corrected transfer of the clips that
will be used in the final cut.
n For more information on the film-tape-film-tape option, see “Relinking Clips by Key
Number” on page 177.
After you perform the final telecine operation, you can capture at a finishing resolution, such
as 1:1 (uncompressed).
818
Film-to-Tape Transfer Options
c Burn-in code cannot be removed from the image and should be used only for the offline
stage of a project.
• 16:9 wide-screen format: Your Avid editing application supports the 16:9 wide-screen
display format. You can either shoot your footage by using a 16:9 lens, or transfer the
footage anamorphically to display a larger area of the film aspect ratio during offline
and online editing. Also, this aspect ratio lets you create media that takes advantage of
new 16:9 monitors that conform to SDTV and HDTV standards.
819
Chapter 21 Working in a Film Project
820
Chapter 22
Working with HD Media
Avid editing applications include support for capture, editing, and output of high-definition
(HD) media in the following resolutions:
• Avid DNxHD (8-bit and 10-bit)
• DVCPRO HD
• HDV
Avid editing applications also support play, edit, import, render, transcode, and export of
high-definition (HD) media in 1:1 (uncompressed) resolution. For more information, see
“Support for Uncompressed HD Media” on page 765.
Avid editing applications capture and process DVCPRO HD media and HDV media in its
native format, through a 1394 port on your computer or through the 1394 port on an Avid
Mojo SDI.
n On a Windows system with an Avid Adrenaline or an Avid Mojo, the 1394 port must be on an
optional IEEE-1394 card installed on a bus separate from the one used by the
Avid Adrenaline or Avid Mojo.
The following sections describe the features and options that let you capture, edit, and output
HD media:
• High-Definition Television
• HDTV Workflows
• Editing in HD
• Working with HDV
821
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
High-Definition Television
High-definition television (HDTV) is a digital broadcasting technology that delivers a larger,
clearer, more detailed picture than standard definition television (SDTV). HDTV refers to
specific digital television (DTV) formats that have been standardized by the Advanced
Television Systems Committee (ATSC) and adopted by the United States Federal
Communications Commission (FCC). HDTV for PAL has been standardized by the Digital
Video Broadcasting (DVB) consortium.
For a table that lists the HDTV digital formats and resolutions that are supported in your
Avid application, see “Resolution Specifications: HD” on page 758.
HDTV uses a 16:9 aspect ratio in place of the standard definition 4:3 ratio. The following
illustration compares the pixel size of the most common HD formats — 720p and 1080i —
to that of the digital version of standard definition NTSC media (ITU-R 601). Both 1080i
and 720p formats fill the 16x9 screen on HD television sets.
1920 pixels
1080i HD
1280 pixels
1080 lines
720p HD
720 lines
720pixels
486 lines
NTSC SD
For more information about HD technology, see the Avid HD Handbook: An A to Z Guide,
which is available on the Avid web site, www.avid.com.
822
HDTV Workflows
HDTV Workflows
This section describes three common workflows for creating HDTV output:
• Creation of film-based television programs
• Creation of video-based television programs
• Creation of video graphics for broadcast
For a more detailed description of the conform workflow, see “Conforming Workflow” in
the Help.
For PAL broadcast, transfer film at 1080p/25, edit offline in a 25p PAL project, and edit
online in a 1080p/25 project.
“Offline Workflow: 24-fps Film Source for HDTV” on page 825 shows the offline stage of
the workflow for such programs, and “Online Workflow: 24-fps Film Source for HDTV” on
page 826 shows the online stage.
For a more detailed description of the conform workflow, see “Conforming Workflow” in
the Help.
823
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
824
HDTV Workflows
DAT
DAT playback system
Sound
recording Film shot
(DAT) at 24 fps
Telecine controller
1 and record deck
1:1 transfer
Log file 1080p/23.976
1080p HD format
HD VTR
33
Avid offline system
23.976p project
4
Pull list
OMFI or
AAF file
6
825
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
8 Pull list
1:1 transfer
1080p 1080p/23.976
Assembled
Log file HD format
reel at 24 fps
9
24p HD VTR
310
11
Avid online
12 OMFI or system
AAF file
13
14
1080p/23.976
15 1080p HD master
826
HDTV Workflows
The workflow for creating such programs uses a single system for offline and online editing,
but you can adapt it to use one system for offline editing and another for online editing. This
workflow uses features that let you change the project and sequence format, eliminating the
need to create a new project and sequence. Modifying the format of the sequence lets you
keep both offline SD material and online HD material available in the same project.
You can use this workflow for video footage shot at 720p/23.976, 720p/59.94 or
1080p/29.97. In these cases, however, you cannot simply change the project format (step 6).
Instead, you need to create a new project that matches the source footage, open the bin or
bins from the NTSC 30i project, change the sequence format, decompose, and batch capture.
For a more detailed description of the conform workflow, see “Conforming Workflow” in
the Help.
827
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
1080i/59.94
1080i HD format
2 HD VTR
30i NTSC
30i SD format
Avid editing
33 system
4
OMFI
5 or AAF
6
file
7
8 OMFI
or AAF
9
file
Pro Tools system
1080i/59.94
10 1080i HD master
828
HDTV Workflows
Graphics
1
workstation
Files created
2
for 720p or
5 1080i
Avid editing
system
33
4 720p or 1080i
720p/59.94 1080i/59.94
broadcast master broadcast master
829
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
Editing in HD
The following sections describe features that are specific to HD projects.
This feature is especially useful if you are working with downconverted HD material in an
offline-to-online workflow, see “Video-Based Television Workflow” on page 827. Each HD
format has an equivalent SD format that you can use for offline editing, as shown in the
following table.
720p/23.976 23.976p NTSC You cannot change between these project formats
because the edit rates are different. See “Converting
a 23.976p NTSC Sequence to 720p/23.976” on
page 834.
720p/50 25p PAL You cannot change between these project formats
because the edit rates are different.
720p/59.94 30i NTSC You cannot change between these project formats
because the edit rates are different, see “Editing at
60 fps” on page 836. Use an NTSC 30i project for
offline editing, then open a new 720p/59.94 project
for online editing. Open the desired NTSC 30i bins
and modify the final sequence, as described in
“Modifying the Format of a Sequence” on page 832.
1080p/23.976 23.976p NTSC For 23.976p NTSC, change the project format and
modify the sequence.
830
Editing in HD
1080p/24 24p NTSC or 24p Change the project format and modify the sequence.
PAL
1080p/25 25p PAL Change the project format and modify the sequence.
1080p/29.97 30i NTSC You cannot change between these project formats
because the edit rates are different. Use an NTSC
30i project for offline editing, then open a new
1080p/29.97 project for online editing and open the
desired NTSC 30i bins. You do not need to modify
the sequence. Duplicate the sequence. Then batch
capture the duplicated sequence or decompose and
batch capture.
1080i/50 25i PAL Change the project format and modify the sequence.
1080i/59.94 30i NTSC Change the project format and modify the sequence.
Another use for this feature is if you are working in an HD project and need to capture SD
material. In an HD project, you can capture only HD material, and in an SD project, you can
capture only SD material. Temporarily changing from an HD project to an SD project gives
you access to the SD compressions. You can capture the material you need, then change
back to the HD project and work with both SD and HD clips, see “Mixing SD and HD” on
page 835.
n You can select only projects with the same edit rate.
When you change the project format, the following changes take place:
• The hardware changes to support input and output for the new project.
• The available resolutions change to those of the new project.
• Any new sequences you create use the format of the new project.
If necessary, you can then modify the format of an existing sequence, see “Modifying the
Format of a Sequence” on page 832.
831
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
The choice of formats is limited to compatible frame rates of the sequence. For example, you
can change an NTSC 30i sequence to 1080i/59.94 or to 720p/59.94, but not to
1080p/23.976.
In some cases, where the timecode format needs to be changed, your Avid application
creates a new, modified sequence. Media for this new sequence is offline. In other cases,
where the timecode format does not need to be changed, the application modifies the
existing sequence and media stays online.
You can check the format of the sequence in the Format column of the bin. (For instructions
on adding a column to a bin, see “Displaying Formats in a Bin” on page 836.)
New 720p
sequence
Modified 1080i
sequence
832
Editing in HD
The following table shows the choices you have for modifying sequences and how each type
of sequence is modified.
To modify the format of clips not used in the sequence, create a sequence of the selected
clips and then modify the sequence. One way to create a sequence of clips is to select the
clips, hold down the Alt key, and select Bin > AutoSequence. See “Using the AutoSequence
Command” on page 349.
833
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
834
Editing in HD
Mixing SD and HD
You can mix SD and HD material in the same project. You can even mix SD and HD
material in the same Timeline if the edit rates match. For example, you can edit both NTSC
30i and 1080i/59.94 into the same sequence and then play the sequence in real time. This
feature is useful if you want to preview SD material in an HD project. For more information,
see “Mixing Resolutions” on page 766.
• In an HD sequence, an SD image is stretched to fill a 16:9 monitor.
• In an SD sequence, an HD image is anamorphically squeezed to fit the 4:3 monitor.
You cannot output a sequence that mixes SD and HD material. To output a mixed sequence
as HD, you need to transcode the clips that use the unsupported resolution to an HD
resolution, see “Transcoding HD Media” on page 837. All master clips then share the same
format.
You might also need to apply an effect, such as Reformat or Resize, in which case you need
to render the effects. This process creates new media in the format of the sequence.
You can set an option to highlight clips that do not match the project format. See
“Highlighting Clips in a Mixed-Format Timeline” in the Help.
n If you have a sequence that mixes SD and HD clips, and you need to recapture the SD clips
in an HD resolution, you can create a subsequence of the SD clips, modify the format of the
subsequence, see “Modifying the Format of a Sequence” on page 832, decompose, and
recapture.
835
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
Format column
For information on displaying a column, see “Manipulating Bin Columns” on page 223.
Editing at 60 fps
The project type 720p/59.94 uses a screen resolution of 1280 x 720 at a frame rate of
60 frames per second. Editing at 60 fps is similar to editing at 24 fps because both
resolutions are progressive — they use full frames instead of interlaced fields. Note the
following:
• Single-frame step commands move at 1/60th of a second. Single-field step commands
are deactivated; if you click a button, the application beeps.
• Draft Quality plays back at 30 fps. Full Quality plays back at 60 fps.
• You can mark IN and OUT points at 1/60th of a second increments.
• You can trim at 1/60th of a second increments.
• Transition effects default to one-second duration (60 frames).
• Deck control for capture and digital cut is limited to 30 fps. A message box warns you if
you try to mark an odd timecode value (such as 01:00:00:03).
n 1080i/50 and 1080i/59.94 are interlaced resolutions that you edit at 25 frames per second
and 30 frames per second.
836
Editing in HD
Transcoding HD Media
For HD projects, the Consolidate/Transcode dialog box lists compatible HD resolutions. For
resolution information, see “Resolution Specifications: HD” on page 758.For information on
transcoding media, see “Using the Transcode Command” in the Help.
9. (Option) Select the Delete Original Media option if you want the system to delete the
original media automatically after the conversion process is complete.
10. (Option) Click the Target Drive menu and select a drive for the new media files different
from the drive setting in the Audio Project settings. For more information on Audio
Project settings, see “Understanding Audio Project Settings” on page 118.
Make sure that you choose a target drive with enough storage space for the generated
media files and the ability to play back media.
11. Click OK.
837
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
n YCbCr and YPbPr refer to the same color space. Avid editing systems use YPbPr to
designate HD analog output, both in the Video Output tool and on the back of the Avid
Adrenaline hardware. The HD tab of the Video Output tool provides sliders to adjust the
YPbPr analog output through the YPbPr connectors on the back of the Avid Adrenaline.
You can capture from an HDV device, edit in native HDV, and export to an HDV device
using these project types.
You can also use HDV in other project types, but Avid editing applications are more efficient
and perform better with the dedicated HDV project types. The other project types you can
use include:
• 1080i/59.94
• 1080i/50
• PAL 25i
• NTSC 30i
n You cannot capture or export native HDV in the non-HDV project types.
838
Working with HDV
Understanding HDV
HDV is a low-cost prosumer format that allows you to record HD video onto standard DV
videocassettes. This is achieved through the use of interframe compression, where a given
frame in the video stream can be composed of information from adjacent frames. Frames are
grouped into a sequence called a “Group of Pictures,” or GOP. Long-GOP (also known as
IPB encoding) refers to the structure of HDV media.
The Avid editing application uses a technique called long-GOP splicing when encoding an
HDV MPEG-2 sequence for export. For more information, see “Long-GOP Splicing for
HDV Encoding” on page 843.
HDV uses MPEG-2 video encoding and MPEG-1 audio encoding. 1080i records at about
25Mbps and 720p records at about 19Mbps. Sony provides HDV cameras that record at
1080i/59.94 and 1080i/50. JVC® cameras record at 720p/29.97 and 720p/23.976.
In the 1080i formats, the data rate of the video is reduced before compression by
horizontally resizing the video display (raster) from 1920 x 1080 pixels to 1440 x 1080
pixels. In contrast, 720p HDV uses the standard raster size of 1280 x 720. A special
resolution, DNxHD-TR (for Thin Raster), improves the performance of 1080i HDV editing.
This resolution matches the 1080i HDV raster size, reducing artifacts that would come from
repeated compressions when rendering effects and graphics.
839
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
You can also export the file in other formats or use Windows Media 9 for export to a
third-party HD-DVD authoring system, See “Exporting HDV as Windows Media” on
page 846.
For information on transferring and conforming HDV sequences on Symphony Nitris, see
“Conforming an HDV Sequence on Symphony Nitris” in the Help.
You can import an HDV transport stream file (.m2t). Transport streams combine video and
audio for transmission through an IEEE-1394 port. Your Avid editing application separates
the transport stream after import or capture into the video and audio for editing.
After import or capture, the master clips in the Avid editing application contain HDV long-
GOP MPEG-2 video in MXF format and 2 channels of uncompressed 48 kHz 16-bit audio.
840
Working with HDV
Capturing HDV
For more information, see “Capturing DV Media Directly from a DV Device” in the Help.
The Sony 1080i HDV cameras mark accurate timecode and can be used for batch capturing.
The JVC 720p/29.97 HDV camera restarts timecode every time the system starts to capture.
You cannot batch capture HDV material with a JVC 720p/29.97 HDV camera.
Importing HDV
To import HDV media, you must import an HDV transport stream. You cannot import
transport stream types other than HDV.
n The file name extension .m2t does not indicate if the transport stream contains HDV media.
841
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
Mixing Resolutions
You can mix SD resolutions and HD resolutions in the same Timeline with HDV as long as
they have compatible frame rates and raster sizes. See “HDV Compatibility Guidelines” on
page 849.
HDV Project Type Select to play back through Avid DNA hardware
842
Working with HDV
For more complete information on rendering and transcoding, see “Basics of Effects
Rendering” and “Using the Transcode Command” in the Help.
Outputting HDV
To send your edited HDV sequence back to an HDV device, you need to use a transport
stream. You can use an existing transport stream or create a new one. To create a digital cut
to go out to other devices, you need to first transcode the sequence.
Your Avid editing application uses a technique called long-GOP splicing when encoding an
HDV MPEG-2 sequence for export. When you export to an HDV device, the application
uses splicing to reconstruct only the edited sections of the media, such as cut points,
transitions, and segments that contain effects. Other areas of the sequence are copied intact.
The result is faster encoding at higher quality.
843
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
The Export to HDV Device dialog box lets you create a transport stream file. You cannot use
the standard Digital Cut tool to output HDV. You must use a IEEE 1394 port to output the
transport stream file back to the HDV device. You can export an entire sequence or the
marked section between IN and OUT points.
Create New Transport Stream Delete Transport Stream after Select to create a transport stream and then save
writing to HDV Device it. Not available if you use an existing transport
stream.
844
Working with HDV
5. Click OK.
The transport stream file is created (or saved, if you used an existing transport stream).
You can use Avid DNA hardware to output a sequence created with HDV media, but you
must transcode the sequence and then use the standard Digital Cut tool.
845
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
You can export an HDV transport stream for use in other applications.
You can also export to other formats, such as QuickTime movie, or use the Send To function
to send the sequence to an application such as Sorenson Squeeze. You can also export to
Windows Media 9 for finishing to HD-DVD.
Use the following samples as a guide when exporting an HDV sequence as Windows Media
for use on the Web or for use in DVD authoring:
846
Working with HDV
847
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
8. Click Save.
The sequence is exported using the selected settings.
The following procedure outlines the steps to take if you want to finish an HDV sequence on
an Avid DS Nitris system.
n To create an AFE file from an Avid editing product running on a Macintosh system, copy the
project folder from the Macintosh system to the Avid DS Nitris system. Then use MediaLog
on the Avid DS Nitris system to create the AFE file. For more information, see the
Avid DS Nitris Conform Guide.
848
Working with HDV
HDV Compatibility
849
Chapter 22 Working with HD Media
850
Chapter 23
International Character Support
This chapter describes how to take advantage of international character support (ICS) in
your Avid editing application.
ICS allows you to display and input characters in languages other than English by doing the
following:
• (Windows only) Install the local language operating system, and work within the
operating system.
• (Macintosh or Windows) Use the standard English language operating system, install
the language pack, and set the locale to your local language.
n Avid Unity™ MediaNetwork v3.2 or later and Avid Unity ISIS™ also support ICS. For more
information, see the MediaNetwork or Avid Unity ISIS documentation.
If you are using a language other than English, French, Italian, German, or Spanish, you
might need to adjust the mapping for the keyboard so the keys in the Keyboard palette match
the keys on your physical keyboard. See “Using Foreign Keyboard Mapping (Windows
Only)” on page 859.
Chapter 23 International Character Support
You need to specify the language in System Preferences and in the Get Info dialog box.
In System Preferences, you need to specify which language should appear in operating
system menus and dialog boxes. You can also add the language in which you want keyboard
layouts and input methods to function.
852
Choosing a Locale on an English Language Operating System (Windows and Macintosh)
2. In the Languages list, click the language you want, and drag it to the top of the list. If
you do not see the language you want in the list, click Edit, select the language, and
click OK.
3. (Option) Select other options in the Language and Format tabs.
4. Click the Close button.
n For more information about the International window, see Mac Help by clicking the question
mark icon in the window.
To add your language’s keyboard layout, input method, and character set palette to the
operating system’s Input menu (Flag icon):
1. Select Apple menu > System Preferences > International.
The International window opens to the Language tab.
853
Chapter 23 International Character Support
If you are attempting to enter text within your Avid editing application and you are not
seeing characters from your language, you need to specify the language in the application’s
Resources folder.
n You do not need to perform this procedure if all of your language’s characters appear
correctly in the Avid editing application.
854
Choosing a Locale on an English Language Operating System (Windows and Macintosh)
The next time you start the application, you can use the language character set that you
specified in the International window. System menus and dialog boxes appear in your
selected language. The Avid menus and buttons still appear in English, but you can now
enter characters in your selected language.
The Get Info dialog box makes use of files known as language resource files to specify the
language and regional code to use. The Avid software installation program automatically
installs a set of language resource files for supported languages. If the language resource file
that you want to use is not in this set, it might not be currently supported by this version of
the Avid software.
n The operating system does not need to be in the same language as that in which you
are typing.
855
Chapter 23 International Character Support
856
Choosing a Locale on an English Language Operating System (Windows and Macintosh)
Details button
6. Select the option you want in the Supplemental Language Support area.
857
Chapter 23 International Character Support
8. In the “Installed services” area in the Settings tab, select a language and a keyboard
layout for that language.
9. If the language you want is not in the list, click Add, select an input language and a
keyboard layout for the language, and then click OK.
10. If you need to install additional files, the Insert CD-ROM dialog box opens. Follow the
instructions and click OK.
11. In the “Default input language” area, select an input language.
n You have to select a language in the Installed Services area (step 8) before it appears in the
Default input Language list.
12. Click OK to close the “Text Services and Input Languages” dialog box.
13. Click the Advanced tab, and select your language in the “Language for non-Unicode
programs” area.
858
Choosing a Locale on an English Language Operating System (Windows and Macintosh)
14. 12. Click OK to close the Regional and Language Options dialog box.
A keyboard icon appears in the taskbar to allow you to switch keyboard layouts.
15. Restart the system.
The default Avid keyboard layouts for English, French, or German languages map correctly
to the characters on the physical keyboard. However, if you are using a different language,
the display in the Keyboard palette might not match your physical keyboard layout. You can
use the Foreign Keyboard Mapping button in the Keyboard palette to display the correct
character in the Keyboard palette.
n The Foreign Keyboard Mapping function is not needed for English, French, or German.
n Avid supports the international English keyboard for Spanish and Italian. The default
keyboard setting for Spanish and Italian is an English keyboard. If you use a Spanish or
Italian keyboard, use keyboard mapping to match the physical keyboard to the Keyboard
setting layout.
n Each language has a certain number of keys that do not map to functions in your Avid
editing application. These are referred to as “dead” keys. You cannot map functions to these
dead keys. If you try to do so, the system displays an error message.
n Within a workgroup, all the systems on the network must be either English or one specific
locale.
If you are working on a double-byte (two-byte) operating system, you should use single-
byte ASCII characters to name bins, projects, tapes, or other Avid elements. If you use
double-byte characters, the characters might appear with extra space between them and the
names might not be recognizable by other systems.
Operating systems that use a double-byte character system usually allow the user to choose
between single-byte ASCII or double-byte ASCII characters. If you have a choice, use
single-byte characters when entering ASCII text.
Do not use the Y-acute and Y-diaeresis characters. The system does not recognize the Y-
acute character, and it can cause problems with file recognition. The system might not
display the Y-diaeresis character correctly.
When you name a Mac OS X computer, use single-byte ASCII characters without spaces.
The system uses the name in .pmr files (in the OMFI MediaFiles folder), and non-ASCII
characters and spaces can cause problems with .pmr files.
860
Recommendations and Restrictions for International Character Support
If you plan to move projects between Macintosh and Windows systems, avoid using
characters that are not in both the MacRoman and Latin1 (ANSI) character sets. The
following two files on the Knowledge Base list the characters you should avoid:
• MacRoman Characters not in ANSI Encoding
• ANSI Characters not in MacRoman Encoding
To display the characters in the HTML files correctly, you might have to set your Web
browser to display characters in Unicode format.
It is common for customers that use EDLs to copy the EDL onto an RT-11 formatted floppy
disk. The RT-11 format has a very limited character set: A-Z (capital letters only), 0-9,
space, and $.
861
Chapter 23 International Character Support
n If you install the Avid editing application after you set up your system for international
character support, you should not need to rebuild the asifont.map file.
If you cannot display Chinese or Japanese characters in the Avid editor, you might need to
regenerate the asifont.map file under the Japanese or Chinese locale. Do one of the
following:
• Navigate to Program Files\Avid\application name and locate the asifont.map file. Delete
the file. Make sure you are in the Japanese or Chinese locale and start the application
again. The system automatically creates a new Japanese or Chinese asifont.map file.
• Uninstall the application. Then reinstall the application under the Japanese or Chinese
locale.
Note that the system uses the current locale to create the asifont.map file appropriate for that
locale.
862
Recommendations and Restrictions for International Character Support
n You can create a style or template for this kind of text box to make the titles easier to create.
• Files exported from a FIGS (French, Italian, German, or Spanish) OS might not display
correctly and might not import on an English OS. This problem might happen when you
export files with certain diacritical marks in the exported file name, such as a capital A,
I, or E with circumflex. The file appears and imports correctly on a FIGS OS but might
not appear correctly on an English OS. When you attempt to import the incorrectly
appearing file, the system displays the following error message:
“File: [File name and location] not found.”
followed by:
“EXCEPTION: SYS ERROR, status: 2, msg: The system cannot find the file specified.”
To work around this limitation, retype the file name (with the same diacritical marks if
desired) and then import it from the English OS.
• When using New Change input (Traditional Chinese), some combinations of keys
cannot be used to form Chinese characters. For example, R + Y and S + D cannot be
used to form Chinese characters in user, project, bin, clip, and sequence names.
Question marks result when the enter key is hit in order to execute that key combination.
(Other known non-functional combinations are R + J, F + U, Q + U + Q + U.)
• You might see problems with certain combinations of Japanese and Roman characters in
the user name. The following limitations apply to user names:
- Avoid mixing Roman and Chinese or Japanese characters in user names. The
system might generate error messages or extra user names with incorrect text
strings.
- Chinese and Japanese user names are not supported on Avid Unity Workgroups. If
you plan to be part of a workgroup environment, use Roman characters for user
names.
• When naming Avid elements, do not use fonts that have an “@” sign at the start of the
font name. These fonts are used when intending to display text vertically and, with
elements such as bin and clip names, might position letters or characters on their side.
863
Chapter 23 International Character Support
• When you are using diacritical marks, exporting a bin as AFE with the default name
might cause MediaLog to freeze. The resulting files have incorrect filenames.
To work around this limitation, avoid using the default name when exporting a file as
AFE, ALE, or Tab Delimited. Rename the file to be exported in the Export dialog box.
864
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
Index
Add Scene button (Script window) 299 converting shot log files with (Windows) 90
Add Scene/Page dialog box 299 Alias file format
Adding brief description of 736
bin columns 224 import specifications for 738
color indicators (Script window) 312 Align to Grid command (Bin menu) 223
comments during editing 346 Aligning columns in a bin 223
edits 372 Alpha channel
filler during trimming 386 adding to a graphics image 741
locators while editing 331 defined 738
memory mark 118 support in graphics formats 738
off-screen indicators (Script window) 311 Alpha channel, options in Import settings 694
page and scene numbers in the Script window 299 Ancillary data in HD media 586
script marks 313 Animation file formats
takes in the Script window 309 described 744
Adjusting Animation files
dupe detection handle lengths 376 importing 744
margins in the Script window 294 Anti-aliased images 741
offset between audio and video playback 328 Appearance Interface settings
pan, using an external fader or mixer 406 button shading style 58
take lines in the Script window 311 Archive to Videotape dialog box 279
video levels for tapes without color bars 154 Archiving, media files 277
volume, using an external fader or mixer 405 ASCII characters, in double-byte systems 860
adjustments 400 ASCII file format
Adrenaline importing Avid logs 109
using Command|8 with 407 ASCII text files
using Digi 002 with 407 importing to a Script window 291
Advanced keyframes Aspect Ratio options (Import settings) 694
Add Keyframe button commands 655 Assembling takes 805
Automatic Start and End Keyframes option 655 Attic folder
Indent Rows command 655 described 48
Large Text command 655 Audio
Real-Time Update option 655 adjusting volume while playing 400
Set Position To Keyframe command 655 and digital cuts 574
Show Add Keyframe Mode Menu command 655 creating leader 249
Sliders option 655 crossfading 634
Thumbwheels option 655 dissolves 634
Update Position While Playing command 655 editing workflow 398
AFE fading 634
exporting as 518 file formats (Audio Project settings) 627
AFE files input levels, adjusting 630, 630
described 529 input sources 630
exporting projects and bins 529 locked 627
AIFF-C file format mapping output channels 630
brief description of 745 Master volume 631
option in Audio Project settings 627 media for shoots 804
ALE (Avid Log Exchange) output options 627
converting shot log files with (Macintosh) 95 selecting mix modes 630
866
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
867
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
868
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
869
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
870
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
871
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
872
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
873
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
874
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
875
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
876
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
877
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
878
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
879
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
880
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
881
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
882
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
for checking system performance 346 Select Unreferenced Clips (Bin menu) 222
for viewing memory 49 Set Font (Edit menu) 60, 295
Menu commands Show All Takes (Script menu) 306
Add Comments (Clip Name menu) 346 Show Every Frame (Timeline Fast menu) 370
Align to Grid (Bin menu) 223 Show Frames (Script menu) 305
Audio EQ (Tools menu) 431 Show Track (Timeline Fast menu) 370
AutoSequence (Bin menu) 349 Unlock Bin Selection (Clip menu) 220
AutoSync (Bin menu) 349 View Type (Timeline Fast menu) 371
Calculator (Tools menu) 84 MetaSync
Calibrate (Peak Hold Menu button) 149 described 360
Capture Tools (Tools menu) 114 MetaSync information
Color (Script menu) 312 in Locators window 336
Console (Tools menu) 85, 86, 151 MII component video standard
Console (Tools menu) logging errors 85 unsupported 728, 728
Custom Sift (Bin menu) 215 Millivolts (mVolts) 720
Delete (Edit menu) columns 223 Mix Mode Selection 630
Delete Take (Script menu) 308 Mixer
Duplicate (Edit menu) 224, 618 adjusting pan with 406
Enlarge Frame (Edit menu) 304 adjusting volume with 405
Export (File menu) 529 connecting 418
Find (Edit menu) 301 described 402
Find Black Holes (Clip menu) 380 using 406, 416
Find Flash Frames (Clip menu) 380 using the Yamaha 01V and O1V/96 425
Get Bin Info (File menu) 86 Mixing
Get Position Info (File menu) 86 SD and HD material 835
Go To Page (Script menu) 301 video resolutions 766
Go To Scene (Script menu) 301 Mod Delay AudioSuite plug-ins 491
Group Clips (Bin menu) 590 Mode option (Remote Play and Capture settings) 715
Hardware (Tools menu) 87 Modify command
Home (Windows menu) 365 changing sequence format 832
Left Margin (Script menu) 294 Clip menu 231
Lock Bin Selection (Clip menu) 220 Modify Pulldown Phase dialog box 128
mapping 83 Modifying
New Deck Controller (Tools menu) 77 clip information before capturing 132
New Script (File menu) 291 clip information using the Modify command 231
Page Setup (File menu) 246 data in bin headings 227
Print Bin (File menu) 246 settings 617
Print Frame (File menu) 247 the pulldown phase after capturing 179
Print Timeline (File menu) 381 Monitor resolutions
Reduce Frame (Edit menu) 304 NTSC, PAL, HD 756
Remote Play and Capture (Clip menu) 175 Monitors
Remote Play and Capture (Special menu) 172, 173 displaying sequence information using 325
Reveal File (File menu) 268 ganging footage in 358
Save Bin (File menu) 47 Motion effects
Select Media Relatives (Bin menu) 221 rendering options 716
Select Offline Items (Bin menu) 221 Mouse Settings
Select Sources (Bin menu) 222 described 714
883
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
Moving N
bin columns 223
script marks 320 Naming tapes 113
slates in the Script window 307 Narration, recording voice-over 444, 444
Moving settings Network drives
between settings files 620 accessing from Console window 86
MPEG resolutions Network drives command 86
described 764 New Deck Controller command (Tools menu) 77
specifications New Script command (File menu) 291
storage requirements for 777 Next In Group button 601
Multi-angle View menus 604 Nine Split button 593, 597
MultiCamera Nine Split Source view 593, 597
editing 589 Non-Avid-controlled deck
Full-Monitor Display 593 logging with a 118
Nine Split Source view 593 Non-drop-frame timecode
Quad Split Source view 593 described 144
MultiCamera mode output 571
described 598 simultaneous output with drop-frame 572
Group menu 603 Non-English character support (Macintosh) 852
grouping 590 Non-English characters
linecut option 602 recommendations and restrictions 860
Multi-angle menus 604 using only one locale 860
MultiCamera Nine Split Edit 593 Non-English keyboard layout 855
MultiCamera Quad Split Edit 593 Non-square pixels 743
Nine Split Source view 597 Normalize AudioSuite plug-in 493
Quad Split Source view 595 NTSC (National Television System Committee)
selective cutting in 605 video
switching camera angles in 601 creating Avid log files for 109
techniques 601 transferring 24-fps film to 808
video quality 600 NTSC Has Setup option 139
Multicamera resolutions NTSC-EIAJ format
specifications 763 setting 139
Multigroup clips
creating 592 O
Multilevel sorting of columns 236
Multi-Tap Delay AudioSuite plug-in 492 Offline editing
mVolt (millivolt) units 720 detecting color-frame shifts during 378
MXF detecting duplicate frames during 374
Media Files tab 138 Offline items
Media Files Tab (Capture Settings dialog box) selecting in bins 221
641 Off-screen dialog
Panasonic P2 files 254 in the lined script 287
MXF file format indicating in the Script window 311
described 746 Off-screen indicators (script integration)
adding to takes 311
described 288
884
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
Offset between audio and video playback, adjusting wrting sequences to 266
328 Page and scene numbers (Script window)
Offset, DV Capture 163 adding 299
OMF changing 300
capturing media files 138 deleting 301
Media Files tab 138 searching for 301
Media Files tab (Capture Settings dialog box) 640 Page Setup command (File menu) 246
OMF Interchange files PAL (Phase Alternating Line) video
additional export options for 682 frames-per-second rates for transfers 130
described 523 transferring film to 812
exporting 525 PAL Method 1
import specifications 739, 746 described 813
methods for exporting 524 PAL Method 2
OMFI file format described 814
brief description of 736 Pan
One-light transfers 818 adjusting for individual keyframes 406
Opening Panasonic P2
shared projects 69 acquisition formats 254
the Script window 293 changing cards 260
Optical connection creating master clips 261
project settings 627 deleting clips 268
Orphans exporting sequences to 266
See Offline items files and folders 254
Output importing master clips 260, 260
audio 574, 627 loading drivers 256
change list 580 mounting cards 256
cut list 580 sharing clips and sequences 266
generating 561 support for 253
mapping audio channels 630 transferring files 258, 259
multiformat 568 updating drive list 256
optical 627 workflow 255
options 561 Parametric midrange in Audio EQtool 433
Output formats Passthrough Mix tool
for 24p and 25p projects 568 Audio Project Settings dialog box 630
Output Gain 630 using 146
Output timecodes Pasting
displaying in bins 237 text in the Script window 298
Overlap edits Patching
creating 383 when capturing to the Timeline 169
using extend edits 384 PCX file format
brief description of 736
import specifications for 739
P Phantom marks 344
P2 Phantom Marks options (Composer settings) 645
See Panasonic P2 Phonetic indexing
P2 card using to link clips with script 316
importing clips from 260, 260 Photo CD file format
885
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
886
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
887
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
888
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
889
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
890
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
891
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
892
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
893
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
894
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
Unlock Bin Selection command (Clip menu) 220 leader, using to maintain sync 354
Unlocking and locking Video compression
bin items 220 defined 755
Unreferenced clips Video Compression options (Export settings) 674
selecting in the bin 222 Video dailies method
Update Position While Playing command 655 defined 805
Updating Video decks
user profiles 43 See Decks
Usage information Video Display settings
viewing 50 described 726
USB-to-MIDI converter Video Input tool
configuring software 418 saving settings in 153
installing driver software (Macintosh) 419 Video Input Tool settings
installing driver software (Windows) 418 described 728
testing installation 419 Video levels
troubleshooting connections 421 adjusting without color bars 154
User Video Mixdown
selecting another 616 AAF export to Pro Tools 527
User interface Video output
customizing appearance 56 advanced calibration 561
User profiles Video Output tool
changing 43 advanced calibration controls 561
creating 43 Video Output Tool settings
deleting 43 described 729
described 41 HD tab 733
exporting 43 SD tab 729
importing 43 Video projects
updating 43 using script integration in 289
User settings Video quality
described 610 settings with multicamera and group clips 600
linking with workspaces 64 Video resolutions
selecting a user from 616 disabling 142
drive striping requirements 757
guidelines for use 755
V mixing 766
Varicam specifications 757
support for Panasonic camera 184 storage in minutes per gigabyte 768
VBI (Vertical Blanking Interval) 580, 732 storage requirements for 767
Vertical Blanking Interval Video test patterns 562
and effects 583 Videotape
and video quality 584 archiving media files with 277
line ranges in 581 capturing bars and tone from 248
preserving information 580, 732 guidelines for naming 113
VHS decks restoring media files from 282
limitations when capturing 152 View Name dialog box (bin) 214
Video View Type command (Timeline Fast menu) 371
creating leader 249 View, bin
895
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
896
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ Index
Y
Yamaha 01V and 01V/96 digital mixer
connecting 418
described 402
recording audio gain 406
setting up 425
YUV file format
additional Export options for 682
brief description of 737
import specifications for 741
897
Index ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
898
The following disclaimer is required by the Independent JPEG Group:
Portions of this software are based on the work of the Independent JPEG Group.
This Software may contain components licensed under the following conditions:
Copyright © 1989 The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms are permitted provided that the above copyright notice and this paragraph
are duplicated in all such forms and that any documentation, advertising materials, and other materials related to such
distribution and use acknowledge that the software was developed by the University of California, Berkeley. The name of the
University may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written
permission. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ``AS IS'' AND WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that copyright notice and this permission
notice appear in supporting documentation. This software is provided "as is" without express or implied warranty.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that copyright notice and this permission
notice appear in supporting documentation. This software is provided "as is" without express or implied warranty.
Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this software for any purpose is hereby granted without fee, provided that
the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
supporting documentation, and that the name of Daniel Dardailler not be used in advertising or publicity pertaining to
distribution of the software without specific, written prior permission. Daniel Dardailler makes no representations about the
suitability of this software for any purpose. It is provided "as is" without express or implied warranty.
Modifications Copyright 1999 Matt Koss, under the same license as above.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose without fee is hereby granted, provided that this
entire notice is included in all copies of any software which is or includes a copy or modification of this software and in all
copies of the supporting documentation for such software.
THIS SOFTWARE IS BEING PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY. IN PARTICULAR,
NEITHER THE AUTHOR NOR AT&T MAKES ANY REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND CONCERNING THE
MERCHANTABILITY OF THIS SOFTWARE OR ITS FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
This product includes software developed by the University of California, Berkeley and its contributors.
The following disclaimer is required by Interplay Entertainment Corp.:
The “Interplay” name is used with the permission of Interplay Entertainment Corp., which bears no responsibility for Avid
products.
This product includes portions of the Alloy Look & Feel software from Incors GmbH.
This product includes software developed by the Apache Software Foundation (http://www.apache.org/).
© DevelopMentor
This product may include the JCifs library, for which the following notice applies:
JCifs © Copyright 2004, The JCIFS Project, is licensed under LGPL (http://jcifs.samba.org/). See the LGPL.txt file in the Third
Party Software directory on the installation CD.
Avid Interplay contains components licensed from LavanTech. These components may only be used as part of and in
connection with Avid Interplay.
Manufactured under license from the Georgia Tech Research Corporation, U.S.A. Patent Pending.
899
900